Commonwealth Coat of Arms

Bankruptcy Act 1966

No. 33, 1966 as amended

Compilation start date:   24 June 2014

Includes amendments up to: Act No. 31, 2014

 

About this compilation

This compilation

This is a compilation of the Bankruptcy Act 1966 as in force on 24 June 2014. It includes any commenced amendment affecting the legislation to that date.

This compilation was prepared on 24 June 2014.

The notes at the end of this compilation (the endnotes) include information about amending laws and the amendment history of each amended provision.

Uncommenced amendments

The effect of uncommenced amendments is not reflected in the text of the compiled law but the text of the amendments is included in the endnotes.

Application, saving and transitional provisions and amendments

If the operation of a provision or amendment is affected by an application, saving or transitional provision that is not included in this compilation, details are included in the endnotes.

Modifications

If a provision of the compiled law is affected by a modification that is in force, details are included in the endnotes.

Provisions ceasing to have effect

If a provision of the compiled law has expired or otherwise ceased to have effect in accordance with a provision of the law, details are included in the endnotes.

 

 

 

Contents

Part I—Preliminary

1 Short title

2 Commencement

4 Repeal

Part IA—Interpretation

5 Interpretation

5A Acting in accordance with a person’s directions or instructions

5B Associated entities: companies

5C Associated entities: natural persons

5D Associated entities: partnerships

5E Associated entities: trusts

5F Controlling an entity in relation to a matter

5G Financial affairs of a company

5H Financial affairs of a natural person

5J Financial affairs of a partnership

5K Financial affairs of a trust

6 Meaning of intent to defraud creditors

6A Statement of affairs for purposes other than Part XI

6B Provision of statement of affairs under Part XI and statement of administration of estate of deceased person

6C Interpretive provisions relating to proceeds of crime orders

Part IB—Application of Act

7 Application of Act

7A Application of the Criminal Code

8 Act to bind the Crown

9 Laws of States and Territories not affected by Act

Part II—Administration

Division 1—General

10 Delegation by Minister or Secretary

11 InspectorGeneral in Bankruptcy

12 Functions of InspectorGeneral

15 Official Receivers

16 Appointment of InspectorGeneral and Official Receivers

17 Acting InspectorGeneral and Acting Official Receivers

17B Arrangements for services of State and Northern Territory Magistrates

18 The Official Trustee in Bankruptcy

18AA Commonwealth Authorities and Companies Act 1997 does not apply to Official Trustee

18A Liability of the Official Trustee

19 Duties etc. of trustee

19AA Power of investigation of bankrupt’s affairs

19A Liability of InspectorGeneral, Official Receivers etc.

Division 2—Common Investment Fund

20A Interpretation

20B The Common Investment Fund

20D Investment of money in Common Fund

20E Borrowing for the Common Fund

20F Moneys in Common Fund not held on account of particular estates etc.

20G Common Investment Fund Equalization Account

20H Credits to and debits from the Equalization Account

20J Interest on moneys in Common Fund payable only in certain circumstances

Part III—Courts

Division 2—Jurisdiction and powers of courts in bankruptcy

27 Bankruptcy courts

29 Courts to help each other

30 General powers of Courts in bankruptcy

31 Exercise of jurisdiction

32 Costs

33 Adjournment, amendment of process and extension and abridgment of times

33A Alteration of filing date for statement of affairs

34 Orders and commissions for examination of witnesses

34A Standard of proof

35 Family Court’s jurisdiction in bankruptcy where trustee is a party to property settlement or spousal maintenance proceedings etc.

35A Transfer of proceedings to Family Court

35B Family Court of Western Australia

36 Enforcement of orders etc.

37 Power of Court to rescind orders etc.

Part IV—Proceedings in connexion with bankruptcy

Division 1—Acts of bankruptcy

40 Acts of bankruptcy

41 Bankruptcy notices

42 Payment etc. of debt to Commonwealth or State after service of bankruptcy notice

Division 2—Creditors’ petitions

43 Jurisdiction to make sequestration orders

44 Conditions on which creditor may petition

45 Creditor’s petition against partnership

46 Petition against 2 or more joint debtors

47 Requirements as to creditor’s petition

49 Change of petitioners

50 Taking control of debtor’s property before sequestration

51 Costs of prosecuting creditor’s petition

52 Proceedings and order on creditor’s petition

53 Consolidation of proceedings

54 Bankrupt’s statement of affairs

Division 2A—Declaration of intention to present debtor’s petition

54A Presentation of declaration

54B When debtor disqualified from presenting declaration

54C Acceptance or rejection of declaration

54D Official Receiver to give information to debtor

54E Enforcement suspended during stay period

54F Duties of sheriff

54G Duty of court registrar

54H Duties of person entitled to deduct money owing to declared debtor

54J Extension of time where this Division prevents the doing of an act

54K Section 33 not to apply to this Division

54L Secured creditor’s rights under security not affected

Division 3—Debtors’ petitions

55 Debtor’s petition

56A Persons who may present a debtor’s petition against a partnership

56B Presentation of a debtor’s petition against a partnership

56C Referral to the Court of a debtor’s petition against a partnership

56D Acceptance of a debtor’s petition against a partnership by the Official Receiver

56E Effects of acceptance of a debtor’s petition against a partnership

56F Extra duties of nonpetitioning partners who become bankrupts

56G Inspection of statements of affairs of partners and partnerships

57 Debtor’s petition by joint debtors who are not partners

57A Time at which person becomes bankrupt on debtor’s petition

Division 4—Effect of bankruptcy on property and proceedings

58 Vesting of property upon bankruptcy—general rule

58A Vesting of property upon bankruptcy—effect of orders in force under the proceeds of crime law

59 Second or subsequent bankruptcy

59A Orders under Part VIII or VIIIAB of the Family Law Act 1975

60 Stay of legal proceedings

61 Actions by bankrupt partner’s trustee

62 Actions on joint contracts

63 Death of bankrupt

Division 5—Meetings of creditors

Subdivision A—Preliminary

63A Definitions

63B Trustee’s representative

Subdivision B—Convening of meetings

64 Trustee to convene meetings

64A Persons to whom notice of meeting to be given

64B Certain matters to be included in notice of meeting

64C If telephone conference facilities are available

64D Statement by creditor as to amount of debt

64E Notice about voting by proxy

64F Notice about appointment of attorney

64G Agenda to be set out in notice of meeting

Subdivision C—Procedure before opening of meeting

64H Creditors, or proxies or attorneys, participating by telephone

64J Preparation of attendance record

Subdivision D—Procedure at meetings

64K Opening of meeting

64L Appointment of minutes secretary

64M Announcement of proxies and attorneys

64N Quorum

64P Election of person to preside at meeting

64Q Whether holding of meeting is convenient to majority of creditors

64R Tabling of bankrupt’s statement of affairs

64S Statements and questions

64T Motions

64U Remuneration of registered trustee

64V Appointment of committee of inspection

64W Other business

64X Next meeting

Subdivision E—Miscellaneous

64Y Adjournment of meeting

64Z Duties of minutes secretary

64ZA Entitlement to vote

64ZB Manner of voting

64ZBA Creditors’ resolution without meeting

64ZC Appointment of proxies

64ZD Provisions relating to motions and amendments of motions

64ZE Joint bankruptcies

64ZF Substantial compliance to be sufficient

Division 5A—Committee of inspection

70 Committee of inspection

71 Vacation of office etc.

72 Member of committee not to purchase part of estate

Division 6—Composition or arrangement with creditors

73 Composition or arrangement

73A Trustee may require surety for cost of meeting

73B Declaration of relationships by proposed trustee of composition or scheme of arrangement

73C Statement of affairs and declarations of relationships to be tabled at meeting

74 Annulment of bankruptcy

74A Variation of composition or scheme of arrangement

75 Effect of composition or scheme of arrangement

76 Application of Part VIII to trustee of a composition or arrangement

76A Meetings of creditors

76B Setting aside and termination of a composition or scheme of arrangement

Part V—Control over person and property of debtors and bankrupts

Division 1—General

77 Duties of bankrupt as to discovery etc. of property

77AA Access by Official Receiver and others to premises

77A Access by trustee to books of associated entity

77C Power of Official Receiver to obtain information and evidence

77CA Power of Official Receiver to obtain statement of affairs

77D Allowances and expenses in respect of attendance

77E Advance on account of allowances and expenses

77F Allowances and expenses to be paid out of bankrupt’s estate

78 Arrest of debtor or bankrupt

80 Notification of change in name, address or daytime telephone number

81 Discovery of bankrupt’s property etc.

Division 2—Offshore information notices

81A Issue of notices

81B Extension of period of notice

81C Variation of notices

81D Withdrawal of notices

81E Notices may be included in same document

81F Relationship between this Division and section 77C

Division 3—Failure to comply with certain notices

81G Effect of noncompliance with notice

Part VI—Administration of property

Division 1—Proof of debts

82 Debts provable in bankruptcy

83 Debt not to be considered proved until admitted

84 Manner of proving debts

85 Proof by employees

86 Mutual credit and setoff

87 Deduction of discounts

88 Apportionment to principal and interest of payments made before bankruptcy

89 Apportionment where security realized before or after bankruptcy

90 Proof of debt by secured creditor

91 Redemption of security by trustee etc.

92 Amendment of valuation

93 Repayment of excess

94 Subsequent realization of security

95 Proof in respect of distinct contracts

96 Proof in respect of proportionate part of periodical payment

97 Production of bills of exchange and promissory notes

98 Amendment of proof of debt

100 Costs of proving debts etc.

101 Inspection of proofs by creditors etc.

102 Admission or rejection of proofs

103 Debts to be rounded down to nearest dollar

104 Appeal against decision of trustee in respect of proof

105 Costs of appeal

106 Trustee may administer oaths etc.

107 Creditor not to receive more than the amount of his or her debt and interest

Division 2—Order of payment of debts

Subdivision A—General

108 Debts proved to rank equally except as otherwise provided

109 Priority payments

109A Debts due to employees

110 Application of estates of joint debtors

113 Apprenticeship etc. claims

114 Payment of liabilities etc. incurred under terminated deed etc.

Subdivision B—The effect of proceeds of crime orders and applications for proceeds of crime orders

114A The effect of proceeds of crime orders

114B The effect of applications for proceeds of crime orders

114C Director of Public Prosecutions or Commissioner of the Australian Federal Police must notify the trustee of certain matters

Division 3—Property available for payment of debts

Subdivision A—General

115 Commencement of bankruptcy

116 Property divisible among creditors

117 Policies of insurance against liabilities to third parties

118 Execution by creditor against property of debtor who becomes a bankrupt etc.

119 Duties of sheriff after receiving notice of presentation of petition etc.

119A Duties of sheriff after receiving notice of bankruptcy etc.

120 Undervalued transactions

121 Transfers to defeat creditors

121A Transactions where consideration given to a third party

122 Avoidance of preferences

123 Protection of certain transfers of property against relation back etc.

124 Protection of certain payments to bankrupt etc.

125 Certain accounts of undischarged bankrupt

126 Dealings with undischarged bankrupt in respect of afteracquired property

127 Limitation of time for making claims by trustee etc.

128 Notice to trustee where identity of vendor etc. with bankrupt in doubt

Subdivision B—Superannuation contributions

128A Simplified outline

128B Superannuation contributions made to defeat creditors—contributor is a person who later becomes a bankrupt

128C Superannuation contributions made to defeat creditors—contributor is a third party

128D Time for making claims by trustee

128E Superannuation accountfreezing notice

128F Revocation of superannuation accountfreezing notice

128G Copy of superannuation accountfreezing notice to be given to trustee etc.

128H Consent of Official Receiver to the cashing etc. of a superannuation interest

128J Power of Court to set aside superannuation accountfreezing notice

128K Judicial enforcement of superannuation accountfreezing notices

128L Protection of trustee of eligible superannuation plan

128M References to a member of an eligible superannuation plan

128N Definitions

Division 4—Realization of property

129 Trustee to take possession of property of bankrupt

129AA Time limit for realising property

129A Eligible judges

130 Warrant for seizure of property connected with the bankrupt

132 Vesting and transfer of property

133 Disclaimer of onerous property

134 Powers exercisable at discretion of trustee

136 Right to pay off mortgages

137 Right of trustee to inspect goods held as security

138 Limitation of trustee’s power in respect of copyright, patents etc.

139 Protection of trustee from personal liability in certain cases

Division 4A—Orders in relation to property of entity controlled by bankrupt or from which bankrupt derived a benefit

139A Trustee may apply to Court

139B Application to be served on respondent entity

139C Who may appear at hearing

139CA Definition of examinable period

139D Order relating to property of entity other than a natural person

139DA Order relating to property of natural person

139E Order relating to net worth of entity other than a natural person

139EA Order relating to increase in value of property of natural person

139F Court to take account of interests of other persons

139G Giving effect to orders under this Division

139H Entity entitled to claim in bankruptcy

Division 4B—Contribution by bankrupt and recovery of property

Subdivision A—Preliminary

139J Objects of Division

Subdivision B—Interpretation

139K Definitions

Subdivision C—Income

139L Meaning of income

139M Derivation of income

139N Income varied by income tax payments and refunds and child support payments

Subdivision D—Liability of bankrupt to pay contributions

139P Liability of bankrupt to pay contribution

139Q Change in liability of bankrupt

139R Liability not affected by subsequent discharge

139S Contribution payable by bankrupt

139T Determination of higher income threshold in cases of hardship

Subdivision E—Provision of information to trustee

139U Bankrupt to provide evidence of income

139V Power of trustee to require bankrupt to provide additional evidence

Subdivision F—Assessments of income and contribution

139W Assessment of bankrupt’s income and contribution

139WA No time limit on making assessment

139X Basis of assessments

139Y Trustee may regard bankrupt as receiving reasonable remuneration

139Z If bankrupt claims not to be in receipt of income

Subdivision G—Review of assessment

139ZA Internal review of assessment

139ZC InspectorGeneral may request further information

139ZD Decision on review

139ZE InspectorGeneral to notify bankrupt and trustee of decision

139ZF Review of assessment decisions

Subdivision H—When contribution payable

139ZG Payment of contribution

139ZH If excess contribution paid

139ZI Notice of determinations

Subdivision HA—Supervised account regime

139ZIA Objects

139ZIB Definitions

139ZIC Trustee may determine that the supervised account regime applies to the bankrupt

139ZID Revocation of determination

139ZIDA When determination ceases to be in force

139ZIE Bankrupt must open and maintain supervised account

139ZIEA New supervised account

139ZIF Bankrupt’s monetary income to be deposited to supervised account

139ZIG Trustee to supervise withdrawals from supervised account

139ZIH Constructive income receipt arrangements

139ZIHA Nonmonetary income receipt arrangements

139ZII Cash income

139ZIIA Keeping of books

139ZIJ Injunctions

139ZIK Interim injunctions

139ZIL Discharge etc. of injunctions

139ZIM Certain limits on granting injunctions not to apply

139ZIN Other powers of the Court unaffected

139ZIO InspectorGeneral may review trustee’s decision

139ZIP InspectorGeneral may request further information

139ZIR InspectorGeneral’s decision on review

139ZIS InspectorGeneral to notify bankrupt and trustee of decision

139ZIT AAT review of decisions

Subdivision I—Collection of money or property by Official Receiver from person other than the bankrupt

139ZJ Definition

139ZK Persons to whom Subdivision applies

139ZL Official Receiver may require persons to make payments

139ZM Power of Court to set aside notice

139ZN Charge over property

139ZO Failure to comply with notice

139ZP Employer not to dismiss or injure bankrupt because of giving of notice

Subdivision J—Collection of money or property by Official Receiver from party to transaction that is void against the trustee

139ZQ Official Receiver may require payment

139ZR Charge over property

139ZS Power of Court to set aside notice

139ZT Failure to comply with notice

Subdivision K—Rolledover superannuation interests etc.

139ZU Order relating to rolledover superannuation interests etc.

139ZV Enforcement of order

139ZW Definitions

Division 5—Distribution of property

140 Declaration and distribution of dividends

141 Joint and separate dividends

142 Apportionment of expenses of administration of joint and separate estates

143 Provision to be made for creditors residing at a distance etc.

144 Right of creditor who has not proved debt before declaration of dividend

145 Final dividend

146 Distribution of dividends where bankrupt fails to file statement of affairs

147 No action for dividend

Part VII—Discharge and annulment

Division 1—Preliminary

148 Misleading conduct by bankrupt

Division 2—Discharge by operation of law

Subdivision A—Discharge after certain period

149 Automatic discharge

149A Bankruptcy extended when objection made

Subdivision B—Objections

149B Objection to discharge

149C Form of notice of objection

149D Grounds of objection

149F Copy of notice of objection to be given to bankrupt

149G Date of effect of objection

149H Trustee ceasing to object on some grounds

149J Withdrawal of objection

Subdivision C—Review of objection

149K Internal review of objection

149M InspectorGeneral may request further information

149N Decision on review

149P InspectorGeneral to notify bankrupt and trustee of decision

149Q Review of decisions

Division 4—Provisions applicable to all discharges

152 Discharged bankrupt to give assistance

153 Effect of discharge

Division 5—Annulment of bankruptcy

153A Annulment on payment of debts

153B Annulment by Court

154 Effect of annulment

Part VIII—Trustees

Division 1—Appointment and official name

154A Application to become a registered trustee

155 Processing of an application

155A Committee’s decision on an application

155B Effect of committee’s decision

155C Registration as a trustee

155D Extension of registration

155E Application for change of conditions on practising as a registered trustee

155F Decision on application for change of conditions

155G Voluntary termination of registration

155H Consideration of involuntary termination of registration

155I Decision on involuntary termination of registration

155J After termination of registration

155K Payment of fees etc. for application, registration and extension

156A Consent to act as trustee

157 Appointment of trustees

158 Appointment of more than one trustee etc.

159 Vacancy in office of trustee

160 Official Trustee to be trustee when no registered trustee is trustee

161 Trustee may act in official name

161A Registered trustee to notify InspectorGeneral of certain events

Division 2—Remuneration and costs

161B Trustee’s remuneration—minimum entitlement

162 Trustee’s remuneration—general

163 Remuneration of the Official Trustee

163A Costs and expenses of Official Receiver

164 Two or more trustees acting in succession

165 Trustee not to accept extra benefit etc.

166 Payment to third parties

167 Review of remuneration etc.

Division 3—Accounts and audits

168 Trustee not to pay moneys into private account

169 Trustee to pay moneys into bank account

170 Trustee to give Official Receiver and bankrupt information etc.

170A Annual return

171 Trustee to give and obtain receipts

173 Books to be kept by trustee

174 Trustee’s books when trading

175 Audit of trustee’s accounts

176 Court may order trustee to make good loss caused by breach of duty

Division 4—Control over trustees

177 Control of creditors over trustees

178 Appeal to Court against trustee’s decision etc.

179 Control of trustees by the Court

Division 5—Vacation of office

180 Resignation of trustee

181 Removal of trustee

181A Streamlined method for replacing trustee

182 Bankruptcy of trustee etc.

183 Release of registered trustee by the Court

184 Release of registered trustee by operation of law after 7 years

184A Release of the Official Trustee

Part IX—Debt agreements

Division 1—Introduction

185 Definitions

Division 2—Debt agreement proposals

185C Giving a debt agreement proposal to the Official Receiver

185D Statement of affairs to be given with a debt agreement proposal

185E Accepting a debt agreement proposal for processing

185EA Processing of debt agreement proposal

185EB Inspection of creditor’s statement

185EC Acceptance of a debt agreement proposal

185ED Cancellation of acceptance of debt agreement proposal for processing

185F Effect of accepting a debt agreement proposal for processing

185G Lapsing of a debt agreement proposal

Division 3—Making a debt agreement

185H Making a debt agreement

185I Parties to a debt agreement

185K Prevention of proceedings relating to debts

Division 3A—Duties of administrators

185LA Duties of an administrator—general

185LB Administrator to notify creditors of a 3month arrears default by a debtor

185LC Administrator to notify Official Receiver of a designated 6month arrears default by a debtor

185LD Administrator to maintain separate bank account

185LE Administrator to keep accounts etc.

185LEA Annual return

185LF Succession of administrator

185LG Duties of an administrator in relation to debt agreements—extended meaning

Division 4—Varying a debt agreement

185M Varying a debt agreement

185MA Procedures for dealing with proposals to vary debt agreements

185MB Inspection of creditor’s statement

185MC Acceptance of a proposal to vary a debt agreement

185MD Withdrawal of proposal to vary a debt agreement

Division 5—Ending a debt agreement

185N End of debt agreement on discharge of obligations under agreement

185NA Release of debtor from debts

185P Terminating a debt agreement by accepting a proposal

185PA Procedures for dealing with proposals to terminate debt agreements

185PB Inspection of creditor’s statement

185PC Acceptance of a proposal to terminate a debt agreement

185PD Withdrawal of proposal to terminate a debt agreement

185Q Terminating a debt agreement by order of the Court

185QA Terminating a debt agreement—designated 6month arrears default

185R Terminating a debt agreement by the bankruptcy of the debtor

185S Validity of things done under a debt agreement that was terminated

Division 6—Voiding a debt agreement

185T Applying for an order declaring a debt agreement void

185U Making an order declaring a debt agreement void

185V Validity of things done under a debt agreement that was declared void

Division 7—General provisions relating to debt agreements

185W Court directions to the Official Receiver

185X No stamp duty payable on a debt agreement

185XA Secured creditors

185Y Money received by administrator to be held on trust

185Z Remuneration of administrator

185ZA Notification of death of administrator

185ZB Official Trustee to replace an administrator who dies etc.

185ZC Official Receiver may appoint a new administrator

185ZCA Court may order administrator to make good loss caused by breach of duty

185ZCB Control of administrators by the Court

185ZD Remuneration of administrator

Division 8—Registration of debt agreement administrators etc.

Subdivision A—Introduction

186A Basic eligibility test

Subdivision B—Registration of debt agreement administrators

186B Application for registration as a debt agreement administrator

186C InspectorGeneral must approve or refuse to approve registration application

186D Registration as a debt agreement administrator

186E Duration of registration as a debt agreement administrator

186F Conditions of registration—general

186G Condition of registration—companies

186H Application to change or remove registration conditions

Subdivision C—Surrender and cancellation of registration as a debt agreement administrator

186J Surrender of registration as a debt agreement administrator

186K Cancellation of an individual’s registration as a debt agreement administrator

186L Cancellation of a company’s registration as a debt agreement administrator

186LA InspectorGeneral may obtain information about debt agreement administration trust accounts

186LB Accountfreezing notices—debt agreement administration trust accounts

186LC Power of court to set aside accountfreezing notices

186LD Judicial enforcement of accountfreezing notices

186LE Protection of bank

Subdivision D—Ineligibility of a person to act as a debt agreement administrator

186M InspectorGeneral may declare a person ineligible to act as an administrator

Subdivision E—Miscellaneous

186N Return of certificate of registration

186P Cessation of registration as a debt agreement administrator—no refund of fees

186Q Guidelines relating to InspectorGeneral’s powers

Part X—Personal insolvency agreements

Division 1—Interpretation

187 Interpretation

187A Application of Part to joint debtors

Division 2—Meeting of creditors and control of debtor’s property

188 Debtor may authorise trustee or solicitor to be controlling trustee

188A Personal insolvency agreement

188B Inspection of statement of debtor’s affairs

189 Control of property of a debtor who has given authority under section 188

189AAA Stay of proceedings relating to creditor’s petition until meeting of debtor’s creditors

189AA Court orders with effect during period of control of debtor’s property

189AB Charge over debtor’s property that is subject to control

189AC Right of indemnity for controlling trustee

189A Report and declaration by controlling trustee

189B Controlling trustee to prepare statement about possible resolutions

190 Duties and powers of controlling trustee

190A Additional duties of controlling trustee

191 Payments to protect property etc.

192 Changing the controlling trustee

194 Time for calling meeting

194A Statement of affairs and declarations of relationships to be tabled at meeting

195 Debtor to attend meeting

196 Procedure for calling and holding meeting

204 Resolution for personal insolvency agreement

205 Duties of sheriff after receiving notice of signing of authority under section 188 etc.

205A Duties of sheriff after receiving notice of execution of personal insolvency agreement etc.

206 Court may adjourn hearing of petition where creditors have passed resolution for personal insolvency agreement

207 Surrender of security etc. where secured creditor has voted

208 Termination of control of debtor’s property by the Court

209 Acts of controlling trustee to bind trustee of subsequent personal insolvency agreement or bankruptcy

210 Other provisions about controlling trustee

211 Other provisions about debtor

Division 3—General provisions

215 Eligibility to be trustee of personal insolvency agreement

215A Nomination or appointment of trustee of personal insolvency agreement

216 Execution of personal insolvency agreements

217 Failure of trustee to execute personal insolvency agreement

218 Notice of execution of personal insolvency agreement

219 Trustee may sue, be sued etc. by official name

220 Filling of vacancy in office of trustee after execution of personal insolvency agreement etc.

221 Sequestration order where debtor fails to attend meeting, execute personal insolvency agreement etc.

221A Variation of personal insolvency agreement

222 Court may set aside personal insolvency agreement

222A Termination of personal insolvency agreement by trustee

222B Termination of personal insolvency agreement by creditors

222C Court may terminate personal insolvency agreement

222D Termination of personal insolvency agreement by occurrence of terminating event

223 Calling of meetings after the first meeting

223A Rules in relation to meetings

224 Validity of acts if personal insolvency agreement set aside or terminated

224A Notice that a personal insolvency agreement has been set aside, varied or terminated

225 Evidence of personal insolvency agreement, resolution etc.

226 Creditor may inspect personal insolvency agreement etc.

227 Stamp duty not payable on personal insolvency agreements etc. entered into under this Part

229 Personal insolvency agreement to bind all creditors

230 Release of provable debts

231 Application of general provisions of Act to personal insolvency agreements

231A Right of debtor to remaining property

232 Certificate relating to discharge of obligations

Part XI—Administration of estates of deceased persons in bankruptcy

244 Administration of estates under this Part upon petition by creditor

245 Debtor dying after presentation of creditor’s petition

246 Statement of deceased debtor’s affairs etc. by legal personal representative

247 Petition for administration under this Part by person administering deceased person’s estate

247A Commencement of administration under Part

248 Application of Act in relation to administrations under this Part

248A Consolidation of proceedings

249 Vesting of property on making of order

249A Charge over property owned in joint tenancy

250 Effect of order under Part where deceased person was bankrupt

251 Real property devised by will that vests directly in devisee to form part of estate in certain cases

252 Liability of legal personal representative

252A Annulment on payment of debts

252B Annulment by Court

252C Effect of annulment

Part XIA—Farmers’ debts assistance

253A Interpretation

253B Law of State or Territory may be proclaimed

253C Notice about stay under proclaimed law

253E Relevant authority may apply for stay of proceedings under certain petitions

253F Relevant authority may be heard on application relating to debtor’s petition

Part XII—Unclaimed dividends or moneys

254 Payment of unclaimed moneys to the Commonwealth

Part XIII—Evidence

255 Record of proceedings or evidence

256 Evidence of matters stated in notices published in Gazette

257 Evidence of proceedings at meetings of creditors or committee of inspection

258 Presumption about due convening of meetings etc.

262 Swearing of affidavits

Part XIV—Offences

263 Concealment etc. of property etc.

263A False affidavits

263C False claims about a creditor’s entitlement to vote

264A Failure of person to attend before the Court etc.

264B Arrest of person failing to attend before the Court etc.

264C Refusal to be sworn or give evidence etc.

264D Prevarication or evasion in the course of examination

264E Offences in relation to Registrar or magistrate conducting an examination

265 Failure of bankrupt or debtor to disclose property etc.

265A Offences relating to exercise of powers under section 77A or 130

266 Disposing or charging of property by person who becomes, or has become, a bankrupt

267 False declaration by debtor or bankrupt

267B Failure of person to provide information

267D Failure of person to attend

267E Arrest of person failing to attend before Official Receiver or authorised officer

267F Refusal to be sworn or give evidence etc.

267G Prevarication or evasion in the course of giving evidence

268 Offences in relation to personal insolvency agreements

269 Bankrupt or debtor who is a party to a debt agreement obtaining credit etc. without disclosing bankruptcy or debt agreement

270 Failure to keep proper books of account

271 Gambling or hazardous speculations

272 Leaving Australia with intent to defeat creditors etc.

273 Trial of offences

275 Criminal liability not affected by discharge etc.

276 Trustee acting under a personal insolvency agreement that has been set aside

277 Punishment of contempt of court

277A Keeping of books in respect of period of bankruptcy

277B Infringement notices for offences

Part XV—Provisions relating to the Bankruptcy (Estate Charges) Act 1997

278 Interpretation

279 Administration of, and powers and functions in relation to, the Charges Acts

280 Deferred payment of interest charge or realisations charge

281 Late payment penalty—interest charge and realisations charge

282 Extension of time for payment—interest charge and realisations charge

283 Remission of interest charge, realisations charge and late payment penalty

284 Recovery of interest charge, realisations charge and late payment penalty

285 Payments by cheque or payment order

286 Regulations may deal with other matters

Part XVI—Miscellaneous

301 Certain provisions in contracts etc. to be void

302 Certain provisions in bills of sale etc. to be void

302A Certain provisions in governing rules of superannuation funds and approved deposit funds to be void

302AB Certain provisions in RSA’s terms and conditions to be void

302B Certain provisions in trust deeds void

303 Applications to Court

304 Parts of dollar to be disregarded in determining majority in value of creditors etc.

304A Indexation

305 Payment of expenses by Commonwealth

306 Formal defect not to invalidate proceedings

306A Protection of Registrars, magistrates etc. in relation to examinations

306B Protection in respect of reports

307 Proceedings in firm name

308 Representation of corporation etc.

309 Service of notices etc.

311 Stamp duty not payable on trustee’s cheques or receipts

312 Return or destruction of old accounts and records

313 Audit of accounts and records of the Official Trustee and the Official Receivers

315 Regulations

316 Legislative instruments determining fees

Schedule 1—Acts repealed

Endnotes

Endnote 1—About the endnotes

Endnote 2—Abbreviation key

Endnote 3—Legislation history

Endnote 4—Amendment history

Endnote 5—Uncommenced amendments [none]

Endnote 6—Modifications

Bankruptcy Regulations 1996 (No. 263, 1996)

Endnote 7—Misdescribed amendments [none]

Endnote 8—Miscellaneous [none]

An Act relating to Bankruptcy

Part IPreliminary

 

1  Short title

  This Act may be cited as the Bankruptcy Act 1966.

2  Commencement

  This Act shall come into operation on a date to be fixed by Proclamation.

4  Repeal

 (1) The Acts specified in Schedule 1 are repealed.

 (2) Notwithstanding the repeal of the Bankruptcy Act 1958 or the Bankruptcy Act 1959 effected by subsection (1) of this section:

 (a) the provisions of section 7 of the Bankruptcy Act 1958, as amended by the Bankruptcy Act 1959, continue to apply to a purported extension of time or a purported fixing of a time to which those provisions applied immediately before the commencement of this Act; and

 (b) the provisions of section 5 of the Bankruptcy Act 1959 continue to apply to a seal or stamp to which those provisions applied immediately before the commencement of this Act;

as if those Acts had not been repealed.

Part IAInterpretation

 

5  Interpretation

 (1) In this Act, unless the contrary intention appears:

ADI (authorised deposittaking institution) means:

 (a) a body corporate that is an ADI for the purposes of the Banking Act 1959; or

 (b) the Reserve Bank of Australia; or

 (c) any other bank approved in writing for the purposes of this definition:

 (i) by the Treasurer; or

 (ii) by a person authorised in writing by the Treasurer to give approvals for the purposes of this definition.

administrator, in relation to a debt agreement, means the person:

 (a) authorised by the agreement to deal with property under the agreement; or

 (b) who becomes the replacement administrator under section 185ZB; or

 (c) appointed by an Official Receiver under section 185ZC.

affidavit includes affirmation and statutory declaration.

approved form means an electronic or other form approved, in writing, by the InspectorGeneral.

associated entity, in relation to a person, means:

 (a) an entity (other than a company) that is, or has been, associated with the person; or

 (b) a company that is, or has been, associated with the person at a time when the company is, or was, as the case may be, a private company.

authorised employee means an APS employee whose duties include either or both of the following:

 (a) supporting the InspectorGeneral in the performance of his or her functions, or in the exercise of his or her powers, under this Act;

 (b) supporting the Official Receivers in the performance of their functions, or in the exercise of their powers, under this Act.

available act of bankruptcy, in relation to a debtor, means an act of bankruptcy available for a petition against the debtor at the date of the presentation of the petition on which, or by virtue of the presentation of which, the debtor becomes a bankrupt.

bankrupt means a person:

 (a) against whose estate a sequestration order has been made; or

 (b) who has become a bankrupt by virtue of the presentation of a debtor’s petition.

bankruptcy, in relation to jurisdiction or proceedings, means any jurisdiction or proceedings under or by virtue of this Act.

books includes any account, deed, paper, writing or document and any record of information however compiled, recorded or stored, whether in writing, on microfilm, by electronic process or otherwise.

breach of duty means malfeasance, misfeasance, negligence, wilful default or breach of trust.

child: without limiting who is a child of a person for the purposes of this Act, each of the following is the child of a person:

 (a) an adopted child, stepchild or exnuptial child of the person;

 (b) someone who is a child of the person within the meaning of the Family Law Act 1975.

close relative, in relation to a person, means a spouse, de facto partner, parent, child, brother, sister, halfbrother, or halfsister, of the person.

Commonwealth proceeds of crime authority means a proceeds of crime authority within the meaning of the Proceeds of Crime Act 2002.

Note: Under that Act, the proceeds of crime authority is either the Commissioner of the Australian Federal Police or the Director of Public Prosecutions (see the definition of proceeds of crime authority in section 338 of that Act). Responsibility can be transferred between these authorities (see section 315B of that Act).

company means a corporation, other than a corporation that is incorporated within Australia or an external Territory and is:

 (a) a public authority; or

 (b) an instrumentality or agency of the Crown in right of the Commonwealth, in right of a State or in right of a Territory of the Commonwealth.

company officer, in relation to a corporation, includes:

 (a) a director or secretary of the corporation;

 (b) a receiver and manager of property of the corporation appointed under a power contained in an instrument;

 (ba) an administrator, within the meaning of the Corporations Act 2001, of the corporation;

 (bb) an administrator of a deed of company arrangement executed by the corporation under Part 5.3A of that Act;

 (d) a liquidator of the corporation appointed in a voluntary winding up of the corporation; and

 (e) a trustee or other person administering a compromise or arrangement made between the corporation and another person or other persons;

but does not include:

 (f) a receiver who is not also a manager;

 (g) a receiver and manager appointed by a court; or

 (h) a liquidator appointed by a court.

confiscation order has the same meaning as in the Proceeds of Crime Act 2002.

constable means a member or special member of the Australian Federal Police or a member of the Police Force of a State or Territory.

corporation includes any body corporate.

corresponding law has the same meaning as in the Proceeds of Crime Act 2002.

court of summary jurisdiction includes a court of a Territory sitting as a court for the making of summary orders or the summary punishment of offences under the law of the Territory.

creditor, in relation to a liability under a maintenance order, includes the Child Support Registrar referred to in the Child Support (Registration and Collection) Act 1988.

creditor’s petition means a petition presented by a creditor or by 2 or more creditors jointly.

debt includes liability.

debt agreement means an agreement under section 185H resulting from the acceptance of a debt agreement proposal.

debt agreement proposal means a written proposal referred to in subsection 185C(1).

debtor’s petition means a petition presented by a debtor against himself or herself and includes a petition presented against a partnership in pursuance of section 56A and a petition presented by joint debtors against themselves in pursuance of section 57.

declaration of intention means a declaration that has been presented under section 54A and accepted under section 54C.

declared debtor means a debtor who has presented under section 54A a declaration of intention.

de facto partner has the meaning given by the Acts Interpretation Act 1901.

director, in relation to a corporation, includes:

 (a) any person occupying or acting in the position of director of the corporation, by whatever name called and whether or not validly appointed to occupy, or duly authorised to act in, the position;

 (b) any person in accordance with whose directions or instructions the directors of the corporation are accustomed to act; and

 (c) if the corporation has a committee of management, council or other governing body:

 (i) a member of that committee of management, council or other governing body;

 (ii) any person occupying or acting in the position of member of that committee of management, council or other governing body, by whatever name called and whether or not validly appointed to occupy, or duly authorised to act, in the position; and

 (iii) any person in accordance with whose directions or instructions the members of that committee of management, council or other governing body are accustomed to act.

eligible judge means a judge of the Court declared by the Minister to be an eligible judge under subsection 129A(2).

end means:

 (a) in relation to a bankruptcy—the discharge of the bankrupt from the bankruptcy or the annulment of the bankruptcy; or

 (b) in relation to a composition or scheme of arrangement under Division 6 of Part IV—the time when the composition or scheme, as the case may be, ceases to be in effect; or

 (ba) in relation to a personal insolvency agreement—the time when all the obligations that the agreement created have been discharged; or

 (c) in relation to an administration under Part XI—the end of the administration.

enforcement process, in relation to a frozen debt, means, in the case of a judgment debt:

 (a) process of a court issued to enforce in any manner payment of the judgment debt; or

 (b) without limiting the generality of paragraph (a), process of a court for attaching, in order to meet the judgment debt, a debt or other money payable or owing, or to become payable or owing, to the declared debtor.

entity means a natural person, company, partnership or trust.

examinable affairs, in relation to a person, means:

 (a) the person’s dealings, transactions, property and affairs; and

 (b) the financial affairs of an associated entity of the person, in so far as they are, or appear to be, relevant to the person or to any of his or her conduct, dealings, transactions, property and affairs.

examinable period has the meaning given by section 139CA.

examinable person, in relation to a person (in this definition called the relevant person), means:

 (a) if the relevant person is a debtor and property of the debtor is known or suspected to be in the possession of a person—that person;

 (b) if the relevant person has become a bankrupt and any of the property of the bankrupt is known or suspected to be in the possession of a person—that person;

 (c) in any case—a person who is believed to be indebted to the relevant person;

 (d) if a person, including:

 (i) a person who is an associated entity of the relevant person; or

 (ii) a person with whom an associated entity of the relevant person is or has been associated;

  may be able to give information about the relevant person or any of the relevant person’s examinable affairs—that person; or

 (e) if books (including books of an associated entity of the relevant person):

 (i) are in the possession of a person, including a person of a kind referred to in subparagraph (d)(i) or (ii); and

 (ii) may relate to the relevant person or any of the relevant person’s examinable affairs;

  that person.

Family Court Judge means a Judge of the Family Court (including the Chief Judge, the Deputy Chief Judge, a Judge Administrator or a Senior Judge).

Federal Circuit Court means the Federal Circuit Court of Australia.

Finance Minister means the Minister administering the Financial Management and Accountability Act 1997.

forfeiture order means a forfeiture order made under a proceeds of crime law.

frozen debt means a debt that:

 (a) is owed by a declared debtor; and

 (b) would, if the debtor had become a bankrupt when the declaration of intention was accepted under section 54C, be provable in the bankruptcy;

but does not include a debt in respect of the debtor’s liability under a maintenance agreement or maintenance order (whenever entered into or made).

goods includes all chattels personal.

industrial instrument means:

 (a) a law of the Commonwealth, a State or a Territory regulating conditions of employment; or

 (b) an award, determination or agreement made under such a law.

InspectorGeneral means the InspectorGeneral in Bankruptcy, and includes a person acting as the InspectorGeneral.

interstate confiscation order means an interstate forfeiture order or an interstate pecuniary penalty order.

interstate forfeiture order has the same meaning as in the Proceeds of Crime Act 2002.

interstate pecuniary penalty order has the same meaning as in the Proceeds of Crime Act 2002.

in the possession of includes in the custody of or under the control of.

magistrate means:

 (a) a person who holds office as a Magistrate of a State, being a person in respect of whom an arrangement under subsection 17B(1) applies;

 (b) a person who holds office as a Magistrate of the Northern Territory, being a person in respect of whom an arrangement under subsection 17B(2) applies; or

 (c) a person who holds office as a Magistrate of a Territory of the Commonwealth (other than the Northern Territory).

maintenance agreement means:

 (a) a maintenance agreement (within the meaning of the Family Law Act 1975) that has been registered in, or approved by, a court in Australia or an external Territory; or

 (b) any other agreement with respect to the maintenance of a person that has been registered in, or approved by, a court in Australia or an external Territory;

but does not include a financial agreement, or Part VIIIAB financial agreement, within the meaning of the Family Law Act 1975.

maintenance order means:

 (a) an order relating to the maintenance of a person, including an order relating to the payment of arrears of maintenance, that is made or registered under a law of the Commonwealth or of a State or Territory of the Commonwealth; or

 (b) an assessment made under the Child Support (Assessment) Act 1989.

modifications includes additions, omissions and substitutions.

National Personal Insolvency Index means the Index of that name established under the regulations.

net value, in relation to property, means:

 (a) if the property is unencumbered—the value of the property;

 (b) if the property is encumbered and the unencumbered value of the property exceeds the amount or value of the encumbrances—the amount of the excess; or

 (c) in any other case—a nil amount.

net worth, in relation to an entity, in relation to a time, means:

 (a) if the entity is a trust and the total value of the trust property as at that time exceeds the total of the amounts of the trustee’s liabilities as at that time (other than liabilities constituted by the rights of persons as beneficiaries under the trust)—the amount of the excess;

 (b) if the entity is not a trust and the total value of the entity’s assets as at that time exceeds the total of the amounts of the entity’s liabilities as at that time—the amount of the excess; or

 (c) in any other case—a nil amount.

oath includes affirmation and statutory declaration.

offence against this Act includes an offence against section 137.1 or 137.2 of the Criminal Code, being an offence that relates to this Act.

officer means an officer of the Court or of the Commonwealth.

Official Receiver includes a person acting as an Official Receiver.

Official Trustee means the Official Trustee in Bankruptcy.

operations, in relation to an entity, means all of the following:

 (a) the business, trading, transactions and dealings of the entity:

 (i) whether alone or jointly with another entity or other entities; and

 (ii) whether or not as agent, bailee or trustee;

 (b) the profits, income and receipts of the entity;

 (c) the losses, outgoings and expenditure of the entity.

parent: a person is the parent of anyone who is the person’s child.

pecuniary penalty order means:

 (a) a pecuniary penalty order made under a proceeds of crime law; or

 (b) a literary proceeds order within the meaning of the Proceeds of Crime Act 2002; or

 (c) an unexplained wealth order within the meaning of the Proceeds of Crime Act 2002.

personal insolvency agreement means a personal insolvency agreement executed under Part X.

Note: Section 188A sets out requirements for personal insolvency agreements.

personal services, in relation to a bankrupt, means services of a physical, intellectual or other kind supplied by the bankrupt himself or herself:

 (a) whether or not in a capacity as employee; and

 (b) whether or not the supply of the services by the bankrupt discharged the obligations of an entity to supply services.

petition means a petition under this Act.

PPSA grantor or debtor (short for Personal Property Securities Act grantor or debtor), in relation to a PPSA security interest, means a grantor or debtor within the meaning of the Personal Property Securities Act 2009.

PPSA secured party (short for Personal Property Securities Act secured party), in relation to a PPSA security interest, means a secured party within the meaning of the Personal Property Securities Act 2009.

PPSA security agreement (short for Personal Property Securities Act security agreement), in relation to a PPSA security interest, means a security agreement within the meaning of the Personal Property Securities Act 2009.

PPSA security interest (short for Personal Property Securities Act security interest) means a security interest within the meaning of the Personal Property Securities Act 2009 and to which that Act applies, other than a transitional security interest within the meaning of that Act.

Note 1: The Personal Property Securities Act 2009 applies to certain security interests in personal property. See the following provisions of that Act:

(a) section 8 (interests to which the Act does not apply);

(b) section 12 (meaning of security interest);

(c) Chapter 9 (transitional provisions).

Note 2: For the meaning of transitional security interest, see section 308 of the Personal Property Securities Act 2009.

premises includes:

 (a) any land;

 (b) any structure, building, aircraft, vehicle, vessel or place (whether built on or not); and

 (c) any part of such a structure, building, aircraft, vehicle, vessel or place.

private company, in relation to a particular time, means a company other than a company that, as at that time:

 (a) has been admitted to the official list of a prescribed financial market (as defined by section 9 of the Corporations Act 2001); and

 (b) has not been removed from that official list.

proceeding means proceeding under this Act.

proceeds, in relation to enforcement process in respect of a debt, means:

 (a) the proceeds of selling property under the enforcement process;

 (b) money taken under the enforcement process;

 (c) money received as a result of attachment under the enforcement process; or

 (d) money paid to avoid the taking or sale of property under, or to avoid attachment under, the enforcement process.

proceeds of crime law means:

 (a) the Proceeds of Crime Act 2002; or

 (b) the Proceeds of Crime Act 1987; or

 (c) a corresponding law.

proceeds of crime order means:

 (a) a restraining order; or

 (b) a forfeiture order; or

 (c) a pecuniary penalty order.

proclaimed law means a law specified for the time being in a Proclamation in force under section 253B.

professional advice means financial, business or legal advice given by a person in the performance of the functions attaching to the person’s professional capacity.

property means real or personal property of every description, whether situate in Australia or elsewhere, and includes any estate, interest or profit, whether present or future, vested or contingent, arising out of or incident to any such real or personal property.

provable debt means a debt or liability that is, under this Act, provable in bankruptcy.

provider, in relation to an RSA, has the same meaning as in the Retirement Savings Accounts Act 1997.

registered trustee means a person who is registered under this Act as qualified to act as a trustee.

Registrar means:

 (a) the Registrar, a Deputy Registrar, a District Registrar or a Deputy District Registrar of the Federal Court; or

 (b) a Registrar of the Federal Circuit Court.

related entity, in relation to a person, means any of the following:

 (a) a relative of the person;

 (b) a body corporate of which the person, or a relative of the person, is a director;

 (c) a body corporate that is related to the body corporate referred to in paragraph (b);

 (d) a director, or a relative of a director, of a body corporate referred to in paragraph (b) or (c);

 (e) a beneficiary under a trust of which the person, or a relative of the person, is a trustee;

 (f) a relative of such a beneficiary;

 (g) a relative of the spouse, or de facto partner, of such a beneficiary;

 (h) a trustee of a trust under which the person, or a relative of the person, is a beneficiary;

 (i) a member of a partnership of which the person, or a relative of the person, is a member;

For the purposes of paragraph (c) of this definition, the question whether a body corporate is related to another body corporate is to be determined in the same manner as that question is determined for the purposes of the Corporations Act 2001.

relative, in relation to a person, means:

 (a) the spouse of the person; or

 (b) a parent or remoter lineal ancestor of the person or of the person’s spouse; or

 (c) a child or remoter lineal descendant of the person or of the person’s spouse; or

 (d) a brother or sister of the person or of the person’s spouse; or

 (e) an uncle, aunt, nephew or niece of the person or of the person’s spouse; or

 (f) the spouse of a person specified in paragraph (b), (c), (d) or (e).

For the purposes of this definition, spouse includes de facto partner.

Note: Parent and child are defined by this subsection.

resolution means a resolution passed by a majority in value of the creditors present personally, by telephone, by attorney or by proxy at a meeting of creditors and voting on the resolution.

restraining order means a restraining order made under a proceeds of crime law.

RSA has the same meaning as in the Retirement Savings Accounts Act 1997.

RSA holder has the same meaning as in the Retirement Savings Accounts Act 1997.

rural support scheme means a program or scheme that:

 (a) is administered by or on behalf of the Commonwealth, a State or a Territory; and

 (b) relates to:

 (i) agriculture or the cultivation of land; or

 (ii) the maintenance of animals for commercial purposes; or

 (iii) horticulture; or

 (iv) any other primary industry activity.

secured creditor, in relation to a debtor, means:

 (a) in the case of a debt secured by a PPSA security interest—the PPSA secured party in relation to the interest, if the interest:

 (i) arose as security for the debt; and

 (ii) is perfected (within the meaning of the Personal Property Securities Act 2009); or

 (b) in the case of any other debt—a person holding a mortgage, charge or lien on property of the debtor as a security for a debt due to him or her from the debtor.

sheriff includes any person charged with the execution of a writ or other process.

special resolution means a resolution passed by a majority in number and at least threefourths in value of the creditors present personally, by telephone, by attorney or by proxy at a meeting of creditors and voting on the resolution.

state of affairs, in relation to an entity, means all of the following:

 (a) the property and assets of the entity:

 (i) whether held alone or jointly with another person or other persons; and

 (ii) whether or not held as agent, bailee or trustee;

 (b) the liabilities of the entity:

 (i) whether actual or contingent;

 (ii) whether owed alone or jointly with another person or other persons; and

 (iii) whether or not owed as trustee.

stay period, in relation to a declaration of intention presented by a debtor, means the period beginning on the day on which the declaration was accepted under section 54C and ending when:

 (a) the period of 21 days beginning on that day ends;

 (b) a creditor’s petition or a debtor’s petition is presented against the debtor;

 (c) the debtor signs an authority under section 188; or

 (d) a sequestration order is made against the debtor;

whichever happens first.

stay under a proclaimed law, in relation to a person or the estate of a deceased person, means a stay, by or under a proclaimed law, of proceedings or of execution in relation to all or any of the debts of that person or of that estate, as the case may be.

stepchild: without limiting who is a stepchild of a person for the purposes of this Act, someone is the stepchild of a person if he or she would be the person’s stepchild except that the person is not legally married to the person’s de facto partner.

Territory, except in the expression “Territory of the Commonwealth”, means the Australian Capital Territory or the Northern Territory of Australia.

the commencement of the bankruptcy, in relation to a bankrupt, means the time at which his or her bankruptcy is, by virtue of section 115, to be deemed to have commenced.

the Court means a Court having jurisdiction in bankruptcy under this Act.

the date of the bankruptcy, in relation to a bankrupt, means the date on which a sequestration order was made against his or her estate or, if he or she became a bankrupt by virtue of the presentation of a debtor’s petition, the date on which he or she became a bankrupt by force of section 55, 56E or 57, as the case requires.

the Family Court means the Family Court of Australia.

the Federal Court means the Federal Court of Australia.

the Official Receiver means any Official Receiver.

the property of the bankrupt, in relation to a bankrupt, means:

 (a) except in subsections 58(3) and (4):

 (i) the property divisible among the bankrupt’s creditors; and

 (ii) any rights and powers in relation to that property that would have been exercisable by the bankrupt if he or she had not become a bankrupt; and

 (b) in subsections 58(3) and (4):

 (i) the property, rights and powers referred to in paragraph (a) of this definition; and

 (ii) any other property of the bankrupt.

the trustee means:

 (a) in relation to a bankruptcy—the trustee of the estate of the bankrupt; or

 (b) in relation to a composition or scheme of arrangement under Division 6 of Part IV—the trustee of the composition or scheme of arrangement; or

 (c) in relation to a personal insolvency agreement—the trustee of the agreement; or

 (d) in relation to the estate of a deceased person in respect of which an order has been made under Part XI—the trustee of the estate; or

 (e) in relation to a trust:

 (i) if only one person is a trustee of the trust—that person; or

 (ii) if 2 or more persons are trustees of the trust—any one or more of those persons;

  in his, her or its capacity as a trustee, or in their respective capacities as trustees, as the case may be, of the trust.

this Act includes the regulations.

 (1A) A reference in this Act to books of an associated entity of a person does not limit the generality of any other reference in this Act to books.

 (1B) A reference in this Act to an entity includes, in the case of a trust, a reference to the trustee of the trust.

 (1C) Paragraph (b) of the definition of examinable affairs in subsection (1) does not limit the generality of a reference in this Act to a person’s conduct, dealings, transactions, property or affairs.

 (2) A person is solvent if, and only if, the person is able to pay all the person’s debts, as and when they become due and payable.

 (3) A person who is not solvent is insolvent.

 (4) Unless the contrary intention appears, a reference in this Act to the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt, or to the trustee of a personal insolvency agreement, shall:

 (a) in relation to an estate or a personal insolvency agreement in respect of which there are 2 or more joint trustees—be read as a reference to all the trustees; or

 (b) in relation to an estate or a personal insolvency agreement in respect of which there are 2 or more joint and several trustees—be read as a reference to all of the trustees or any one or more of the trustees.

 (6) For the purposes of this Act, the members of a person’s family are taken to include the following (without limitation):

 (a) a de facto partner of the person;

 (b) someone who is the child of the person, or of whom the person is the child, because of the definition of child in this section;

 (c) anyone else who would be a member of the person’s family if someone mentioned in paragraph (a) or (b) is taken to be a member of the person’s family.

5A  Acting in accordance with a person’s directions or instructions

  For the purposes of this Act, a person shall not be regarded as a person in accordance with whose directions or instructions the directors of a body corporate are accustomed to act merely because the directors act on advice given by the person in the proper performance of the functions attaching to the person’s professional capacity or to the person’s business relationship with the directors or with the body corporate.

5B  Associated entities: companies

 (1) For the purposes of this Act, a company is associated with a person if the person:

 (a) is a company officer of the company or otherwise is concerned, or takes part, in the company’s management; or

 (b) is able to control, or to influence materially, the company’s activities or internal affairs; or

 (c) is a member of the company; or

 (d) is in a position to cast, or to control the casting of, a vote at a general meeting of the company; or

 (e) has power to dispose of, or to exercise control over the disposal of, a share in the company; or

 (f) is financially interested in the company’s success or failure or apparent success or failure; or

 (g) is owed a debt by the company; or

 (h) is employed, or is engaged under a contract for services, by the company; or

 (j) acts as agent for the company in any transaction or dealing; or

 (k) gives professional advice to the company.

 (2) For the purposes of this Act, a company is also associated with a person if the company:

 (a) holds property jointly with the person; or

 (b) is dealing with the person’s property as an agent for the person; or

 (c) is a trustee of a trust under which the person is capable of benefiting; or

 (d) acquires or disposes of property as a result of dealing with the person.

 (3) The circumstances set out in subsections (1) and (2) are the only circumstances in which a company is associated with a person for the purposes of this Act.

5C  Associated entities: natural persons

 (1) For the purposes of this Act, a natural person (in this section called the associate) is associated with another person if the other person:

 (a) holds property jointly with the associate; or

 (b) is a trustee of a trust under which the associate is capable of benefiting; or

 (ba) can benefit under a trust of which the associate is a trustee; or

 (c) is employed, or is engaged under a contract for services, by the associate; or

 (d) acts as agent for the associate in any transaction or dealing; or

 (da) is a principal for whom the associate acts as an agent; or

 (e) is an attorney of the associate under a power of attorney; or

 (f) has appointed the associate as the other person’s attorney under a power of attorney; or

 (g) gives professional advice to the associate; or

 (h) is given professional advice by the associate.

 (2) A natural person (the associate) is also associated with another person if the associate has acquired or disposed of property as a result of dealing with the other person.

 (3) The circumstances set out in subsections (1) and (2) are the only circumstances in which a natural person is associated with another person for the purposes of this Act.

5D  Associated entities: partnerships

  For the purposes of this Act, a partnership is associated with a person if, and only if, the person:

 (a) is a partner in the partnership;

 (b) is able to control, or to influence materially, the partnership’s activities or internal affairs;

 (c) is financially interested in the partnership’s success or failure or apparent success or failure;

 (d) is a creditor of the partnership;

 (e) is employed, or is engaged under a contract for services, by the partnership;

 (f) acts as agent for the partnership in any transaction or dealing; or

 (g) gives professional advice to the partnership.

5E  Associated entities: trusts

  For the purposes of this Act, a trust is associated with a person if, and only if, the person:

 (a) is the settlor, or one of the settlors, of the trust;

 (b) has power under the terms of the trust to appoint or remove a trustee of the trust or to vary, or cause to be varied, any of the terms of the trust;

 (c) is a trustee of the trust;

 (d) is able to control, or to influence materially, the activities of the trustee of the trust;

 (e) if a trustee of the trust is a company—is a company officer of the company or otherwise is concerned, or takes part, in the company’s management;

 (f) is capable of benefiting under the trust;

 (g) is a creditor of the trustee of the trust;

 (h) is employed, or is engaged under a contract for services, by the trustee of the trust;

 (j) acts as agent for the trustee of the trust in any transaction or dealing; or

 (k) gives professional advice to the trustee of the trust.

5F  Controlling an entity in relation to a matter

 (1) Subject to this section, a person shall be taken, for the purposes of this Act, to control an entity at a particular time in relation to a matter if, and only if:

 (a) no act, omission or decision inconsistent with the person’s directions, instructions or wishes was; and

 (b) having regard to all the circumstances, it may reasonably be expected that no such act, omission or decision would have been;

done or made at that time, in relation to the matter, by or on behalf of the entity.

 (2) A person shall not be taken to control an entity at a particular time in relation to a matter merely because:

 (a) no act, omission or decision inconsistent with advice given by the person in the proper performance of the functions attaching to his or her professional capacity, or to his or her business relationship with the entity, was; and

 (b) having regard to all the circumstances, it may reasonably be expected that no such act, omission or decision would have been;

done or made at that time, in relation to that matter, by or on behalf of the entity.

 (3) A reference in subsection (1) or (2), in relation to a matter, to an act, omission or decision is a reference to an act, omission or decision that, having regard to the nature of that matter, is of substantial importance.

 (4) A person shall not be taken to control a company at a particular time in relation to a matter if the company is not a private company at that time.

5G  Financial affairs of a company

  For the purposes of this Act, a company’s financial affairs include:

 (a) the company’s promotion, formation, membership, control, operations and state of affairs;

 (b) the management and proceedings of the company;

 (c) any act or thing done (including any contract made and any transaction entered into) by or on behalf of the company, or to or in relation to the company or its business or property, at a time when:

 (i) a receiver, or a receiver and manager, is in possession of, or has control over, property of the company;

 (ia) the company is under administration within the meaning of the Corporations Act 2001;

 (ib) a deed of company arrangement that the company executed under Part 5.3A of that Act has not yet terminated;

 (iii) a compromise or arrangement made between the company and another person or other persons is being administered; or

 (iv) the company is being wound up;

  and, without limiting the generality of the foregoing, any conduct of such a receiver or such a receiver and manager, of an administrator (within the meaning of that Act) of the company, of an administrator of such a deed, of any person administering such a compromise or arrangement or of any liquidator or provisional liquidator of the company;

 (d) the ownership of shares in, and debentures of, the company;

 (e) the power of persons to exercise, or to control the exercise of, the rights to vote attached to shares in the company or to dispose of, or to exercise control over the disposal of, such shares;

 (f) the circumstances under which a person acquired or disposed of, or became entitled to acquire or dispose of, shares in, or debentures of, the company; and

 (g) matters concerned with ascertaining the persons with whom the company is or has been associated.

5H  Financial affairs of a natural person

  For the purposes of this Act, the financial affairs of a natural person include:

 (a) the person’s operations and state of affairs;

 (b) any act or thing done (including any contract made and any transaction entered into) by or on behalf of the person, or to or in relation to the person or his or her business or property, at a time when:

 (i) the person was, under this Act or the law of an external Territory, a bankrupt in respect of a bankruptcy from which the person had not been discharged;

 (ii) the person had, under the law of an external Territory or the law of a country other than Australia, the status of an undischarged bankrupt;

 (iii) the property of the person was subject to control under Division 2 of Part X by reason of an authority given by the person under section 188; or

 (iv) a personal insolvency agreement under Part X or under the corresponding provisions of a law of an external Territory or a country other than Australia was in effect in relation to the person or the person’s property;

 (c) without limiting the generality of paragraph (b), any conduct of the trustee of such a bankrupt estate or of such a personal insolvency agreement or a person acting under such an authority; and

 (d) matters concerned with ascertaining the persons with whom the person is or has been associated.

5J  Financial affairs of a partnership

  For the purposes of this Act, the financial affairs of a partnership include:

 (a) the partnership’s promotion, formation, membership, control, operations and state of affairs;

 (b) the management and proceedings of the partnership;

 (c) any act or thing done (including any contract made and transaction entered into) on behalf of the partnership, or to or in relation to the partnership, at a time when the partnership is being wound up; and

 (d) matters concerned with ascertaining the persons with whom the partnership is or has been associated.

5K  Financial affairs of a trust

  For the purposes of this Act, the financial affairs of a trust include:

 (a) the creation of the trust;

 (b) matters arising under, or otherwise relating to, the terms of the trust;

 (c) the appointment and removal of a trustee of the trust;

 (d) the business, trading, transactions and dealings of the trustee of the trust;

 (e) the profits, income and receipts of the trustee of the trust;

 (f) the losses, outgoings and expenditure of the trustee of the trust;

 (g) the trust property, including transactions and dealings in, and the income arising from, the trust property;

 (h) the liabilities of the trustee of the trust;

 (j) the management of the trust;

 (k) any act or thing done (including any contract made and transaction entered into) by or on behalf of the trustee of the trust, or to or in relation to the trust, at a time when the trust is being wound up;

 (m) matters concerned with ascertaining the persons with whom the trust is or has been associated; and

 (n) matters concerned with ascertaining the rights of the beneficiaries under the trust and any payments, or distributions of property, that the beneficiaries have received, or are entitled to receive, under the terms of the trust.

6  Meaning of intent to defraud creditors

  A reference in this Act to an intent to defraud the creditors of a person or to defeat or delay the creditors of a person shall be read as including an intent to defraud, or to defeat or delay, any one or more of those creditors.

6A  Statement of affairs for purposes other than Part XI

 (1) This section has effect for the purposes of the following provisions of this Act, namely, subsections 54(1) and (2) and subsection 54A(2), paragraphs 55(2)(b), 56B(3)(a) and (b), 56F(1)(a) and (b), 57(2)(a) and (b) and sections 77CA and 185D and Part X.

 (2) A reference in a provision of this Act referred to in subsection (1) to a statement of affairs is a reference to a statement that:

 (a) is in an approved form; and

 (b) includes a statement identifying any creditor who is a related entity of the debtor or bankrupt; and

 (c) contains a declaration that, so far as the debtor or bankrupt is aware, the particulars set out in the statement are correct.

 (3) If the trustee has reasonable grounds to suspect that:

 (a) any particulars set out in a statement of affairs that was filed by a person are false or misleading in a material respect; or

 (b) any material particulars have been omitted from that statement;

the trustee may, by written notice given to the person, require the person, within a specified period of not less than 14 days, to provide such information or to produce such books as are specified in the notice for the purpose of enabling the trustee to decide whether the particulars set out in the statement are correct.

 (4) For the purposes of the application of subsection (3) to a statement of affairs that is required to be given under Part X, a reference in that subsection to the trustee is a reference to whichever of the following is applicable:

 (a) the controlling trustee within the meaning of that Part;

 (b) the trustee of the personal insolvency agreement concerned.

6B  Provision of statement of affairs under Part XI and statement of administration of estate of deceased person

 (2) A reference in paragraph 246(1)(a) or subsection 247(1) to a statement of a deceased person’s affairs and of administration of the deceased person’s estate is a reference to a statement, in an approved form, of those affairs and of that administration.

 (3) If the trustee administering the estate of a deceased person under Part XI has reasonable grounds to suspect that:

 (a) any particulars set out in a statement of affairs that was filed by a person under subsection 246(1) or 247(1) are false or misleading in a material respect; or

 (b) any material particulars have been omitted from that statement;

the trustee may give the person a written notice requiring the person to provide specified information or books within a specified period of at least 14 days to enable the trustee to decide whether the particulars set out in the statement are correct.

6C  Interpretive provisions relating to proceeds of crime orders

When property is covered by a restraining order or a forfeiture order

 (1) For the purposes of this Act, property is covered by a restraining order or a forfeiture order during the period:

 (a) starting when the order comes into force in relation to the property; and

 (b) ending when the earliest of the following occurs:

 (i) the order ceases to be in force;

 (ii) a court excludes the property from the order;

 (iii) if the order is a restraining order—a court excludes the property from forfeiture that would or may result from conviction for an offence.

Satisfaction of pecuniary penalty orders

 (2) Without limiting the circumstances in which a pecuniary penalty order ceases to be in force, a pecuniary penalty order ceases to be in force if it is satisfied.

When applications for proceeds of crime orders are finally determined

 (3) For the purposes of this Act, an application for a proceeds of crime order is taken to be finally determined when:

 (a) the application is withdrawn; or

 (b) if the application is successful—the resulting proceeds of crime order comes into force; or

 (c) if the application is unsuccessful—the time within which an appeal can be made has expired and any appeals have been finally determined or otherwise disposed of.

Part IBApplication of Act

 

 

7  Application of Act

 (1) This Act extends to debtors being persons who are not Australian citizens and persons who have privilege of Parliament.

 (1A) This Act applies to debtors whether or not they have attained the age of 18 years.

 (2) A sequestration order shall not be made against, nor a debtor’s petition presented by:

 (a) a corporation; or

 (b) a partnership or association registered under a law of the Commonwealth, of a State, or of a Territory of the Commonwealth, that provides for the winding up of a partnership or association registered under that law.

 (3) This Act applies, with any modifications prescribed by the regulations, in relation to limited partnerships as if they were ordinary partnerships and, upon all the general partners of a limited partnership becoming bankrupt, the assets of the limited partnership shall vest in the trustee.

7A  Application of the Criminal Code

  Chapter 2 of the Criminal Code applies to all offences against this Act.

Note: Chapter 2 of the Criminal Code sets out the general principles of criminal responsibility.

8  Act to bind the Crown

  This Act binds the Crown in right of the Commonwealth, of each of the States and of the Northern Territory.

9  Laws of States and Territories not affected by Act

 (1) This Act does not affect a law of a State or Territory relating to matters not dealt with expressly or by necessary implication in this Act.

Part IIAdministration

Division 1General

10  Delegation by Minister or Secretary

 (1) The Minister may, either generally or as otherwise provided in the instrument of delegation, by writing signed by him or her, delegate to an officer all or any of the Minister’s powers under this Act, other than this power of delegation.

 (2) A power delegated under subsection (1) shall, when exercised by a delegate, be deemed to have been exercised by the Minister.

 (3) A delegation under subsection (1) does not prevent the exercise of a power by the Minister.

 (4) The Secretary may, either generally or as otherwise provided in the instrument of delegation, by writing signed by him or her, delegate to an officer all or any of the Secretary’s powers under this Act, other than this power of delegation.

 (5) A power delegated under subsection (4) shall, when exercised by a delegate, be deemed to have been exercised by the Secretary.

 (6) A delegation under subsection (4) does not prevent the exercise of a power by the Secretary.

 (7) In this section:

exercise includes perform.

power includes a function.

Secretary means the Secretary of the Department.

11  InspectorGeneral in Bankruptcy

 (1) For the purposes of this Act, there shall be an InspectorGeneral in Bankruptcy.

 (2) The InspectorGeneral has:

 (a) the general administration of this Act; and

 (b) the other powers and other functions conferred or imposed on him or her by this Act.

 (3) The InspectorGeneral may exercise any of the powers (including the power under section 18), and perform any of the functions, of an Official Receiver, in the same way as the Official Receiver.

 (4) The InspectorGeneral may by signed instrument delegate to an authorised employee all or any of the powers and functions of the InspectorGeneral under this Act.

12  Functions of InspectorGeneral

 (1) The InspectorGeneral:

 (a) shall make such inquiries and investigations as the Minister directs; and

 (b) may make such inquiries and investigations as the InspectorGeneral thinks fit with respect to the administration of, or the conduct of a trustee (including a controlling trustee) in relation to:

 (i) a bankruptcy; or

 (ii) a composition or scheme of arrangement under Division 6 of Part IV; or

 (iii) a personal insolvency agreement; or

 (iv) an administration under Part XI; or

 (v) property in relation to which a direction has been given under subsection 50(1); or

 (vi) property in relation to which the trustee is the controlling trustee under an authority given under section 188; and

 (ba) may make such inquiries and investigations as the InspectorGeneral thinks fit with respect to so much of the conduct and examinable affairs of:

 (i) a bankrupt; or

 (ii) a bankrupt or debtor under a composition or scheme of arrangement under Division 6 of Part IV; or

 (iia) a debtor under a debt agreement proposal or debt agreement under Part IX; or

 (iib) a debtor whose property is subject to control under Division 2 of Part X; or

 (iii) a debtor under a personal insolvency agreement;

  as is relevant to the bankruptcy, composition, scheme or agreement, as the case may be; and

 (bb) may make such inquiries and investigations as the InspectorGeneral thinks fit with respect to any conduct of an administrator that relates to a debt agreement; and

 (bc) may make such inquiries and investigations as the InspectorGeneral thinks fit with respect to whether a person has committed an offence against this Act; and

 (c) shall from time to time obtain from Official Receivers and other officers and from registered trustees reports as to the operation of this Act; and

 (d) must give the Minister, after the end of each financial year, a report on the operation of this Act during that financial year for presentation by the Minister to the Parliament.

 (1A) Where the InspectorGeneral requests a registered trustee or the administrator of a debt agreement, for the purposes of subsection (1), to provide a report as to the operation of this Act, the registered trustee or administrator, as the case may be, shall forthwith provide the report requested.

 (1BA) The InspectorGeneral may make an inquiry or investigation under paragraph (1)(b), (ba), (bb) or (bc) at any time, whether before or after the end of the bankruptcy, composition, scheme or agreement or administration concerned.

 (1B) Where the InspectorGeneral makes an inquiry or investigation referred to in paragraph (1)(b), (ba), (bb) or (bc), the InspectorGeneral may give a copy of the report of the results of the inquiry or investigation to any person the InspectorGeneral thinks fit.

 (1C) Without limiting the generality of paragraphs (1)(a) and (b), the InspectorGeneral may make inquiries and investigations under those paragraphs at the request of:

 (a) if the InspectorGeneral is satisfied that the request relates to an application, or proposed application, for a confiscation order—the Commonwealth proceeds of crime authority that is the responsible authority, or that is proposed to be the responsible authority, for the application or proposed application under the Proceeds of Crime Act 2002; or

 (b) if the InspectorGeneral is satisfied that the request relates to an application, or proposed application, for an interstate confiscation order—a person who is entitled, under a corresponding law, to apply for an order of that kind.

 (1D) For the purposes of paragraph (1)(bb), any conduct engaged in by the administrator of a debt agreement:

 (a) in fulfilment, or purported fulfilment, of a duty of the administrator under this Act; or

 (b) in breach of a duty of the administrator under this Act;

is taken to be conduct of the administrator that relates to a debt agreement, even if the conduct does not relate to a particular debt agreement.

 (1E) For the purposes of paragraph (1)(bb), if a person signs a certificate under subsection 185C(2D) in relation to a debt agreement proposal, the person’s conduct in relation to the certificate is taken to be conduct of an administrator that relates to a debt agreement.

 (1F) For the purposes of paragraph (1)(bb), if a person:

 (a) gives a notification in compliance, or purported compliance with subsection 185N(5); or

 (b) breaches subsection 185N(5);

the giving of the notification, or the breach, as the case may be, is taken to be the conduct of an administrator that relates to a debt agreement.

 (2) For the purposes of discharging his or her functions under this Act, the InspectorGeneral may:

 (a) require the production of any books kept by an Official Receiver or by a trustee; and

 (b) require a trustee to answer an inquiry made to him or her in relation to any of the following matters in which the trustee is, or has been, engaged:

 (i) a bankruptcy;

 (ii) the control of property under an authority given under section 188;

 (iii) an administration under Part XI;

 (iv) a personal insolvency agreement, scheme of arrangement or composition; and

 (c) at any time investigate the books of a trustee; and

 (d) require the production of any books kept by the administrator, or former administrator, of a debt agreement; and

 (e) require the administrator, or former administrator, of a debt agreement to answer an inquiry made of the administrator or former administrator, as the case may be, in relation to the administration of the debt agreement; and

 (f) at any time investigate the books of the administrator, or former administrator, of a debt agreement.

 (2A) If the InspectorGeneral believes on reasonable grounds that a person has information that is relevant to an inquiry or investigation under paragraph (1)(bc), the InspectorGeneral may, by written notice given to the person, require the person to give to the InspectorGeneral, within the period and in the manner specified in the notice, any such information.

 (2B) The period specified in a notice given under subsection (2A) must be at least 14 days after the notice is given.

 (2C) A person commits an offence if:

 (a) the person has been given a notice under subsection (2A); and

 (b) the person fails to comply with the notice.

Penalty: Imprisonment for 12 months.

 (2D) A notice under subsection (2A) must set out the effect of the following provisions:

 (a) subsection (2C);

 (b) section 137.1 of the Criminal Code (about giving false or misleading information).

 (2E) Subsection (2A) does not limit the application of subsection (2) in relation to an inquiry or investigation under paragraph (1)(bc).

 (4) The InspectorGeneral:

 (a) is entitled to attend any meeting of creditors held under this Act; and

 (b) subject to section 64ZA, is entitled to participate in any such meeting as the InspectorGeneral thinks fit.

15  Official Receivers

 (1) There is to be such number of Official Receivers as the Minister thinks necessary.

 (3) Each Official Receiver has such powers and functions as are conferred or imposed on an Official Receiver by this Act.

 (4) An Official Receiver may by signed instrument delegate to an authorised employee all or any of the powers and functions of the Official Receiver under this Act.

 (5) The Court may review an act done by an Official Receiver.

Note: Section 303 explains who may apply to the Court for review of an Official Receiver’s action.

16  Appointment of InspectorGeneral and Official Receivers

  The InspectorGeneral and each Official Receiver shall be appointed by the Minister.

17  Acting InspectorGeneral and Acting Official Receivers

 (1) The Minister may appoint a person to act as InspectorGeneral:

 (a) during a vacancy in the office of InspectorGeneral; or

 (b) during any period, or during all periods, when the InspectorGeneral is absent from duty or from Australia or is, for any other reason, unable to perform the functions of his or her office.

Note: For rules that apply to acting appointments, see section 33A of the Acts Interpretation Act 1901.

 (2) The InspectorGeneral may appoint a person to act as Official Receiver:

 (a) during a vacancy in the office of Official Receiver; or

 (b) during any period, or during all periods, when the Official Receiver is absent from duty or from Australia or is, for any other reason, unable to perform the functions of his or her office.

Note: For rules that apply to acting appointments, see section 33A of the Acts Interpretation Act 1901.

17B  Arrangements for services of State and Northern Territory Magistrates

 (1) The GovernorGeneral may arrange with the Governor of a State for the performance of the functions of a magistrate under this Act by all or any of the persons who from time to time hold office as Magistrates of the State.

 (2) The GovernorGeneral may arrange with the Administrator of the Northern Territory for the performance of the functions of a magistrate under this Act by all or any of the persons who from time to time hold office as Magistrates of the Territory.

18  The Official Trustee in Bankruptcy

 (1) The corporation sole known as the Official Trustee in Bankruptcy, that existed immediately before this subsection commenced, continues in existence as a body corporate with the same name.

 (2) The body corporate continued in existence by force of subsection (1):

 (a) has perpetual succession;

 (b) may acquire, hold and dispose of real and personal property; and

 (c) may sue and be sued in its corporate name.

 (4) The Official Trustee shall have such seals as the Minister directs by writing under his or her hand.

 (5) The designs of the seals of the Official Trustee shall be as determined by the Minister by writing under his or her hand.

 (7) All courts (whether exercising federal jurisdiction or not), and all persons acting judicially, shall take judicial notice of the mark of such a seal affixed on a document and shall, in the absence of proof to the contrary, presume that it was duly affixed.

 (8) The Official Receiver may exercise the powers, and perform the functions, of the Official Trustee.

 (8AA) In exercising powers or performing functions under subsection (8), an Official Receiver must act in the name of, and on behalf of, the Official Trustee.

 (8A) All acts and things done in the name of, or on behalf of, the Official Trustee by any Official Receiver, shall be deemed to have been done by the Official Trustee.

 (8B) The InspectorGeneral may exercise any of the powers, and perform any of the functions, of the Official Trustee that are not related to any of the following matters:

 (a) a bankruptcy;

 (b) control of a debtor’s property under section 50;

 (c) a scheme of arrangement or composition under Division 6 of Part IV;

 (d) a matter relating to a debt agreement proposal;

 (e) Part X administration;

 (f) administration under Part XI.

 (8C) In exercising powers or performing functions under subsection (8B), the InspectorGeneral must act in the name of, and on behalf of, the Official Trustee.

 (8D) Anything done by the InspectorGeneral in the name of, or on behalf of, the Official Trustee is taken to have been done by the Official Trustee.

 (8E) In subsection (8B):

matter relating to a debt agreement proposal includes:

 (a) a debt agreement; and

 (b) an activity required or permitted by a debt agreement.

Part X administration means:

 (a) an activity that a controlling trustee may or must carry out after consenting to exercise powers given by an authority under section 188 (including control of a debtor’s property under Division 2 of Part X); or

 (b) a personal insolvency agreement.

 (9) Where, under a provision of this Act, the exercise of a power or the performance of a function by the Official Trustee is dependent upon the opinion, belief or state of mind of the Official Trustee in relation to a matter:

 (a) the power may be exercised or the function performed by a person who may exercise the power or perform the function under subsection (8) or (8B), in the name of, or on behalf of, the Official Trustee upon the opinion, belief or state of mind in relation to that matter of the person exercising the power or performing the function; and

 (b) any act or thing done in accordance with this subsection shall be deemed to have been done by the Official Trustee.

 (10) Where the Official Trustee is one of the trustees of a personal insolvency agreement, composition or scheme of arrangement, a power the exercise of which, or a function the performance of which, is dependent upon the opinion, belief or state of mind of those trustees in relation to a matter may be exercised or performed by those trustees as if the opinion, belief or state of mind in relation to that matter of:

 (a) an Official Receiver who; or

 (b) another person who with the authority of an Official Receiver;

acts in the name of, or on behalf of, the Official Trustee in the exercise of the power or the performance of the function were the opinion, belief or state of mind in relation to the matter of the Official Trustee.

 (11) A reference in a law of the Commonwealth to the Official Receiver of the estate of a bankrupt shall, in relation to the vesting, holding or disposal of property, be read as including a reference to the Official Trustee.

 (12) A reference in a law of the Commonwealth to the Official Receiver in Bankruptcy shall be read as including a reference to the Official Trustee.

18AA  Commonwealth Authorities and Companies Act 1997 does not apply to Official Trustee

  The Official Trustee is not a Commonwealth authority for the purposes of the Commonwealth Authorities and Companies Act 1997.

18A  Liability of the Official Trustee

 (1) The Official Trustee is subject to the same personal liability in respect of an act done, or omitted to be done, by it as:

 (a) the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt; or

 (b) the trustee of the estate of a deceased debtor; or

 (c) the trustee of a composition or scheme of arrangement accepted under Division 6 of Part IV; or

 (d) the controlling trustee in relation to a debtor whose property is subject to control under Division 2 of Part X; or

 (e) the trustee of a personal insolvency agreement;

as an individual would be subject if the individual had done, or omitted to do, that act as such a trustee.

 (2) The Commonwealth is by force of this subsection liable to indemnify the Official Trustee against any personal liability, including any personal liability as to costs, incurred by it:

 (a) by reason of subsection (1); or

 (b) for any act done, or omitted to be done, by it in carrying out, or purporting to carry out, a direction given, or an order made, by the Court under section 50; or

 (c) for any act done, or omitted to be done, by the Official Trustee:

 (i) under Part IX; or

 (ii) under the authority contained in a debt agreement to deal with the property of the person who is a party (as debtor) to the agreement.

 (3) Nothing in subsection (2) affects any right that the Official Trustee has, apart from that subsection, to be reimbursed in respect of any personal liability referred to in that subsection or any other indemnity given to the Official Trustee in respect of any such liability.

 (4) Where the Commonwealth makes a payment in accordance with the indemnity referred to in subsection (2), the Commonwealth has the same right to reimbursement in respect of the payment (including reimbursement under another indemnity given to the Official Trustee) as the Official Trustee would have if the Official Trustee had made the payment.

19  Duties etc. of trustee

 (1) The duties of the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt include the following:

 (a) notifying the bankrupt’s creditors of the bankruptcy;

 (b) determining whether the estate includes property that can be realised to pay a dividend to creditors;

 (c) reporting to creditors within 3 months of the date of the bankruptcy on the likelihood of creditors receiving a dividend before the end of the bankruptcy;

 (d) giving information about the administration of the estate to a creditor who reasonably requests it;

 (e) determining whether the bankrupt has made a transfer of property that is void against the trustee;

 (f) taking appropriate steps to recover property for the benefit of the estate;

 (g) taking whatever action is practicable to try to ensure that the bankrupt discharges all of the bankrupt’s duties under this Act;

 (h) considering whether the bankrupt has committed an offence against this Act;

 (i) referring to the InspectorGeneral or to relevant law enforcement authorities any evidence of an offence by the bankrupt against this Act;

 (j) administering the estate as efficiently as possible by avoiding unnecessary expense;

 (k) exercising powers and performing functions in a commercially sound way.

 (2) Where a person who became a bankrupt on a creditor’s petition is unable to prepare a proper statement of affairs, the trustee may employ, at the expense of the estate, a qualified person to assist in the preparation of the statement.

19AA  Power of investigation of bankrupt’s affairs

 (1) The trustee of the estate of a bankrupt may investigate:

 (a) the bankrupt’s conduct and examinable affairs; and

 (b) books, accounts and records kept by the bankrupt;

so far as they relate to the bankruptcy.

19A  Liability of InspectorGeneral, Official Receivers etc.

 (1) The Commonwealth shall indemnify a person to whom this section applies against any liability incurred by him or her:

 (a) for any act done negligently, or negligently omitted to be done, by him or her in the course of the performance of his or her duties under this Act; and

 (b) for any act done by him or her in good faith in the purported performance of his or her duties under this Act.

 (2) The Commonwealth has the same liability for acts of, or omissions by, a person to whom this section applies in the course of the performance or purported performance of his or her duties under this Act as a master has for acts of, or omissions by, his or her servants.

 (3) A reference in this section to a person to whom this section applies shall be read as a reference to the InspectorGeneral, a Registrar, an Official Receiver, an officer performing any of the functions or duties, or exercising any of the powers, of an Official Receiver or an officer or other person assisting a Registrar or an Official Receiver in the performance of his or her functions or duties or the exercise of his or her powers.

Division 2Common Investment Fund

20A  Interpretation

  In this Division, unless the contrary intention appears:

Common Fund means the Common Investment Fund established in pursuance of section 20B.

Equalization Account means the Common Investment Fund Equalization Account continued in existence by section 20G.

20B  The Common Investment Fund

 (1) The Official Trustee shall open and maintain an account to be known as the Common Investment Fund.

 (2) All moneys (other than moneys to which subsection (8) applies) received by the Official Trustee after the commencement of this section shall be paid into the Common Fund.

 (3) All moneys (other than moneys to which subsection (8) applies) held by the Official Trustee at the commencement of this section, including moneys that, at that time, are held on deposit with a bank under subsection 172(1), and all investments made under that subsection and held by the Official Trustee at that time, shall form part of the Common Fund.

 (4) The Official Trustee shall open and maintain, with an ADI or ADIs, such accounts for the purposes of the Common Fund as are necessary for the purposes of the Common Fund.

 (6) The payment of moneys into an account referred to in subsection (4) shall be deemed to be the payment of those moneys into the Common Fund.

 (7) Any payment that the Official Trustee is authorized, required or permitted, by or under a provision of this Act, to make out of moneys standing to the credit of the estate of a bankrupt or a deceased debtor shall be made out of moneys in the Common Fund.

 (7A) Any payment that the Official Trustee is authorised, required or permitted to make under:

 (a) a debt agreement; or

 (b) a personal insolvency agreement;

is to be made out of money in the Common Fund.

 (8) This subsection applies to moneys held or received by the Official Trustee:

 (a) under a direction given, or order made, under section 50; or

 (c) as the controlling trustee in relation to a debtor whose property is subject to control under Division 2 of Part X.

20D  Investment of money in Common Fund

 (1) The moneys in the Common Fund not immediately required for the purposes of this Act may be invested by the Official Trustee:

 (a) in public securities; or

 (b) in a loan the repayment of which is guaranteed by the Commonwealth, a State or a Territory; or

 (c) in a loan to a municipal corporation or other local governing body in Australia; or

 (d) in a loan to, or on deposit with, an ADI; or

 (e) in bank bills accepted or endorsed by an ADI.

 (4) The Official Trustee:

 (a) shall endeavour to ensure that the moneys in the Common Fund lodged in accounts at call with an ADI or ADIs are, as far as practicable, at all times sufficient to meet the payments that under this Act are to be made out of moneys in the Common Fund; and

 (b) will ensure that moneys in the Common Fund that, in the opinion of the Official Trustee, are not required to be kept in accounts at call with an ADI or ADIs in accordance with paragraph (a) are, as far as practicable, invested in accordance with subsection (1).

 (6) Interest derived from the investment of moneys in the Common Fund is not subject to taxation under a law of the Commonwealth, a State or a Territory of the Commonwealth.

 (7) The Common Fund is not subject to taxation under a law of the Commonwealth, or to taxation under a law of a State or Territory of the Commonwealth to which the Commonwealth is not subject, and the Official Trustee is not otherwise subject to taxation under such a law in respect of anything done in the exercise of powers conferred on it by subsection (1).

 (8) In this section, public securities means:

 (a) bonds, debentures, stock and other securities issued under an Act;

 (b) bonds, debentures, stock and other securities issued by:

 (i) a State;

 (ii) a Territory;

 (iii) a municipal corporation or other local governing body; or

 (iv) a public authority constituted by or under a law of a State or Territory of the Commonwealth;

 (c) securities issued in respect of a loan to a body (whether incorporated or not) whose principal business is the supply and distribution, by a system of reticulation, in Australia or in a Territory of the Commonwealth, of water, gas or electricity; and

 (d) other securities specified in the regulations as public securities for the purposes of this section;

but does not include:

 (e) securities referred to in paragraph (a) or (b) that are issued in respect of a loan raised outside Australia and the Territories of the Commonwealth unless the securities are public securities for the purposes of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936; or

 (f) securities issued after 12 April 1976 by an ADI.

20E  Borrowing for the Common Fund

 (1) Where the Official Trustee is of the opinion:

 (a) that moneys in the Common Fund deposited in accounts at call with an ADI or ADIs are likely to be insufficient to meet payments that under this Act are to be made out of moneys in the Common Fund; and

 (b) that it would be undesirable to convert into money investments made under section 20D for the purpose of enabling those payments to be so made;

the Official Trustee may apply to the Finance Minister to borrow from the Commonwealth under this section moneys not exceeding such amount as is specified in the instrument.

 (2) The Finance Minister may, on behalf of the Commonwealth, lend to the Official Trustee, on such terms and conditions as he or she determines, moneys that the Official Trustee has applied under subsection (1) to borrow.

 (3) Moneys borrowed by the Official Trustee from the Commonwealth under this section shall be paid into the Common Fund.

 (4) Interest is not payable on moneys lent to the Official Trustee by the Commonwealth under this section.

 (5) Moneys lent to the Official Trustee by the Commonwealth under this section shall be paid out of moneys available under an appropriation made by the Parliament.

20F  Moneys in Common Fund not held on account of particular estates etc.

 (1) No moneys in the Common Fund shall be held, or be deemed for any purpose to be held, on account of any particular estate or fund.

 (2) Investments made from moneys in the Common Fund shall not be made, and shall not be deemed for any purpose to be made, on account of any particular estate or fund.

 (3) Any capital appreciation or depreciation in the value of investments made from moneys in the Common Fund shall not increase or decrease the amount payable under this Act in respect of any estate or fund.

 (4) The making of a capital profit or capital loss on the realization of investments made from moneys in the Common Fund shall not increase or decrease the amount payable under this Act in respect of any estate or fund.

 (5) Interest derived from the investment of moneys in the Common Fund shall not increase the amount payable under this Act in respect of any estate or fund.

 (6) The Official Trustee shall cause accounts to be kept showing the amount in the Common Fund from time to time standing to the credit of each estate or fund in respect of which moneys have been paid into the Common Fund.

 (7) Moneys received or held by the Official Trustee as trustee of any estate or fund do not cease to be moneys in hand for the purposes of this Act by reason only that those moneys have been paid into or become part of the Common Fund.

 (8) In this section:

estate means the estate of a bankrupt or of a deceased debtor.

fund means a fund of moneys referred to in paragraph 20J(1)(b).

20G  Common Investment Fund Equalization Account

 (1) There is continued in existence the Common Investment Fund Equalization Account.

Note: The Account was established by subsection 5(3) of the Financial Management Legislation Amendment Act 1999.

 (2) The Account is a Special Account for the purposes of the Financial Management and Accountability Act 1997.

20H  Credits to and debits from the Equalization Account

 (1) Interest derived from the investment of money in the Common Fund must be paid to the Commonwealth.

 (2) An amount equal to the amount of any capital profit made upon the realization of an investment made from money in the Common Fund must be paid out of the Common Fund to the Commonwealth.

 (3) Whenever a payment is made to the Commonwealth under subsection (1) or (2), an equal amount must be credited to the Equalization Account.

 (4) An amount equal to:

 (a) the amount of any capital loss incurred upon the realization of an investment made from money in the Common Fund; or

 (b) each amount of interest that:

 (i) forms part of the estate of a bankrupt or of a deceased debtor by virtue of subsection 20J(2) or (3); or

 (ii) forms part of a fund referred to in paragraph 20J(1)(b) by virtue of subsection 20J(2) or (3A); or

 (iii) is payable to a person by virtue of subsection 20J(4);

is to be debited from the Equalization Account and paid into the Common Fund.

 (5) The InspectorGeneral must, at such times as the InspectorGeneral considers appropriate and, in any event, at least once every 6 months, determine whether any amounts standing to the credit of the Equalization Account are not required for the purposes of subsection (4). If the InspectorGeneral determines that any amounts are not so required, the InspectorGeneral may direct that the amounts not so required, or any part of those amounts, are to be debited from the Equalization Account.

 (6) Whenever an amount required by subsection (4) to be debited from the Equalization Account exceeds the amount standing to the credit of the Equalization Account, an amount equal to the excess must be credited to the Equalization Account.

20J  Interest on moneys in Common Fund payable only in certain circumstances

 (1) Where the Official Trustee is:

 (a) the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt or of a deceased debtor; or

 (b) the trustee of a fund of moneys held or received by the Official Trustee in respect of a particular debtor or bankrupt by reason of being:

 (i) the trustee of a composition, or of a scheme of arrangement, accepted under Division 6 of Part IV; or

 (ii) the trustee of a personal insolvency agreement;

the estate or the fund is not entitled, except as provided by subsections (2), (3) and (3A), to interest on moneys held by the Official Trustee as trustee of the estate or fund, as the case may be.

 (2) Where moneys have been held, or are likely to be held, for a prescribed reason, or for one prescribed reason and then for another prescribed reason, by the Official Trustee as the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt or of a deceased debtor, or as trustee of a fund referred to in paragraph (1)(b), for not less than one year longer than those moneys would have been held, or would be likely to be held, by the Official Trustee but for that reason or those reasons, the InspectorGeneral may direct, by writing under his or her hand, that interest on those moneys, at the rate prescribed by the regulations for the purposes of this section and in respect of such period as he or she determines, shall form part of that estate or fund, as the case may be.

 (3) Where, on or after the date of commencement of this section (in the subsection referred to as the commencing date), the Official Trustee receives an amount by way of interest on moneys (other than moneys of the kind referred to in paragraph (1)(b)), or on investments, that form part of the Common Fund by virtue of subsection 20B(3):

 (a) if the interest accrued in respect of a period that ended before the commencing date—the amount of the interest forms part of the estate in respect of which those moneys or investments were held immediately before the commencing date; or

 (b) if the interest accrued in respect of a period that commenced before, but ended on or after, the commencing date—an amount that bears to the amount of that interest the same proportion as the number of days in the part of the period in respect of which the interest accrued that occurred before the commencing date bears to the number of days in that period forms part of the estate in respect of which those moneys or investments were held immediately before the commencing date.

 (3A) Where, on or after the date of commencement of this subsection (in this subsection referred to as the commencing day), the Official Trustee receives an amount by way of interest on moneys held or received by the Official Trustee by reason of being trustee of a fund referred to in paragraph (1)(b) (in this subsection referred to as the appropriate fund), being moneys that form part of the Common Fund:

 (a) if the interest accrued in respect of a period that ended before the commencing date—the amount of the interest forms part of the appropriate fund; or

 (b) if the interest accrued in respect of a period that commenced before, but ended on or after, the commencing day—an amount that bears to the amount of that interest the same proportion as the number of days in the part of the period in respect of which the interest accrued that occurred before the commencing day bears to the number of days in that period forms part of the appropriate fund.

 (4) Where it is established that:

 (a) moneys held by the Official Trustee as the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt or of a deceased debtor do not form part of the estate; or

 (b) moneys held by the Official Trustee as part of a fund referred to in paragraph (1)(b) do not form part of the fund;

interest on those moneys is payable to the person to whom those moneys are payable, out of the Common Fund, at the rate prescribed by the regulations for the purposes of this section and in respect of the period during which those moneys are held by the Official Trustee.

 (5) For the purposes of subsection (2), moneys shall be taken to have been held, or to be likely to be held, by the Official Trustee for a prescribed reason if the moneys have been held, or are likely to be held, as the case may be, by the Official Trustee:

 (a) by reason of the institution or defending of legal proceedings in good faith;

 (b) by reason that a person has, or has had, under consideration, in good faith, the institution or defending of legal proceedings; or

 (c) for any other reason declared by the regulations to be a prescribed reason for the purposes of this section.

Part IIICourts

Division 2Jurisdiction and powers of courts in bankruptcy

27  Bankruptcy courts

 (1) The Federal Court and the Federal Circuit Court have concurrent jurisdiction in bankruptcy, and that jurisdiction is exclusive of the jurisdiction of all courts other than:

 (a) the jurisdiction of the High Court under section 75 of the Constitution; or

 (b) the jurisdiction of the Family Court under section 35 or 35A of this Act.

29  Courts to help each other

 (1) All Courts having jurisdiction under this Act, the Judges of those Courts and the officers of or under the control of those Courts shall severally act in aid of and be auxiliary to each other in all matters of bankruptcy.

 (2) In all matters of bankruptcy, the Court:

 (a) shall act in aid of and be auxiliary to the courts of the external Territories, and of prescribed countries, that have jurisdiction in bankruptcy; and

 (b) may act in aid of and be auxiliary to the courts of other countries that have jurisdiction in bankruptcy.

 (3) Where a letter of request from a court of an external Territory, or of a country other than Australia, requesting aid in a matter of bankruptcy is filed in the Court, the Court may exercise such powers with respect to the matter as it could exercise if the matter had arisen within its own jurisdiction.

 (4) The Court may request a court of an external Territory, or of a country other than Australia, that has jurisdiction in bankruptcy to act in aid of and be auxiliary to it in any matter of bankruptcy.

 (5) In this section, prescribed country means:

 (a) the United Kingdom, Canada and New Zealand;

 (b) a country prescribed by the regulations for the purposes of this subsection; and

 (c) a colony, overseas territory or protectorate of a country specified in paragraph (a) or of a country so prescribed.

30  General powers of Courts in bankruptcy

 (1) The Court:

 (a) has full power to decide all questions, whether of law or of fact, in any case of bankruptcy or any matter under Part IX, X or XI coming within the cognizance of the Court; and

 (b) may make such orders (including declaratory orders and orders granting injunctions or other equitable remedies) as the Court considers necessary for the purposes of carrying out or giving effect to this Act in any such case or matter.

 (2) The Court may direct such inquiries to be made and accounts to be taken for the purposes of any proceeding before the Court as the Court considers necessary and may, when directing an account to be taken, or subsequently, give special directions as to the manner in which the account is to be taken or vouched.

 (3) If in a proceeding before the Federal Court under this Act a question of fact arises that a party desires to have tried before a jury, the Federal Court may, if it thinks fit, direct the trial of that question to be had before a jury, and the trial may be had accordingly in the same manner as if it were the trial of an issue of fact in an action.

 (5) Where:

 (a) a bankrupt, a debtor or any other person has failed to comply with an order or direction of a Registrar, or with a direction or requirement of an Official Receiver or trustee, under this Act; or

 (b) a trustee has failed to comply with an order, direction or requirement of a Registrar, or with a requirement or request of the InspectorGeneral, under this Act;

the Court may, on the application of the Registrar, Official Receiver, trustee or InspectorGeneral, as the case requires:

 (c) order the person who has failed to comply with the order, direction, requirement or request, as the case may be, to comply with it; or

 (d) if it thinks fit, make an immediate order for the committal to prison of that person.

 (6) The power conferred on the Court by subsection (5) is in addition to, and not in substitution for, any other right or remedy in respect of the failure to comply with the order, direction, requirement or request, as the case may be.

31  Exercise of jurisdiction

 (1) In exercising jurisdiction under this Act, the Court shall hear and determine the following matters in open Court:

 (a) creditors’ petitions;

 (b) examinations under this Act;

 (c) proceedings in connection with the consideration of an annulment of a bankruptcy under section 153B;

 (d) applications under:

 (i) section 222 (as applied by section 76B); or

 (ii) section 222C (as applied by section 76B);

  for an order setting aside or terminating a composition or scheme of arrangement under Division 6 of Part IV;

 (e) applications to set aside or avoid a charge, charging order, settlement, disposition, conveyance, transfer security or payment;

 (ea) applications under section 139A;

 (f) applications to declare for or against the title of the trustee to any property;

 (g) applications for the committal of a person to prison or for the release from prison of a person committed to prison;

 (i) applications for the trial of questions of fact with a jury and the trial of those questions;

 (j) applications under Part X:

 (i) for an order setting aside or terminating a personal insolvency agreement; or

 (ii) for a sequestration order against the estate of a debtor;

 (ja) applications for an order of annulment of the administration of the estate of a deceased person under Part XI; and

 (k) summary trials under Part XIV.

 (2) All other matters under this Act may, in the discretion of the Court, be heard in open Court or in Chambers.

32  Costs

  The Court may, in any proceeding before it, including a proceeding dismissed for want of jurisdiction, make such orders as to costs as it thinks fit.

33  Adjournment, amendment of process and extension and abridgment of times

 (1) The Court may:

 (a) upon such terms as it thinks fit, at any time adjourn any proceeding before it, either to a fixed date or generally;

 (b) at any time allow the amendment of any written process, proceeding or notice under this Act; or

 (c) extend before its expiration or, if this Act does not expressly provide to the contrary, after its expiration, any time limited by this Act, or any time fixed by the Court or the Registrar under this Act (other than the time fixed for compliance with the requirements of a bankruptcy notice), for doing an act or thing or abridge any such time.

33A  Alteration of filing date for statement of affairs

 (1) This section applies to a statement of affairs that was filed for the purposes of section 54, 55, 56B, 56F or 57 by a bankrupt, or by a person who later became a bankrupt.

 (2) If the Court is satisfied that the person believed, on reasonable grounds, that the statement had already been filed at a time before it was actually filed, the Court may order that the statement is to be treated as having been filed at a time before it was actually filed.

 (3) The Court cannot make an order that would result in the person being discharged from bankruptcy earlier than 30 days after the order is made.

 (4) In this section:

filed includes presented, lodged or given.

34  Orders and commissions for examination of witnesses

  The Court may, for the purposes of any proceeding before it:

 (a) order the examination upon oath of a person before an officer of the Court or other person, at any place within Australia; or

 (b) order that a commission issue to a person either within or beyond Australia authorizing him or her to take the testimony of a person upon oath;

and may:

 (c) by the same or a subsequent order, give any necessary directions concerning the time, place and manner of the examination; and

 (d) admit in evidence, saving all just exceptions, the testimony obtained at the examination or in pursuance of the commission.

34A  Standard of proof

 (1) Where, in proceedings in the Court (other than proceedings for an offence), it is necessary, for a purpose relating to a matter arising under this Act, to establish, or for the Court to be satisfied as to, a particular fact (including a contravention of this Act), it is sufficient if that fact is established, or the Court is satisfied as to that fact, as the case may be, on the balance of probabilities.

 (2) Subsection (1) has effect except to the extent that this Act expressly provides otherwise.

35  Family Court’s jurisdiction in bankruptcy where trustee is a party to property settlement or spousal maintenance proceedings etc.

 (1) If, at a particular time:

 (a) a party to a marriage is a bankrupt; and

 (b) the trustee of the bankrupt’s estate is:

 (i) a party to property settlement proceedings in relation to either or both of the parties to the marriage; or

 (ii) an applicant under section 79A of the Family Law Act 1975 for the variation or setting aside of an order made under section 79 of that Act in property settlement proceedings in relation to either or both of the parties to the marriage; or

 (iii) a party to spousal maintenance proceedings in relation to the maintenance of a party to the marriage;

then, at and after that time, the Family Court has jurisdiction in bankruptcy in relation to any matter connected with, or arising out of, the bankruptcy of the bankrupt.

 (1A) If, at a particular time:

 (a) a party to a de facto relationship is a bankrupt; and

 (b) the trustee of the bankrupt’s estate is:

 (i) a party to property settlement proceedings in relation to either or both of the parties to the de facto relationship; or

 (ii) an applicant under section 90SN of the Family Law Act 1975 for the variation or setting aside of an order made under section 90SM of that Act in property settlement proceedings in relation to either or both of the parties to the de facto relationship; or

 (iii) a party to maintenance proceedings under Part VIIIAB of the Family Law Act 1975 in relation to the maintenance of one of the parties to the de facto relationship;

then, at and after that time, the Family Court has jurisdiction in bankruptcy in relation to any matter connected with, or arising out of, the bankruptcy of the bankrupt.

 (2) Subsections (1) and (1A) do not limit the Family Court’s jurisdiction under section 35A.

 (3) In this section:

property settlement proceedings has the same meaning as in the Family Law Act 1975.

spousal maintenance proceedings means proceedings under the Family Law Act 1975 with respect to the maintenance of a party to a marriage.

 (4) An expression used in subsection (1A) that is also used in the Family Law Act 1975 has the same meaning in that subsection as it has in that Act.

35A  Transfer of proceedings to Family Court

 (1) Subject to subsection (2), where a proceeding is pending in the Federal Court, the Federal Court may, on the application of a party to the proceeding or of its own motion, transfer the proceeding to the Family Court.

 (2) A proceeding that is pending in the Federal Court at the commencement of this section shall not be transferred to the Family Court unless the parties to the proceeding consent to the transfer.

 (2A) If a proceeding is pending in the Federal Circuit Court, the Federal Circuit Court may, on the application of a party to the proceeding or on its own initiative, transfer the proceeding to the Family Court.

 (3) Subject to subsection (4), where a proceeding is transferred to the Family Court:

 (a) the Family Court has jurisdiction to hear and determine the proceeding;

 (b) the Family Court also has jurisdiction to hear and determine matters not otherwise within its jurisdiction (whether by virtue of paragraph (a) or otherwise):

 (i) that are associated with matters arising in the proceeding; or

 (ii) that, apart from subsection 32(1) of the Federal Court of Australia Act 1976, the Federal Court would have had jurisdiction to hear and determine in the proceeding;

 (c) the Family Court may, in and in relation to the proceeding:

 (i) grant such remedies;

 (ii) make orders of such kinds; and

 (iii) issue, and direct the issue of, writs of such kinds;

  as the Federal Court could have granted, made, issued or directed the issue of, as the case may be, in and in relation to the proceeding;

 (d) remedies, orders and writs granted, made or issued by the Family Court in and in relation to the proceeding have effect, and may be enforced by the Family Court, as if they had been granted, made or issued by the Federal Court;

 (e) appeals lie from judgments of the Family Court given in and in relation to the proceeding as if the judgments were judgments of the Federal Court constituted by a single Judge, and do not otherwise lie; and

 (f) subject to paragraphs (a) to (e) (inclusive), this Act, the Federal Court of Australia Act 1976, and other laws of the Commonwealth, apply in and in relation to the proceeding as if:

 (i) a reference to the Federal Court (other than in the expression “the Court or a Judge”) included a reference to the Family Court;

 (ii) a reference to a Judge of the Federal Court (other than in the expression “the Court or a Judge”) included a reference to a Family Court Judge;

 (iii) a reference to the expression “the Court or a Judge” when used in relation to the Federal Court included a reference to a Family Court Judge sitting in Chambers;

 (iv) a reference to a Registrar included a reference to a Registrar of the Family Court; and

 (v) any other necessary changes were made.

Note: Rules of Court made under the Family Law Act 1975 (rather than Rules of Court made under the Federal Court of Australia Act 1976) apply in relation to proceedings transferred to the Family Court under this section.

 (4) Where any difficulty arises in the application of paragraphs (3)(c), (d) and (f) in or in relation to a particular proceeding, the Family Court may, on the application of a party to the proceeding or of its own motion, give such directions, and make such orders, as it considers appropriate to resolve the difficulty.

 (5) An appeal does not lie from a decision of the Federal Court or the Federal Circuit Court in relation to the transfer of a proceeding under this Act to the Family Court.

35B  Family Court of Western Australia

 (1) Sections 27, 35 (other than subsection (1A)) and 35A apply to the Family Court of Western Australia in a corresponding way to the way in which they apply to the Family Court of Australia.

 (1A) Despite subsection (1), section 35A does not apply to the Family Court of Western Australia in relation to a de facto financial cause (within the meaning of the Family Law Act 1975).

 (2) Paragraph 35A(3)(f) has effect, in relation to a proceeding transferred to the Family Court of Western Australia, as if:

 (a) each reference in subparagraph 35A(3)(f)(ii) or (iii) to a Family Court Judge were a reference to a judge of the Family Court of Western Australia; and

 (b) the reference in subparagraph 35A(3)(f)(iv) to a Registrar of the Family Court were a reference to a registrar of the Family Court of Western Australia.

36  Enforcement of orders etc.

 (1) An order of the Court made, or a warrant issued, under this Act may be enforced throughout Australia by a constable.

 (2) A warrant for the arrest or detention of a person for the purpose of giving effect to an order of committal or a sentence of imprisonment made or imposed by the Court under this Act may be issued under the seal of the Court.

 (3) Where the Court commits a person to prison under this Act, the committal may be to such prison as the Court thinks fit.

37  Power of Court to rescind orders etc.

 (1) Subject to subsection (2), the Court may rescind, vary or discharge an order made by it under this Act or may suspend the operation of such an order.

 (2) The Court does not have power to rescind or discharge, or to suspend the operation of:

 (a) a sequestration order; or

 (b) an order for the administration of the estate of a deceased person under Part XI.

Part IVProceedings in connexion with bankruptcy

Division 1Acts of bankruptcy

40  Acts of bankruptcy

 (1) A debtor commits an act of bankruptcy in each of the following cases:

 (a) if in Australia or elsewhere he or she makes a conveyance or assignment of his or her property for the benefit of his or her creditors generally;

 (b) if in Australia or elsewhere:

 (i) he or she makes a conveyance, transfer, settlement or other disposition of his or her property or of any part of his or her property;

 (ii) he or she creates a charge on his or her property or on any part of his or her property;

 (iii) he or she makes a payment; or

 (iv) he or she incurs an obligation;

  that would, if he or she became a bankrupt, be void as against the trustee;

 (c) if, with intent to defeat or delay his or her creditors:

 (i) he or she departs or remains out of Australia;

 (ii) he or she departs from his or her dwellinghouse or usual place of business;

 (iii) he or she otherwise absents himself or herself; or

 (iv) he or she begins to keep house;

 (d) if:

 (i) execution has been issued against him or her under process of a court and any of his or her property has, in consequence, either been sold by the sheriff or held by the sheriff for 21 days; or

 (ii) execution has been issued against him or her under process of a court and has been returned unsatisfied;

 (daa) if the debtor presents a debtor’s petition under this Act;

 (da) if the debtor presents to the Official Receiver a declaration under section 54A;

 (e) if, at a meeting of any of his or her creditors:

 (i) he or she consents to present a debtor’s petition under this Act and does not, within 7 days from the date on which he or she so consented, present the petition; or

 (ii) he or she consents to sign an authority under section 188 and does not, within 7 days from the date on which he or she so consented, sign such an authority and inform the chair of the meeting, in writing, of the name of the person in whose favour the authority has been signed;

 (f) if, at a meeting of any of his or her creditors, he or she admits that he or she is in insolvent circumstances and, having been requested by a resolution of a majority of the creditors present at the meeting either in person or by attorney to bring his or her affairs under the provisions of this Act, he or she does not, within 7 days from the date of the meeting, either:

 (i) present a debtor’s petition; or

 (ii) sign an authority under section 188 and inform the chair of the meeting, in writing, of the name of the person in whose favour the authority has been signed;

 (g) if a creditor who has obtained against the debtor a final judgment or final order, being a judgment or order the execution of which has not been stayed, has served on the debtor in Australia or, by leave of the Court, elsewhere, a bankruptcy notice under this Act and the debtor does not:

 (i) where the notice was served in Australia—within the time specified in the notice; or

 (ii) where the notice was served elsewhere—within the time fixed for the purpose by the order giving leave to effect the service;

  comply with the requirements of the notice or satisfy the Court that he or she has a counterclaim, setoff or cross demand equal to or exceeding the amount of the judgment debt or sum payable under the final order, as the case may be, being a counterclaim, setoff or cross demand that he or she could not have set up in the action or proceeding in which the judgment or order was obtained;

 (h) if he or she gives notice to any of his or her creditors that he or she has suspended, or that he or she is about to suspend, payment of his or her debts;

 (ha) if the debtor gives the Official Receiver a debt agreement proposal;

 (hb) if a debt agreement proposal given by the debtor to the Official Receiver is accepted by the debtor’s creditors;

 (hc) if the debtor breaches a debt agreement;

 (hd) if a debt agreement to which the debtor was a party (as a debtor) is terminated under section 185P, 185Q or 185QA;

 (i) if he or she signs an authority under section 188;

 (j) if a meeting of his or her creditors is called in pursuance of such an authority;

 (k) if, without sufficient cause, he or she fails to attend a meeting of his or her creditors called in pursuance of such an authority;

 (l) if, having been required by a special resolution of a meeting of his or her creditors so called to execute a personal insolvency agreement or to present a debtor’s petition, he or she fails, without sufficient cause:

 (i) to comply with the requirements of this Act as to the execution of the agreement by him or her; or

 (ii) to present a debtor’s petition within the time specified in the resolution;

  as the case may be;

 (m) if a personal insolvency agreement executed by him or her under Part X is:

 (i) set aside by the Court; or

 (ii) terminated;

 (n) if a composition or scheme of arrangement accepted by the debtor’s creditors under Division 6 of Part IV is:

 (i) set aside by the Court; or

 (ii) terminated;

 (o) if the debtor becomes insolvent as a result of one or more transfers of property in accordance with:

 (i) a financial agreement (within the meaning of the Family Law Act 1975); or

 (ii) a Part VIIIAB financial agreement (within the meaning of the Family Law Act 1975);

  to which the debtor is a party.

 (2) In calculating for the purposes of subparagraph (1)(d)(i) the period for which property has been held by the sheriff, any time between the date on which an interpleader summons in respect of the property is taken out and the date on which the proceedings on the summons are finally disposed of, settled or discontinued shall not be taken into account.

 (3) For the purposes of paragraph (1)(g):

 (a) where leave is given by a court to enforce an award made on a submission to arbitration, being an award under which money is payable by a debtor to another person:

 (i) the award shall be deemed to be a final order obtained by that person against the debtor; and

 (ii) the arbitration proceedings shall be deemed to be the proceeding in which that final order was obtained;

 (b) a judgment or order that is enforceable as, or in the same manner as, a final judgment obtained in an action shall be deemed to be a final judgment so obtained and the proceedings in which, or in consequence of which, the judgment or order was obtained shall be deemed to be the action in which it was obtained;

 (d) a person who is for the time being entitled to enforce a final judgment or final order for the payment of money shall be deemed to be a creditor who has obtained a final judgment or final order;

 (e) a judgment or order for the payment of money made by the Court in the exercise of jurisdiction conferred on it by this Act shall be deemed to be a judgment or order the execution of which has not been stayed notwithstanding that it may not be enforceable at law by execution; and

 (f) an order made after the commencement of this paragraph under the Family Law Act 1975 for the payment by a person of arrears of maintenance for another person shall be deemed to be a final order against the firstmentioned person obtained by the other person.

 (4) The act of bankruptcy specified in paragraph (1)(j) shall be deemed to be committed on the day on which the notices calling the meeting are delivered or sent to the creditors or, if they are not all delivered or sent on the one day, on the day on which the last of the notices is so delivered or sent.

 (5) The act of bankruptcy specified in paragraph (1)(l) shall be deemed to be committed on the day after the day on which the period within which the agreement is required to be executed by the debtor or the period within which the petition is required to be presented, as the case may be, expires.

 (6) The act of bankruptcy specified in paragraph (1)(m) shall be deemed to be committed on the day on which the agreement is set aside or terminated, as the case may be.

 (7) The act of bankruptcy specified in paragraph (1)(n) shall be deemed to be committed on the day on which the composition or scheme of arrangement is set aside or terminated.

 (7A) For the purposes of paragraph (1)(o):

 (a) transfer of property includes a payment of money; and

 (b) a person who does something that results in another person becoming the owner of property that did not previously exist is taken to have transferred the property to the other person.

 (8) This section applies, so far as it is capable of application, in relation to acts and things done or occurring, and omissions and failures to do acts or things occurring, before, or partly before and partly after, the commencement of this Act, as well as to acts and things done or occurring, and omissions and failures to do acts and things occurring, after the commencement of this Act.

41  Bankruptcy notices

 (1) An Official Receiver may issue a bankruptcy notice on the application of a creditor who has obtained against a debtor:

 (a) a final judgment or final order that:

 (i) is of the kind described in paragraph 40(1)(g); and

 (ii) is for an amount of at least $5,000; or

 (b) 2 or more final judgments or final orders that:

 (i) are of the kind described in paragraph 40(1)(g); and

 (ii) taken together are for an amount of at least $5,000.

 (2) The notice must be in accordance with the form prescribed by the regulations.

 (3) A bankruptcy notice shall not be issued in relation to a debtor:

 (a) except on the application of a creditor who has obtained against the debtor a final judgment or final order within the meaning of paragraph 40(1)(g) or a person who, by virtue of paragraph 40(3)(d), is to be deemed to be such a creditor;

 (b) if, at the time of the application for the issue of the bankruptcy notice, execution of a judgment or order to which it relates has been stayed; or

 (c) in respect of a judgment or order for the payment of money if:

 (i) a period of more than 6 years has elapsed since the judgment was given or the order was made; or

 (ii) the operation of the judgment or order is suspended under section 37.

 (5) A bankruptcy notice is not invalidated by reason only that the sum specified in the notice as the amount due to the creditor exceeds the amount in fact due, unless the debtor, within the time allowed for payment, gives notice to the creditor that he or she disputes the validity of the notice on the ground of the misstatement.

 (6) Where the amount specified in a bankruptcy notice exceeds the amount in fact due and the debtor does not give notice to the creditor in accordance with subsection (5), he or she shall be deemed to have complied with the notice if, within the time allowed for payment, he or she takes such action as would have constituted compliance with the notice if the amount due had been correctly specified in it.

 (6A) Where, before the expiration of the time fixed for compliance with the requirements of a bankruptcy notice:

 (a) proceedings to set aside a judgment or order in respect of which the bankruptcy notice was issued have been instituted by the debtor; or

 (b) an application has been made to the Court to set aside the bankruptcy notice;

the Court may, subject to subsection (6C), extend the time for compliance with the bankruptcy notice.

 (6C) Where:

 (a) a debtor applies to the Court for an extension of the time for complying with a bankruptcy notice on the ground that proceedings to set aside a judgment or order in respect of which the bankruptcy notice was issued have been instituted by the debtor; and

 (b) the Court is of the opinion that the proceedings to set aside the judgment or order:

 (i) have not been instituted bona fide; or

 (ii) are not being prosecuted with due diligence;

the Court shall not extend the time for compliance with the bankruptcy notice.

 (7) Where, before the expiration of the time fixed for compliance with the requirements of a bankruptcy notice, the debtor has applied to the Court for an order setting aside the bankruptcy notice on the ground that the debtor has such a counterclaim, setoff or cross demand as is referred to in paragraph 40(1)(g), and the Court has not, before the expiration of that time, determined whether it is satisfied that the debtor has such a counterclaim, setoff or cross demand, that time shall be deemed to have been extended, immediately before its expiration, until and including the day on which the Court determines whether it is so satisfied.

42  Payment etc. of debt to Commonwealth or State after service of bankruptcy notice

 (1) Where a bankruptcy notice under this Act is served on a debtor by the Commonwealth or a State, it is a sufficient compliance with the notice if, within the time allowed by the notice, the debtor pays the amount required to be paid by the notice to, or secures it or compounds it to the satisfaction of:

 (a) the Secretary of the AttorneyGeneral’s Department, or the Crown Solicitor of the State, as the case may be; or

 (b) if an agent of the Commonwealth, or of the State, as the case may be, is specified in the notice for the purpose, the agent so specified.

 (2) A statement that the debtor may comply with the notice in the manner referred to in subsection (1) may be included in a bankruptcy notice issued on the application of the Commonwealth or a State.

Division 2Creditors’ petitions

43  Jurisdiction to make sequestration orders

 (1) Subject to this Act, where:

 (a) a debtor has committed an act of bankruptcy; and

 (b) at the time when the act of bankruptcy was committed, the debtor:

 (i) was personally present or ordinarily resident in Australia;

 (ii) had a dwellinghouse or place of business in Australia;

 (iii) was carrying on business in Australia, either personally or by means of an agent or manager; or

 (iv) was a member of a firm or partnership carrying on business in Australia by means of a partner or partners or of an agent or manager;

the Court may, on a petition presented by a creditor, make a sequestration order against the estate of the debtor.

 (2) Upon the making of a sequestration order against the estate of a debtor, the debtor becomes a bankrupt, and continues to be a bankrupt until:

 (a) he or she is discharged by force of subsection 149(1); or

 (b) his or her bankruptcy is annulled by force of subsection 74(5) or 153A(1) or under section 153B.

44  Conditions on which creditor may petition

 (1) A creditor’s petition shall not be presented against a debtor unless:

 (a) there is owing by the debtor to the petitioning creditor a debt that amounts to $5,000 or 2 or more debts that amount in the aggregate to $5,000, or, where 2 or more creditors join in the petition, there is owing by the debtor to the several petitioning creditors debts that amount in the aggregate to $5,000;

 (b) that debt, or each of those debts, as the case may be:

 (i) is a liquidated sum due at law or in equity or partly at law and partly in equity; and

 (ii) is payable either immediately or at a certain future time; and

 (c) the act of bankruptcy on which the petition is founded was committed within 6 months before the presentation of the petition.

 (2) Subject to subsection (3), a secured creditor shall, for the purposes of paragraph (1)(a), be deemed to be a creditor only to the extent, if any, by which the amount of the debt owing to him or her exceeds the value of his or her security.

 (3) A secured creditor may present, or join in presenting, a creditor’s petition as if he or she were an unsecured creditor if he or she includes in the petition a statement that he or she is willing to surrender his or her security for the benefit of creditors generally in the event of a sequestration order being made against the debtor.

 (4) Where a petitioning creditor is a secured creditor, he or she shall set out in the petition particulars of his or her security.

 (5) Where a secured creditor has presented, or joined in presenting, a creditor’s petition as if he or she were an unsecured creditor, he or she shall, upon request in writing by the trustee within 3 months after the making of a sequestration order, surrender his or her security to the trustee for the benefit of the creditors generally.

 (6) A secured creditor to whom subsection (5) applies who fails to surrender his or her security when requested to do so by the trustee in accordance with that subsection is guilty of contempt of court.

45  Creditor’s petition against partnership

 (1) A creditor of a partnership may present a petition against the partnership if he or she is entitled to present a petition against any one of the members of the partnership in respect of a partnership debt.

 (2) A creditor who is entitled to present a petition against a partnership may present a petition against any of the members of the partnership without including the others.

46  Petition against 2 or more joint debtors

 (1) A creditor’s petition may be presented against 2 or more joint debtors, whether partners or not.

 (2) Where there are 2 or more respondents to a creditor’s petition, the Court may make a sequestration order against one or more of them and dismiss the petition in so far as it relates to the other or others.

47  Requirements as to creditor’s petition

 (1) A creditor’s petition must be verified by an affidavit of a person who knows the relevant facts.

 (1A) If the rules of court prescribe a form for the purposes of this subsection, the petition must be in the form prescribed.

 (2) Except with the leave of the Court, a creditor’s petition shall not be withdrawn after presentation.

49  Change of petitioners

  Where a creditor’s petition is not prosecuted with due diligence or where for any other reason the Court considers it proper to do so, the Court may permit to be substituted as petitioner or petitioners another creditor or other creditors to whom the debtor is indebted in the amount required by this Act in the case of a petitioning creditor, and the petition may be proceeded with as if the substituted creditor or creditors had been the petitioning creditor.

50  Taking control of debtor’s property before sequestration

 (1) At any time after a bankruptcy notice is issued, or a creditor’s petition is presented, in relation to a debtor, but before the debtor becomes a bankrupt, the Court may:

 (a) direct the Official Trustee or a specified registered trustee to take control of the debtor’s property; and

 (b) make any other orders in relation to the property.

 (1A) The Court may give a direction or make an order only if:

 (a) a creditor has applied for the Court to make a direction; and

 (b) the Court is satisfied that it is in the interests of the creditors to do so; and

 (c) the debtor has not complied with the bankruptcy notice.

 (1B) If the Court directs a trustee to take control of the debtor’s property, the Court must specify when the control is to end.

 (2) Without limiting the generality of subsection (1), the Court may, at any time after giving a direction under subsection (1), summon the debtor, or an examinable person in relation to the debtor, for examination under this section in relation to the debtor.

 (3) A summons to a person under subsection (2) shall require the person to attend:

 (a) at a specified place and at a specified time on a specified day; and

 (b) before the Court, the Registrar or a magistrate, as specified in the summons;

to be examined on oath under this section about the debtor and the debtor’s examinable affairs.

 (4) A summons to a person under subsection (2) may require the person to produce at the examination books (including books of an associated entity of the debtor) that:

 (a) are in the possession of the firstmentioned person; and

 (b) relate to the debtor or to any of the debtor’s examinable affairs.

 (5) For the purpose of the examination under this section of a person summoned under subsection (2), subsections 81(2) to (17), inclusive, apply, with any modifications prescribed by the regulations, as if:

 (a) a sequestration order had been made against the debtor when the Court gave the direction under subsection (1) of this section;

 (b) the examination were being held under section 81; and

 (c) a reference in those subsections to a creditor were a reference to a person who has a debt that would be provable in the debtor’s bankruptcy if a sequestration order had been made as mentioned in paragraph (a) of this subsection.

51  Costs of prosecuting creditor’s petition

  Subject to section 109, the prosecution of a creditor’s petition to and including the making of a sequestration order on the petition shall be at the expense of the creditor.

52  Proceedings and order on creditor’s petition

 (1) At the hearing of a creditor’s petition, the Court shall require proof of:

 (a) the matters stated in the petition (for which purpose the Court may accept the affidavit verifying the petition as sufficient);

 (b) service of the petition; and

 (c) the fact that the debt or debts on which the petitioning creditor relies is or are still owing;

and, if it is satisfied with the proof of those matters, may make a sequestration order against the estate of the debtor.

 (1A) If the Court makes a sequestration order, the creditor who obtained the order must give a copy of it to the Official Receiver before the end of the period of 2 days beginning on the day the order was made.

Penalty: 5 penalty units.

Note: See also section 277B (about infringement notices).

 (1B) Subsection (1A) is an offence of strict liability.

Note: For strict liability, see section 6.1 of the Criminal Code.

 (2) If the Court is not satisfied with the proof of any of those matters, or is satisfied by the debtor:

 (a) that he or she is able to pay his or her debts; or

 (b) that for other sufficient cause a sequestration order ought not to be made;

it may dismiss the petition.

 (3) The Court may, if it thinks fit, upon such terms and conditions as it thinks proper, stay all proceedings under a sequestration order for a period not exceeding 21 days.

 (4) A creditor’s petition lapses at the expiration of:

 (a) subject to paragraph (b), the period of 12 months commencing on the date of presentation of the petition; or

 (b) if the Court makes an order under subsection (5) in relation to the petition—the period fixed by the order;

unless, before the expiration of whichever of those periods is applicable, a sequestration order is made on the petition or the petition is dismissed or withdrawn.

 (5) The Court may, at any time before the expiration of the period of 12 months commencing on the date of presentation of a creditor’s petition, if it considers it just and equitable to do so, upon such terms and conditions as it thinks fit, order that the period at the expiration of which the petition will lapse be such period, being a period exceeding 12 months and not exceeding 24 months, commencing on the date of presentation of the petition as is specified in the order.

53  Consolidation of proceedings

 (1) Where 2 or more members of a partnership or 2 or more joint debtors have become bankrupts, the Court may consolidate the proceedings upon such terms as it thinks fit.

 (2) Where the Court makes an order under subsection (1), section 110 applies in the administration under this Act of all of the estates to which the order relates.

 (3) Where the Court makes an order under subsection (1) in relation to the estates of 2 or more bankrupts, the Court may, in the order:

 (a) declare a specified date to be, for the purpose of the application of the provisions of Division 3 of Part VI in the administration of the joint estate, the date on which all the petitions relevant to the administration of those estates shall be deemed to have been presented;

 (b) declare a specified date to be, for that purpose, the date of the bankruptcy in respect of each of those estates; and

 (c) declare a specified time to be, for that purpose, the time that is the commencement of the bankruptcy in respect of all those estates;

and, if the Court does so, those estates shall be administered accordingly.

54  Bankrupt’s statement of affairs

 (1) Where a sequestration order is made, the person against whose estate it is made shall, within 14 days from the day on which he or she is notified of the bankruptcy:

 (a) make out and file with the Official Receiver a statement of his or her affairs; and

 (b) furnish a copy of the statement to the trustee.

Penalty: 25 penalty units.

 (2) Where a sequestration order is made against 2 or more joint debtors (whether partners or not), each of those persons shall (in addition to complying with subsection (1) in relation to his or her affairs), within 14 days from the day on which he or she is notified of the bankruptcy, and either on his or her own account or jointly with another or others of those debtors:

 (a) make out and file in the office of the Official Receiver a statement of the joint affairs of those persons; and

 (b) furnish a copy of the statement to the trustee.

Penalty: 5 penalty units.

 (3) Subsections (1) and (2) are offences of strict liability.

Note: For strict liability, see section 6.1 of the Criminal Code.

 (4) A person who states in writing that he or she is a creditor of a bankrupt against whom a sequestration order has been made, or a creditor of 2 or more bankrupts against whom the one sequestration order has been made, may without fee, and any other person may on payment of the fee determined by the Minister by legislative instrument, inspect, personally or by an agent, the statement of affairs filed by the bankrupt or the statements of affairs filed by the bankrupts, as the case may be, and may obtain a copy of, or take extracts from, the statement or statements.

 (5) A bankrupt against whom a sequestration order has been made may, without fee and either personally or by an agent:

 (a) inspect the bankrupt’s statement of affairs; or

 (b) obtain a copy of, or take extracts from, the bankrupt’s statement of affairs.

 (6) If the approved form for a statement of affairs indicates that particular information in the statement will not be made available to the public, then the Official Receiver must ensure that the information is not made available under this section to any person (other than the bankrupt or an agent of the bankrupt).

 (7) The Official Receiver may refuse to allow a person access under this section to particular information in a bankrupt’s statement of affairs on the ground that access to that information would jeopardise, or be likely to jeopardise, the safety of any person.

Division 2ADeclaration of intention to present debtor’s petition

54A  Presentation of declaration

 (1) Subject to section 54B, a debtor may present to the Official Receiver a declaration, in the approved form, of the debtor’s intention to present a debtor’s petition.

 (2) A declaration presented by a debtor under this section must be accompanied by a statement of the debtor’s affairs and a copy of that statement.

54B  When debtor disqualified from presenting declaration

  A debtor is not entitled to present a declaration under section 54A:

 (a) when the debtor is not entitled, except with the leave of the Court, to present a petition under section 55;

 (b) after a creditor’s petition presented against the debtor is served on the debtor and before:

 (i) a sequestration order is made on the petition;

 (ii) the petition is withdrawn or dismissed; or

 (iii) the petition lapses under subsection 52(4);

 (c) after a debtor’s petition is presented against the debtor and before the petition is accepted or rejected;

 (d) while the debtor’s property is subject to control under Division 2 of Part X;

 (e) within 6 months after the debtor signs an authority under section 188; or

 (f) within 12 months after a declaration presented by the debtor under section 54A is accepted under section 54C.

54C  Acceptance or rejection of declaration

 (1) Subject to section 54D, where a debtor presents a declaration under section 54A, the Official Receiver shall:

 (a) if it appears to the Official Receiver that the debtor is entitled to present a declaration under section 54A and that the declaration presented is in accordance with the approved form:

 (i) accept the declaration and endorse it accordingly; and

 (ii) forthwith sign a copy of the declaration; or

 (b) in any other case—reject the declaration.

 (2) If the Official Receiver accepts the declaration, the Official Receiver must give written notice of the acceptance of the declaration to each of the creditors disclosed in the debtor’s statement of affairs.

54D  Official Receiver to give information to debtor

 (1) Before accepting a declaration presented by a debtor under section 54A, the Official Receiver must give the debtor the information prescribed by the regulations.

 (2) A contravention of subsection (1) does not affect the validity of the Official Receiver’s acceptance under section 54C of a declaration presented under section 54A.

54E  Enforcement suspended during stay period

 (1) Where, during the stay period in relation to a declaration of intention presented by a debtor, a copy of the declaration signed by the Official Receiver who accepted it is produced to a creditor to whom the debtor owes a frozen debt, subsection (2) has effect throughout the remainder of that period.

 (2) It is not competent for the creditor:

 (a) to apply for the issue of enforcement process in respect of the debt; or

 (b) to enforce a remedy against the debtor’s person or property in respect of the debt.

 (3) Nothing in this section prevents a creditor from commencing a legal proceeding in respect of a debt, or from taking a fresh step in such a proceeding otherwise than in connection with enforcing a judgment.

54F  Duties of sheriff

 (1) Where, during the stay period in relation to a declaration of intention presented by a debtor, a copy of the declaration signed by the Official Receiver who accepted it is produced to a sheriff, subsections (2) and (3) have effect throughout the remainder of that period.

 (2) The sheriff shall refrain from taking action, or further action, to execute, or to sell property under, enforcement process issued in respect of a frozen debt owed by the debtor.

 (3) The sheriff shall refrain from paying to a person proceeds of enforcement process issued in respect of a frozen debt owed by the debtor.

 (4) A contravention of this section does not affect a person’s title to property that was purchased in good faith under a sale under enforcement process issued in respect of a debt.

 (5) Where:

 (a) under this section, a sheriff refrains from taking action, or further action, to sell real property under enforcement process issued in respect of a debt;

 (b) the debtor becomes a bankrupt; and

 (c) the property vests in the trustee of the bankrupt’s estate;

the costs of executing the enforcement process are a first charge on the property.

54G  Duty of court registrar

  Where, during the stay period in relation to a declaration of intention presented by a debtor, a copy of the declaration signed by the Official Receiver who accepted it is produced to the registrar or other appropriate officer of a court, the registrar or other officer shall, throughout the remainder of that period, refrain from paying to a person proceeds of enforcement process issued in respect of a frozen debt owed by the debtor.

54H  Duties of person entitled to deduct money owing to declared debtor

 (1) Where, during the stay period in relation to a declaration of intention presented by a debtor, a copy of the declaration signed by the Official Receiver who accepted it is produced to a person who is entitled under a law of the Commonwealth, of a State, or of a Territory of the Commonwealth:

 (a) to retain or deduct money from money payable or owing, or to become payable or owing, to the debtor; and

 (b) to apply the retained or deducted money toward discharging a frozen debt owed by the debtor to any person;

subsections (2) and (3) apply.

 (2) The person shall, throughout the remainder of that period:

 (a) refrain from so retaining or deducting money; and

 (b) refrain from paying to a person (other than the debtor), or otherwise applying, money that was so retained or deducted before the signed copy was produced to the person.

 (3) Nothing in this section affects a person’s liability to pay money to the debtor.

54J  Extension of time where this Division prevents the doing of an act

  Where, throughout a particular period, this Division prevents the doing of a particular act, that period shall be disregarded in determining, for the purposes of any law, agreement or instrument, whether or not that act has been done within a particular period or before a particular time.

54K  Section 33 not to apply to this Division

  Nothing in section 33 permits the extension or abridgment of a period or time limited by this Division.

54L  Secured creditor’s rights under security not affected

  Nothing in this Division affects the right of a secured creditor to realise or otherwise deal with the creditor’s security.

Division 3Debtors’ petitions

55  Debtor’s petition

 (1) Subject to this section, a debtor may present to the Official Receiver a petition against himself or herself.

 (2) A petition presented by a debtor under this section:

 (a) shall be in accordance with the approved form; and

 (b) shall be accompanied by a statement of the debtor’s affairs and a copy of that statement.

 (2A) The Official Receiver must reject a debtor’s petition unless, at the time when the petition is presented, the debtor:

 (a) was personally present or ordinarily resident in Australia; or

 (b) had a dwellinghouse or place of business in Australia; or

 (c) was carrying on business in Australia, either personally or by means of an agent or manager; or

 (d) was a member of a firm or partnership carrying on business in Australia by means of a partner or partners or of an agent or manager.

 (3) The Official Receiver may reject a debtor’s petition if:

 (a) the petition does not comply substantially with the approved form; or

 (b) the petition is not accompanied by a statement of affairs; or

 (c) the Official Receiver thinks that the statement of affairs accompanying the petition is inadequate.

 (3AA) The Official Receiver may reject a debtor’s petition (the current petition) if:

 (a) it appears from the information in the statement of affairs (and any additional information supplied by the debtor) that, if the debtor did not become a bankrupt, the debtor would be likely (either immediately or within a reasonable time) to be able to pay all the debts specified in the statement of affairs; and

 (b) at least one of the following applies:

 (i) it appears from the information in the statement of affairs (and any additional information supplied by the debtor) that the debtor is unwilling to pay one or more debts to a particular creditor or creditors, or is unwilling to pay creditors in general;

 (ii) before the current petition was presented, the debtor previously became a bankrupt on a debtor’s petition at least 3 times, or at least once in the period of 5 years before presentation of the current petition.

 (3AB) The Official Receiver is not required to consider in each case whether there is a discretion to reject under subsection (3AA).

 (3AC) The debtor may apply to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal for the review of a decision by the Official Receiver to reject a petition under subsection (3AA).

 (3A) Before accepting a debtor’s petition the Official Receiver must give the debtor the information prescribed by the regulations.

 (3B) The Official Receiver must refer a debtor’s petition to the Court for a direction to accept or reject it if there is a creditor’s petition pending against a group of debtors (whether they are joint debtors or members of a partnership) that includes the debtor against whom the debtor’s petition is presented.

Example 1: When Anna presents a debtor’s petition against herself, there is a creditor’s petition pending against Anna and Tim as joint debtors. The Official Receiver must refer the debtor’s petition to the Court.

Example 2: When Peter presents a debtor’s petition against himself, there are 2 creditor’s petitions pending against him alone. The Official Receiver is not required to refer the debtor’s petition to the Court, because Peter does not form a group by himself.

 (3C) If the Court directs the Official Receiver to accept the debtor’s petition, the Court must specify the time of the commencement of the bankruptcy that results from acceptance of the debtor’s petition.

 (4) The Official Receiver must accept a debtor’s petition, unless the Official Receiver rejects it under this section or is directed by the Court to reject it.

 (4A) Where the Official Receiver accepts a petition presented under this section:

 (a) he or she shall endorse the petition accordingly; and

 (b) upon the Official Receiver endorsing the petition, the debtor who presented the petition becomes a bankrupt by force of this section and by virtue of presentation of the petition.

 (5) If a registered trustee is the trustee of the estate of a debtor who becomes a bankrupt under this section, the Official Receiver must:

 (a) notify the trustee of the bankruptcy; and

 (b) give the trustee a copy of the statement of affairs that accompanied the debtor’s petition.

 (5A) A debtor who is a party (as debtor) to a debt agreement must not present a debtor’s petition unless the Court gives the debtor permission to do so.

 (6) A debtor who has executed a personal insolvency agreement is not, except with the leave of the Court, entitled to present a petition against himself or herself unless:

 (a) the agreement has been set aside; or

 (b) the agreement has been terminated; or

 (c) all the obligations that the agreement created have been discharged.

 (6A) A debtor in relation to whom a stay under a proclaimed law applies is not, except with the leave of the Court, entitled to present a petition against himself or herself.

 (7) Where a petition is presented by a debtor against himself or herself in contravention of subsection (5A), (6) or (6A), the debtor does not become a bankrupt by virtue of its presentation.

 (8) A person who becomes a bankrupt by force of this section continues to be a bankrupt until:

 (a) he or she is discharged by force of subsection 149(1); or

 (b) his or her bankruptcy is annulled by force of subsection 74(5) or 153A(1) or under section 153B.

 (9) A person who states in writing that he or she is a creditor of a bankrupt who has become a bankrupt by force of this section may without fee, and any other person may on payment of the fee determined by the Minister by legislative instrument, inspect, personally or by an agent, the statement of affairs that accompanied the petition presented by the bankrupt, and may obtain a copy of, or take extracts from, the statement.

 (10) A bankrupt who has become a bankrupt by force of this section may, without fee and either personally or by an agent:

 (a) inspect the bankrupt’s statement of affairs; and

 (b) obtain a copy of, or make extracts from, the bankrupt’s statement of affairs.

 (11) If the approved form for a statement of affairs indicates that particular information in the statement will not be made available to the public, then the Official Receiver must ensure that the information is not made available under this section to any person other than the bankrupt (or an agent of the bankrupt).

 (12) The Official Receiver may refuse to allow a person access under this section to particular information in a bankrupt’s statement of affairs on the ground that access to that information would jeopardise, or be likely to jeopardise, the safety of any person.

56A  Persons who may present a debtor’s petition against a partnership

 (1) A debtor’s petition against a partnership may be presented by:

 (a) all the partners; or

 (b) a majority of the partners who are resident in Australia.

 (2) A member of a partnership who is a party (as debtor) to a debt agreement must not join in presenting a debtor’s petition against the partnership unless the Court gives the member permission to do so.

 (3) A member of a partnership who has executed a personal insolvency agreement must not join in presenting a petition against the partnership unless:

 (a) the agreement has been set aside; or

 (b) the agreement has been terminated; or

 (c) all the obligations that the agreement created have been discharged; or

 (d) the Court gives permission for the member to join in presenting a petition against the partnership.

 (6) A member of a partnership in relation to whom a stay under a proclaimed law applies must not join in presenting a petition against the partnership unless the Court gives the member permission to do so.

 (7) If a member of a partnership contravenes subsection (2), (3), (4), (5) or (6) by joining in the presentation of a petition, the petition does not have any effect.

56B  Presentation of a debtor’s petition against a partnership

 (1) Any debtor’s petition against a partnership must be presented to the Official Receiver.

 (2) A petition must be in accordance with the approved form.

 (3) A petition must be accompanied by:

 (a) a statement of affairs of each member of the partnership by whom the petition is presented; and

 (b) a statement of the partnership affairs; and

 (c) a copy of each of those statements.

 (4) The Official Receiver may reject a petition if:

 (a) the petition does not comply substantially with the approved form; or

 (b) the petition is not accompanied by the statements of affairs of each petitioning partner and of the partnership; or

 (c) the Official Receiver thinks that any of the statements of affairs accompanying the petition is inadequate.

 (5) Before accepting a debtor’s petition against a partnership, the Official Receiver must give the information prescribed by the regulations to each member of the partnership who joined in presenting the petition.

56C  Referral to the Court of a debtor’s petition against a partnership

 (1) The Official Receiver must refer a debtor’s petition against a partnership to the Court for a direction to accept or reject the petition if either or both of the following conditions are met:

 (a) the petition was presented against the partnership by some, but not all, members of the partnership;

 (b) there is at least one creditor’s petition pending against at least one of the members of the partnership (not counting a creditor’s petition against all the members of the partnership and noone else).

Example 1: Edith, Lindsay and Bertha are the members of a partnership. When Edith and Lindsay present a debtor’s petition against the partnership there is a creditor’s petition pending against Bertha. The Official Receiver must refer the debtor’s petition to the Court.

Example 2: Keith, Leigh and Judith are the members of a partnership. When they all present a debtor’s petition against the partnership, there are 2 creditor’s petitions pending: one against Keith, Leigh and Judith, the other against Judith alone. The Official Receiver must refer the debtor’s petition to the Court.

Example 3: Meredith, Ramsay and Wilson are the members of a partnership. When they all present a debtor’s petition against the partnership, there are 2 creditor’s petitions pending. Both of the creditor’s petitions are against Meredith, Ramsay and Wilson (and noone else). There is no requirement for the Official Receiver to refer the debtor’s petition to the Court.

 (2) If the Official Receiver refers a petition to the Court because the petition was presented by some, but not all, of the members of the partnership, the Official Receiver must give notice in accordance with the regulations to the members who did not present the petition.

 (3) After a petition has been referred to the Court, the Court must direct the Official Receiver:

 (a) to accept the petition in the form in which it was referred to the Court; or

 (b) to accept the petition after amending it as directed by the Court; or

 (c) to reject the petition.

 (4) If:

 (a) a debtor’s petition is presented against a partnership that includes a person to whom a stay applies under a proclaimed law; and

 (b) the person is not one of the petitioning partners;

the Court must not give a direction in relation to the petition until the person administering the proclaimed law has had an opportunity to be heard.

 (5) If the Court directs the Official Receiver to accept (either with or without amendments) a petition referred to the Court, the Court must specify the time of the commencement of the bankruptcy of each of the persons who becomes a bankrupt as a result of the acceptance of the petition.

56D  Acceptance of a debtor’s petition against a partnership by the Official Receiver

 (1) The Official Receiver must accept a debtor’s petition against a partnership unless the Official Receiver rejects it under section 56B or is directed by the Court to reject the petition.

 (2) When the Official Receiver accepts the petition, the Official Receiver must note on it the fact that it has been accepted.

56E  Effects of acceptance of a debtor’s petition against a partnership

 (1) When the Official Receiver notes the fact of acceptance on a petition that has not been amended under a direction of the Court, each member of the partnership becomes a bankrupt by force of this section.

 (2) When the Official Receiver notes the fact of acceptance on a petition that has been amended under a direction of the Court, each member of the partnership to whom the petition applies becomes a bankrupt by force of this section.

 (3) A person who becomes a bankrupt by force of this section continues to be a bankrupt until:

 (a) he or she is discharged by force of subsection 149(1); or

 (b) his or her bankruptcy is annulled by force of subsection 74(5) or 153A(1) or under section 153B.

 (4) If a registered trustee is the trustee of the estate of a person who becomes a bankrupt under this section, the Official Receiver must:

 (a) notify the trustee of the bankruptcy; and

 (b) give the trustee a copy of each statement of affairs that accompanied the debtor’s petition.

56F  Extra duties of nonpetitioning partners who become bankrupts

 (1) A member of a partnership who did not join in presenting a debtor’s petition against the partnership but became a bankrupt as a result of the acceptance of the petition must give the Official Receiver:

 (a) a statement of the member’s affairs; and

 (b) a statement of the affairs of the partnership;

within 14 days after the day that the member was notified of his or her bankruptcy.

Penalty: 25 penalty units.

 (1A) Subsection (1) is an offence of strict liability.

Note: For strict liability, see section 6.1 of the Criminal Code.

 (1B) Subsection (1) does not apply if the member has a reasonable excuse.

Note: A defendant bears an evidential burden in relation to the matter in subsection (1B) (see subsection 13.3(3) of the Criminal Code).

 (2) A member of a partnership complies with paragraph (1)(b) if the member and at least one other member of the partnership who did not join in presenting the petition against the partnership jointly give the Official Receiver a statement of the affairs of the partnership.

 (3) A member of a partnership who must give statements of affairs to the Official Receiver under subsection (1) must give copies of the statements to the trustee in the member’s bankruptcy.

56G  Inspection of statements of affairs of partners and partnerships

 (1) A person may inspect, obtain a copy of, or take extracts from, any statement of affairs that was given to the Official Receiver in connection with a debtor’s petition against a partnership.

 (2) Before inspecting, obtaining a copy of or taking extracts from a statement, the person must pay the fee determined by the Minister by legislative instrument, unless:

 (a) the person states in writing that he or she is a creditor of the partnership or of a member of the partnership who became a bankrupt as a result of the petition; or

 (aa) the person is a member of the partnership who became a bankrupt as a result of the petition; or

 (b) the person is an agent of a person described in paragraph (a) or (aa).

 (3) A person who has become a bankrupt by force of section 56E may, without fee and either personally or by an agent:

 (a) inspect any statement of affairs that accompanied the petition; and

 (b) obtain a copy of, or make extracts from, any statement of affairs that accompanied the petition.

 (4) If the approved form for a statement of affairs indicates that particular information in the statement will not be made available to the public, then the Official Receiver must ensure that the information is not made available under this section to any person (other than a member of the partnership who became a bankrupt as a result of the petition or an agent of such a member).

 (5) The Official Receiver may refuse to allow a person access under this section to particular information in a statement of affairs on the ground that access to that information would jeopardise, or be likely to jeopardise, the safety of any person.

57  Debtor’s petition by joint debtors who are not partners

 (1) Where joint debtors are not in partnership with one another, the debtors, or any 2 or more of the debtors, may present to the Official Receiver a petition jointly against themselves.

 (2) A petition under this section shall be in accordance with the approved form and shall be accompanied by:

 (a) a statement of affairs of each of the petitioning debtors;

 (b) a statement of their joint affairs; and

 (c) a copy of each of those statements.

 (2A) The Official Receiver must reject a debtor’s petition unless, at the time when the petition is presented, each petitioning debtor:

 (a) was personally present or ordinarily resident in Australia; or

 (b) had a dwellinghouse or place of business in Australia; or

 (c) was carrying on business in Australia, either personally or by means of an agent or manager; or

 (d) was a member of a firm or partnership carrying on business in Australia by means of a partner or partners or of an agent or manager.

 (3) The Official Receiver may reject a debtor’s petition if:

 (a) the petition does not comply substantially with the approved form; or

 (b) the petition is not accompanied by all the statements of affairs required by subsection (2); or

 (c) the Official Receiver thinks that any of the statements of affairs accompanying the petition is inadequate.

 (3AA) The Official Receiver may reject a debtor’s petition (the current petition) if the following conditions are satisfied for at least one of the petitioning debtors:

 (a) it appears from the information in the statement of affairs (and any additional information supplied by the debtor) that, if the debtor did not become a bankrupt, the debtor would be likely (either immediately or within a reasonable time) to be able to pay all the debts specified in the debtor’s statement of affairs;

 (b) at least one of the following applies:

 (i) it appears from the information in the statement of affairs (and any additional information supplied by the debtor) that the debtor is unwilling to pay one or more debts to a particular creditor or creditors, or is unwilling to pay creditors in general;

 (ii) before the current petition was presented, the debtor previously became a bankrupt on a debtor’s petition at least 3 times, or at least once in the period of 5 years before presentation of the current petition.

 (3AB) The Official Receiver is not required to consider in each case whether there is a discretion to reject under subsection (3AA).

 (3AC) An application may be made to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal for the review of a decision by the Official Receiver to reject a petition under subsection (3AA).

 (3A) Before accepting a debtor’s petition against joint debtors, the Official Receiver must give each petitioning debtor the information prescribed by the regulations.

 (3B) The Official Receiver must refer a debtor’s petition to the Court for a direction to accept or reject it if there is at least one creditor’s petition that:

 (a) is pending against at least one of the debtors (whether or not the creditor’s petition also relates to other persons); and

 (b) does not relate only to all the joint debtors who presented the debtor’s petition.

Example 1: Peta and Abdul are joint debtors. When they present a debtor’s petition against themselves, there is a creditor’s petition pending against Abdul. The Official Receiver must refer the debtor’s petition to the Court, because the creditor’s petition does not relate to both Peta and Abdul.

Example 2: Joan and Craig are joint debtors. When they present a debtor’s petition against themselves, there is a creditor’s petition pending against Joan, Craig and Paul. The Official Receiver must refer the debtor’s petition to the Court.

Example 3: Kim, Robin and Jane are joint debtors. When they present a debtor’s petition against themselves, there is a creditor’s petition pending against Kim, Robin and Jane, and noone else. The Official Receiver is not required to refer the debtor’s petition to the Court.

 (3C) If the Court directs the Official Receiver to accept the debtor’s petition, the Court must specify the time of the commencement of each bankruptcy that results from acceptance of the debtor’s petition.

 (4) The Official Receiver must accept a debtor’s petition, unless the Official Receiver rejects it under subsection (3) or is directed by the Court to reject it.

 (5) Where the Official Receiver accepts a petition presented under this section:

 (a) he or she shall endorse the petition accordingly; and

 (b) upon the Official Receiver endorsing the petition, each of the petitioning debtors becomes a bankrupt by force of this section and by virtue of presentation of the petition.

 (6) If a registered trustee is the trustee of the estate of a person who becomes a bankrupt under this section, the Official Receiver must:

 (a) notify the trustee of the bankruptcy; and

 (b) give the trustee a copy of each statement of affairs that accompanied the debtor’s petition.

 (6A) A debtor who is a party (as debtor) to a debt agreement must not present a debtor’s petition unless the Court gives the debtor permission to do so.

 (7) A debtor who has executed a personal insolvency agreement is not entitled to join in presenting a petition under this section unless:

 (a) the agreement has been set aside; or

 (b) the agreement has been terminated; or

 (c) all the obligations that the agreement created have been discharged; or

 (d) the Court grants leave for the debtor to join in presenting a petition under this section.

 (8) A debtor in relation to whom a stay under a proclaimed law applies is not, except with the leave of the Court, entitled to join in presenting a petition under this section.

 (9) Where a petition is presented in contravention of subsection (6A), (7) or (8), the presentation of the petition does not have any effect.

 (10) A person who becomes a bankrupt by force of this section continues to be a bankrupt until:

 (a) he or she is discharged by force of subsection 149(1); or

 (b) his or her bankruptcy is annulled by force of subsection 74(5) or 153A(1) or under section 153B.

 (11) A person who states in writing that he or she is a creditor of a bankrupt who has become a bankrupt by virtue of the presentation of a debtor’s petition against joint debtors, or a creditor of joint debtors some or all of whom have become bankrupts by force of this section, may without fee, and any other person may on payment of the fee determined by the Minister by legislative instrument, inspect, personally or by an agent, any statement of affairs that accompanied the petition presented by the joint debtors, and may obtain a copy of, or take extracts from, any such statement of affairs.

 (12) A bankrupt who has become a bankrupt by force of this section may, without fee and either personally or by an agent:

 (a) inspect any statement of affairs that accompanied the petition; and

 (b) obtain a copy of, or make extracts from, any statement of affairs that accompanied the petition.

 (13) If the approved form for a statement of affairs indicates that particular information in the statement will not be made available to the public, then the Official Receiver must ensure that the information is not made available under this section to any person (other than a petitioning debtor or an agent of a petitioning debtor).

 (14) The Official Receiver may refuse to allow a person access under this section to particular information in a statement of affairs on the ground that access to that information would jeopardise, or be likely to jeopardise, the safety of any person.

57A  Time at which person becomes bankrupt on debtor’s petition

  Where, after the commencement of this section, a person becomes a bankrupt by virtue of the presentation of a debtor’s petition, the person shall, for the purposes of this Act, be deemed to become a bankrupt at the first instant of the day on which the petition is accepted by the Official Receiver.

Division 4Effect of bankruptcy on property and proceedings

58  Vesting of property upon bankruptcy—general rule

 (1) Subject to this Act, where a debtor becomes a bankrupt:

 (a) the property of the bankrupt, not being afteracquired property, vests forthwith in the Official Trustee or, if, at the time when the debtor becomes a bankrupt, a registered trustee becomes the trustee of the estate of the bankrupt by virtue of section 156A, in that registered trustee; and

 (b) afteracquired property of the bankrupt vests, as soon as it is acquired by, or devolves on, the bankrupt, in the Official Trustee or, if a registered trustee is the trustee of the estate of the bankrupt, in that registered trustee.

Note 1: This subsection has a limited application if there are orders in force under the proceeds of crime law: see section 58A.

Note 2: Even if property has vested under this section, it may, under the Proceeds of Crime Act 2002:

(a) become subject to a restraining order; and

(b) be taken into account in making a pecuniary penalty order; and

(c) become subject to a charge to secure the payment of an amount under a pecuniary penalty order, if it is subject to a restraining order; and

(d) be dealt with by the Official Trustee, if it is subject to a restraining order and a court has directed the Official Trustee to pay the Commonwealth an amount under a pecuniary penalty order out of property subject to the restraining order.

 (2) Where a law of the Commonwealth or of a State or Territory of the Commonwealth requires the transmission of property to be registered and enables the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt to be registered as the owner of any such property that is part of the property of the bankrupt, that property, notwithstanding that it vests in equity in the trustee by virtue of this section, does not so vest at law until the requirements of that law have been complied with.

 (3) Except as provided by this Act, after a debtor has become a bankrupt, it is not competent for a creditor:

 (a) to enforce any remedy against the person or the property of the bankrupt in respect of a provable debt; or

 (b) except with the leave of the Court and on such terms as the Court thinks fit, to commence any legal proceeding in respect of a provable debt or take any fresh step in such a proceeding.

 (4) After a debtor has become a bankrupt, distress for rent shall not be levied or proceeded with against the property of the bankrupt, whether or not the bankrupt is a tenant of the landlord by whom the distress is sought to be levied.

 (5) Nothing in this section affects the right of a secured creditor to realize or otherwise deal with his or her security.

 (5A) Nothing in this section shall be taken to prevent a creditor from enforcing any remedy against a bankrupt, or against any property of a bankrupt that is not vested in the trustee of the bankrupt, in respect of any liability of the bankrupt under:

 (a) a maintenance agreement; or

 (b) a maintenance order;

whether entered into or made, as the case may be, before or after the commencement of this subsection.

 (6) In this section, afteracquired property, in relation to a bankrupt, means property that is acquired by, or devolves on, the bankrupt on or after the date of the bankruptcy, being property that is divisible amongst the creditors of the bankrupt.

58A  Vesting of property upon bankruptcy—effect of orders in force under the proceeds of crime law

If a restraining order or forfeiture order is in force

 (1) If property of a bankrupt is covered by a restraining order, or a forfeiture order, made before the date of the bankruptcy, subsection 58(1) does not apply to property that is covered by the order while that property is so covered.

If a pecuniary penalty order is in force

 (2) If a pecuniary penalty order is made against a bankrupt before the date of the bankruptcy, subsection 58(1) does not apply to any of the property of the bankrupt while the order is in force.

Note: For proceeds of crime orders made on or after the date of the bankruptcy, and applications for proceeds of crime orders, see sections 114A to 114C.

Notifying the trustee of grounds for subsection 58(1) to apply to property

 (3) If circumstances arise as a result of which this section no longer prevents subsection 58(1) applying to property of the bankrupt, the Director of Public Prosecutions (or the Commissioner of the Australian Federal Police, if the Commissioner is the Commonwealth proceeds of crime authority that is the responsible authority for the order under the Proceeds of Crime Act 2002) must, as soon as practicable, give the trustee written notice of the existence of the circumstances.

59  Second or subsequent bankruptcy

 (1) Where a person who is a bankrupt again becomes a bankrupt:

 (a) the property of the bankrupt:

 (i) that was acquired by, or devolved on, the bankrupt on or after the date of the earlier bankruptcy; and

 (ii) that had not been distributed amongst the creditors in the earlier bankruptcy before the date on which the person became a bankrupt on the later occasion;

  shall (subject to any disposition of that property made by the trustee in the earlier bankruptcy without knowledge of the presentation of the petition on, or by virtue of the presentation of which, the person became bankrupt on the later occasion and subject also to section 126) vest forthwith in the trustee in the later bankruptcy;

 (b) property:

 (i) that is acquired by, or devolves on, the bankrupt on or after the date of the later bankruptcy; and

 (ii) that is divisible amongst the creditors in the later bankruptcy;

  vests in the trustee in the later bankruptcy as soon as it is acquired by, or devolves on, the bankrupt;

 (c) the trustee in the earlier bankruptcy:

 (i) shall be deemed to be a creditor in the later bankruptcy in respect of any unsatisfied balance of his or her expenses or remuneration in the earlier bankruptcy, the liabilities incurred by him or her in administering the estate in the earlier bankruptcy and the debts proved in the earlier bankruptcy (whether or not those debts are entitled to priority, or are postponed, in the earlier bankruptcy);

 (ii) shall rank equally with the ordinary unsecured creditors in the later bankruptcy; and

 (iii) may, where he or she has lodged a proof of debt in the later bankruptcy, amend that proof of debt, without the consent of the trustee in the later bankruptcy, for the purpose of adding:

 (A) his or her expenses in the earlier bankruptcy that have, or his or her remuneration in the earlier bankruptcy that has, accrued after the proof of debt was lodged;

 (B) liabilities incurred by him or her in administering the estate in the earlier bankruptcy after the proof of debt was lodged; or

 (C) debts proved in the earlier bankruptcy after the proof of debt was lodged;

  or, with the consent of the trustee in the later bankruptcy, for any other purpose;

 (d) a charge or charging order that, by virtue of subsection 118(9), is void as against the trustee in the earlier bankruptcy continues to be void as against that trustee; and

 (e) a transaction that, by virtue of section 120, 121, 122, 128B or 128C, is void as against the trustee in the earlier bankruptcy continues to be void as against that trustee.

 (2) Where the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt receives notice of the presentation of a creditor’s petition against the bankrupt, the trustee shall hold the afteracquired property of the bankrupt that is then in the possession of the trustee, or the proceeds thereof, until the petition has been dealt with by the Court or has lapsed.

 (3) Where the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt receives notice that a debtor’s petition against the bankrupt has been referred to the Court, the trustee shall hold the afteracquired property of the bankrupt that is then in the possession of the trustee, or the proceeds thereof, until the Court has dealt with the petition.

 (4) Where the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt is holding afteracquired property of the bankrupt, or the proceeds of any such property, in pursuance of subsection (2) or (3) and the bankrupt again becomes a bankrupt, the trustee shall:

 (a) in a case where the trustee is also the trustee in the later bankruptcy—hold all such property, and the proceeds of such property, as the trustee in the later bankruptcy; or

 (b) in any other case—deliver all such property, and pay the proceeds of such property, to the trustee in the later bankruptcy.

 (5) Where a law of the Commonwealth or of a State or Territory of the Commonwealth requires the transmission of property to be registered, and enables the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt to be registered as the owner of any such property that is part of the property of the bankrupt, that property, notwithstanding that it vests in equity in the trustee by virtue of subsection (1), does not vest in the trustee at law until the requirements of that law have been complied with.

 (6) In subsections (2), (3) and (4), afteracquired property, in relation to a bankrupt, means such of the property that was acquired by, or devolved on, the bankrupt on or after the date of the bankruptcy, being property divisible amongst the creditors of the bankrupt, as has not been distributed amongst the creditors in the bankruptcy.

59A  Orders under Part VIII or VIIIAB of the Family Law Act 1975

  Sections 58 and 59 have effect subject to an order under Part VIII or VIIIAB of the Family Law Act 1975.

60  Stay of legal proceedings

 (1) The Court may, at any time after the presentation of a petition, upon such terms and conditions as it thinks fit:

 (a) discharge an order made, whether before or after the commencement of this subsection, against the person or property of the debtor under any law relating to the imprisonment of fraudulent debtors and, in a case where the debtor is imprisoned or otherwise held in custody under such a law, discharge the debtor out of custody; or

 (b) stay any legal process, whether civil or criminal and whether instituted before or after the commencement of this subsection, against the person or property of the debtor:

 (i) in respect of the nonpayment of a provable debt or of a pecuniary penalty payable in consequence of the nonpayment of a provable debt; or

 (ii) in consequence of his or her refusal or failure to comply with an order of a court, whether made in civil or criminal proceedings, for the payment of a provable debt;

  and, in a case where the debtor is imprisoned or otherwise held in custody in consequence of the nonpayment of a provable debt or of a pecuniary penalty referred to in subparagraph (i) or in consequence of his or her refusal or failure to comply with an order referred to in subparagraph (ii), discharge the debtor out of custody.

 (2) An action commenced by a person who subsequently becomes a bankrupt is, upon his or her becoming a bankrupt, stayed until the trustee makes election, in writing, to prosecute or discontinue the action.

 (3) If the trustee does not make such an election within 28 days after notice of the action is served upon him or her by a defendant or other party to the action, he or she shall be deemed to have abandoned the action.

 (4) Notwithstanding anything contained in this section, a bankrupt may continue, in his or her own name, an action commenced by him or her before he or she became a bankrupt in respect of:

 (a) any personal injury or wrong done to the bankrupt, his or her spouse or de facto partner or a member of his or her family; or

 (b) the death of his or her spouse or de facto partner or of a member of his or her family.

Note: See also subsection 5(6).

 (4A) Notwithstanding paragraph (1)(b), this section does not empower the Court to stay any proceedings under a proceeds of crime law.

 (5) In this section, action means any civil proceeding, whether at law or in equity.

61  Actions by bankrupt partner’s trustee

 (1) Where a member of a partnership becomes a bankrupt, the Court may, upon the application of the trustee, authorize the trustee to commence and prosecute any action in the names of the trustee and of the bankrupt’s partner or partners.

 (2) Notice of the application for authority to commence the action shall be given to the bankrupt’s partner or partners, who, or any of whom, may show cause against it.

 (3) Upon application by such a partner, the Court may, if it thinks fit, direct that that partner shall receive the share of the proceeds of the action to which he or she is entitled as a partner.

 (4) If a partner does not claim any benefit from the action, the Court may order that he or she be indemnified against costs in respect of the action.

 (5) Unless the Court otherwise orders, a release by a partner of the debt or demand to which the action relates made after notice has been given to him or her under this section is void as against the trustee.

 (6) This section applies to and in relation to joint debtors who are not partners as if they were partners.

62  Actions on joint contracts

  Where a bankrupt is a contractor in respect of a contract jointly with another person or other persons, that person or those persons may sue or be sued in respect of the contract without the joinder of the bankrupt.

63  Death of bankrupt

  Where a bankrupt dies before he or she is discharged from the bankruptcy, the proceedings in bankruptcy shall, unless the Court otherwise directs, be continued, so far as they are capable of being continued, as if he or she were alive.

Division 5Meetings of creditors

Subdivision APreliminary

63A  Definitions

 (1) In this Division, unless the contrary intention appears:

bankrupt, in relation to a meeting of the creditors of 2 or more bankrupts, means each bankrupt.

creditors and their representatives, in relation to a meeting, means:

 (a) the creditors who are entitled to vote at the meeting and are participating in person or by telephone in the meeting; and

 (b) the persons participating in person or by telephone in the meeting as proxies or attorneys of any other creditors who are entitled to vote at the meeting.

joint bankruptcy means:

 (a) a bankruptcy that occurs as the result of a sequestration order made under section 52, being an order made on a petition presented under section 46; or

 (b) a bankruptcy that occurs by force of section 56E or 57; or

 (c) bankruptcies in respect of which an order under section 53 has been made; or

 (d) bankruptcies that occur under section 55 where:

 (i) the date of each bankruptcy is the same; and

 (ii) immediately before the bankruptcies occurred, the bankrupts were joint debtors or partners who owned property jointly.

meeting means a meeting of the creditors of a bankrupt or a meeting of the creditors of any one or more of the bankrupts who were made bankrupt in a joint bankruptcy.

minutes secretary, in relation to a meeting, means a person appointed under section 64L to record the minutes of the meeting.

President, in relation to a meeting, means the person elected under section 64P to preside at the meeting.

working day, in relation to a proposed meeting, means a day other than a Saturday, a Sunday or a public holiday in the place where the meeting is proposed to be held.

 (2) A reference in this Division to a person participating in person in a meeting is a reference to a person being physically present at the meeting.

63B  Trustee’s representative

 (1) The trustee of a bankrupt may, by signed writing, appoint a person to represent the trustee at a meeting.

 (2) If the trustee is not personally present at a meeting, then, unless the contrary intention appears, a reference in this Division to the trustee, in respect of matters occurring at that meeting, is a reference to a person so appointed to represent the trustee at that meeting.

Subdivision BConvening of meetings

64  Trustee to convene meetings

 (1) The trustee must convene a meeting of the creditors of a bankrupt:

 (a) whenever the creditors so direct by resolution; and

 (b) whenever so requested in writing by at least onefourth in value of the creditors; and

 (c) whenever so requested in writing by less than onefourth in value of the creditors, being a creditor who has, or creditors who together have, lodged with the trustee sufficient security for the cost of holding the meeting.

 (2) The trustee may convene at any time a meeting of the creditors of a bankrupt.

 (3) When convening a meeting, the trustee must consider whether the proposed time and place is convenient for the creditors.

64A  Persons to whom notice of meeting to be given

 (1) If:

 (a) the bankrupt has told the trustee, or the trustee has otherwise found out, that a person is a creditor of the bankrupt; and

 (b) the trustee is aware of one or more of the following:

 (i) the address of a place of business of the person;

 (ii) the address of a place of residence of the person or, in the case of a company, the address of its registered office;

 (iii) an address to which notices may be sent to the person;

 (iv) a document exchange number to which notices may be sent to the person;

 (v) a fax transmission number to which notices may be sent to the person;

 (vi) an email address to which notices may be sent to the person;

the trustee must give notice to the person of any meeting of the bankrupt’s creditors.

 (2) Notice of a meeting must be given in a manner specified in the regulations.

64B  Certain matters to be included in notice of meeting

 (1) The notice must set out the full name and the address of a place of residence of the bankrupt.

 (2) If the meeting is the first meeting of the bankrupt’s creditors, the notice must set out any trade or business name under which the bankrupt carried on business.

 (3) The notice must set out the time, date and place at which the meeting is to be held.

 (4) The notice must set out the agenda for the meeting and must state that additional matters may be added to the agenda with the leave of the meeting.

 (5) The notice must state that a creditor, or a proxy or attorney of a creditor, may make a statement at the meeting at the appropriate time during the proceedings.

64C  If telephone conference facilities are available

  If telephone conference facilities are expected to be available at the place where the meeting is to be held and the trustee considers that, having regard to all the circumstances, it will be appropriate to use those facilities, the notice must:

 (a) set out the relevant telephone number; and

 (b) tell the creditors that a creditor, or the proxy or attorney of a creditor, who wishes to participate in the meeting by telephone must give to the trustee, not later than the secondlast working day before the day on which the meeting is to be held, a written statement setting out:

 (i) the name of the creditor and of the proxy or attorney (if any); and

 (ii) an address to which notices to the creditor, proxy or attorney may be sent; and

 (iii) a telephone number at which the creditor, proxy or attorney may be contacted; and

 (iv) any fax transmission number to which notices to the creditor, proxy or attorney may be sent; and

 (c) also tell the creditors that a creditor, or the proxy or attorney of a creditor, who participates in the meeting by telephone must pay any costs incurred by the creditor, proxy or attorney in so participating and is not entitled to be reimbursed those costs out of the bankrupt’s estate.

64D  Statement by creditor as to amount of debt

  The notice must state that each creditor must give to the trustee at or before the meeting a written statement setting out:

 (a) the amount in respect of which the creditor claims that the bankrupt is indebted to the creditor; and

 (aa) if the creditor has been assigned a debt that the bankrupt owes to the creditor—the value of the consideration that the creditor gave for the assignment of the debt; and

 (b) if the meeting is the first meeting of the bankrupt’s creditors:

 (i) whether the creditor holds a security in respect of the debt and, if so, the value of the security as estimated by the creditor and the amount of the creditor’s debt after deducting that value; and

 (ii) brief particulars of the transaction and circumstances that gave rise to the debt.

64E  Notice about voting by proxy

 (1) The notice must have attached to it a form for use in appointing a proxy.

 (2) The notice must tell the creditors that, where a creditor wishes to appoint a person to represent the creditor at the meeting as the creditor’s proxy, the creditor must complete the form of appointment of proxy and either:

 (a) arrange for the proxy to give the completed form to the trustee at the meeting; or

 (b) send the completed form with the statement given by the creditor to the trustee in accordance with section 64D.

64F  Notice about appointment of attorney

  The notice must tell the creditors that, where a creditor wishes to be represented at the meeting by an attorney, the creditor must arrange for the power of attorney to be produced to the trustee at or before the meeting.

64G  Agenda to be set out in notice of meeting

The agenda to be set out in a notice of meeting in accordance with subsection 64B(4) is to comprise the following items:

 (a) opening of the meeting and introduction of the trustee and the bankrupt;

 (b) appointment of a minutes secretary;

 (c) announcement of appointment of proxies and attorneys and circulation of instruments appointing proxies and copies of powers of attorney for inspection by the persons present;

 (d) determination whether a quorum exists;

 (e) election of a person to preside at the remainder of the meeting;

 (f) proposal of a motion “that the meeting is being held at a time, date and place that are convenient to the majority of creditors”;

 (g) if the meeting is the first meeting—tabling of the bankrupt’s statement of affairs;

 (h) statements by the trustee and by creditors and their representatives;

 (i) questions to the trustee and to the bankrupt;

 (j) President’s summary of matters raised in statements and questions;

 (k) proposal of other motions (if any);

 (l) if the trustee is a registered trustee who does not wish to be remunerated as prescribed by the regulations—if the meeting is the first meeting, approval of the remuneration proposed by the trustee, or, if the meeting is a subsequent meeting, a statement by the trustee of the amount of remuneration drawn before the meeting was held;

 (m) appointment of committee of inspection (if required);

 (n) any other business;

 (o) fixing of time, date and place for another meeting;

 (p) closure of meeting.

Subdivision CProcedure before opening of meeting

64H  Creditors, or proxies or attorneys, participating by telephone

 (1) If a trustee has considered it appropriate that telephone conference facilities may be used for a meeting of creditors pursuant to section 64C and if a creditor, or the proxy or attorney of the creditor, who wishes to participate by telephone in the meeting has satisfied the requirements of paragraph 64C(b), in so far as they are applicable, the trustee must take all reasonable steps to ensure that the creditor, or the proxy or attorney of the creditor, is contacted on the telephone number provided by that person before the start of the meeting, and if such a person is so contacted the trustee must take all reasonable steps to ensure that that person can hear the proceedings, and can be heard, by means of those facilities, so that that person can participate in the meeting.

 (2) A creditor who, or whose proxy or attorney, so participates in the meeting by telephone is taken, for all purposes of this Act, to be present personally at the meeting.

64J  Preparation of attendance record

 (1) The trustee must prepare an attendance record in accordance with subsection (2) for the purposes of the meeting and must keep the record in his or her possession after the conclusion of the meeting.

 (2) The attendance record must include 5 columns and must indicate that particulars of creditors are to be entered as follows:

 (a) the name of each creditor participating in person or by telephone, or represented by a proxy or attorney participating in person or by telephone, is to be entered in the first column;

 (b) if a creditor is so represented by a proxy or attorney, the name of the proxy or attorney is to be entered in the second column opposite to the name of the creditor in the first column;

 (c) in respect of each creditor whose name is entered in the first column:

 (i) the value of the creditor’s debt is to be entered in the third column; and

 (ii) if the debt is secured in whole or in part:

 (A) the nature, and the value as estimated by the creditor, of the security is to be entered in the fourth column; and

 (B) the balance of the creditor’s debt after deducting that value is to be entered in the fifth column.

 (3) The attendance record must also include provision for recording whether the bankrupt is present and the names of any other persons present who are not creditors or proxies or attorneys of creditors, including provision for recording the capacity in which those other persons are present.

Subdivision DProcedure at meetings

64K  Opening of meeting

 (1) The trustee is to preside at the meeting until a person is appointed to preside under section 64P.

 (2) The trustee must open the meeting and introduce himself or herself and, if the bankrupt is present, introduce the bankrupt.

 (3) If the bankrupt is not present, the trustee must announce that fact and, if the trustee is aware of any reason why the bankrupt is not present, must state that reason.

 (4) The trustee must circulate the attendance record prepared in accordance with section 64J among the creditors, and creditors’ proxies and attorneys, participating in person and must ask them to enter in that record the relevant particulars, as required by the attendance record, of:

 (a) the creditors who, or whose proxies and attorneys, are so participating in person; and

 (b) those proxies and attorneys; and

 (c) the debts of those creditors.

 (5) The trustee must enter in the attendance record the relevant particulars, as required by the attendance record, of:

 (a) creditors who, or whose proxies or attorneys, are participating in the meeting by telephone; and

 (b) those proxies and attorneys; and

 (c) the debts of those creditors.

 (6) The trustee must state in the attendance record whether or not the bankrupt is present and, if the bankrupt is not present and the trustee is aware of any reason why the bankrupt is not present, must set out that reason.

64L  Appointment of minutes secretary

 (1) The trustee must then:

 (a) invite the creditors and their representatives to propose a motion appointing a person to record the minutes of the meeting; or

 (b) if no such motion is passed—appoint a person to record those minutes.

 (2) Anyone participating in person in the meeting, whether or not a creditor or a proxy or attorney of a creditor, and including the trustee but not including the bankrupt, is eligible for appointment as the minutes secretary.

 (3) If a person appointed to record the minutes of a meeting subsequently refuses, or is unable, to record, or to continue to record, those minutes, subsections (1) and (2) apply for the purpose of appointing another person to record the minutes.

64M  Announcement of proxies and attorneys

 (1) The trustee must then announce:

 (a) the names of the creditors who are not participating in person or by telephone but whose proxies or attorneys are participating in person or by telephone; and

 (b) the names of the proxies and attorneys.

Note: Under subsection 64ZB(3), a proxy or attorney may be allowed to vote even though the appointing instrument is lodged after the announcement.

 (2) The trustee must then circulate the instruments appointing proxies, and the powers of attorney or copies of the powers of attorney, for inspection by persons present at the meeting.

64N  Quorum

 (1) The trustee must then determine whether a quorum is present.

 (2) A quorum is constituted by:

 (a) the presence in person of the trustee (or the trustee’s representative); and

 (b) a creditor, or a proxy or attorney of a creditor, participating in person or by telephone.

Note: A meeting requires at least 2 persons. Therefore the person covered by paragraph (2)(a) cannot also be the proxy or attorney of the creditor covered by paragraph (2)(b).

 (3) If a quorum is not present within 30 minutes after the time fixed for the meeting, the meeting is adjourned to a time, date and place fixed by the trustee.

 (4) The date of the adjourned meeting must be not earlier than 7 days nor later than 14 days from the date of the original meeting.

 (5) The time and place of the adjourned meeting need not be the same as the time and place of the original meeting.

 (6) The following provisions of this Division apply to any meeting at which a quorum is present within 30 minutes after the time fixed for that meeting.

 (7) To remove any doubt, but without limiting by implication the application of subsection 63B(2) to other references in this Division to the trustee, the reference in subparagraph (2)(a)(ii) of this section to the presence in person of the trustee includes a reference to the presence in person of a person appointed under subsection 63B(1) to represent the trustee.

64P  Election of person to preside at meeting

 (1) The trustee must:

 (a) invite the creditors and their representatives to nominate a person for election to preside at the meeting; or

 (b) if no person is so nominated—nominate a person for election to preside at the meeting.

 (2) Anyone participating in person in the meeting, whether or not a creditor or a proxy or attorney of a creditor, and including the trustee but not including the bankrupt, is eligible to be nominated for appointment, and may be elected, to preside at the meeting.

 (3) If only one person is nominated, that person is taken to be elected to preside at the meeting.

 (4) If 2 or more persons are nominated, an election is to be held to determine which of the persons nominated is to preside at the meeting and the person who receives the greatest number of votes (whether or not a majority of the votes cast) is taken to be elected to preside at the meeting.

 (5) Subject to subsection (6), voting at the election is to be on the voices.

 (6) If the trustee is unable to determine which of the persons nominated received the greatest number of the votes on the voices, the trustee must ask each creditor, and each proxy or attorney, participating in person or by telephone to state for which nominee the creditor, proxy or attorney is casting a vote or whether the creditor, proxy or attorney is abstaining from casting a vote.

 (7) If 2 or more persons each receive the greatest number of votes, the trustee must decide by lot which of those persons is to be chosen to preside at the meeting, and the person so chosen is taken to be elected to preside at the meeting.

 (8) A person elected under this section to preside at the meeting is to preside at all times after he or she is elected.

 (9) If a person so elected subsequently refuses, or is unable, to preside, or to continue to preside, at the meeting, the preceding provisions of this section apply for the purpose of electing another person to preside at the meeting.

64Q  Whether holding of meeting is convenient to majority of creditors

 (1) As soon as the President is elected, he or she must invite the creditors and their representatives to propose a motion that the meeting is being held at a time, date and place that are convenient to a majority of creditors.

 (2) If no such motion is proposed, or such a motion is proposed but is not passed, the meeting is adjourned to such time, date and place as the meeting resolves.

64R  Tabling of bankrupt’s statement of affairs

 (1) If the meeting is the first meeting, the President must then request the trustee to lay the bankrupt’s statement of affairs before the meeting and the trustee must comply with the request.

 (2) If any of the creditors and their representatives requests that a creditor be given a copy of the statement of affairs, the trustee must comply with the request as soon as reasonably practicable.

64S  Statements and questions

 (1) The President must then invite the trustee and the creditors and their representatives to make statements to the meeting.

 (2) After the statements (if any) have been made, the President must invite the creditors and their representatives to ask questions of the trustee and, if the bankrupt is present, of the bankrupt.

 (3) After the statements (if any) have been made and the questions (if any) have been asked, the President may, if he or she wishes to do so, summarise the matters raised in any such statements and in any questions asked of, and answers given by, the trustee and the bankrupt.

64T  Motions

  The President must then invite the creditors and their representatives to propose any relevant motions.

64U  Remuneration of registered trustee

 (1) If the meeting is the first meeting of the bankrupt’s creditors and the trustee is a registered trustee, the President must then ask the trustee to state the basis on which the trustee wishes to be remunerated.

 (5) The trustee must then state the basis on which the trustee wishes to be remunerated. The statement must:

 (a) if the trustee proposes to charge on a timecost basis:

 (i) if there is only one rate at which the remuneration is to be calculated—state that rate; or

 (ii) otherwise—state the respective rates at which the remuneration of the trustee and the other persons who will be assisting, or will be likely to assist, the trustee in the performance of his or her duties are to be calculated; or

 (b) if the trustee proposes to charge on the basis of a commission upon money received by the trustee—state the rate of that commission;

and must also state the periods at which the trustee proposes to withdraw funds from the bankrupt’s estate in respect of the trustee’s remuneration.

 (5A) The statement under subsection (5) must also include:

 (a) an estimate of the total amount of the trustee’s remuneration; and

 (b) an explanation of the likely impact of that remuneration on the dividends (if any) to creditors.

 (6) Any of the creditors and their representatives may ask the trustee questions about the proposed remuneration of the trustee and, if such a question is asked, the trustee must answer it.

 (6A) The President must invite the creditors and their representatives to propose a motion that the trustee be remunerated in accordance with the statement and, if no such motion is proposed, the trustee may propose such a motion.

 (7) Any of the creditors and their representatives may move an amendment to a motion proposed in accordance with subsection (6A) so as to change in any way the basis on which the trustee is to charge or the periods at which the trustee may withdraw funds in respect of his or her remuneration or to refer the fixing of the trustee’s remuneration to a committee of inspection.

 (7A) If:

 (a) the meeting is the first meeting of the bankrupt’s creditors and the trustee is a registered trustee; and

 (b) the following apply:

 (i) before the meeting the trustee had given a notice under section 64ZBA that contained a proposal relating to how the trustee was to be remunerated;

 (ii) the notice satisfied subsections 64ZBA(2) and (2A);

 (iii) the proposal was taken to have been passed under subsection 64ZBA(3);

then subsections (1) to (7) of this section do not apply in relation to the meeting.

 (8) If the meeting is not the first meeting of the bankrupt’s creditors and the trustee is a registered trustee, the President must request the trustee to lay before the meeting a statement of the amount of remuneration drawn by the trustee from the funds of the bankrupt’s estate before the meeting was held and the trustee must comply with the request.

64V  Appointment of committee of inspection

  The President must then tell the creditors and their representatives that, if they wish to appoint a committee of inspection, a motion for the appointment of such a committee may be proposed and must explain to them the effect of section 70.

64W  Other business

  If no motion is proposed for the appointment of a committee of inspection, or a motion for the appointment of such a committee has been passed or defeated, the President must then invite the creditors and their representatives to raise any other matters relevant to the bankruptcy.

64X  Next meeting

 (1) The President must then invite the creditors and their representatives to propose a motion fixing a time, date and place for another meeting.

 (2) The passing of a resolution fixing a time, date and place for another meeting does not prevent the trustee from convening any other meeting before or after the date so fixed.

Subdivision EMiscellaneous

64Y  Adjournment of meeting

 (1) If, at any time during a meeting, the meeting is adjourned, or a resolution is passed for the adjournment of the meeting:

 (a) the adjourned meeting is taken to be a continuation of the original meeting; and

 (b) without limiting the application of paragraph (a):

 (i) the persons who carried out the duties of President and minutes secretary at the original meeting are to continue to do so at the adjourned meeting; and

 (ii) any matters required to be dealt with at the original meeting that were not so dealt with are to be dealt with at the adjourned meeting.

 (2) The trustee must give notice of the time, date and place of the adjourned meeting to each creditor in accordance with subsection 64A(2).

64Z  Duties of minutes secretary

 (1) It is the duty of the minutes secretary of a meeting to take minutes in accordance with this section recording the business transacted at the meeting.

 (2) The minutes may, but need not, record full particulars of statements made, questions asked and answers given at the meeting but must contain sufficient particulars to show that the meeting dealt with all matters that are required by this Division to be dealt with.

 (3) Without limiting the generality of subsection (2), the minutes must record:

 (a) the name, and the address of a place of residence or business, of the minutes secretary or, if there were different minutes secretaries at different times during the meeting, of each minutes secretary; and

 (b) the votes cast for each nominee at an election of a person to preside at the meeting (other than an election at which voting took place on the voices); and

 (c) the name, and the address of a place of residence or business, of the President or, if there were different Presidents at different times during the meeting, of each President.

 (4) The minutes must record the precise words of each motion proposed at the meeting and of any amendment proposed to such a motion.

 (5) If a resolution or a special resolution is passed at the meeting:

 (a) the minutes secretary must prepare a certificate recording the precise words of the resolution or special resolution; and

 (b) the President and the minutes secretary must each sign the certificate; and

 (c) the minutes secretary must give the certificate:

 (i) to the trustee; or

 (ii) in the case of a resolution passed under section 181 removing the trustee—to the trustee appointed in place of the trustee removed and to the Official Receiver; and

 (d) the trustee to whom the certificate is given must keep it and allow the bankrupt, a creditor or an authorised employee to inspect it at any reasonable time.

 (6) If a motion is passed or defeated on the voices, the minutes must record that fact and, if a person who voted against a motion that was passed on the voices asks that the person’s dissent be recorded in the minutes, that dissent must be so recorded.

 (7) The minutes must record the value of each creditor’s debt and the total value of the debts of all the creditors.

 (8) If a poll is taken on a motion, the minutes must record:

 (a) the number and names of the creditors (if any) who voted in favour of the motion and the total value of their debts; and

 (b) the number and names of the creditors (if any) who voted against the motion and the total value of their debts; and

 (c) the number and names of the creditors (if any) who abstained from voting on the motion and the total value of their debts.

 (9) A reference in this section to the value of a creditor’s debt is, if the creditor is a secured creditor, a reference to the value of that debt after deducting the value of the security as estimated by the creditor in the statement given by the creditor to the trustee under section 64D.

 (10) The minutes must be dated, and be signed by the President and the minutes secretary, not later than 14 days after the date of the meeting.

64ZA  Entitlement to vote

 (1) This section applies to voting:

 (a) at an election under section 64P of a person to preside at a meeting; and

 (b) on any motion proposed at a meeting or an amendment proposed to such a motion.

 (2) In this section:

creditor means a creditor who, or whose proxy or attorney, participates in the meeting in person or by telephone.

 (3) A person other than a creditor is not entitled to vote.

 (4) Subject to subsections (5) and (6), each creditor is entitled to vote and has one vote.

 (5) If a creditor is a secured creditor, the creditor is not entitled to vote unless the debt, or the total amount of the debts, owed to the creditor exceeds the amount estimated by the creditor in the statement given to the trustee under section 64D to be the value of the security.

 (6) A creditor who has failed to give to the trustee a statement in accordance with section 64D is not entitled to vote.

 (7) A creditor is not disqualified from voting merely because the creditor is the President or the minutes secretary.

 (8) The trustee may determine any question that arises as to the entitlement of a person to vote.

 (9) If the trustee needs a period in which to determine a question referred to in subsection (8), the meeting is to be adjourned to such time, date and place as the meeting resolves, being a date not later than 14 days after the date of the original meeting, for the purpose of enabling the trustee to determine the question.

64ZB  Manner of voting

 (1) A creditor who participates in a meeting in person or by telephone may cast the creditor’s vote personally and not otherwise.

 (2) Subject to subsections (3) and (5), the vote of a creditor who is not participating in a meeting in person or by telephone may be cast by a proxy duly appointed by the creditor, or by an attorney duly authorised by the creditor under a power of attorney, being a proxy or attorney participating in the meeting in person or by telephone, and the casting of a creditor’s vote by such a proxy or attorney is taken to constitute the casting of a vote by the creditor.

 (3) A person claiming to be the proxy of a creditor is not entitled to vote as proxy unless the instrument of appointment has been lodged with the President (or with the trustee, before the President was elected), either before or after the announcement is made under section 64M about the appointment of proxies and attorneys.

 (3A) If an instrument of appointment of a proxy is lodged with the President in substitution for another instrument with an earlier date, then the later instrument commences to have effect (from the time it is lodged with the President) in substitution for the earlier instrument.

 (4) A creditor’s proxy or attorney is not disqualified from casting the creditor’s vote merely because the proxy or attorney is the trustee, the President or the minutes secretary.

 (5) If the trustee or an associate of the trustee is a creditor’s proxy or attorney, the trustee or associate may not cast the creditor’s vote on a motion relating to the trustee’s remuneration unless the instrument appointing the proxy or the power of attorney, as the case may be, expressly authorises the trustee or associate to cast the creditor’s vote on such a motion.

 (6) For the purposes of subsection (5), a person is an associate of the trustee if the person is:

 (a) a partner of the trustee; or

 (b) an employee of the trustee; or

 (c) a solicitor for the trustee, for a partnership in which the trustee is a partner, or for a person or partnership that employs the trustee.

 (7) A motion proposed at a meeting is to be resolved:

 (a) subject to paragraph (b)—on the voices; or

 (b) if:

 (i) the President is unable to determine the result of the voting on the voices; or

 (ii) any of the creditors and their representatives requests a poll, whether the request is made before the motion is put to the vote on the voices or after the President announces the result of the vote on the voices; or

 (iii) the motion relates to a matter in respect of which this Act requires the passing of a resolution or special resolution;

  by a poll taken:

 (iv) by a show of hands or written votes of creditors, or proxies or attorneys, participating in person; and

 (v) by statements made by telephone to the President by creditors, or proxies or attorneys, participating by telephone.

 (8) For the purposes of determining whether a motion proposed at the meeting is resolved, the value of a creditor who:

 (a) has been assigned a debt; and

 (b) is present at the meeting personally, by telephone, by attorney or by proxy; and

 (c) is voting on the motion;

is to be worked out by taking the value of the assigned debt to be equal to the value of the consideration that the creditor gave for the assignment of the debt.

64ZBA  Creditors’ resolution without meeting

 (1) The trustee may at any time put a proposal to the creditors by giving a notice under this section.

 (2) The notice must:

 (a) contain a single proposal; and

 (b) include a statement of the reasons for the proposal and the likely impact it will have on creditors (if it is passed); and

 (c) be given to each creditor who would be entitled under section 64A to receive notice of a meeting of creditors; and

 (d) invite the creditor to either:

 (i) vote Yes or No on the proposal; or

 (ii) object to the proposal being resolved without a meeting of creditors; and

 (e) specify a time by which replies must be received by the trustee (in order to be taken into account).

 (2A) If the proposal relates to how the trustee is to be remunerated, the notice must also:

 (a) if the trustee proposes to charge on a timecost basis:

 (i) if there is only one rate at which the remuneration is to be calculated—state that rate; or

 (ii) otherwise—state the respective rates at which the remuneration of the trustee and the other persons who will be assisting, or will be likely to assist, the trustee in the performance of his or her duties are to be calculated; and

 (b) if the trustee proposes to charge on the basis of a commission upon money received by the trustee—state the rate of that commission; and

 (c) state the periods at which the trustee proposes to withdraw funds from the bankrupt’s estate in respect of the trustee’s remuneration; and

 (d) include an estimate of the total amount of the trustee’s remuneration and an explanation of the likely impact of that remuneration on the dividends (if any) to creditors.

 (3) If, within the time specified in the notice:

 (a) at least 1 creditor votes in writing; and

 (b) no other creditor objects in writing to the proposal being resolved without a meeting of creditors;

then the following provisions have effect:

 (c) if the proposal requires a special resolution and there is a Yes vote by a majority in number, and at least 75% in value, of those who voted within the required time—the proposal is taken to have been passed by a special resolution of creditors at a meeting;

 (d) if the proposal does not require a special resolution and there is a Yes vote by a majority in value of those who voted within the required time—the proposal is taken to have been passed by a resolution of creditors at a meeting;

 (e) in any other case—the proposal is taken not to have been passed.

 (4) A certificate signed by the trustee stating any matter relating to a proposal under this section is prima facie evidence of the matter.

64ZC  Appointment of proxies

 (1) An instrument appointing a proxy must set out:

 (a) the full name, and the address of a place of residence or business, of the creditor; and

 (b) the full name, and the address of a place of residence or business, of the person appointed as proxy.

 (2) An instrument appointing a proxy may appoint more than one person as proxy but:

 (a) if the first person named in the instrument as a proxy is participating in person or by telephone in the meeting, only that person may cast the creditor’s vote; and

 (b) any other person named in the instrument as a proxy may cast the creditor’s vote if, and only if, that person is participating in person or by telephone in the meeting and no person named in the instrument as a proxy before the name of that person is participating in person or by telephone in the meeting.

 (3) An instrument appointing a proxy must set out the bankrupt’s name and must state whether the appointment relates to a particular meeting or to all meetings.

 (4) An instrument appointing a proxy may authorise the proxy to cast the creditor’s vote at a meeting to which the proxy relates on all matters arising at the meeting or may authorise the proxy to cast the creditor’s vote at that meeting only on matters specified in the instrument.

 (5) An instrument appointing a proxy may direct the proxy as to the manner in which the proxy is to vote on a particular matter or matters that may arise at the meeting or on a particular motion or motions that may be proposed at the meeting.

 (6) If an instrument appointing a proxy purports to appoint the bankrupt as a proxy, the purported appointment does not have any effect but, if the instrument also appoints another person as a proxy, the appointment of the other person is not affected and the instrument has effect as if the purported appointment of the bankrupt were not included.

64ZD  Provisions relating to motions and amendments of motions

 (1) Subject to the right of the trustee to propose a motion relating to the trustee’s remuneration under subsection 64U(6A), the only persons who may propose motions, or amendments of motions, at a meeting are the creditors and their representatives.

 (2) A motion or amendment does not need to be seconded.

 (3) If a motion is proposed, the person presiding at the meeting must allow a reasonable time for debate on the motion and on any amendment proposed to the motion.

 (4) After a reasonable time for debate has elapsed, the person presiding must:

 (a) if no amendment has been proposed—put the motion to a vote; or

 (b) if an amendment or amendments have been proposed, put the amendment or amendments to a vote; and

 (i) if the amendment or amendments are defeated—put the original motion to a vote; or

 (ii) if an amendment or amendments are passed—put the original motion as amended to a vote.

 (5) If a question arises as to the terms of a motion or amendment that is being put to a vote, the person presiding must read the motion or amendment to the meeting.

64ZE  Joint bankruptcies

 (1) At a meeting of the creditors in a joint bankruptcy, the trustee must explain to the creditors and their representatives the likely effect of section 110 with respect to the distribution of dividends.

 (2) At a meeting of the creditors in a bankruptcy to which section 141 applies, the trustee must explain to the creditors and their representatives the likely effect of section 141 with respect to the distribution of dividends.

64ZF  Substantial compliance to be sufficient

  A meeting, or anything done at a meeting, is not invalid because a requirement of this Subdivision has not been strictly complied with if the requirement has been substantially complied with.

Division 5ACommittee of inspection

70  Committee of inspection

 (1) The creditors who are entitled to vote may, at a meeting of the creditors, by resolution appoint a committee of inspection for the purpose of advising and superintending the trustee.

 (2) The committee of inspection shall consist of not more than 5 and not less than 3 persons.

 (3) A person is not eligible for appointment as a member of a committee of inspection unless:

 (a) he or she is a creditor or a person authorized by a creditor to act for the creditor in relation to the bankruptcy; or

 (b) he or she is a person whom a creditor intends to authorize to act for him or her in relation to the bankruptcy.

 (4) A creditor or other person referred to in paragraph (3)(a) is not qualified to act as a member of the committee of inspection until, in the case of a creditor, his or her proof of debt or, in the case of another person, the creditor’s proof of debt, has been admitted and a person referred to in paragraph (3)(b) is not qualified so to act until the creditor has authorized him or her to act for the creditor in relation to the bankruptcy and the creditor’s proof of debt has been admitted.

 (5) Subject to subsection (6), the committee of inspection shall meet at such times as the committee appoints from time to time.

 (6) The trustee or a member of the committee may call a meeting of the committee at any time.

 (7) The committee may act by a majority of its members present at a meeting but, except as provided by the next succeeding section, shall not act unless a majority of its members is present at the meeting.

71  Vacation of office etc.

 (1) A member of a committee of inspection may resign his or her office by notice in writing signed by him or her and delivered to, or sent by post to, the trustee.

 (2) The office of a member of such a committee becomes vacant if:

 (a) he or she becomes a bankrupt; or

 (b) he or she executes a personal insolvency agreement; or

 (c) he or she is absent from 5 consecutive meetings of the committee; or

 (d) in the case of a member who is not a creditor, he or she ceases to be a person authorized by a creditor to act for him or her in relation to the bankruptcy.

 (3) A member of such a committee may be removed from office by resolution at a meeting of creditors of which 7 days’ notice, stating the object of the meeting, has been given.

 (4) Where:

 (a) a vacancy has occurred in the membership of such a committee; and

 (b) there are 2 or more continuing members;

the continuing members may act notwithstanding the vacancy and may appoint an eligible person to fill the vacancy.

 (5) Where the number of members of such a committee is at any time less than 2, a creditor may request the trustee to convene a meeting of creditors for the purpose of filling the vacancy or all or any of the vacancies and the trustee shall convene a meeting accordingly.

72  Member of committee not to purchase part of estate

 (1) A member of the committee of inspection shall not, while acting as such a member, except by leave of the Court, either directly or indirectly, become purchaser of any part of the property of the bankrupt.

 (2) Where a member of the committee of inspection is a person authorized by a creditor to act for the creditor in relation to the bankruptcy, the creditor shall not, while that person is acting as a member of the committee, except by leave of the Court, either directly or indirectly, become purchaser of any part of the property of the bankrupt.

 (3) A purchase made in contravention of this section may be set aside by the Court on the application of a creditor.

Division 6Composition or arrangement with creditors

73  Composition or arrangement

 (1) Where a bankrupt desires to make a proposal to his or her creditors for:

 (a) a composition in satisfaction of his or her debts; or

 (b) a scheme of arrangement of his or her affairs;

he or she may lodge with the trustee a proposal in writing signed by him or her setting out the terms of the proposed composition or scheme of arrangement and particulars of any sureties or securities forming part of the proposal.

 (1A) The trustee must, within 2 working days after receiving the proposal, give a copy of the proposal to the Official Receiver.

Penalty: 5 penalty units.

Note: See also section 277B (about infringement notices).

 (1B) For the purposes of subsection (1A), a working day is a day that is not a Saturday, Sunday or public holiday in the place in which the bankrupt resides.

 (1C) Subsection (1A) is an offence of strict liability.

Note: For strict liability, see section 6.1 of the Criminal Code.

 (2) The trustee shall call a meeting of creditors and shall send to each creditor before the meeting a copy of the proposal accompanied by a report on it.

 (2A) The report must indicate whether the proposal would benefit the bankrupt’s creditors generally.

 (2AA) The report must name each creditor who was identified as a related entity of the bankrupt in the bankrupt’s statement of affairs.

 (2B) The trustee may refuse to call the meeting if the proposal does not make adequate provision for payment to the trustee of accrued fees that:

 (a) are owing to the trustee (at the time the proposal is lodged) in respect of the administration of the bankrupt’s estate, but are not able to be taken out of the bankrupt’s estate; and

 (b) have been approved by the creditors before the proposal is considered.

 (3) The bankrupt may, at the meeting, amend the terms of his or her proposal, but not in a way that reduces any provision for payment to the trustee of fees referred to in subsection (2B).

 (4) The creditors may, by special resolution, accept the proposal.

 (5) A creditor who has proved his or her debt may assent to or dissent from the proposal by written notice to that effect delivered to the trustee before the meeting or sent by post to the trustee and received by him or her before the meeting, and in that case the creditor shall, for the purposes of this Division, be deemed to have been present at the meeting and to have voted according to his or her assent or dissent.

73A  Trustee may require surety for cost of meeting

 (1) Before calling a meeting under section 73, the trustee may require the bankrupt to lodge with the trustee an amount that is sufficient to cover:

 (a) the estimated costs that will be incurred by the trustee in arranging and holding the meeting; and

 (b) the estimated fee that will (if approved by the creditors) be payable to the trustee in respect of the meeting.

 (2) If the amount lodged by the bankrupt is more than the actual costs and fee, then the trustee must refund the excess to the bankrupt.

73B  Declaration of relationships by proposed trustee of composition or scheme of arrangement

 (1) This section applies if the proposal provides that a person (the proposed trustee) other than the trustee of the bankrupt’s estate is to become the trustee of the composition or scheme of arrangement.

 (2) The proposed trustee must make a written declaration stating whether the bankrupt is a related entity of:

 (a) the proposed trustee; or

 (b) a related entity of the proposed trustee.

 (3) The proposed trustee must:

 (a) give a copy of the declaration to the Official Receiver; and

 (b) give a copy of the declaration to the trustee of the bankrupt’s estate; and

 (c) keep a copy of the declaration.

 (4) The trustee of the bankrupt’s estate must give a copy of the declaration to each of the creditors at the same time as the trustee gives a copy of the subsection 73(2) report to each creditor.

73C  Statement of affairs and declarations of relationships to be tabled at meeting

Scope

 (1) This section applies to a meeting that is called under section 73.

Bankrupt’s statement of affairs

 (2) The trustee must table at the meeting a copy of the bankrupt’s statement of affairs.

 (3) If:

 (a) the bankrupt had been required, immediately before the start of the meeting, to prepare a statement of affairs; and

 (b) that statement would have differed in one or more material respects from the statement a copy of which was tabled under subsection (2);

the bankrupt must table at the meeting a written statement identifying those differences.

Proposed trustee’s declaration

 (4) If the proposal provides that a person (the proposed trustee) other than the trustee of the bankrupt’s estate is to become the trustee of the composition or scheme of arrangement, the trustee of the bankrupt’s estate must table at the meeting a copy of the declaration made by the proposed trustee under subsection 73B(2).

 (5) If:

 (a) the proposal provides that a person (the proposed trustee) other than the trustee of the bankrupt’s estate is to become the trustee of the composition or scheme of arrangement; and

 (b) assuming that the proposed trustee had been required, immediately before the start of the meeting, to make a declaration stating whether the bankrupt is a related entity of:

 (i) the proposed trustee; or

 (ii) a related entity of the proposed trustee;

  that declaration would have differed in one or more material respects from the declaration made by the proposed trustee under subsection 73B(2);

the proposed trustee must table at the meeting a written statement identifying those differences.

74  Annulment of bankruptcy

 (5) Upon the passing of a special resolution at a meeting of creditors of a bankrupt under subsection 73(4), the bankruptcy is annulled, by force of this subsection, on the date on which the special resolution was passed.

 (5A) The trustee must, before the end of the period of 2 days beginning on that date, give the Official Receiver a written notice setting out the name and the bankruptcy number of the former bankrupt and the date of the annulment.

Penalty: 5 penalty units.

Note: See also section 277B (about infringement notices).

 (5B) Subsection (5A) is an offence of strict liability.

Note: For strict liability, see section 6.1 of the Criminal Code.

 (6) Where a bankruptcy is annulled under this section, all sales and dispositions of property and payments duly made, and all acts done, by the trustee or any person acting under the authority of the trustee or the Court before the annulment shall be deemed to have been validly made or done but, subject to subsection (7), the property of the bankrupt still vested in the trustee vests in such person as the Court appoints or, in default of such an appointment, reverts to the bankrupt for all his or her estate or interest in it, on such terms and subject to such conditions (if any) as the Court orders.

 (7) Where a law of the Commonwealth or of a State or Territory of the Commonwealth requires the transmission of property to be registered, any such property vested in the trustee at the time of the annulment of the bankruptcy, notwithstanding that it vests in equity in such person as the Court appoints or in the bankrupt, as the case may be, does not vest in that person or the bankrupt at law until the requirements of that law have been complied with.

74A  Variation of composition or scheme of arrangement

 (1) This section applies to a composition or scheme of arrangement that has been accepted in accordance with this Division.

Variation by special resolution of creditors

 (2) The creditors, with the written consent of the debtor, may vary the composition or scheme by special resolution at a meeting called for the purpose.

Variation proposal by trustee

 (3) The trustee may, in writing, propose a variation of the composition or scheme. The trustee cannot propose a variation without the written consent of the debtor.

 (4) The trustee must give notice of the proposed variation to all the creditors who would be entitled under section 64A (as that section applies in accordance with section 76A) to receive notice of a meeting of creditors.

 (5) The notice must:

 (a) include a statement of the reasons for the variation and the likely impact it will have on creditors (if it takes effect); and

 (b) specify a proposed date of effect for the variation (at least 14 days after the notice is given); and

 (c) state that any creditor may, by written notice to the trustee at least 2 days before the specified date, object to the variation taking effect without there being a meeting of creditors.

 (6) If no creditor lodges a written notice of objection with the trustee at least 2 days before the specified date, then the proposed variation takes effect on the date specified in the notice.

 (7) A certificate signed by the trustee stating any matter relating to a proposed variation under this section is prima facie evidence of the matter.

75  Effect of composition or scheme of arrangement

 (1) Subject to this section, a composition or scheme of arrangement accepted in accordance with this Division is binding on all the creditors of the bankrupt so far as relates to provable debts due to them from the bankrupt.

 (2) The acceptance of a composition or scheme of arrangement does not:

 (a) except with the consent of the creditor to whom the debt is due, release the bankrupt from a provable debt that would not be released by his or her discharge from bankruptcy; or

 (b) release any other person from any liability from which he or she would not be released by the discharge of the bankrupt.

 (3) The provisions of a composition or scheme of arrangement that has been accepted in accordance with this Division may be enforced by the Court on application by a person interested, and disobedience of an order of the Court made on the application is a contempt of the Court and is punishable accordingly.

76  Application of Part VIII to trustee of a composition or arrangement

 (1) Part VIII applies, with any modifications prescribed by the regulations, in relation to the trustee of a composition or scheme of arrangement under this Division as if the debtor were a bankrupt and the trustee were the trustee in his or her bankruptcy.

 (2) If, after taking into account the modifications prescribed by the regulations, a provision of Part VIII is incapable of application in relation to the trustee of a composition or scheme of arrangement, or is inconsistent with this Division, that provision does not so have application.

76A  Meetings of creditors

  Division 5 of Part IV applies, so far as it is capable of applying and with such modifications (if any) as are prescribed by the regulations, to meetings of creditors under this Division.

76B  Setting aside and termination of a composition or scheme of arrangement

  Sections 222 to 222D, 224 and 224A apply, with such modifications (if any) as are prescribed by the regulations, in relation to a composition or scheme of arrangement under this Division as if:

 (a) the composition or scheme were a personal insolvency agreement executed by the debtor; and

 (b) the trustee of the composition or scheme were the trustee of the personal insolvency agreement.

Part VControl over person and property of debtors and bankrupts

Division 1General

77  Duties of bankrupt as to discovery etc. of property

 (1) A bankrupt shall, unless excused by the trustee or prevented by illness or other sufficient cause:

 (a) forthwith after becoming a bankrupt, give to the trustee:

 (i) all books (including books of an associated entity of the bankrupt) that are in the possession of the bankrupt and relate to any of his or her examinable affairs; and

 (ii) the bankrupt’s passport, if any; and

 (b) attend the trustee whenever the trustee reasonably requires; and

 (ba) give such information about any of the bankrupt’s conduct and examinable affairs as the trustee requires; and

 (bb) as soon as practicable after becoming a bankrupt, advise the trustee of any material change that occurred between the time the bankrupt lodged his or her statement of affairs and the time the bankrupt became a bankrupt; and

 (bc) if a material change occurred later, advise the trustee of that change as soon as practicable after the change occurs; and

 (c) attend a meeting of creditors whenever the trustee requires; and

 (d) at each meeting of creditors at which the bankrupt is present, give such information about any of the bankrupt’s conduct and examinable affairs as the meeting requires; and

 (e) execute such instruments and generally do all such acts and things in relation to his or her property and its realization as are required by this Act or by the trustee or as are ordered by the Court upon the application of the trustee; and

 (f) disclose to the trustee, as soon as practicable, property that is acquired by him or her, or devolves on him or her, before his or her discharge, being property divisible amongst his or her creditors; and

 (g) aid to the utmost of his or her power in the administration of his or her estate.

 (2) In this section:

material change means a change in the particulars contained in the bankrupt’s statement of affairs, where the change could reasonably be expected to be relevant to the administration of the bankrupt’s estate.

77AA  Access by Official Receiver and others to premises

 (1) The Official Receiver, or an officer authorised in writing by the Official Receiver to exercise powers under this section, is entitled at all reasonable times to full and free access to all premises and books for any purpose of this Act, and for that purpose:

 (a) may make copies of, or take extracts from, books; and

 (b) may remove from premises any books that the Official Receiver or officer reasonably considers may be relevant to the examinable affairs of:

 (i) a bankrupt whose affairs are being administered under Part IV; or

 (ii) a person who is a party (as debtor) to a debt agreement; or

 (iii) a debtor whose affairs are being administered under Part X; or

 (iv) a deceased debtor whose affairs are being administered under Part XI or are subject to a debt agreement.

 (1A) A registered trustee may accompany and assist the Official Receiver or an officer exercising powers under subsection (1) if:

 (a) the Official Receiver has given written authority for the registered trustee to do so; and

 (b) the exercise of the powers under subsection (1) relates to a bankrupt, debtor or deceased debtor whose affairs the registered trustee is administering.

 (1B) The registered trustee may be accompanied by a person nominated by the registered trustee.

 (1C) The Official Receiver or officer may remove books from premises only if the Official Receiver or officer reasonably considers that:

 (a) it is not reasonably practicable to make copies of, or take extracts from, the books on the premises; or

 (b) it would be an unreasonable intrusion on the affairs of the occupier of the premises to remain on the premises to make copies of, or take extracts from, the books.

 (1D) If the Official Receiver or officer reasonably believes that any books are, or may be, relevant to the examinable affairs of a bankrupt, a person who is a party (as debtor) to a debt agreement, a debtor whose affairs are being administered under Part X or a deceased debtor whose affairs are being administered under Part XI, the Official Receiver or officer may keep the books until he or she decides that:

 (a) he or she no longer needs the books; or

 (b) the books are not relevant to the examinable affairs of any bankrupt, person who is a party (as debtor) to a debt agreement, debtor or deceased debtor.

 (1E) While the Official Receiver or officer is keeping books, a person whose books they are, or from whose premises the books were taken, may inspect the books at any reasonable time.

 (2) An officer is not entitled to enter or remain in or on any premises under this section if, on being requested by the occupier of the premises for proof of authority, the officer does not produce the officer’s authority under subsection (1).

 (3) The occupier of any premises entered or proposed to be entered by the Official Receiver, or by an officer, under subsection (1) must provide the Official Receiver or officer with all reasonable facilities and assistance for the effective exercise of powers under this section.

Penalty: $3,000.

77A  Access by trustee to books of associated entity

 (1) Where a trustee is conducting under section 19AA an investigation relating to a person (in this section called the bankrupt), subsections (2) and (3) of this section apply.

 (2) For the purposes of the investigation, the a trustee may by writing require a person to produce:

 (a) to a specified person, being the a trustee or another person; and

 (b) at a specified place, and within a specified period or at a specified time on a specified day, being a place, and a period or a time and day, that are reasonable in the circumstances;

specified books, or specified classes of books, that:

 (c) are books of an associated entity of the bankrupt;

 (d) are in the possession of the person of whom the requirement is made; and

 (e) in the trustee’s opinion, are relevant to the investigation.

 (3) Where the trustee requires a person (in this subsection called the relevant person) under this section to produce books to a specified person, the trustee or the specified person:

 (a) if the books are so produced:

 (i) may make copies of, or take extracts from, the books; and

 (ii) may require the relevant person, or any other person who was a party to the compilation of the books, to explain to the best of his or her knowledge and belief any matter about the compilation of the books or to which the books relate; or

 (b) in any other case—may require the relevant person to state, to the best of his or her knowledge or belief:

 (i) where the books may be found; and

 (ii) who last had possession, custody or control of the books and where that person may be found.

 (4) The production of books under this section does not prejudice a lien that a person has on the books.

77C  Power of Official Receiver to obtain information and evidence

 (1) The Official Receiver may, by written notice given to a person, require the person to do one or both of the following:

 (a) give the Official Receiver information the Official Receiver requires for the purposes of the performance of the functions of the Official Receiver or a trustee under this Act;

 (b) attend before the Official Receiver, or an officer authorised in writing by the Official Receiver to exercise powers under this paragraph, and do one or both of the following:

 (i) give evidence relating to any matters connected with the performance of the functions of the Official Receiver or a trustee under this Act;

 (ii) produce all books in the person’s possession relating to any matters connected with the performance of the functions of the Official Receiver or a trustee under this Act.

It does not matter whether or not the person is a bankrupt or is employed in or in connection with a Department, or an authority, of the Commonwealth or of a State or Territory.

 (2) The Official Receiver or authorised officer may require the information or evidence to be given on oath, and either orally or in writing, and for that purpose may administer an oath.

 (3) Notes taken down and signed by a person who attends before the Official Receiver or an authorised officer under paragraph (1)(b), and the transcript of the evidence given by the person at the attendance:

 (a) may be used in evidence in any proceeding under this Act whether or not the person is a party to the proceeding; and

 (b) may be inspected:

 (i) by the person, without fee; and

 (ii) if the notes and evidence relate to matters concerning the bankruptcy of the person or of another person—by the trustee and a person who states in writing that he or she is a creditor, without fee; and

 (iii) by any other person on payment of the fee determined by the Minister by legislative instrument.

77CA  Power of Official Receiver to obtain statement of affairs

  The Official Receiver may, by written notice given to a bankrupt, require the bankrupt to give the Official Receiver a statement of the bankrupt’s affairs within 14 days after receiving the notice.

Note 1: Section 6A sets out requirements for statements of affairs.

Note 2: A failure to comply with the notice is an offence: see section 267B.

77D  Allowances and expenses in respect of attendance

 (1) Subject to this section, a person who attends before the Official Receiver, or before an authorised officer, under subsection 77C(1) is entitled:

 (a) to be paid by the Official Receiver an allowance of $20 in respect of each day or part of a day on which the person so attends; and

 (b) to be reimbursed by the Official Receiver any reasonable expenses incurred by the person for transport, meals and accommodation in connection with the person’s attendance.

 (2) A person who is or has been a bankrupt is not entitled to be paid an allowance, or reimbursed any expenses, in respect of the attendance of that person to give evidence or produce books relating to his or her bankruptcy.

 (3) A person is not entitled to be reimbursed any expenses unless the person produces to the Official Receiver sufficient documentary evidence to establish that the person incurred those expenses.

 (4) This section has effect subject to section 304A.

77E  Advance on account of allowances and expenses

 (1) If a person who is required by a notice under subsection 77C(1) to attend before the Official Receiver or an authorised officer is entitled under subsection 77D(1) to be paid an allowance and to be reimbursed expenses in respect of the attendance, the Official Receiver must, before the person begins to travel for the purpose of so attending, offer to the person, on account of the allowance and reimbursement of expenses, an advance determined under this section.

 (2) If the Official Receiver is satisfied that it will be necessary for the person to travel by aircraft from the person’s principal place of residence to the place at which the person is required to attend, the advance is to be an amount equal to the sum of $20 and the ordinary oneway economy class airfare from the airport nearest to that principal place of residence to the airport nearest to the place at which the person is required to attend.

 (3) If the person will be travelling by private motor vehicle, the advance is to be the sum of $20 and whichever is the lesser of the following amounts:

 (a) an amount prescribed by the regulations;

 (b) if there is an airport open to civilian passenger traffic that is within a radius of 100 kilometres from the person’s principal place of residence—the ordinary oneway economy class airfare from that airport to the airport nearest to the place at which the person is required to attend.

 (4) If the person will be travelling otherwise than as mentioned in subsections (2) and (3), the advance is to be:

 (a) if the distance between the person’s principal place of residence and the place at which the person is required to attend exceeds 50 kilometres—$10 plus such additional amount (if any) as is prescribed by the regulations; or

 (b) in any other case—$10.

 (5) The regulations may prescribe different amounts in respect of different distances and different means of travel.

 (6) This section has effect subject to section 304A.

77F  Allowances and expenses to be paid out of bankrupt’s estate

  If the evidence that a person gives, or the books that a person produces, under section 77C, relate to matters concerning the bankruptcy of a particular person, any amount payable to the firstmentioned person under section 77D or 77E is to be paid out of the estate of the bankrupt as an expense of the administration of the bankruptcy.

78  Arrest of debtor or bankrupt

 (1) Where it is made to appear to the Court:

 (a) that a debtor against whom a bankruptcy notice has been issued or a petition has been presented has absconded, or is about to abscond, with a view to avoiding payment of his or her debts or to preventing or delaying proceedings against him or her under this Act;

 (b) that a debtor against whom a bankruptcy notice has been issued or a petition has been presented has concealed or removed, or is about to conceal or remove, any of his or her property with a view to preventing or delaying possession of it being taken under this Act in the event of his or her becoming a bankrupt;

 (c) that a debtor against whom a bankruptcy notice has been issued or a petition has been presented has destroyed, concealed or removed, or is about to destroy, conceal or remove, books (including books of an associated entity of the debtor) relating to any of the debtor’s examinable affairs;

 (d) that a bankrupt has concealed, or, without the permission of the trustee, has removed, any of the property of the bankrupt; or

 (f) that a bankrupt has, without good cause shown, neglected or failed to comply with an order of the Court or with any other obligation under this Act;

the Court may issue a warrant for the arrest of the debtor or bankrupt, as the case may be, and his or her committal to such gaol as the Court appoints until the Court otherwise orders and may, by the same warrant, order that any property and books in the possession of the debtor or bankrupt be seized and delivered into the custody of such person as the Court appoints.

 (2) Any property and books delivered into the custody of a person in pursuance of an order under subsection (1) shall be retained by him or her until the Court makes an order as to their disposal.

 (3) Paragraphs (1)(a), (b) and (c) apply in relation to a debtor whether or not he or she has become a bankrupt and whether, in the case of a debtor against whom a petition has been presented, the petition was a creditor’s petition or a debtor’s petition.

80  Notification of change in name, address or daytime telephone number

 (1) If during a bankruptcy a change occurs in the bankrupt’s name or in the address of the bankrupt’s principal place of residence, the bankrupt must immediately tell the trustee in writing of the change.

Penalty: Imprisonment for 6 months.

 (1A) Subsection (1) is an offence of strict liability.

Note: For strict liability, see section 6.1 of the Criminal Code.

 (2) For the purposes of subsection (1), a change in the name of a bankrupt shall be deemed to occur if the bankrupt in fact assumes the use of a different name or an additional name.

81  Discovery of bankrupt’s property etc.

 (1) Where a person (in this section called the relevant person) becomes a bankrupt, the Court or a Registrar may at any time (whether before or after the end of the bankruptcy), on the application of:

 (a) a person (in this section called a creditor) who has or had a debt provable in the bankruptcy;

 (b) the trustee of the relevant person’s estate; or

 (c) the Official Receiver;

summon the relevant person, or an examinable person in relation to the relevant person, for examination in relation to the bankruptcy.

 (1A) A summons to a person by the Court or the Registrar under subsection (1) shall require the person to attend:

 (a) at a specified place and at a specified time on a specified day, being a place, time and day that are reasonable in the circumstances; and

 (b) before the Court or the Registrar or, if the Court or the Registrar thinks fit, a magistrate;

to be examined on oath under this section about the relevant person and the relevant person’s examinable affairs.

 (1B) A summons to a person under subsection (1) may require the person to produce at the examination books (including books of an associated entity of the relevant person) that:

 (a) are in the possession of the firstmentioned person; and

 (b) relate to the relevant person or to any of the relevant person’s examinable affairs.

 (1C) Before summoning a person on an application under subsection (1) by a creditor, the Court or the Registrar, as the case requires, may impose on the applicant such terms as to costs as it, or he or she, thinks fit.

 (2) An examination under this section shall be held in public.

 (3) The Court, the Registrar or a magistrate may at any time adjourn the examination of a person under this section either to a fixed date or generally, or conclude the examination.

 (4) The Registrar or a magistrate may at any time adjourn the examination of a person under this section for further hearing before the Court.

 (5) Where the examination is adjourned by the Registrar or a magistrate for further hearing before the Court, the Registrar or the magistrate, as the case may be, may submit to the Court such report with respect to the examination as he or she thinks fit.

 (6) Where the examination is adjourned for further hearing before the Court, the Court may:

 (a) continue the examination;

 (b) at any time direct that the examination be continued before the Registrar or a magistrate; or

 (c) make such other order as it thinks proper in the circumstances.

 (7) A person summoned to attend before the Court, the Registrar or a magistrate for examination under this section is entitled to be represented, on his or her examination, by counsel or a solicitor, who may reexamine him or her after his or her examination.

 (8) Where a person is summoned for examination under this section, a creditor, the trustee or the Official Receiver may take part in the examination and, for that purpose, may be represented by counsel or a solicitor or by an agent authorized in writing for the purpose.

 (9) Without limiting the generality of subsection (8), where the Official Trustee is the trustee, the Official Trustee may, for the purpose of taking part in the examination, be represented by the Official Receiver.

 (10) The Court, the Registrar or the magistrate may put, or allow to be put, to a person being examined under this section such questions about the relevant person or any of the relevant person’s examinable affairs as the Court, the Registrar or the magistrate, as the case may be, thinks appropriate.

 (10A) Notwithstanding subsection (10), where a person is being examined under this section after the end of the bankruptcy, a question about a matter or thing arising or occurring after the end of the bankruptcy shall not be put, or allowed to be put, at the examination unless the question is about a matter or thing connected with the administration of the relevant person’s estate.

 (11) A person being examined under this section shall answer all questions that the Court, the Registrar or the magistrate puts or allows to be put to him or her.

 (11AA) Subject to any contrary direction by the Court, the Registrar or the magistrate, the relevant person is not excused from answering a question merely because to do so might tend to incriminate the relevant person.

 (11A) The Court, the Registrar or the magistrate may direct a person who is being examined under this section to produce at the examination specified books, or specified classes of books, that are in the possession of the person and are relevant to matters about which the person is being, or is to be, examined.

 (11B) Without limiting the generality of subsection (11A), a direction under that subsection may relate to books of an associated entity of the relevant person.

 (12) Where a person admits on examination under this section that he or she is indebted to the relevant person, then, the Court, the Registrar or the magistrate, as the case may be, may, on the application of the trustee or a creditor, order the person to pay to the trustee, at or by such time and in such manner as the Court, the Registrar or the magistrate, as the case may be, thinks fit, the whole or a part of the amount in which the person admits he or she is indebted to the relevant person.

 (13) Where a person admits on examination under this section that there is in the possession of the person property of the relevant person that is divisible among creditors, the Court, the Registrar or the magistrate, as the case requires, may, on the application of the trustee or a creditor, order the firstmentioned person to deliver the property to the trustee within a specified period, in a specified manner and on specified terms.

 (14) The Court, the Registrar or the magistrate, as the case may be, may direct that the costs of a person, other than the relevant person, examined under this section shall be paid out of the estate of the relevant person.

 (15) The Court, the Registrar or the magistrate, as the case may be, may cause such notes of the examination of a person under this section to be taken down in writing as the Court, the Registrar or the magistrate, as the case may be, thinks proper, and the person examined shall sign the notes.

 (17) Notes taken down and signed by a person in pursuance of subsection (15), and the transcript of the evidence given at the examination of a person under this section:

 (a) may be used in evidence in any proceedings under this Act whether or not the person is a party to the proceeding; and

 (b) shall be open to inspection by the person, the relevant person, the trustee or a person who states in writing that he or she is a creditor without fee and by any other person on payment of the fee prescribed by the regulations.

Division 2Offshore information notices

81A  Issue of notices

 (1) If the Official Receiver has reason to believe that:

 (a) information relevant to the examinable affairs of a bankrupt is:

 (i) known (whether exclusively or otherwise) by a person outside Australia; or

 (ii) recorded (whether exclusively or otherwise) in a book outside Australia; or

 (b) books relevant to the examinable affairs of a bankrupt are outside Australia (whether or not copies are in Australia or, if the books are copies of other books, whether or not those other books are in Australia);

the Official Receiver, by written notice (in this Division called the offshore information notice) given to any person, may request the person:

 (c) to give to the Official Receiver, within the period and in the manner set out in that notice, any such information; or

 (d) to produce to the Official Receiver, within the period and in the manner set out in that notice, any such books; or

 (e) to make copies of any such books and to produce to the Official Receiver, within the period and in the manner set out in that notice, those copies.

 (2) The period set out in the offshore information notice must end 90 days after the date on which the notice is given.

81B  Extension of period of notice

 (1) Upon written application made by the person to whom the offshore information notice was given within the period set out in that notice, the Official Receiver, by written notice given to that person, may extend the period set out in the offshore information notice.

 (2) If:

 (a) an application under subsection (1) is made before the end of the period set out in the offshore information notice; and

 (b) at the end of the period, the Official Receiver has not notified the person of the decision of the Official Receiver on the application;

the following provisions have effect:

 (c) the Official Receiver is taken to have extended the period under subsection (1) to the end of the day on which the decision of the Official Receiver is notified to the person to whom the offshore information notice was given;

 (d) if the Official Receiver decides to extend the period—the extended period must end after the day referred to in paragraph (c).

 (3) A reference in this Division (other than subsection (1) of this section) to the period set out in the offshore information notice is a reference to the period as extended under that subsection.

81C  Variation of notices

 (1) If:

 (a) an offshore information notice (in this subsection called the first notice) was given to a person; and

 (b) during the period set out in the first notice (including a period set out by virtue of one or more previous applications of this subsection), another offshore information notice (in this subsection called the subsequent notice) is given to the person; and

 (c) the subsequent notice is expressed to be by way of variation of the first notice;

the following provisions have effect:

 (d) the request, or each of the requests, set out in the subsequent notice is taken, for the purposes of section 81G, to have been set out in the first notice;

 (e) if the period set out in the first notice would, apart from this subsection, end before the end of the period set out in the subsequent notice—the period set out in the first notice is taken to have been extended under subsection 81B(1) to the end of the period set out in the subsequent notice.

 (2) The Official Receiver, by written notice given to the person to whom the offshore information notice was given, may vary the offshore information notice by:

 (a) reducing its scope; or

 (b) correcting a clerical error or obvious mistake;

and, if the Official Receiver does so, a reference in this Division to the offshore information notice is taken to be a reference to that notice as so varied.

81D  Withdrawal of notices

 (1) The Official Receiver may withdraw an offshore information notice.

 (2) If the Official Receiver withdraws an offshore information notice, the withdrawal does not prevent the Official Receiver from giving another offshore information notice in substitution, in whole or in part, for the withdrawn notice.

81E  Notices may be included in same document

  An offshore information notice may be contained in the same document as a notice under section 77C.

81F  Relationship between this Division and section 77C

  Nothing in this Division affects the operation of section 77C and nothing in section 77C affects the operation of this Division.

Division 3Failure to comply with certain notices

81G  Effect of noncompliance with notice

 (1) In this section:

relevant proceeding means a proceeding:

 (a) for the recovery of an amount payable by a bankrupt under section 139ZG; or

 (b) for the recovery of an amount payable by a person under section 139ZL; or

 (c) involving the question whether a transaction is void against the trustee under Division 3 of Part VI.

 (2) Subject to subsection (3), where a person refuses or fails to comply with a request or requirement set out in a notice given to the person under Division 1 or 2 to give any information or produce any books:

 (a) if the request or requirement applies to information—the information is not admissible in a relevant proceeding; or

 (b) if the request or requirement applies to books—neither the books, nor any secondary evidence of the books, is admissible in a relevant proceeding.

 (3) Subsection (2) does not apply to information or a book if the person proves that:

 (a) the information or book was not in the possession of the person when the notice was given; and

 (b) there were no reasonable steps that the person could have taken to obtain the information or book.

 (4) A notice given to a person under Division 1 or 2 must set out the effect of subsections (2) and (3).

 (5) A failure to comply with subsection (4) does not affect the validity of the notice.

Part VIAdministration of property

Division 1Proof of debts

82  Debts provable in bankruptcy

 (1) Subject to this Division, all debts and liabilities, present or future, certain or contingent, to which a bankrupt was subject at the date of the bankruptcy, or to which he or she may become subject before his or her discharge by reason of an obligation incurred before the date of the bankruptcy, are provable in his or her bankruptcy.

 (1A) Without limiting subsection (1), debts referred to in that subsection include a debt consisting of all or part of a sum that became payable by the bankrupt under a maintenance agreement or maintenance order before the date of the bankruptcy.

 (2) Demands in the nature of unliquidated damages arising otherwise than by reason of a contract, promise or breach of trust are not provable in bankruptcy.

 (3) Penalties or fines imposed by a court in respect of an offence against a law, whether a law of the Commonwealth or not, are not provable in bankruptcy.

 (3AA) An amount payable under an order made under section 1317G of the Corporations Act 2001 is not provable in bankruptcy.

 (3AB) A debt incurred under Part 41 of the Higher Education Support Act 2003 is not provable in bankruptcy.

 (3A) An amount payable under an order made under a proceeds of crime law is not provable in bankruptcy.

 (3B) A debt is not provable in a bankruptcy in so far as the debt consists of interest accruing, in respect of a period commencing on or after the date of the bankruptcy, on a debt that is provable in the bankruptcy.

 (4) The trustee shall make an estimate of the value of a debt or liability provable in the bankruptcy which, by reason of its being subject to a contingency, or for any other reason, does not bear a certain value.

 (5) A person aggrieved by an estimate so made may appeal to the Court not later than 28 days after the day on which the person is notified of the estimate.

 (6) If the Court finds that the value of the debt or liability cannot be fairly estimated, the debt or liability shall be deemed not to be provable in the bankruptcy.

 (7) If the Court finds that the value of the debt or liability can be fairly estimated, the Court shall assess the value in such manner as it thinks proper.

 (8) In this section, liability includes:

 (a) compensation for work or labour done;

 (b) an obligation or possible obligation to pay money or money’s worth on the breach of an express or implied covenant, contract, agreement or undertaking, whether or not the breach occurs, is likely to occur or is capable of occurring, before the discharge of the bankrupt; and

 (c) an express or implied engagement, agreement or undertaking, to pay, or capable of resulting in the payment of, money or money’s worth, whether the payment is:

 (i) in respect of amount—fixed or unliquidated;

 (ii) in respect of time—present or future, or certain or dependent on a contingency; or

 (iii) in respect of the manner of valuation—capable of being ascertained by fixed rules or only as matter of opinion.

83  Debt not to be considered proved until admitted

  For the purposes of this Act, a creditor shall be taken not to have proved a debt until a proof of debt lodged by him or her in respect of that debt has been admitted.

84  Manner of proving debts

 (1) Subject to this Division, a creditor who desires to prove a debt in a bankruptcy shall lodge, or cause to be lodged, with the trustee a proof of debt in accordance with this section.

 (2) A proof of debt:

 (a) shall set out particulars of the debt;

 (b) shall be in accordance with the approved form;

 (c) shall specify the vouchers, if any, by which the debt can be substantiated; and

 (d) shall state whether or not the creditor is a secured creditor.

 (3) Where the trustee is of the opinion that it is desirable that all the matters, or some of the matters, contained in a proof of debt lodged with him or her by a creditor should be verified by statutory declaration, the trustee may serve on the creditor a written notice informing the creditor that he or she is of that opinion and that, unless the creditor lodges with the trustee a statutory declaration verifying the matters contained in the proof of the debt or such of those matters as the trustee specifies in the notice, the trustee will administer the estate as if the proof of debt had not been lodged.

 (4) A statutory declaration verifying matters in a proof of debt lodged by a creditor may be made by:

 (a) the creditor; or

 (b) a person whose own knowledge includes the facts set out in the statutory declaration and the proof of debt, and who is authorised by the creditor to make the declaration.

 (5) Where the trustee serves a notice on a creditor under subsection (3) in respect of a proof of debt, the proof of debt shall, for the purposes of this Act (other than section 263), be deemed not to have been lodged with the trustee unless and until the creditor has lodged with the trustee a statutory declaration verifying the matters in the proof of debt or such of those matters as are specified in the notice, as the case requires.

 (6) A proof of debt under this section, or a statutory declaration referred to in subsection (3), sent to the trustee by post as certified mail (postage being prepaid) shall be deemed to have been lodged with the trustee and shall be deemed to have been so lodged at the time at which it would have been delivered in the ordinary course of post unless it is shown that the trustee did not receive it at that time.

85  Proof by employees

 (1) Where it appears from the bankrupt’s statement of affairs that he or she is indebted to numerous persons employed by him or her for wages or salary, the debts may be proved by one of those persons on behalf of all of those persons.

 (2) The proof of debt in respect of the several debts shall be in accordance with the approved form.

 (2A) Where the trustee is of the opinion that it is desirable that all the matters, or some of the matters, contained in a proof of debt lodged with him or her by a person in pursuance of this section should be verified by statutory declaration, the trustee may serve on the person a written notice informing the person that he or she is of that opinion and that, unless the person lodges with the trustee a statutory declaration verifying the matters contained in the proof of debt or such of those matters as the trustee specifies in the notice, the trustee will administer the estate as if the proof of the debt had not been lodged.

 (2B) A statutory declaration verifying matters in a proof of debt lodged by a person (the creditor) under this section may be made by:

 (a) the creditor; or

 (b) another person whose own knowledge includes the facts set out in the statutory declaration and the proof of debt, and who is authorised by the creditor to make the declaration.

 (2C) Where the trustee serves a notice on a person under subsection (2A) in respect of a proof of debt, the proof of debt shall, for the purposes of this Act (other than section 263), be deemed not to have been lodged with the trustee unless and until the person has lodged with the trustee a statutory declaration verifying the matters in the proof of debt or such of those matters as are specified in the notice, as the case requires.

 (2D) A proof of debt under this section, or a statutory declaration referred to in subsection (2A), sent to the trustee by post as certified mail (postage being prepaid) shall be deemed to have been lodged with the trustee and shall be deemed to have been so lodged at the time at which it would have been delivered in the ordinary course of post unless it is shown that the trustee did not receive it at that time.

 (3) A proof of debt lodged in pursuance of this section has the same effect as if separate proofs of debt had been lodged by each of the creditors to whom it relates.

86  Mutual credit and setoff

 (1) Subject to this section, where there have been mutual credits, mutual debts or other mutual dealings between a person who has become a bankrupt and a person claiming to prove a debt in the bankruptcy:

 (a) an account shall be taken of what is due from the one party to the other in respect of those mutual dealings;

 (b) the sum due from the one party shall be set off against any sum due from the other party; and

 (c) only the balance of the account may be claimed in the bankruptcy, or is payable to the trustee in the bankruptcy, as the case may be.

 (2) A person is not entitled under this section to claim the benefit of a setoff if, at the time of giving credit to the person who has become a bankrupt or at the time of receiving credit from that person, he or she had notice of an available act of bankruptcy committed by that person.

87  Deduction of discounts

  In proving a debt, a creditor shall make an allowance for all discounts for which an allowance would have been made if the debtor had not become a bankrupt.

88  Apportionment to principal and interest of payments made before bankruptcy

  A payment made by a debtor to a creditor before the debtor became a bankrupt and representing in part principal and in part interest shall, notwithstanding any agreement to the contrary, be deemed, for the purposes of this Act but not otherwise, to have been apportioned in satisfaction of principal and interest in the proportion that the principal bears to the amount payable as interest at the agreed rate.

89  Apportionment where security realized before or after bankruptcy

 (1) Where a debt that consisted partly of principal and partly of interest was secured and the security has been realized before the debtor became a bankrupt, the proceeds of the realization shall, for the purposes of this Act but not otherwise, notwithstanding any agreement to the contrary, be deemed to have been apportioned in satisfaction of principal and interest in the proportion that the principal bore, at the time of the realization, to the amount then payable as interest at the agreed rate.

 (2) Where a debt that consists partly of principal and partly of interest is secured and the security is realized after the debtor became a bankrupt or the value of the security is estimated in the creditor’s proof of debt, the amount realized or estimated shall, for the purposes of this Act but not otherwise and notwithstanding any agreement to the contrary, be deemed to have been apportioned in satisfaction of principal and interest in the proportion that the principal bears to the amount payable as interest at the agreed rate.

90  Proof of debt by secured creditor

 (1) A secured creditor is entitled to prove the whole or a part of his or her secured debt in the debtor’s bankruptcy in accordance with the succeeding provisions of this Division, and not otherwise.

 (2) A secured creditor who surrenders his or her security to the trustee for the benefit of creditors generally may prove for the whole of his or her debt.

 (3) A secured creditor who realizes his or her security may prove for any balance due to him or her after deducting the net amount realized, unless the trustee is not satisfied that the realization has been effected in good faith and in a proper manner.

 (4) A secured creditor who has not realized or surrendered his or her security may:

 (a) estimate its value; and

 (b) prove for the balance due to him or her after deducting the value so estimated.

 (5) A secured creditor to whom subsection (4) applies shall state particulars of his or her security, and the value at which he or she estimates it, in his or her proof of debt.

91  Redemption of security by trustee etc.

 (1) Where a secured creditor has lodged a proof of debt in respect of the balance due after deducting the estimated value of his or her security, the trustee may at any time redeem the security on payment to the creditor of the value at which it has been estimated by the creditor.

 (2) If the trustee is dissatisfied with the value at which a security has been estimated by a creditor, he or she may require the property comprised in the security to be offered for sale at such times and on such terms and conditions as are agreed on by the creditor and the trustee.

 (3) If any such property is offered for sale by public auction, the creditor, or the trustee on behalf of the estate is entitled to bid for, and purchase, the property.

 (4) The creditor may at any time, by notice in writing, require the trustee to elect whether he or she will, or will not, exercise his or her power of redeeming the security or of requiring it to be realized and if the trustee does not, within 3 months after receiving the notice, notify the creditor, in writing that he or she elects to exercise the power:

 (a) he or she is not entitled to exercise it;

 (b) subject to subsection (5), any equity of redemption or other interest in the property comprised in the security that is vested in the trustee vests in the creditor; and

 (c) the amount of the creditor’s debt shall, for the purposes of this Division, be deemed to be reduced by the amount at which the creditor has estimated the value of the security.

 (5) The vesting of an equity of redemption or other interest in property by virtue of paragraph (4)(b) is subject to compliance with any law of the Commonwealth or of a State or Territory of the Commonwealth requiring the transmission of such interests in property to be registered.

92  Amendment of valuation

 (1) Where a secured creditor has lodged a proof of debt in respect of the balance due after deducting the estimated value of his or her security, he or she may, at any time, apply to the trustee or the Court for permission to amend the proof of debt by altering the estimated value.

 (2) If the trustee or the Court is satisfied:

 (a) that the estimate of the value of the security was made in good faith on a mistaken basis; or

 (b) that the value of the security has changed since the estimate was made;

the trustee or the Court may permit the creditor to amend his or her proof of debt accordingly.

 (3) Where the Court permits a creditor to amend his or her proof of debt, it may do so on such terms as it thinks just and equitable.

93  Repayment of excess

 (1) Where a creditor who has amended a proof of debt under section 92 has received, by way of dividend, any amount in excess of the amount to which he or she would have been entitled under the amended proof of debt, he or she shall forthwith repay the amount of the excess to the trustee.

 (2) Where a creditor who has so amended a proof of debt has received, by way of dividend, less than the amount to which he or she would have been entitled under the amended proof of debt, he or she is entitled to be paid, out of moneys for the time being available for distribution as dividend, the amount of the deficiency before those moneys are applied in the payment of future dividends, but is not entitled to affect the distribution of a dividend declared before the amendment of the proof of debt.

94  Subsequent realization of security

  Where a secured creditor who has lodged a proof of debt in respect of the balance due after deducting the estimated value of his or her security subsequently realizes his or her security, or it is realized under section 91, the net amount realized shall be substituted for the estimated value of the security and section 93 applies as if the proof of debt had been amended accordingly by the creditor under section 92.

95  Proof in respect of distinct contracts

  Where a person was, at the time when he or she became a bankrupt, liable in respect of distinct contracts as a member of 2 or more distinct firms, or as a sole contractor and also as a member of a firm, the fact that the firms are in whole or in part composed of the same individuals, or that the sole contractor is also a member of the firm, does not prevent proof in respect of the contracts against the estates respectively liable on the contracts.

96  Proof in respect of proportionate part of periodical payment

  Where a person who is liable to make any periodical payments (including rent) becomes a bankrupt on a day other than a day on which such a payment becomes due, the person entitled to the payments may prove in the bankruptcy for a proportionate part of a payment in respect of the period from the date when the last payment became due to the date of the bankruptcy, as if the payment accrued due from day to day.

97  Production of bills of exchange and promissory notes

  Where a creditor seeks to prove a debt in respect of a bill of exchange, promissory note or other negotiable instrument or security on which the bankrupt is liable, the proof of debt shall not, subject to any order of the Court to the contrary, be admitted, unless the bill, note, instrument or security is produced to the trustee.

98  Amendment of proof of debt

 (1) A creditor may, with the consent of the trustee, amend a proof of debt lodged by him or her.

 (2) This section does not authorize the amendment of the proof of debt of a secured creditor by altering the estimated value of his or her security.

100  Costs of proving debts etc.

 (1) A creditor shall, unless the Court in the particular case otherwise orders, bear his or her own costs of proving a debt.

 (2) The costs in relation to the amendment of a proof of debt under section 92 or 98 shall be borne by the creditor.

101  Inspection of proofs by creditors etc.

 (1) A creditor is entitled to examine at all reasonable times the proofs of debt of other creditors.

 (2) The trustee shall, upon request in writing by a creditor who has a provable debt, supply the creditor with a statement in writing containing the names of the creditors who have lodged proofs of debt, the amount claimed by each such creditor and the amount admitted by the trustee in respect of each such creditor.

102  Admission or rejection of proofs

 (1) The trustee shall examine each proof of debt and the grounds of the debt sought to be proved and, subject to the power of the Court to extend the time, shall, not later than 14 days after the expiration of the period specified in the notice of intention to declare a dividend as the period within which creditors may lodge their proofs of debt, either:

 (a) admit the proof of debt in whole;

 (b) admit it in part and reject it in part;

 (c) reject it in whole; or

 (d) require further evidence in support of it.

 (2) Where the trustee rejects a proof of debt in whole or in part, he or she shall inform the creditor by whom it was lodged, in writing, of the grounds of the rejection.

 (3) Where the trustee considers that a proof of debt has been wrongly admitted, he or she may:

 (a) revoke the decision to admit the proof of debt and reject it in whole; or

 (b) amend the decision to admit the proof of debt by increasing or reducing the amount of the admitted debt.

 (4) Where the trustee considers that a proof of debt has been wrongly rejected in whole, he or she may:

 (a) revoke the decision to reject the proof of debt; and

 (b) admit the proof of debt in whole or admit the proof of debt in part and reject it in part.

 (5) Where the trustee revokes a decision to admit a proof of debt and rejects it in whole or amends such a decision by reducing the amount of the admitted debt:

 (a) he or she shall inform the creditor by whom it was lodged, in writing, of his or her grounds for the revocation or amendment; and

 (b) the creditor shall forthwith repay to the trustee any amount received by way of dividend in respect of the proof of debt or any amount received by way of dividend in excess of the amount that the creditor would have been entitled to receive if his or her debt had been originally admitted for the reduced amount, as the case requires.

 (6) Where the trustee revokes a decision to reject a proof of debt in whole, or amends a decision to admit a proof of debt in part by increasing the amount of the admitted debt, the creditor by whom it was lodged is entitled to be paid, out of available money for the time being in the hands of the trustee, the dividends or additional amounts of dividend, as the case may be, that the creditor would have been entitled to receive if the debt had been originally admitted in whole or for the increased amount, as the case may be, before the available money is applied in the payment of a further dividend, but the creditor is not entitled to disturb the distribution of any dividends declared before the trustee revoked or so amended the decision.

103  Debts to be rounded down to nearest dollar

  If the amount of a debt includes cents, the cents must be disregarded in admitting proof of the debt.

104  Appeal against decision of trustee in respect of proof

 (1) A creditor, or the bankrupt, may apply to the Court for review of a decision of the trustee under subsection 102(1), (3) or (4) in respect of a proof of debt.

 (2) The Court may, upon the application, confirm, reverse or vary the decision of the trustee.

 (3) Subject to the power of the Court to extend the time, an application under this section to review a decision shall not be heard by the Court unless it was made within 21 days from the date on which the decision was made.

105  Costs of appeal

 (1) The Official Trustee is not personally liable for costs in relation to an application to review a decision made by the Official Trustee under subsection 102(1), (3) or (4) in respect of a proof of debt.

 (2) A registered trustee is not personally liable for such costs unless the Court is of opinion that there are special circumstances that justify an order that the trustee be personally liable.

106  Trustee may administer oaths etc.

 (1) A trustee may, for the purpose of carrying out his or her duties under this Division, administer oaths and take affirmations and affidavits, but is not entitled to charge a fee in respect of such an oath, affirmation or affidavit unless he or she is authorized to do so as a Commissioner for Affidavits.

 (2) This section does not apply in relation to the Official Trustee.

107  Creditor not to receive more than the amount of his or her debt and interest

  Subject to the operation of the provisions of section 91, a creditor is not entitled to receive, in respect of a provable debt, more than the amount of the debt and any interest payable to him or her under this Act.

Division 2Order of payment of debts

Subdivision AGeneral

108  Debts proved to rank equally except as otherwise provided

  Except as otherwise provided by this Act, all debts proved in a bankruptcy rank equally and, if the proceeds of the property of the bankrupt are insufficient to meet them in full, they shall be paid proportionately.

Note: The rules under this Subdivision for payments of debts can be affected by proceeds of crime orders and applications for proceeds of crime orders: see Subdivision B.

109  Priority payments

 (1) Subject to this Act, the trustee must, before applying the proceeds of the property of the bankrupt in making any other payments, apply those proceeds in the following order:

 (a) first, in the order prescribed by the regulations, in payment of the taxed costs of the petitioning creditor and the costs, charges and expenses of the administration of the bankruptcy, including the remuneration and expenses of the trustee and the costs of any audit carried out under section 175;

 (b) second, if the bankrupt had signed an authority under section 188 before the date of the bankruptcy, in payment of:

 (i) the remuneration of the controlling trustee (as defined in section 187); and

 (ii) the costs, charges and expenses properly and reasonably incurred by the controlling trustee while the authority was in force (including any debts incurred by the controlling trustee that are provable in the bankruptcy);

 (c) third, in the case of a bankruptcy that occurs within 2 months after a personal insolvency agreement executed by the bankrupt, or a composition or scheme of arrangement accepted by the bankrupt’s creditors, has (including at a time before the commencement of this paragraph) been set aside or terminated, in payment of liabilities, commitments, expenses or remuneration referred to in section 114;

 (d) fourth, in the case of the estate of a deceased debtor whose estate is being administered under Part XI, in payment of proper funeral and testamentary expenses;

 (e) fifth, in payment of amounts (including amounts payable by way of allowance or reimbursement under a contract of employment or under an industrial instrument, but not including amounts in respect of long service leave, extended leave, annual leave, recreation leave or sick leave), not exceeding in the case of any one employee $1,500 or such greater amount as is prescribed by the regulations for the purposes of this paragraph, due to or in respect of any employee of the bankrupt, whether remunerated by salary, wages, commission or otherwise, in respect of services rendered to or for the bankrupt before the date of the bankruptcy;

 (f) sixth, in payment of all amounts due in respect of compensation payable under any law of the Commonwealth or of a State or Territory relating to workers compensation, being compensation the liability for which accrued before the date of the bankruptcy;

 (g) seventh, in payment of all amounts due to or in respect of any employee of the bankrupt, whether remunerated by salary, wages, commission or otherwise, in respect of long service leave, extended leave, annual leave, recreation leave or sick leave in respect of a period before the date of the bankruptcy;

 (h) eighth, in payment of any sum payable under section 113;

 (j) ninth, in payment of:

 (i) such preferences, priorities or advantages in favour of any creditor or group of creditors as regards any other creditor or group of creditors; and

 (ii) such costs, charges and expenses incurred in the interests of creditors before the date of the bankruptcy;

  as a meeting of the creditors, by special resolution, resolves.

 (1A) Subsection (1) has effect subject to:

 (a) section 50 of the Child Support (Registration and Collection) Act 1988; and

 (b) former subsections 221YHJ(3), (4) and (5) and 221YHZD(3), (4) and (5) and former section 221YU of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936.

Note: The provisions of the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936 referred to do not apply to liabilities arising after 30 June 1993.

 (1B) The reference in paragraph (1)(e) to amounts due in respect of an employee of the bankrupt includes a reference to amounts due as contributions to a fund for the purposes of making provision for, or obtaining, superannuation benefits for the employee, or for dependants of the employee.

 (1C) The reference in paragraph (1)(e) to amounts due to or in respect of any employee of the bankrupt also includes a reference to amounts due as superannuation guarantee charge (within the meaning of the Superannuation Guarantee (Administration) Act 1992), or general interest charge in respect of nonpayment of the superannuation guarantee charge.

 (2) Subject to subsection (3), where a payment has been made by the bankrupt of an amount referred to in paragraph (1)(e) or (g) and the payment was made out of moneys advanced by a person for the purpose of enabling the payment, or such a payment, to be made, the person by whom the moneys were advanced has the same right of priority in respect of the moneys so advanced as the person who received the payment would have had if the payment had not been made.

 (3) The right of priority conferred by subsection (2) in respect of moneys advanced for the purpose referred to in that subsection does not extend to so much of the money so advanced as exceeds the amount by which the amount in respect of which the person who received the payment would have been entitled to priority has been diminished by reason of the payment.

 (5) Paragraph (1)(f) does not apply to the extent to which the bankrupt is indemnified under a contract of insurance against the liability referred to in that paragraph.

 (6) Where, under a law of the Commonwealth or of a State or Territory that provides for workers compensation, a bankrupt is liable to make a payment to a body or fund by way of reimbursing the body or fund in respect of compensation paid or payable by the body or out of the fund under that law, paragraph (1)(f) does not apply to the amount so payable by the bankrupt.

 (6A) Where compensation payable under a law relating to workers compensation is payable by way of periodical payments, the amount of that compensation shall, for the purposes of paragraph (1)(f), be taken to be the lump sum for which those periodical payments could, if redeemable, be redeemed under the law under which those periodical payments are made.

 (7) A special resolution shall not be deemed to have been duly passed for the purposes of paragraph (1)(j) unless the notice convening the meeting at which it was passed contained a copy of the proposed resolution.

 (7A) The trustee must keep the minutes of the meeting, and a written record of the terms of a special resolution, referred to in paragraph (1)(j).

 (7B) The trustee must allow a creditor or an authorised employee to inspect the minutes and record at any reasonable time.

 (8) A payment must not be made under paragraph (1)(j) until 28 days after the day on which the special resolution referred to in that paragraph was passed.

 (9) The bankrupt or a creditor may, before the expiration of the period referred to in subsection (8), apply to the Court to reverse or vary the decision of the creditors and the Court may, upon the application, make such order as it thinks proper.

 (10) Where in any bankruptcy:

 (a) property has been recovered, realized or preserved under an indemnity for costs of litigation given by a creditor or creditors; or

 (b) expenses in relation to which a creditor has, or creditors have, indemnified a trustee have been recovered;

the Court may, upon the application of the trustee or a creditor, make such orders as it thinks just and equitable with respect to the distribution of that property and the amount of those expenses so recovered with a view to giving the indemnifying creditor or creditors, as the case may be, an advantage over others in consideration of the risk assumed by creditor or creditors.

 (11) Except as provided in paragraph (1)(a), the debts in each of the classes specified in subsection (1) rank equally between themselves and shall be paid in full unless the proceeds of the property of the bankrupt are insufficient to meet them, in which case they shall be paid proportionately.

 (12) In subsection (11), debts includes liabilities, remuneration, commitments and expenses specified in subsection (1).

109A  Debts due to employees

 (1) Where a contract of employment with a bankrupt was subsisting immediately before the date of the bankruptcy, the employee under the contract is, whether or not the employee is a person referred to in subsection (2), entitled to payment under section 109 as if the employee’s employment had been terminated by the bankrupt on that date.

 (2) Where, for the purposes of a bankruptcy, a trustee employs a person whose employment by the bankrupt had been terminated by reason of the bankruptcy, that person shall, for the purpose of calculating any entitlement to payment for long service leave, extended leave, annual leave, recreation leave or sick leave, be deemed, while the trustee employs that person for those purposes, to be employed by the bankrupt.

 (3) Subject to subsection (4), where, after the date of a bankruptcy, an amount in respect of long service leave or extended leave becomes due to a person referred to in subsection (2) in respect of the employment so referred to, the amount is a cost of the bankruptcy.

 (4) Where, at the date of a bankruptcy, the length of qualifying service of a person employed by the bankrupt is insufficient to entitle that person to any amount in respect of long service leave or extended leave, but, by the operation of subsection (2), that person becomes entitled to such an amount after that date, that amount:

 (a) is a cost of the bankruptcy to the extent of an amount that bears to that amount the same proportion as the length of that person’s qualifying service after that date bears to the total length of that person’s qualifying service; and

 (b) shall, to the extent of the balance of that amount, be deemed to be an amount referred to in paragraph 109(1)(g).

110  Application of estates of joint debtors

 (1) In the case of joint debtors, whether partners or not, the joint estate shall be applied in the first instance in payment of their joint debts, and the separate estate of each joint debtor shall be applied in the first instance in payment of his or her separate debts.

 (2) If there is a surplus in the case of any of the separate estates, it shall be dealt with as part of the joint estate and if there is a surplus in the case of the joint estate, it shall be dealt with as part of the respective separate estates in proportion to the right and interest of each joint debtor in the joint estate.

113  Apprenticeship etc. claims

 (1) Where, at the time of the presentation of a petition on which, or by virtue of the presentation of which, a person became a bankrupt, a person was apprenticed, or was an articled clerk, to the bankrupt, the sequestration order or, in the case of a debtor’s petition, the presentation of the petition is, if the apprentice or clerk or a person acting on his or her behalf gives notice in writing to the trustee that the apprentice or clerk elects that the indenture of apprenticeship or articles of agreement be discharged, a complete discharge of that indenture or those articles.

 (2) Where such an indenture or such articles are so discharged and any money has been paid by or on behalf of the apprentice or clerk to the bankrupt as a fee, the trustee may, on application by or on behalf of the apprentice or clerk, pay out of the property of the bankrupt, to or for the use of the apprentice or clerk, such sum as the trustee thinks reasonable, having regard to the amount paid by or on behalf of the apprentice or clerk and to the time during which he or she has served with the bankrupt under the indenture or articles and to the other circumstances of the case.

 (3) The trustee shall, on the application of an apprentice or articled clerk to the bankrupt, or of a person acting on his or her behalf, execute a transfer of the indenture of apprenticeship or articles of agreement to some other person.

114  Payment of liabilities etc. incurred under terminated deed etc.

 (1) Where a debtor becomes a bankrupt after a personal insolvency agreement executed by him or her, or a composition or scheme of arrangement accepted by his or her creditors, has, whether before or after the commencement of this Act, been set aside or terminated:

 (a) any unpaid liabilities incurred in good faith, and any unpaid commitments entered into in good faith, under the terminated agreement, composition or scheme of arrangement by the trustee or the debtor;

 (b) any expenses reasonably incurred in good faith under the terminated agreement, composition or scheme of arrangement by the trustee, being expenses for which he or she has not been reimbursed; and

 (c) such proportionate part of the unpaid remuneration of the trustee as the creditors in relation to the terminated agreement, composition or scheme of arrangement determine by resolution;

are debts provable in the bankruptcy.

 (2) In this section:

the terminated agreement, composition or scheme of arrangement means the agreement, composition or scheme of arrangement that has been set aside or terminated.

Subdivision BThe effect of proceeds of crime orders and applications for proceeds of crime orders

114A  The effect of proceeds of crime orders

 (1) If property of a bankrupt is covered by a restraining order, or a forfeiture order, made on or after the date of the bankruptcy, proceeds of property that is covered by the order must not be applied under Subdivision A while that property is so covered.

 (2) If a pecuniary penalty order is made against a bankrupt on or after the date of the bankruptcy, proceeds of any of the property of the bankrupt must not be applied under Subdivision A while the order is in force.

Note: For proceeds of crime orders made before the date of the bankruptcy, see section 58A.

114B  The effect of applications for proceeds of crime orders

 (1) If:

 (a) an application is made under a proceeds of crime law for a restraining order or a forfeiture order; and

 (b) if the order were made, it would cover property of a bankrupt (whether the application is made before, on or after the date of the bankruptcy);

proceeds of any of the property of the bankrupt that would be covered by the order must not be applied under Subdivision A before the application is finally determined.

 (2) If:

 (a) an application is made under a proceeds of crime law for a pecuniary penalty order; and

 (b) the person against whom the order would be made is, or later becomes, a bankrupt;

proceeds of any of the property of the bankrupt must not be applied under Subdivision A before the application is finally determined.

114C  Director of Public Prosecutions or Commissioner of the Australian Federal Police must notify the trustee of certain matters

  If circumstances arise as a result of which:

 (a) this Subdivision prevents Subdivision A from being applied to the proceeds of property of a bankrupt; or

 (b) this Subdivision no longer prevents Subdivision A from being applied to the proceeds of property of a bankrupt;

the Director of Public Prosecutions (or the Commissioner of the Australian Federal Police, if the Commissioner is the Commonwealth proceeds of crime authority that is the responsible authority for the order under the Proceeds of Crime Act 2002) must, as soon as practicable, give the trustee written notice of the existence of the circumstances.

Division 3Property available for payment of debts

Subdivision AGeneral

115  Commencement of bankruptcy

 (1) If a person becomes a bankrupt on a creditor’s petition and subsection (1A) does not apply, then the bankruptcy is taken to have relation back to, and to have commenced at, the time of the commission of the earliest act of bankruptcy committed by the person within the period of 6 months immediately before the date on which the creditor’s petition was presented.

 (1A) If:

 (a) a person becomes a bankrupt on a creditor’s petition that was based on breach of a bankruptcy notice; and

 (b) the time for compliance with the notice was extended under subsection 41(7); and

 (c) the Court making the sequestration order considers that the application under subsection 41(7) was frivolous, vexatious or otherwise without substantial merit;

then the bankruptcy is taken to have relation back to, and to have commenced at, the time that would have applied under subsection (1) of this section if the time for compliance had not been extended.

 (1B) If a person becomes a bankrupt because of a sequestration order made under Division 6 of Part IV or under Part X, then the bankruptcy is taken to have relation back to, and to have commenced at, the time of the commission of the earliest act of bankruptcy committed by the person within the period of 6 months immediately before the date on which the application for the sequestration order was made.

 (2) The bankruptcy of a person who becomes a bankrupt as a result of the acceptance of a debtor’s petition is taken to have relation back to, and to have commenced at, the time indicated in the following table.

 

Debtor’s petition bankruptcy—time to which bankruptcy has relation back and time bankruptcy commences

 


Circumstances in which debtor’s petition was presented or accepted

Time to which bankruptcy has relation back and time of commencement of bankruptcy

1

Petition accepted by the Official Receiver under a direction of the Court

Time specified by the Court as the commencement of the bankruptcy

2

Petition presented when at least one creditor’s petition was pending against the petitioning debtor (whether alone, as a member of a partnership or as a joint debtor), and accepted by the Official Receiver without a direction from the Court

Time of the commission of the earliest act of bankruptcy on which any of the creditor’s petitions was based

3

Petition presented when no creditor’s petitions were pending but the debtor had committed at least one act of bankruptcy in the past 6 months, and accepted by the Official Receiver without a direction from the Court

Time of commission of the earliest act of bankruptcy within the 6 months before the petition was presented

4

Petition presented when no creditor’s petitions were pending and the debtor had not committed any act of bankruptcy in the past 6 months, and accepted by the Official Receiver without a direction from the Court

Time of presentation of the petition

 (3) A creditor’s petition or a sequestration order made on a creditor’s petition is not invalid by reason of the commission of an act of bankruptcy before the time when the debt on which the petition was based was incurred.

116  Property divisible among creditors

 (1) Subject to this Act:

 (a) all property that belonged to, or was vested in, a bankrupt at the commencement of the bankruptcy, or has been acquired or is acquired by him or her, or has devolved or devolves on him or her, after the commencement of the bankruptcy and before his or her discharge; and

 (b) the capacity to exercise, and to take proceedings for exercising all such powers in, over or in respect of property as might have been exercised by the bankrupt for his or her own benefit at the commencement of the bankruptcy or at any time after the commencement of the bankruptcy and before his or her discharge; and

 (c) property that is vested in the trustee of the bankrupt’s estate by or under an order under section 139D or 139DA; and

 (d) money that is paid to the trustee of the bankrupt’s estate under an order under section 139E or 139EA; and

 (e) money that is paid to the trustee of the bankrupt’s estate under an order under paragraph 128K(1)(b); and

 (f) money that is paid to the trustee of the bankrupt’s estate under a section 139ZQ notice that relates to a transaction that is void against the trustee under section 128C; and

 (g) money that is paid to the trustee of the bankrupt’s estate under an order under section 139ZU;

is property divisible amongst the creditors of the bankrupt.

 (2) Subsection (1) does not extend to the following property:

 (a) property held by the bankrupt in trust for another person;

 (b) the bankrupt’s household property that is:

 (i) of a kind prescribed by the regulations; or

 (ii) identified by a resolution passed by the creditors before the trustee realises the property;

 (ba) personal property of the bankrupt that:

 (i) has sentimental value for the bankrupt; and

 (ii) is of a kind prescribed by the regulations; and

 (iii) is identified by a special resolution passed by the creditors before the trustee realises the property;

 (c) the bankrupt’s property that is for use by the bankrupt in earning income by personal exertion and:

 (i) does not have a total value greater than the limit prescribed by the regulations; or

 (ii) is identified by a resolution passed by the creditors; or

 (iii) is identified by an order made by the Court on an application by the bankrupt;

 (ca) property used by the bankrupt primarily as a means of transport, being property whose aggregate value does not exceed the amount prescribed by the regulations or, if before the trustee realises the lastmentioned property the creditors determine by resolution a greater amount in relation to that property, that greater amount;

 (d) subject to sections 128B, 128C and 139ZU:

 (i) policies of life assurance or endowment assurance in respect of the life of the bankrupt or the spouse or de facto partner of the bankrupt;

 (ii) the proceeds of such policies received on or after the date of the bankruptcy;

 (iii) the interest of the bankrupt in:

 (A) a regulated superannuation fund (within the meaning of the Superannuation Industry (Supervision) Act 1993); or

 (B) an approved deposit fund (within the meaning of that Act); or

 (C) an exempt public sector superannuation scheme (within the meaning of that Act);

 (iv) a payment to the bankrupt from such a fund received on or after the date of the bankruptcy, if the payment is not a pension within the meaning of the Superannuation Industry (Supervision) Act 1993;

 (iva) a payment to the bankrupt under a payment split under Part VIIIB of the Family Law Act 1975 where:

 (A) the eligible superannuation plan involved is a fund or scheme covered by subparagraph (iii); and

 (B) the splittable payment involved is not a pension within the meaning of the Superannuation Industry (Supervision) Act 1993;

 (v) the amount of money a bankrupt holds in an RSA;

 (vi) a payment to a bankrupt from an RSA received on or after the date of the bankruptcy, if the payment is not a pension or annuity within the meaning of the Retirement Savings Accounts Act 1997;

 (vii) a payment to the bankrupt under a payment split under Part VIIIB of the Family Law Act 1975 where:

 (A) the eligible superannuation plan involved is an RSA; and

 (B) the splittable payment involved is not a pension or annuity within the meaning of the Retirement Savings Accounts Act 1997;

 (g) any right of the bankrupt to recover damages or compensation:

 (i) for personal injury or wrong done to the bankrupt, the spouse or de facto partner of the bankrupt or a member of the family of the bankrupt; or

 (ii) in respect of the death of the spouse or de facto partner of the bankrupt or a member of the family of the bankrupt;

  and any damages or compensation recovered by the bankrupt (whether before or after he or she became a bankrupt) in respect of such an injury or wrong or the death of such a person;

Note: See also subsection 5(6).

 (k) amounts paid to the bankrupt under a rural support scheme prescribed for the purposes of this paragraph;

 (l) amounts paid to the bankrupt under a rural support scheme prescribed for the purposes of this paragraph, where the amounts are paid in circumstances prescribed for the purposes of this paragraph;

 (m) prescribed amounts paid to the bankrupt under a rural support scheme prescribed for the purposes of this paragraph;

 (ma) prescribed amounts paid to the bankrupt under a rural support scheme prescribed for the purposes of this paragraph, where the amounts are paid in circumstances prescribed for the purposes of this paragraph;

 (mb) amounts paid to the bankrupt by the Commonwealth as compensation in relation to the loss of:

 (i) an amount covered by paragraph (k), (l), (m) or (ma); or

 (ii) property purchased or acquired wholly or partly with such an amount;

 (n) property to which, by virtue of subsection (3), this paragraph applies;

 (p) amounts paid to the bankrupt under subsection (2C) or (4);

 (q) any property that, under an order under Part VIII of the Family Law Act 1975, the trustee is required to transfer to the spouse, or a former spouse, of the bankrupt;

 (r) any property that, under an order under Part VIIIAB of the Family Law Act 1975, the trustee is required to transfer to a former de facto partner of the bankrupt.

 (2B) Where, because of a resolution passed by the creditors, or an order made by the Court, under paragraph (2)(b), (c) or (ca), property that is vested in the trustee ceases at a particular time to be property divisible among the creditors, then, immediately after that time:

 (a) the property revests in the bankrupt;

 (b) the trustee is discharged from the trustee’s liabilities in respect of the property; and

 (c) the bankrupt becomes subject to those liabilities.

 (2C) Where:

 (a) property used by the bankrupt primarily as a means of transport is vested in the trustee; and

 (b) as at the time when the trustee realises that property:

 (i) no other property has remained vested in the bankrupt by virtue of paragraph (2)(ca); and

 (ii) no other property has, because of a determination by the creditors under paragraph (2)(ca), revested in the bankrupt by virtue of subsection (2B);

the trustee shall pay to the bankrupt so much of the proceeds of realising that property as, when added to the aggregate of the amounts (if any) that the trustee has previously paid to the bankrupt under this subsection, does not exceed the prescribed amount within the meaning of paragraph (2)(ca).

 (2D) In subsections (3) and (4):

exempt loan money, in relation to a particular time, means so much of the principal sum of a loan to the bankrupt, or to the bankrupt and another person or other persons, as was repaid, before that time, out of exempt money.

exempt money means money of any of the following kinds:

 (a) an amount to which subsection (1) does not extend because of subparagraph (2)(d)(ii) or (iv);

 (b) damages or compensation of a kind referred to in paragraph (2)(g);

 (c) amounts covered by paragraph (2)(k), (l), (m), (ma) or (mb).

outlay, in relation to property, in relation to a particular time, means all of the following:

 (a) the money paid for the purchase, or used in the acquisition, of the property;

 (b) the money paid before that time in respect of the extensions, alterations and improvements, if any, of the property constructed or made since that purchase or acquisition.

protected money, in relation to a particular time, means:

 (a) exempt money; or

 (b) exempt loan money in relation to that time.

 (2E) Nothing in this Act or the Legislative Instruments Act 2003 prevents regulations made for the purposes of paragraph (2)(k), (l), (m) or (ma) from applying to amounts paid before the regulations take effect.

 (2F) Regulations made for the purposes of paragraph (2)(k), (l), (m) or (ma) may make provision in relation to a matter by applying, adopting or incorporating any matter contained in an instrument or other writing as in force or existing from time to time.

 (3) Where, at any time, the whole, or substantially the whole, of the money paid for the purchase, or used in the acquisition, of particular property is protected money, paragraph (2)(n) applies to the property.

 (4) Where, as at the time when the trustee realises particular property to which paragraph (2)(n) does not apply, the outlay in relation to the property is in part protected money and in part other money, the trustee shall pay to the bankrupt so much of the proceeds of realising the property as can fairly be attributed to that protected money.

117  Policies of insurance against liabilities to third parties

 (1) Where:

 (a) a bankrupt is or was insured under a contract of insurance against liabilities to third parties; and

 (b) a liability against which he or she is or was so insured has been incurred (whether before or after he or she became a bankrupt);

the right of the bankrupt to indemnity under the policy vests in the trustee and any amount received by the trustee from the insurer under the policy in respect of the liability shall, if the liability has not already been satisfied, be paid in full forthwith to the third party to whom it has been incurred.

 (2) Subsection (1) does not limit the rights of the third party in respect of any balance due to him or her after the payment referred to in that subsection has been made.

 (3) This section applies notwithstanding any agreement to the contrary, whether entered into before or after the commencement of this Act.

118  Execution by creditor against property of debtor who becomes a bankrupt etc.

 (1) Subject to subsection (2), where:

 (a) a creditor has, within 6 months before the presentation of a petition, or after the presentation of a petition, against a debtor:

 (i) received moneys as a result of execution having been issued by him or her, or on his or her behalf, against property of the debtor, being moneys that are the proceeds of the sale of property of the debtor that has been sold in pursuance of the process or that were seized, or paid to avoid seizure or sale of property of the debtor, in pursuance of the process; or

 (ii) received moneys as a result of the attachment by him or her, or on his or her behalf, of a debt due to the debtor; and

 (b) the debtor subsequently becomes a bankrupt on, or by virtue of the presentation of, the petition;

the creditor shall pay to the trustee of the estate of the bankrupt the amount by which the amount of those moneys exceeds the taxed costs of the execution or attachment, as the case may be.

 (2) Subsection (1) does not apply in relation to a creditor who has received moneys as a result of execution having been issued by him or her, or on his or her behalf, against property of a debtor, or as a result of the attachment by him or her, or on his or her behalf, of a debt due to the debtor, in respect of any liability of the debtor under a maintenance agreement or maintenance order (whether entered into or made, as the case may be, before or after the commencement of this section).

 (3) Where a creditor has, in pursuance of subsection (1), paid the proceeds of the sale of property or other moneys to the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt, the creditor may prove in the bankruptcy for his or her debt as an unsecured creditor as if the execution or attachment, as the case may be, had not taken place.

 (4) Where:

 (a) a creditor has, in pursuance of subsection (1), paid to the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt the proceeds of the sale of property or other moneys that were received as a result of execution having been issued by him or her, or on his or her behalf, against property of the bankrupt or of the attachment by him or her, or on his or her behalf, of a debt due to the bankrupt; and

 (b) that property or debt would not have been property divisible amongst the creditors of the bankrupt if the bankrupt had become a bankrupt immediately before the execution was issued or the debt was attached, as the case may be;

the trustee shall pay those proceeds or other moneys to the bankrupt or to a person authorized by the bankrupt in writing for the purpose.

 (5) Subject to this section, where notice in writing of the presentation of a creditor’s petition against a debtor is given to a creditor:

 (a) the creditor shall not take any action or further action, as the case may be, to attach a debt due to the debtor until the petition has been dealt with by the Court or has lapsed; and

 (b) if a debt due to the debtor has been attached by the creditor:

 (i) the creditor shall forthwith give a written notice of the presentation of the petition to the person liable to pay that debt; and

 (ii) the attachment of the debt is suspended until the petition has been dealt with by the Court or has lapsed.

 (6) Subject to this section, where notice in writing of the reference to the Court of a debtor’s petition against a debtor is given to a creditor:

 (a) the creditor shall not take any action or further action, as the case may be, to attach a debt due to the debtor until the Court has dealt with the petition; and

 (b) if a debt due to the debtor has been attached by the creditor:

 (i) the creditor shall forthwith give a written notice of the presentation of the petition to the person liable to pay that debt; and

 (ii) the attachment of the debt is suspended until the Court has dealt with the petition.

 (7) Nothing in this section shall be taken to prevent a person liable to pay a debt to a debtor from paying the debt or a part of the debt to the debtor during the suspension, in accordance with subsection (5) or (6), of an attachment of that debt.

 (8) A creditor who contravenes, or fails to comply with, subsection (5) or (6) is guilty of contempt of court.

 (9) Subject to subsection (10), where:

 (a) a creditor has, within 6 months before the presentation of a petition, or after the presentation of a petition, against a debtor obtained a charge or charging order against property of the debtor; and

 (b) the debtor subsequently becomes a bankrupt on, or by virtue of the presentation of, the petition;

the charge or charging order, as the case may be, is void as against the trustee in the bankruptcy.

 (10) Subsections (5), (6) and (9) do not apply in relation to the attachment of a debt due to a debtor, or to a charge or charging order against property of a debtor, in respect of any liability of the debtor under a maintenance agreement or maintenance order (whether entered into or made, as the case may be, before or after the commencement of this section).

 (11) Notwithstanding anything contained in this Act, a person who purchases property in good faith:

 (a) under a sale by a sheriff in consequence of the issue of execution against property of a debtor who, after the sale, becomes a bankrupt; or

 (b) under a sale in consequence of the enforcement by a creditor of a charge or a charging order against property of a debtor who, after the sale, becomes a bankrupt;

acquires a good title to it as against the trustee of the estate of the bankrupt.

 (12) In this section:

charge means a charge created by a law of the Commonwealth or of a State or Territory of the Commonwealth upon registration of a judgment in any registry.

charging order means a charging order made by a court in respect of a judgment.

119  Duties of sheriff after receiving notice of presentation of petition etc.

 (1) Subject to this section, where notice in writing of the presentation of a creditor’s petition against a debtor is given to a sheriff, the sheriff:

 (a) shall refrain:

 (i) from taking any action to sell property of the debtor in pursuance of any process of execution issued by or on behalf of a creditor; and

 (ii) from taking any action on behalf of a creditor to attach a debt due to the debtor; and

 (b) shall not:

 (i) pay to the creditor by whom, or on whose behalf, the process of execution was issued, or to any person on his or her behalf, the proceeds of the sale of property of the debtor that has been sold in pursuance of any such process or any moneys seized, or paid to avoid seizure or sale of property of the debtor, in pursuance of any such process; or

 (ii) pay to the creditor, or to any person on his or her behalf, any moneys received as a result of the attachment of the debt due to the debtor;

until the petition has been dealt with by the Court or has lapsed.

 (2) Subject to this section, where notice in writing of the reference to the Court of a debtor’s petition against a debtor is given to a sheriff, the sheriff:

 (a) shall refrain:

 (i) from taking any action to sell property of the debtor in pursuance of any process of execution issued by or on behalf of a creditor; and

 (ii) from taking any action on behalf of a creditor to attach a debt due to the debtor; and

 (b) shall not:

 (i) pay to the creditor by whom, or on whose behalf, the process of execution was issued, or to any person on his or her behalf, the proceeds of the sale of property of the debtor that has been sold in pursuance of any such process or any moneys seized, or paid to avoid seizure or sale of property of the debtor, in pursuance of any such process; or

 (ii) pay to the creditor, or to any person on his or her behalf, any moneys received as a result of the attachment of the debt due to the debtor;

until the Court has dealt with the petition.

 (3) Where notice of the presentation of a creditor’s petition against a debtor has been given under subsection (1) to a sheriff or notice of the reference to the Court of a debtor’s petition against a debtor has been given under subsection (2) to a sheriff, a creditor who has issued a process of execution, or on whose behalf a process of execution has been issued, against property of the debtor, or who has taken action, or on whose behalf action has been taken, to attach a debt due to the debtor, in respect of a liability of the debtor under a maintenance agreement or maintenance order (whether entered into or made, as the case may be, before or after the commencement of this section) may give to the sheriff a written notice setting out details of the maintenance agreement or maintenance order, and, upon the giving of the notice, subsection (1) or (2), as the case may be, ceases to apply in relation to the process of execution or attachment, as the case may be.

 (4) Subject to this section, where notice in writing of the presentation of a creditor’s petition against a debtor is given to the registrar or other appropriate officer of a court:

 (a) to which the proceeds of the sale of property of the debtor or other moneys have been paid by a sheriff in pursuance of a process of execution issued, by or on behalf of a creditor, against property of the debtor; or

 (b) to which moneys have been paid in pursuance of proceedings instituted, by or on behalf of a creditor, to attach a debt due to the debtor;

any of those proceeds or moneys not paid out of court shall not be paid to the creditor or to any person on his or her behalf until the petition has been dealt with by the Court or has lapsed.

 (5) Subject to this section, where notice in writing of the reference to the Court of a debtor’s petition against a debtor is given to the registrar or other appropriate officer of a Court:

 (a) to which the proceeds of the sale of property of the debtor or other moneys have been paid by a sheriff in pursuance of a process of execution issued, by or on behalf of a creditor, against property of the debtor; or

 (b) to which moneys have been paid in pursuance of proceedings instituted, by or on behalf of a creditor, to attach a debt due to the debtor;

any of those proceeds or moneys not paid out of court shall not be paid to the creditor or to any person on his or her behalf until the Court has dealt with the petition.

 (6) Where notice of the presentation of a creditor’s petition against a debtor has been given under subsection (4) to the registrar or other appropriate officer of any court or notice of the reference to the Court of a debtor’s petition against a debtor has been given under subsection (5) to the registrar or other appropriate officer of any court, a creditor who has issued a process of execution, or on whose behalf a process of execution has been issued, against property of the debtor, or who has taken action, or on whose behalf action has been taken, to attach a debt due to the debtor, in respect of a liability of the debtor under a maintenance agreement or maintenance order (whether entered into or made, as the case may be, before or after the commencement of this section) may give to the registrar or other officer a written notice setting out details of the maintenance agreement or maintenance order, and, upon the giving of the notice, subsection (4) or (5), as the case may be, ceases to apply in relation to the process of execution or attachment, as the case may be.

 (7) Where a sheriff, in pursuance of subsection (1) or (2), refrains from taking action to sell property of a debtor (being real property), the debtor becomes a bankrupt and the property vests in the trustee in the bankruptcy, the costs of the execution are a first charge on that property.

 (8) A failure by a sheriff to comply with a provision of this section does not affect the title of a person who purchases property of a bankrupt in good faith under a sale by the sheriff in pursuance of a process of execution issued by or on behalf of a creditor.

119A  Duties of sheriff after receiving notice of bankruptcy etc.

 (1) Where a debtor has become a bankrupt (whether on a creditor’s petition or otherwise and whether before or after the commencement of this section), the trustee may give to the sheriff or to the registrar or other appropriate officer of a court, notice in writing of that fact and, upon the giving of the notice:

 (a) the sheriff shall deliver or pay to the trustee:

 (i) any property of the bankrupt in his or her possession under a process of execution issued by or on behalf of a creditor;

 (ii) any proceeds of the sale of property of the bankrupt or other moneys in his or her possession, being proceeds of the sale of property sold, whether before or after the bankrupt became a bankrupt, in pursuance of any such process or moneys seized, or paid to avoid seizure or sale of property of the bankrupt, whether before or after the bankrupt became a bankrupt, in pursuance of any such process; and

 (iii) any moneys in his or her possession as a result of the attachment, by or on behalf of a creditor, of a debt due to the bankrupt; or

 (b) the registrar or other officer of the court shall pay to the trustee:

 (i) any proceeds of the sale of property of the bankrupt or other moneys in court, being proceeds of sale or other moneys paid into court, whether before or after the bankrupt became a bankrupt, by a sheriff in pursuance of a process of execution issued, by or on behalf of a creditor, against property of the bankrupt; and

 (ii) any moneys in court that have been paid into court, whether before or after the bankrupt became a bankrupt, in pursuance of proceedings instituted, by or on behalf of a creditor, to attach a debt due to the bankrupt;

as the case requires.

 (2) Where property is, or the proceeds of the sale of property or other moneys are, required by subsection (1) to be delivered or paid to the trustee, the costs of the execution or attachment, as the case may be, are a first charge on that property or those proceeds of sale or other moneys, as the case may be.

 (3) For the purpose of giving effect to the charge referred to in subsection (2), the sheriff, registrar or other officer of a court may retain on behalf of the creditor entitled to the benefit of the charge, such amount from the proceeds of sale or other moneys referred to in that subsection as he or she thinks necessary for the purpose.

 (4) Where a sheriff, registrar or other officer of a court has, in pursuance of subsection (1), delivered property or paid moneys to the trustee, the creditor who issued the process of execution or instituted the attachment proceedings, or on whose behalf the process was issued or the proceedings instituted, as the case may be, may prove in the bankruptcy for his or her debt as an unsecured creditor as if the execution or attachment, as the case may be, had not taken place.

 (5) Where:

 (a) a sheriff, registrar or other officer of a court has, in pursuance of subsection (1), delivered to the trustee property that was seized, or paid to the trustee the proceeds of the sale of property or other moneys that were received, as a result of the issue of execution against property of a bankrupt or the attachment of a debt due to a bankrupt; and

 (b) that property or debt would not have been property divisible amongst the creditors of the bankrupt if the bankrupt had become a bankrupt immediately before the execution was issued or the debt attached, as the case may be;

the trustee shall deliver that property, or pay those proceeds or other moneys, as the case requires, to the bankrupt or to a person authorized by the bankrupt in writing for the purpose.

 (6) Where:

 (a) property has been delivered by a sheriff, or the proceeds of the sale of property or other moneys have been paid by a sheriff, registrar or other officer of a court, to the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt in pursuance of subsection (1); and

 (b) the property was in the possession of the sheriff, or the proceeds of the sale of the property or the other moneys were in the possession of the sheriff or paid into court, as the case may be, under or in pursuance of a process of execution issued, or proceedings to attach a debt instituted, by or on behalf of a creditor in respect of a liability of the bankrupt under a maintenance agreement or maintenance order (whether entered into or made, as the case may be, before or after the commencement of this section);

the trustee shall deliver that property, or pay those proceeds or other moneys, as the case requires, to that creditor.

 (7) A failure by a sheriff to comply with a provision of this section does not affect the title of a person who purchases property of a bankrupt in good faith under a sale by the sheriff in pursuance of a process of execution issued by or on behalf of a creditor.

120  Undervalued transactions

Transfers that are void against trustee

 (1) A transfer of property by a person who later becomes a bankrupt (the transferor) to another person (the transferee) is void against the trustee in the transferor’s bankruptcy if:

 (a) the transfer took place in the period beginning 5 years before the commencement of the bankruptcy and ending on the date of the bankruptcy; and

 (b) the transferee gave no consideration for the transfer or gave consideration of less value than the market value of the property.

Note: For the application of this section where consideration is given to a third party rather than the transferor, see section 121A.

Exemptions

 (2) Subsection (1) does not apply to:

 (a) a payment of tax payable under a law of the Commonwealth or of a State or Territory; or

 (b) a transfer to meet all or part of a liability under a maintenance agreement or a maintenance order; or

 (c) a transfer of property under a debt agreement; or

 (d) a transfer of property if the transfer is of a kind described in the regulations.

 (3) Despite subsection (1), a transfer is not void against the trustee if:

 (a) in the case of a transfer to a related entity of the transferor:

 (i) the transfer took place more than 4 years before the commencement of the bankruptcy; and

 (ii) the transferee proves that, at the time of the transfer, the transferor was solvent; or

 (b) in any other case:

 (i) the transfer took place more than 2 years before the commencement of the bankruptcy; and

 (ii) the transferee proves that, at the time of the transfer, the transferor was solvent.

Rebuttable presumption of insolvency

 (3A) For the purposes of subsection (3), a rebuttable presumption arises that the transferor was insolvent at the time of the transfer if it is established that the transferor:

 (a) had not, in respect of that time, kept such books, accounts and records as are usual and proper in relation to the business carried on by the transferor and as sufficiently disclose the transferor’s business transactions and financial position; or

 (b) having kept such books, accounts and records, has not preserved them.

Refund of consideration

 (4) The trustee must pay to the transferee an amount equal to the value of any consideration that the transferee gave for a transfer that is void against the trustee.

What is not consideration

 (5) For the purposes of subsections (1) and (4), the following have no value as consideration:

 (a) the fact that the transferee is related to the transferor;

 (b) if the transferee is the spouse or de facto partner of the transferor—the transferee making a deed in favour of the transferor;

 (c) the transferee’s promise to marry, or to become the de facto partner of, the transferor;

 (d) the transferee’s love or affection for the transferor;

 (e) if the transferee is the spouse, or a former spouse, of the transferor—the transferee granting the transferor a right to live at the transferred property, unless the grant relates to a transfer or settlement of property, or an agreement, under the Family Law Act 1975;

 (f) if the transferee is a former de facto partner of the transferor—the transferee granting the transferor a right to live at the transferred property, unless the grant relates to a transfer or settlement of property, or an agreement, under the Family Law Act 1975.

Protection of successors in title

 (6) This section does not affect the rights of a person who acquired property from the transferee in good faith and by giving consideration that was at least as valuable as the market value of the property.

Meaning of transfer of property and market value

 (7) For the purposes of this section:

 (a) transfer of property includes a payment of money; and

 (b) a person who does something that results in another person becoming the owner of property that did not previously exist is taken to have transferred the property to the other person; and

 (c) the market value of property transferred is its market value at the time of the transfer.

121  Transfers to defeat creditors

Transfers that are void

 (1) A transfer of property by a person who later becomes a bankrupt (the transferor) to another person (the transferee) is void against the trustee in the transferor’s bankruptcy if:

 (a) the property would probably have become part of the transferor’s estate or would probably have been available to creditors if the property had not been transferred; and

 (b) the transferor’s main purpose in making the transfer was:

 (i) to prevent the transferred property from becoming divisible among the transferor’s creditors; or

 (ii) to hinder or delay the process of making property available for division among the transferor’s creditors.

Note: For the application of this section where consideration is given to a third party rather than the transferor, see section 121A.

Showing the transferor’s main purpose in making a transfer

 (2) The transferor’s main purpose in making the transfer is taken to be the purpose described in paragraph (1)(b) if it can reasonably be inferred from all the circumstances that, at the time of the transfer, the transferor was, or was about to become, insolvent.

Other ways of showing the transferor’s main purpose in making a transfer

 (3) Subsection (2) does not limit the ways of establishing the transferor’s main purpose in making a transfer.

Transfer not void if transferee acted in good faith

 (4) Despite subsection (1), a transfer of property is not void against the trustee if:

 (a) the consideration that the transferee gave for the transfer was at least as valuable as the market value of the property; and

 (b) the transferee did not know, and could not reasonably have inferred, that the transferor’s main purpose in making the transfer was the purpose described in paragraph (1)(b); and

 (c) the transferee could not reasonably have inferred that, at the time of the transfer, the transferor was, or was about to become, insolvent.

Rebuttable presumption of insolvency

 (4A) For the purposes of this section, a rebuttable presumption arises that the transferor was, or was about to become, insolvent at the time of the transfer if it is established that the transferor:

 (a) had not, in respect of that time, kept such books, accounts and records as are usual and proper in relation to the business carried on by the transferor and as sufficiently disclose the transferor’s business transactions and financial position; or

 (b) having kept such books, accounts and records, has not preserved them.

Refund of consideration

 (5) The trustee must pay to the transferee an amount equal to the value of any consideration that the transferee gave for a transfer that is void against the trustee.

What is not consideration

 (6) For the purposes of subsections (4) and (5), the following have no value as consideration:

 (a) the fact that the transferee is related to the transferor;

 (b) if the transferee is the spouse or de facto partner of the transferor—the transferee making a deed in favour of the transferor;

 (c) the transferee’s promise to marry, or to become the de facto partner of, the transferor;

 (d) the transferee’s love or affection for the transferor;

 (e) if the transferee is the spouse, or a former spouse, of the transferor—the transferee granting the transferor a right to live at the transferred property, unless the grant relates to a transfer or settlement of property, or an agreement, under the Family Law Act 1975;

 (f) if the transferee is a former de facto partner of the transferor—the transferee granting the transferor a right to live at the transferred property, unless the grant relates to a transfer or settlement of property, or an agreement, under the Family Law Act 1975.

Exemption of transfers of property under debt agreements

 (7) This section does not apply to a transfer of property under a debt agreement.

Protection of successors in title

 (8) This section does not affect the rights of a person who acquired property from the transferee in good faith and for at least the market value of the property.

Meaning of transfer of property and market value

 (9) For the purposes of this section:

 (a) transfer of property includes a payment of money; and

 (b) a person who does something that results in another person becoming the owner of property that did not previously exist is taken to have transferred the property to the other person; and

 (c) the market value of property transferred is its market value at the time of the transfer.

121A  Transactions where consideration given to a third party

 (1) This section applies if:

 (a) a person who later becomes a bankrupt (the transferor) transfers property to another person (the transferee); and

 (b) the transferee gives some or all of the consideration for the transfer to a person (a third party) other than the transferor.

 (2) Sections 120 and 121 apply as if the giving of the consideration to the third party were a transfer by the transferor of the property constituting the consideration.

 (3) If the giving of the consideration to the third party is void against the trustee in the transferor’s bankruptcy under section 120 or 121, the trustee has the same rights to recover the property constituting the consideration as the trustee would have if the giving of the consideration had actually been a transfer by the transferor of the property constituting the consideration.

122  Avoidance of preferences

 (1) A transfer of property by a person who is insolvent (the debtor) in favour of a creditor is void against the trustee in the debtor’s bankruptcy if the transfer:

 (a) had the effect of giving the creditor a preference, priority or advantage over other creditors; and

 (b) was made in the period that relates to the debtor, as indicated in the following table.

 

Periods during which transfers of property may be void

 

Description of petition leading to debtor’s bankruptcy

Period during which the transfer was made

1

Creditor’s petition

Period beginning 6 months before the presentation of the petition and ending immediately before the date of the bankruptcy of the debtor

2

Debtor’s petition presented when at least one creditor’s petition was pending against a petitioning debtor or a member of a partnership against which the debtor’s petition was presented

Period beginning on the commencement of the debtor’s bankruptcy and ending immediately before the date of the bankruptcy of the debtor

3

Debtor’s petition presented in any other circumstances

Period beginning 6 months before the presentation of the petition and ending immediately before the date of the bankruptcy of the debtor

 (1A) Subsection (1) applies in relation to a transfer of property by the debtor in favour of a creditor:

 (a) whether or not the liability of the debtor to the creditor is his or her separate liability or is a liability with another person or other persons jointly; and

 (b) whether or not the property transferred is the debtor’s own property or is the property of the debtor and one or more other persons.

 (2) Nothing in this section affects:

 (a) the rights of a purchaser, payee or encumbrancer in the ordinary course of business who acted in good faith and who gave consideration at least as valuable as the market value of the property; or

 (b) the rights of a person who is making title through or under a creditor of the debtor in good faith and who gave consideration at least as valuable as the market value of the property; or

 (c) a conveyance, transfer, charge, payment or obligation of the debtor executed, made or incurred under or in pursuance of a maintenance agreement or maintenance order; or

 (d) a transfer of property under a debt agreement.

 (3) The burden of proving the matters referred to in subsection (2) lies upon the person claiming to have the benefit of that subsection.

 (4) For the purposes of this section:

 (a) a transfer of property is taken to have been made in favour of a creditor if it is made in favour of a person in trust for the creditor; and

 (b) a payment of tax, or of any other amount payable to the Commonwealth, or to the Commissioner of Taxation, under or because of an Act of which the Commissioner has the general administration, is taken to be made for consideration equal in value to the payment and in the ordinary course of business; and

 (c) a creditor shall be deemed not to be a purchaser, payee or encumbrancer in good faith if the transfer of property was made under such circumstances as to lead to the inference that the creditor knew, or had reason to suspect:

 (i) that the debtor was unable to pay his or her debts as they became due from his or her own money; and

 (ii) that the effect of the transfer would be to give him or her a preference, priority or advantage over other creditors.

 (4A) A reference in this section (other than subsection (5)) to a creditor of the debtor shall be read as including a reference to a person who would be a creditor of the debtor in relation to a contract, agreement, transaction or other dealing if the contract, agreement, transaction or other dealing were not, in whole or in part, void or unenforceable, or had not been voided in whole or in part, by or under a law of the Commonwealth or of a State or Territory of the Commonwealth.

 (5) If a transfer of property is set aside by the trustee in a bankruptcy as a result of this section, the creditor to whom the property was transferred may prove in the bankruptcy as if the transfer had not been made.

 (7) In this section:

tax means tax (however described) payable under a law of the Commonwealth or of a State or Territory, and includes, for example, a levy, a charge, and municipal or other rates.

 (8) For the purposes of this section:

 (a) transfer of property includes a payment of money; and

 (b) a person who does something that results in another person becoming the owner of property that did not previously exist is taken to have transferred the property to the other person; and

 (c) the market value of property transferred is its market value at the time of the transfer.

123  Protection of certain transfers of property against relation back etc.

 (1) Subject to sections 118 to 122 (inclusive) and sections 128B and 128C, nothing in this Act invalidates, in any case where a debtor becomes a bankrupt:

 (a) a payment by the debtor to any of his or her creditors;

 (b) a conveyance, transfer or assignment by the debtor for market value;

 (c) a contract, dealing or other transaction by or with the debtor for market value; or

 (d) any transaction to the extent of a present advance made by an existing creditor;

if:

 (e) the transaction took place before the day on which the debtor became a bankrupt;

 (f) the person, other than the debtor, with whom it took place, did not, at the time of the transaction, have notice of the presentation of a petition against the debtor; and

 (g) the transaction was in good faith and in the ordinary course of business.

 (2) The burden of proving the matters referred to in paragraphs (1)(e), (f) and (g) in relation to a transaction lies upon the person who relies on the validity of the transaction.

 (3) For the purposes of subsection (1), a transaction shall not be deemed not to have been in good faith and in the ordinary course of business by reason only that, at the time of the transaction, the person, other than the debtor, with whom it took place had notice of the commission of an act of bankruptcy by the debtor.

 (4) Nothing in this Act invalidates a payment by a debtor, on or before the date on which he or she became a bankrupt, of, or in respect of, a penalty or fine imposed on him or her by a court in respect of an offence against a law, whether a law of the Commonwealth or not.

 (6) Subject to sections 121, 128B and 128C, nothing in this Act invalidates, in any case where a debtor becomes a bankrupt, a conveyance, transfer, charge, disposition, assignment, payment or obligation executed, made or incurred by the debtor, before the day on which the debtor became a bankrupt, under or in pursuance of a maintenance agreement or maintenance order.

 (7) In this section:

payment includes the drawing, making or indorsing of a bill of exchange, cheque or promissory note.

transaction includes payment, delivery, conveyance, transfer, assignment, contract or dealing.

124  Protection of certain payments to bankrupt etc.

 (1) Notwithstanding anything contained in this Act, a payment of money or delivery of property (including a security or a negotiable instrument) to, or in accordance with the order or direction of, a person who becomes, or has become, a bankrupt or a person claiming by assignment from him or her is a good discharge to the person paying the money or delivering the property:

 (a) if, in the case of a payment or delivery made before the day on which the firstmentioned person becomes a bankrupt—it is made in good faith and in the ordinary course of business; or

 (b) if, in the case of a payment or delivery made on or after the day on which the firstmentioned person became a bankrupt—it is made in good faith, in the ordinary course of business and without negligence.

 (2) The burden of proving the matters referred to in subsection (1) lies upon the person who relies on the validity of the payment or delivery of property.

 (3) For the purposes of this section, a payment or delivery of property shall not be deemed not to have been made in good faith and in the ordinary course of business by reason only that, at the time of the payment or delivery, the person by whom it was made:

 (a) knew or had reason to suspect that the person to whom, or in accordance with whose order or direction, it was made was unable to pay his or her debts as they became due from his or her own money; or

 (b) had notice of the commission of an act of bankruptcy by that person or of the presentation of a creditor’s petition against that person.

125  Certain accounts of undischarged bankrupt

 (1) Where a prescribed organization has ascertained that a person having an account with it is an undischarged bankrupt, then, unless the prescribed organization is satisfied that the account is on behalf of some other person, it shall forthwith inform the trustee, in writing, of the existence of the account and, subject to subsection (2), shall not make any further payments out of the account, except under an order of the Court of which a copy has been served on it or in accordance with written instructions from the trustee.

 (2) If, within 1 month from the date on which the prescribed organization informed the trustee of the existence of the account, a copy of an order of the Court in respect of the account has not been served on the prescribed organization and it has not received written instructions from the trustee within that period in respect of the account, the prescribed organization is entitled to act without regard to any claim or right the trustee may have in respect of the account.

 (2A) This section does not apply in relation to an account held by a bankrupt if the account is a supervised account in relation to the bankrupt.

 (3) In this section:

bank means an ADI or any other bank.

cooperative society means:

 (a) a society registered or incorporated as a cooperative housing society under a law of a State or Territory; or

 (b) any other society whose principal business consists of borrowing moneys from its members and lending those moneys to its members and that is registered or incorporated under a law of a State or Territory relating to cooperative societies.

prescribed organization means a bank, a cooperative society or any other financial organization of a kind prescribed by the regulations for the purposes of this definition.

supervised account has the meaning given by section 139ZIB.

126  Dealings with undischarged bankrupt in respect of afteracquired property

 (1) A transaction by a bankrupt with a person dealing with him or her in good faith and for valuable consideration in respect of property acquired by the bankrupt on or after the day on which he or she became a bankrupt is, if completed before any intervention by the trustee, valid against the trustee, and any estate or interest in that property which, by virtue of this Act, is vested in the trustee shall determine and pass in such manner and to such extent as is necessary for giving effect to the transaction.

 (2) For the purposes of subsection (1), the receipt of any money, security or negotiable instrument from, or in accordance with the order or direction of, a bankrupt by his or her banker, and any payment of money or delivery of a security or negotiable instrument made to, or in accordance with the order or direction of, a bankrupt by his or her banker, shall be deemed to be a transaction by the bankrupt with that banker dealing with him or her for valuable consideration.

 (3) The lodging by the trustee of a caveat having the effect of forbidding the registration of an instrument affecting any land, or an estate or interest in any land, shall be deemed to be a sufficient intervention for the purposes of this section in relation to a transaction in respect of that land or that estate or interest in land.

 (4) In this section:

banker means an ADI or any other banker.

127  Limitation of time for making claims by trustee etc.

 (1) After the expiration of 20 years from the date on which a person became a bankrupt, a claim shall not be made by the trustee in the bankruptcy to any property of the bankrupt, and that property shall, subject to the rights, if any, of a person other than the trustee in respect of the property, be deemed to be vested in the bankrupt, or a person claiming through or under him or her, as the case may be.

 (2) An action under subsection 118(9) with respect to a charge or charging order shall not be commenced by the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt after the expiration of 6 years from the date on which the bankrupt became a bankrupt.

 (3) An action under section 120 with respect to a transfer shall not be commenced by the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt after the expiration of 6 years from the date on which the bankrupt became a bankrupt.

 (4) An action under section 121 with respect to a transfer of property may be commenced by the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt at any time.

 (5) An action under section 122 with respect to a transfer of property shall not be commenced by the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt after the expiration of 6 years from the date on which the bankrupt became a bankrupt.

128  Notice to trustee where identity of vendor etc. with bankrupt in doubt

 (1) Where a doubt arises as to the identity with a bankrupt of a person appearing in the title to any property, an intending or actual vendor, mortgagor or lessor of the property or applicant to bring land under the provisions of any law of the Commonwealth or of a State or Territory of the Commonwealth relating to title to land, or a resuming or constructing authority under any law of the Commonwealth or of a State or Territory of the Commonwealth may give to the trustee in the bankruptcy a notice containing particulars of the property in question and of the person whose identity with the bankrupt is in question, and a statement of his or her intention to sell, mortgage or lease, or complete a sale, mortgage or lease of, the property or to bring the property under the provisions of any law of the Commonwealth or of a State or Territory of the Commonwealth relating to title to land, or to pay compensation in respect of the resumption of the property, as the case may be.

 (2) The trustee may, within 3 months after the notice was given, file with the Registrar of Titles or RegistrarGeneral or other appropriate officer of the Commonwealth, or of the State or Territory concerned, a memorandum claiming the property in respect of which the notice was given.

 (3) If the trustee does not file a memorandum claiming the property in accordance with subsection (2), he or she is not entitled at a future time to assert his or her title to that property or to make any claim in respect of that property as against the vendor, mortgagor, lessor, applicant or the resuming or constructing authority, as the case may be, or a person claiming under or through the vendor, mortgagor, lessor or applicant.

 (4) The trustee may, at any time before the expiration of the period of 3 months referred to in subsection (2), withdraw a memorandum filed under that subsection.

Subdivision BSuperannuation contributions

128A  Simplified outline

  The following is a simplified outline of this Subdivision:

 This Subdivision enables the recovery of superannuation contributions made to defeat the bankrupt’s creditors.

 There are 2 types of recoverable contributions:

 (a) contributions made by a person who later becomes a bankrupt (see section 128B);

 (b) contributions made by a third party for the benefit of a person who later becomes a bankrupt (see section 128C).

 Superannuation accounts may be frozen for up to 180 days pending the taking of recovery action under section 139ZQ or 139ZU.

128B  Superannuation contributions made to defeat creditors—contributor is a person who later becomes a bankrupt

Transfers that are void

 (1) A transfer of property by a person who later becomes a bankrupt (the transferor) to another person (the transferee) is void against the trustee in the transferor’s bankruptcy if:

 (a) the transfer is made by way of a contribution to an eligible superannuation plan; and

 (b) the property would probably have become part of the transferor’s estate or would probably have been available to creditors if the property had not been transferred; and

 (c) the transferor’s main purpose in making the transfer was:

 (i) to prevent the transferred property from becoming divisible among the transferor’s creditors; or

 (ii) to hinder or delay the process of making property available for division among the transferor’s creditors; and

 (d) the transfer occurs on or after 28 July 2006.

Showing the transferor’s main purpose in making a transfer

 (2) The transferor’s main purpose in making the transfer is taken to be the purpose described in paragraph (1)(c) if it can reasonably be inferred from all the circumstances that, at the time of the transfer, the transferor was, or was about to become, insolvent.

 (3) In determining whether the transferor’s main purpose in making the transfer was the purpose described in paragraph (1)(c), regard must be had to:

 (a) whether, during any period ending before the transfer, the transferor had established a pattern of making contributions to one or more eligible superannuation plans; and

 (b) if so, whether the transfer, when considered in the light of that pattern, is out of character.

Other ways of showing the transferor’s main purpose in making a transfer

 (4) Subsections (2) and (3) do not limit the ways of establishing the transferor’s main purpose in making a transfer.

Rebuttable presumption of insolvency

 (5) For the purposes of this section, a rebuttable presumption arises that the transferor was, or was about to become, insolvent at the time of the transfer if it is established that the transferor:

 (a) had not, in respect of that time, kept such books, accounts and records as are usual and proper in relation to the business carried on by the transferor and as sufficiently disclose the transferor’s business transactions and financial position; or

 (b) having kept such books, accounts and records, has not preserved them.

Refund of contributions tax etc.

 (5A) If:

 (a) as a result of subsection (1), a transfer made by way of a contribution to an eligible superannuation plan is void against the trustee in the transferor’s bankruptcy; and

 (b) any of the following amounts was debited from the contribution:

 (i) an amount in respect of tax in respect of the contribution;

 (ii) a fee, or a charge, in respect of the contribution; and

 (c) in compliance with a section 139ZQ notice that relates to the transfer, the trustee of the eligible superannuation plan pays an amount to the trustee in the transferor’s bankruptcy; and

 (d) the amount paid in compliance with the section 139ZQ notice exceeds the amount so debited;

the trustee in the transferor’s bankruptcy must pay to the trustee of the eligible superannuation plan an amount equal to the amount so debited.

Protection of successors in title

 (6) This section does not affect the rights of a person who acquired property from the transferee in good faith and for at least the market value of the property.

Meaning of transfer of property and market value

 (7) For the purposes of this section:

 (a) transfer of property includes a payment of money; and

 (b) a person who does something that results in another person becoming the owner of property that did not previously exist is taken to have transferred the property to the other person; and

 (c) the market value of property transferred is its market value at the time of the transfer.

128C  Superannuation contributions made to defeat creditors—contributor is a third party

Transfers that are void

 (1) If:

 (a) a person (the transferor) transfers property to another person, (the transferee); and

 (b) the transfer is by way of a contribution to an eligible superannuation plan for the benefit of a person who later becomes a bankrupt (the beneficiary); and

 (c) the transferor did so under a scheme to which the beneficiary was a party; and

 (d) the property would probably have become part of the beneficiary’s estate or would probably have been available to creditors if the property had not been transferred; and

 (e) the beneficiary’s main purpose in entering into the scheme was:

 (i) to prevent the transferred property from becoming divisible among the beneficiary’s creditors; or

 (ii) to hinder or delay the process of making property available for division among the beneficiary’s creditors; and

 (f) the transfer occurred on or after 28 July 2006;

the transfer is void against the trustee in the beneficiary’s bankruptcy.

 (2) For the purposes of paragraph (1)(b), disregard a benefit that is payable in the event of the death of a person.

Showing the beneficiary’s main purpose in entering into the scheme

 (3) The beneficiary’s main purpose in entering into the scheme is taken to be the purpose described in paragraph (1)(e) if it can reasonably be inferred from all the circumstances that, at the time when the beneficiary entered into the scheme, the beneficiary was, or was about to become, insolvent.

 (4) In determining whether the beneficiary’s main purpose in entering into the scheme was the purpose described in paragraph (1)(e), regard must be had to:

 (a) whether, during any period ending before the scheme was entered into, the transferor had established a pattern of making contributions to one or more eligible superannuation plans for the benefit of the beneficiary; and

 (b) if so, whether the transfer, when considered in the light of that pattern, is out of character.

 (5) For the purposes of paragraph (4)(a), disregard a benefit that is payable in the event of the death of a person.

Other ways of showing the beneficiary’s main purpose in entering into a scheme

 (6) Subsections (3) and (4) do not limit the ways of establishing the beneficiary’s main purpose in entering into a scheme.

Rebuttable presumption of insolvency

 (7) For the purposes of this section, a rebuttable presumption arises that the beneficiary was, or was about to become, insolvent at the time the beneficiary entered into the scheme if it is established that the beneficiary:

 (a) had not, in respect of that time, kept such books, accounts and records as are usual and proper in relation to the business carried on by the beneficiary and as sufficiently disclose the beneficiary’s business transactions and financial position; or

 (b) having kept such books, accounts and records, has not preserved them.

Refund of contributions tax etc.

 (7A) If:

 (a) as a result of subsection (1), a transfer made by way of a contribution to an eligible superannuation plan is void against the trustee in the beneficiary’s bankruptcy; and

 (b) any of the following amounts was debited from the contribution:

 (i) an amount in respect of tax in respect of the contribution;

 (ii) a fee, or a charge, in respect of the contribution; and

 (c) in compliance with a section 139ZQ notice that relates to the transfer, the trustee of the eligible superannuation plan pays an amount to the trustee in the beneficiary’s bankruptcy; and

 (d) the amount paid in compliance with the section 139ZQ notice exceeds the amount so debited;

the trustee in the beneficiary’s bankruptcy must pay to the trustee of the eligible superannuation plan an amount equal to the amount so debited.

Protection of successors in title

 (8) This section does not affect the rights of a person who acquired property from the transferee in good faith and for at least the market value of the property.

Meaning of transfer of property and market value

 (9) For the purposes of this section:

 (a) transfer of property includes a payment of money; and

 (b) a person who does something that results in another person becoming the owner of property that did not previously exist is taken to have transferred the property to the other person; and

 (c) the market value of property transferred is its market value at the time of the transfer.

128D  Time for making claims by trustee

 (1) An action under section 128B or 128C with respect to a transaction may be commenced by the trustee of a bankrupt’s estate at any time.

 (2) A section 139ZQ notice in relation to a transaction that, under section 128B or 128C, is void against the trustee of a bankrupt’s estate must not be given before the commencement of Part 2 of Schedule 1 to the Bankruptcy Legislation Amendment (Superannuation Contributions) Act 2007.

 (3) A section 139ZQ notice in relation to a transaction that, under section 128B or 128C, is void against the trustee of a bankrupt’s estate may be given even if the transaction occurred before the commencement of Part 2 of Schedule 1 to the Bankruptcy Legislation Amendment (Superannuation Contributions) Act 2007.

128E  Superannuation accountfreezing notice

Scope

 (1) This section applies in relation to a member of an eligible superannuation plan if the Official Receiver has reasonable grounds to believe that:

 (a) a transaction is void against the trustee of a bankrupt’s estate under section 128B or 128C; and

 (b) either:

 (i) the whole or a part of the member’s superannuation interest is attributable to the transaction; or

 (ii) the trustee of the bankrupt’s estate has made an application for a section 139ZU order that relates to the transaction and the member’s superannuation interest.

Giving of freezing notice

 (2) The Official Receiver may, by written notice (a superannuation accountfreezing notice) given to the trustee of the eligible superannuation plan, direct the trustee of the plan not to:

 (a) cash or debit; or

 (b) permit the cashing, debiting, rollover, transfer or forfeiture of;

the whole or any part of the superannuation interest except:

 (c) for the purposes of complying with a notice under section 139ZQ; or

 (d) for the purposes of complying with an order under section 139ZU; or

 (e) for the purposes of charging costs against, or debiting costs from, the superannuation interest; or

 (f) for the purposes of giving effect to a family law payment split; or

 (g) in accordance with the written consent of the Official Receiver given under section 128H; or

 (h) for the purposes of complying with an order under paragraph 128K(1)(b); or

 (i) for the purposes of complying with an order under subsection 139ZT(2); or

 (j) in such circumstances (if any) as are specified in the regulations.

 (3) The superannuation accountfreezing notice must set out the facts and circumstances because of which the Official Receiver considers that the Official Receiver has reasonable grounds to believe that:

 (a) the transaction is void against the trustee of the bankrupt’s estate under section 128B or 128C; and

 (b) either:

 (i) the whole or a part of the member’s superannuation interest is attributable to the transaction; or

 (ii) the trustee of the bankrupt’s estate has made an application for a section 139ZU order that relates to the transaction and the member’s superannuation interest.

When Official Receiver may give freezing notice

 (4) The Official Receiver may give the superannuation accountfreezing notice:

 (a) if the Official Trustee is the trustee of the bankrupt’s estate—on the initiative of the Official Receiver; or

 (b) if a registered trustee is the trustee of the bankrupt’s estate—on application by the registered trustee.

When freezing notice comes into force

 (5) The superannuation accountfreezing notice comes into force when the notice is given to the trustee of the eligible superannuation plan.

128F  Revocation of superannuation accountfreezing notice

Revocation of freezing notice by Official Receiver

 (1) If a superannuation accountfreezing notice is in force in relation to a member of an eligible superannuation plan, the Official Receiver may, by written notice given to the trustee of the plan, revoke the superannuation accountfreezing notice.

 (2) The Official Receiver may revoke a superannuation accountfreezing notice that relates to a member of an eligible superannuation plan:

 (a) if the Official Trustee is the trustee of the bankrupt’s estate—on the initiative of the Official Receiver; or

 (b) if a registered trustee is the trustee of the bankrupt’s estate—on application by the registered trustee; or

 (c) in any case—on application by the member.

Revocation of freezing notice when section 139ZQ notice complied with etc.

 (3) If:

 (a) subparagraph 128E(1)(b)(i) applied in relation to a superannuation accountfreezing notice given in relation to a member of an eligible superannuation plan; and

 (b) during the 180day period after the superannuation accountfreezing notice comes into force, a section 139ZQ notice is given in relation to the transaction referred to in paragraph 128E(1)(a);

the superannuation accountfreezing notice is revoked:

 (c) when the trustee of the plan complies with the section 139ZQ notice; or

 (d) when the section 139ZQ notice is revoked; or

 (e) when the Court sets aside the section 139ZQ notice.

Revocation of freezing notice if no section 139ZQ notice given after 180 days

 (4) If subparagraph 128E(1)(b)(i) applied in relation to a superannuation accountfreezing notice given in relation to a member of an eligible superannuation plan, the superannuation accountfreezing notice is revoked if:

 (a) 180 days pass after the notice comes into force; and

 (b) no section 139ZQ notice has been given in relation to the transaction referred to in paragraph 128E(1)(a).

Revocation of freezing notice when section 139ZU order complied with etc.

 (5) If:

 (a) subparagraph 128E(1)(b)(ii) applied in relation to a superannuation accountfreezing notice given in relation to a member of an eligible superannuation plan; and

 (b) during the 180day period after the superannuation accountfreezing notice comes into force, a section 139ZU order is made in relation to the transaction referred to in paragraph 128E(1)(a) and in relation to the member’s superannuation interest;

the superannuation accountfreezing notice is revoked:

 (c) when the trustee of the plan complies with the section 139ZU order; or

 (d) when the section 139ZU order is set aside on appeal.

Revocation of freezing notice when application for section 139ZU order dismissed or withdrawn

 (6) If:

 (a) subparagraph 128E(1)(b)(ii) applied in relation to a superannuation accountfreezing notice given in relation to a member of an eligible superannuation plan; and

 (b) during the 180day period after the superannuation accountfreezing notice comes into force:

 (i) the Court dismisses an application for a section 139ZU order in relation to the transaction referred to in paragraph 128E(1)(a) and in relation to the member’s superannuation interest; or

 (ii) an application for a section 139ZU order in relation to the transaction referred to in paragraph 128E(1)(a) and in relation to the member’s superannuation interest is withdrawn;

the superannuation accountfreezing notice is revoked.

Revocation of freezing notice if no section 139ZU order made after 180 days

 (7) If subparagraph 128E(1)(b)(ii) applied in relation to a superannuation accountfreezing notice given in relation to a member of an eligible superannuation plan, the superannuation accountfreezing notice is revoked if:

 (a) 180 days pass after the notice comes into force; and

 (b) no section 139ZU order has been made in relation to the transaction referred to in paragraph 128E(1)(a) and in relation to the member’s superannuation interest.

Extension of 180day period

 (8) The Court may, on application by the Official Receiver, extend, or further extend, the 180day period referred to in subsection (5), (6) or (7).

 (9) The Official Receiver may make an application under subsection (8):

 (a) if the Official Trustee is the trustee of the bankrupt’s estate—on the initiative of the Official Receiver; or

 (b) if a registered trustee is the trustee of the bankrupt’s estate—on application by the registered trustee.

128G  Copy of superannuation accountfreezing notice to be given to trustee etc.

 (1) If the Official Receiver gives or revokes a superannuation accountfreezing notice that relates to a member of an eligible superannuation plan:

 (a) the Official Receiver must give 2 copies of the superannuation accountfreezing notice or the revocation notice, as the case may be, to the trustee of the bankrupt’s estate; and

 (b) the trustee must give one of those copies to the member.

 (2) A failure to comply with subsection (1) does not affect the validity of the superannuation accountfreezing notice or the revocation notice, as the case may be.

128H  Consent of Official Receiver to the cashing etc. of a superannuation interest

Scope

 (1) This section applies if a superannuation accountfreezing notice is in force in relation to a member’s superannuation interest.

Consent

 (2) The member may apply in writing to the Official Receiver for the Official Receiver to consent to the cashing, debiting, rollover, transfer or forfeiture, in whole or in part, of the member’s superannuation interest.

 (3) If an application is made under subsection (2), the Official Receiver may, by written notice given to the trustee of the eligible superannuation plan concerned, consent to the cashing, debiting, rollover, transfer or forfeiture, in whole or in part, of the member’s superannuation interest.

 (4) A consent under subsection (3) may be:

 (a) unconditional; or

 (b) subject to such conditions (if any) as are specified in the notice of consent.

 (5) If the Official Receiver gives a consent under subsection (3) in relation to a member’s superannuation interest, the Official Receiver must give a copy of the consent to the member.

Consultation

 (6) Before giving a consent under subsection (3), the Official Receiver must consult the trustee of the bankrupt’s estate.

Review of decisions

 (7) Applications may be made to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal for review of a decision of the Official Receiver refusing to give a consent under subsection (3).

 (8) The trustee of the bankrupt’s estate may apply to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal for review of a decision of the Official Receiver giving a consent under subsection (3).

128J  Power of Court to set aside superannuation accountfreezing notice

 (1) If the Court, on application by:

 (a) a person to whom a superannuation accountfreezing notice has been given; or

 (b) the member whose superannuation interest is affected by a superannuation accountfreezing notice; or

 (c) any other interested person;

is satisfied that the Official Receiver did not have reasonable grounds to believe that:

 (d) the relevant transaction is void against the trustee of a bankrupt’s estate under section 128B or 128C; and

 (e) either:

 (i) the whole or a part of the relevant member’s superannuation interest is attributable to the transaction; or

 (ii) the trustee of the bankrupt’s estate has made an application for a section 139ZU order that relates to the transaction and the relevant member’s superannuation interest;

the Court may make an order setting aside the notice.

 (2) A superannuation accountfreezing notice that has been set aside is taken not to have been given.

128K  Judicial enforcement of superannuation accountfreezing notices

 (1) If the Court is satisfied that the trustee of an eligible superannuation plan has breached, or is proposing to breach, a superannuation accountfreezing notice, the Court may, on application of the trustee of the relevant bankrupt’s estate, make any or all of the following orders:

 (a) an order directing the trustee of the plan to comply with that notice;

 (b) an order directing the trustee of the plan to pay to the trustee of the relevant bankrupt’s estate an amount not exceeding the money, or the value of the property, received as a result of the transaction referred to in paragraph 128E(1)(a);

 (c) any other order that the Court thinks appropriate.

 (2) The Court may discharge or vary an order granted under this section.

 (3) An order by the Court under paragraph (1)(b) is enforceable as if it were an order for the payment of money made by the Court when exercising jurisdiction otherwise than under this Act.

128L  Protection of trustee of eligible superannuation plan

 (1) No criminal or civil proceedings lie against the trustee of an eligible superannuation plan because of anything done (or not done) by the trustee in good faith:

 (a) in compliance with a superannuation accountfreezing notice; or

 (b) in connection with, or incidental to, the trustee’s compliance with a superannuation accountfreezing notice; or

 (c) in compliance with a section 139ZQ notice; or

 (d) in connection with, or incidental to, the trustee’s compliance with a section 139ZQ notice; or

 (e) in compliance with a section 139ZU order; or

 (f) in connection with, or incidental to, the trustee’s compliance with a section 139ZU order; or

 (g) in compliance with a subsection 139ZT(2) order; or

 (h) in connection with, or incidental to, the trustee’s compliance with a subsection 139ZT(2) order; or

 (i) in compliance with a paragraph 128K(1)(b) order; or

 (j) in connection with, or incidental to, the trustee’s compliance with a paragraph 128K(1)(b) order.

 (2) Anything done (or not done) by the trustee of a regulated superannuation fund, or the trustee of an approved deposit fund, in good faith:

 (a) in compliance with a superannuation accountfreezing notice; or

 (b) in connection with, or incidental to, the trustee’s compliance with a superannuation accountfreezing notice; or

 (c) in compliance with a section 139ZQ notice; or

 (d) in connection with, or incidental to, the trustee’s compliance with a section 139ZQ notice; or

 (e) in compliance with a section 139ZU order; or

 (f) in connection with, or incidental to, the trustee’s compliance with a section 139ZU order; or

 (g) in compliance with a subsection 139ZT(2) order; or

 (h) in connection with, or incidental to, the trustee’s compliance with a subsection 139ZT(2) order; or

 (i) in compliance with a paragraph 128K(1)(b) order; or

 (j) in connection with, or incidental to, the trustee’s compliance with a paragraph 128K(1)(b) order;

is taken not to be in breach of:

 (k) the Superannuation Industry (Supervision) Act 1993; or

 (l) any standards prescribed under that Act.

 (3) Anything done (or not done) by an RSA provider in good faith:

 (a) in compliance with a superannuation accountfreezing notice; or

 (b) in connection with, or incidental to, the RSA provider’s compliance with a superannuation accountfreezing notice; or

 (c) in compliance with a section 139ZQ notice; or

 (d) in connection with, or incidental to, the RSA provider’s compliance with a section 139ZQ notice; or

 (e) in compliance with a section 139ZU order; or

 (f) in connection with, or incidental to, the trustee’s compliance with a section 139ZU order; or

 (g) in compliance with a subsection 139ZT(2) order; or

 (h) in connection with, or incidental to, the trustee’s compliance with a subsection 139ZT(2) order; or

 (i) in compliance with a paragraph 128K(1)(b) order; or

 (j) in connection with, or incidental to, the trustee’s compliance with a paragraph 128K(1)(b) order;

is taken not to be in breach of:

 (k) the Retirement Savings Accounts Act 1997; or

 (l) any standards prescribed under that Act.

128M  References to a member of an eligible superannuation plan

  References in a provision of this Subdivision to:

 (a) a member of an eligible superannuation plan; and

 (b) a bankrupt;

do not imply that the bankrupt may not be the member.

128N  Definitions

  In this Subdivision:

approved deposit fund has the same meaning as in the Superannuation Industry (Supervision) Act 1993.

cashed, in relation to a superannuation interest, includes applied towards the provision of a pension.

contribution, in relation to an RSA, has the same meaning as in the Retirement Savings Accounts Act 1997.

costs:

 (a) in relation to a regulated superannuation fund, an approved deposit fund or an RSA—includes:

 (i) transaction costs; and

 (ii) government charges; and

 (iii) taxes and duties; and

 (iv) charges relating to the management or investment of fund assets or RSA assets, as the case may be; or

 (b) in any other case—includes anything that, under the regulations, is taken to be costs for the purposes of this paragraph.

eligible superannuation plan means any of the following:

 (a) a regulated superannuation fund;

 (b) an approved deposit fund;

 (c) an RSA;

 (d) a public sector superannuation scheme.

family law payment split means a payment split under Part VIIIB of the Family Law Act 1975.

member:

 (a) in relation to a regulated superannuation fund—means a member of the fund; or

 (b) in relation to an approved deposit fund—means a depositor in the fund; or

 (c) in relation to an RSA—means the RSA holder; or

 (d) in relation to a public sector superannuation scheme—has the meaning given by the regulations.

pension includes:

 (a) a benefit provided by a fund, if the benefit is taken, under regulations made for the purposes of the definition of pension in subsection 10(1) of the Superannuation Industry (Supervision) Act 1993, to be a pension for the purposes of that Act; and

 (b) a benefit provided by a public sector superannuation scheme, if the benefit is taken, under the regulations, to be a pension for the purposes of this definition.

public sector superannuation scheme has the same meaning as in the Superannuation Industry (Supervision) Act 1993, but does not include a regulated superannuation fund.

regulated superannuation fund has the same meaning as in the Superannuation Industry (Supervision) Act 1993.

RSA provider has the same meaning as in the Retirement Savings Accounts Act 1997.

scheme means:

 (a) any agreement, arrangement, understanding, promise or undertaking, whether express or implied and whether or not enforceable, or intended to be enforceable, by legal proceedings; and

 (b) any scheme, plan, proposal, action, course of action or course of conduct, whether unilateral or otherwise.

superannuation accountfreezing notice means a notice under section 128E.

superannuation interest means an interest in an eligible superannuation plan, but does not include a reversionary interest.

trustee, in relation to an eligible superannuation plan, means:

 (a) if the plan is a fund that has a trustee (within the ordinary meaning of that word)—the trustee of the plan; or

 (b) if the plan is an RSA—the RSA provider; or

 (c) if:

 (i) none of the preceding paragraphs apply; and

 (ii) a person is identified in accordance with the regulations as the trustee of the plan for the purposes of this definition;

  the person identified in accordance with the regulations; or

 (d) in any other case—the person who manages the plan.

If a person who is not the trustee of an eligible superannuation plan nevertheless has the power to make payments to members of the plan, then references in this Subdivision to the trustee of the plan include references to that person.

withdrawal benefit:

 (a) in relation to a regulated superannuation fund or an approved deposit fund—has the same meaning as in the Superannuation Industry (Supervision) Regulations 1994; or

 (b) in relation to an RSA—has the same meaning as in the Retirement Savings Accounts Regulations 1997; or

 (c) in relation to a public sector superannuation scheme—has the meaning given by the regulations.

Division 4Realization of property

129  Trustee to take possession of property of bankrupt

 (1) The trustee shall forthwith take possession of all the property of the bankrupt capable of manual delivery, including all deeds, books and documents of the bankrupt.

 (2) The Court may, on the application of the trustee, enforce possession accordingly.

 (3) A person is not entitled, as against the trustee, to withhold possession of the books of account or any papers or documents of the bankrupt relating to the accounts or to any of the examinable affairs of the bankrupt or to claim any lien on any such papers or documents.

 (4) If a person has in his or her possession or power any moneys or security that he or she is not by law entitled to retain as against the bankrupt or the trustee, he or she shall pay or deliver the moneys or security to the trustee.

 (4A) Where:

 (a) moneys are payable to a person under a law of the Commonwealth or of a State or Territory of the Commonwealth;

 (b) that person is a bankrupt or the moneys are payable to the person as the legal personal representative of a person who was at the time of his or her death a bankrupt; and

 (c) the moneys constitute property divisible amongst the creditors of the bankrupt or the deceased bankrupt, as the case may be;

those moneys shall, upon demand by the trustee, be paid to the trustee notwithstanding any provision to the contrary in that law.

 (4B) A demand under subsection (4A) shall be in accordance with the approved form.

 (4C) A payment made in pursuance of a demand under subsection (4A) is, to the extent of the amount paid, a valid discharge to the person making the payment as against the bankrupt or the estate of the deceased bankrupt, as the case may be.

 (5) A person who does not pay or deliver to the trustee any moneys or security that he or she is required by subsection (4) or (4A) so to pay or deliver is guilty of contempt of court.

 (6) If the person so failing to pay or deliver any moneys or security is a corporation, both the corporation and each officer of the corporation who is responsible for the noncompliance are guilty of contempt of court.

129AA  Time limit for realising property

 (1) This section applies only to:

 (a) property (other than cash) that was disclosed in the bankrupt’s statement of affairs; and

 (b) afteracquired property (other than cash) that the bankrupt discloses in writing to the trustee within 14 days after the bankrupt becomes aware that the property devolved on, or was acquired by, the bankrupt.

In this subsection, cash includes amounts standing to the credit of a bank account or similar account.

 (2) If any such property is still vested in the trustee immediately before the revesting time, then it becomes vested in the bankrupt at the revesting time by force of this section.

 (3) Initially, the revesting time for property is:

 (a) for property disclosed in the statement of affairs—the beginning of the day that is the sixth anniversary of the day on which the bankrupt is discharged from the bankruptcy; and

 (b) for afteracquired property that is disclosed before the bankrupt is discharged from the bankruptcy—the beginning of the day that is the sixth anniversary of the day on which the bankrupt is discharged; and

 (c) for afteracquired property that is disclosed after the bankrupt is discharged from the bankruptcy—the beginning of the day that is the sixth anniversary of the day on which the bankrupt disclosed the property to the trustee.

 (4) If the trustee, before the current revesting time, gives the bankrupt a written notice (an extension notice) stating that a later revesting time applies to particular property, then that later time becomes the revesting time for that property.

 (5) There is no limit on the number of extension notices that the trustee may give (either generally or in relation to particular property).

 (6) The time specified in an extension notice must be either:

 (a) a specified time that is not more than 3 years after the current revesting time; or

 (b) a time that is reckoned by reference to a specified event (for example, the death of a life tenant), but is not more than 3 years after the happening of that event.

 (7) Any property that becomes vested in the bankrupt under this section thereupon ceases to be subject to section 127.

129A  Eligible judges

 (1) A judge of the Court may, by writing, consent to be declared by the Minister under subsection (2).

 (2) The Minister may, by writing, declare a judge of the Court whose consent is in force under subsection (1) to be an eligible judge for the purposes of this Act.

 (3) An eligible judge has, in relation to the power to issue a warrant under section 130, the same protection and immunity as a Justice of the High Court has in relation to proceedings in the High Court.

130  Warrant for seizure of property connected with the bankrupt

 (1) The trustee of a bankrupt’s estate may apply to an eligible judge for the issue of a warrant under subsection (2) if the trustee has reasonable grounds for suspecting that there is on or in any premises property (in this section called relevant property), being:

 (a) any of the property of the bankrupt;

 (b) property that may be connected with, or related to, the bankrupt’s examinable affairs; or

 (c) books (including books of an associated entity of the bankrupt) relevant to any of the bankrupt’s examinable affairs.

 (2) On an application under subsection (1), the judge may issue a warrant authorising a constable, together with any other person named in the warrant:

 (a) to enter on or into the premises, using such force as is necessary for the purpose and is reasonable in the circumstances;

 (b) to search the premises for relevant property;

 (c) to break open, and search for relevant property, any cupboard, drawer, chest, trunk, box, package or other receptacle, whether a fixture or not, on or in the premises;

 (d) to take possession of, or secure against interference, any relevant property found on or in the premises; and

 (e) to deliver to the trustee, or to a person authorised in writing by the trustee for the purpose, any property of which possession is taken under the warrant.

 (3) An eligible judge shall not issue a warrant under subsection (2) unless:

 (a) an affidavit has been furnished to the judge setting out the grounds on which the issue of the warrant is sought;

 (b) the applicant for the warrant (or some other person) has given to the judge, either orally or by affidavit, such further information (if any) as the judge requires concerning the grounds on which the issue of the warrant is sought; and

 (c) the judge is satisfied that there are reasonable grounds for issuing the warrant.

 (4) Where an eligible judge issues a warrant under subsection (2), he or she shall set out on the affidavit furnished in accordance with subsection (3):

 (a) on which of the grounds specified in the affidavit; and

 (b) on which other grounds (if any);

he or she has relied to justify the issue of the warrant.

 (5) A warrant under this section shall:

 (a) state whether entry is authorised to be made at any time of the day or night or during specified hours of the day or night; and

 (b) specify a day, not later than 7 days after the day of issue of the warrant, on which the warrant ceases to have effect.

 (6) Where, under this section, a person takes possession of property, or secures property against interference, a person is not entitled, as against the trustee, to claim a lien on the property, but such a lien is not otherwise prejudiced.

 (7) Where, under this section, a person takes possession of books, or secures books against interference, that person or any other person to whom the books are delivered under paragraph (2)(e):

 (a) may make copies of, or take extracts from, the books;

 (b) may require a person who was a party to the compilation of the books to explain to the best of the person’s knowledge and belief any matter about the compilation of the books or to which the books relate;

 (c) may retain possession of the books for such period as is necessary to enable the books to be inspected, and copies of, or extracts from, the books to be made or taken, by or on behalf of the trustee; and

 (d) during that period shall permit a person who would be entitled to inspect any one or more of those books if they were not in the possession of the firstmentioned person or the other person to inspect at all reasonable times such of those books as that person would be so entitled to inspect.

 (8) The powers conferred by this section are in addition to, and not in derogation of, any other powers conferred by law.

132  Vesting and transfer of property

 (1) Subject to this section, and to section 158, where a trustee is appointed by the creditors, the property of the bankrupt passes to and vests in the trustee so appointed on the day on which the appointment takes effect.

 (2) Subject to this section, the property of the bankrupt passes from trustee to trustee and vests in the trustee for the time being during his or her continuance in office or, if the Official Trustee becomes the trustee, in the Official Trustee, without any conveyance, assignment or transfer.

 (3) Where a law of the Commonwealth or of a State or Territory of the Commonwealth requires the transmission of property to be registered, and enables the trustee to be registered as the owner of any such property that is part of the property of the bankrupt, that property, notwithstanding that it vests in equity in the trustee by virtue of this section, does not vest in the trustee at law until the requirements of that law have been complied with.

133  Disclaimer of onerous property

 (1AA) Where any part of the property of the bankrupt consists of:

 (a) land of any tenure burdened with onerous covenants; or

 (b) property (including land) that is unsaleable or is not readily saleable;

subsection (1) applies.

 (1AB) Where:

 (a) any part of the property of the bankrupt consists of property, being neither land nor an interest in land; and

 (b) it may reasonably be expected that the costs, charges and expenses that the trustee would incur in realising the property would exceed the proceeds of realising the property;

subsection (1) applies.

 (1) Subject to this section, the trustee may, notwithstanding that he or she has endeavoured to sell or has taken possession of the property or exercised any act of ownership in relation to it and notwithstanding, in the case of property the transfer of which is required by a law of the Commonwealth or of a State or Territory of the Commonwealth to be registered, that he or she has not become the registered owner of that property, by writing signed by him or her, at any time disclaim the property.

 (1A) Subject to this section, the trustee may at any time, by writing signed by him or her, disclaim any contract that forms part of the property of the bankrupt whether or not the trustee has endeavoured to assign the property or exercised any rights in relation to it.

 (2) A disclaimer under subsection (1) or (1A) operates to determine forthwith the rights, interests and liabilities of the bankrupt and his or her property in or in respect of the property disclaimed, and discharges the trustee from all personal liability in respect of the property disclaimed as from the date when the property vested in him or her, but does not, except so far as is necessary for the purpose of releasing the bankrupt and his or her property and the trustee from liability, affect the rights or liabilities of any other person.

 (3) If a trustee disclaims property whose transfer must be registered under a law of the Commonwealth or of a State or Territory of the Commonwealth, the trustee must give notice of the disclaimer as soon as practicable to the officer who has the function of registering the transfer.

 (4) A trustee is not entitled to disclaim a lease without the leave of the Court unless:

 (a) the trustee has given to the lessor and, if the bankrupt has sublet the whole or any part of the leased property or has mortgaged the lease, to each sublessee or mortgagee, 28 days’ written notice of his or her intention to disclaim the lease; and

 (b) no person to whom the trustee has given such a notice has, within 28 days after it was given to the person, by written notice given to the trustee, required the trustee to apply to the Court for leave to disclaim the lease.

 (5) The Court may, in relation to an application for leave to disclaim a lease under this section:

 (a) impose such terms as a condition of granting the leave; and

 (b) make such orders with respect to fixtures, improvements and other matters arising out of the lease;

as the Court considers just and equitable.

 (5A) A trustee is not entitled to disclaim a contract (other than an unprofitable contract) without the leave of the Court.

 (5B) The Court may, in relation to an application for leave to disclaim a contract under this section:

 (a) impose such terms as a condition of granting the leave; and

 (b) make such orders with respect to matters arising out of the contract;

as the Court considers just and equitable.

 (6) Where:

 (a) an application in writing has been made to the trustee by a person interested in property requiring him or her to decide whether he or she will disclaim the property or not; and

 (b) the trustee has, for a period of 28 days after the receipt of the application, or such extended period as is allowed by the Court, declined or neglected to disclaim the property;

the trustee is not entitled to disclaim the property under this section and, in the case of a contract, he or she shall be deemed to have adopted it.

 (7) The Court may, on the application of a person who is, as against the trustee, entitled to the benefit or subject to the burden of a contract made with the bankrupt, make an order rescinding the contract on such terms as to payment by or to either party of damages for the nonperformance of the contract, or otherwise, as the Court considers just and equitable.

 (8) Damages so payable may be proved as a debt in the bankruptcy.

 (9) The Court may, on application by a person either claiming an interest in, or being under a liability not discharged by this Act in respect of, disclaimed property, and after hearing such persons as it thinks fit, make an order, on such terms as the Court considers just and equitable, for the vesting of the property in, or delivery of the property to, a person entitled to it or a person in whom, or to whom, it seems to the Court to be just and equitable that it should be vested or delivered, or a trustee for that person.

 (10) Subject to subsection (11), where an order vesting property in a person is made under subsection (9), the property to which it relates vests forthwith in the person named in the order for that purpose without any conveyance, transfer or assignment.

 (11) Where:

 (a) the property to which such an order relates is property the transfer of which is required by a law of the Commonwealth or of a State or Territory of the Commonwealth to be registered; and

 (b) that law enables the registration of such an order;

the property, notwithstanding that it vests in equity in the person named in the order, does not vest in that person at law until the requirements of that law have been complied with.

 (12) A person aggrieved by the operation of a disclaimer under this section shall be deemed to be a creditor of the bankrupt to the extent of any loss he or she has suffered by reason of the disclaimer and may prove the loss as a debt in the bankruptcy.

 (13) In this section:

mortgage includes charge.

mortgagee includes the person entitled to the benefit of a charge.

134  Powers exercisable at discretion of trustee

 (1) Subject to this Act, the trustee may do all or any of the following things:

 (a) sell all or any part of the property of the bankrupt;

 (aa) accept, without terms or conditions, or subject to terms and conditions, a sum of money payable at a future time as the consideration or part of the consideration for the sale of any property of the bankrupt;

 (ab) lease any property of the bankrupt;

 (ac) divide among the creditors, in its existing form and according to its estimated value, property that, by reason of its peculiar nature or other special circumstances, cannot readily or advantageously be sold;

 (b) carry on a business of the bankrupt so far as may be necessary to dispose of it or wind it up for the benefit of creditors;

 (c) postpone the windingup of the estate;

 (d) prove in respect of any debt due to the bankrupt;

 (da) mortgage or charge any of the property of the bankrupt for the purpose of raising money for the payment of the debts provable in the bankruptcy;

 (e) compromise any debt claimed to be due to the bankrupt or any claim by the bankrupt;

 (f) make a compromise with a creditor or a person claiming to be a creditor in respect of a debt provable, or claimed to be provable, in the bankruptcy;

 (g) make a compromise in respect of any claim arising out of the administration of the estate of the bankrupt, whether the claim is made by or against the trustee;

 (h) deal with property to which the bankrupt is beneficially entitled as tenant in tail in the same manner as the bankrupt could deal with it if he or she were not a bankrupt;

 (i) obtain such advice or assistance as he or she considers desirable relating to the administration of the estate or to the conduct or affairs of the bankrupt;

 (ia) refer any dispute to arbitration;

 (j) bring, institute or defend any action or other legal proceeding relating to the administration of the estate;

 (k) execute powers of attorney, deeds or other instruments for the purpose of carrying the provisions of this Act into effect; and

 (m) employ the bankrupt:

 (i) to superintend the management of the whole, or a part, of the property of the bankrupt;

 (ii) to carry on the bankrupt’s trade or business for the benefit of the bankrupt’s creditors; or

 (iii) to assist in any other way in administering the property of the bankrupt;

  and, in consideration of the bankrupt’s services, make such allowance to the bankrupt out of the estate as the trustee considers reasonable;

 (ma) make such allowance out of the estate as he or she thinks just to the bankrupt, the spouse or de facto partner of the bankrupt or the family of the bankrupt;

Note: See also subsection 5(6).

 (n) superintend the management of the whole, or a part, of the property of the bankrupt;

 (o) administer the property of the bankrupt in any other way.

 (1A) An allowance made to the bankrupt in pursuance of paragraph (1)(m) may be reduced by the Court upon the application of an interested person.

 (3) Subject to this Act, the trustee may use his or her own discretion in the administration of the estate.

 (4) The trustee may at any time apply to the Court for directions in respect of a matter arising in connexion with the administration of the estate.

Note: Section 178 allows an application to be made to the Court by the bankrupt, a creditor or any other person who is affected by an act, omission or decision of the trustee.

136  Right to pay off mortgages

 (1) Where any property of the bankrupt is subject to a mortgage, the trustee may, upon giving 6 months’ notice in writing to the mortgagee of his or her intention to do so or upon paying 6 months’ interest in lieu of notice, require the mortgagee to discharge the mortgage notwithstanding that the due time for payment of the moneys owing under the mortgage has not arrived and, upon tender of the moneys secured by the mortgage and, if appropriate, interest in lieu of notice, the mortgagee is bound to execute such documents as are necessary in consequence of the payment.

 (2) The rights conferred on the trustee by subsection (1) are in addition to any rights to pay off the whole or part of the moneys secured by the mortgage before the due time conferred on the mortgagor by the mortgage instrument or by a law of a State or Territory of the Commonwealth.

137  Right of trustee to inspect goods held as security

 (1) Where goods of a bankrupt are held by a person by way of security, the trustee may, after giving notice in writing of his or her intention to do so, inspect the goods.

 (2) Where notice has been given under subsection (1), the person holding the goods is not entitled to realize his or her security until he or she has given the trustee a reasonable opportunity of inspecting the goods and of exercising his or her right of redemption if he or she thinks fit to do so.

 (3) Nothing in this section affects the rights or title of a bona fide purchaser for value who purchased, or entered into an agreement to purchase, goods held by way of security without notice of the fact that the person from whom the goods were purchased or with whom the agreement to purchase the goods was made had received a notice under this section.

138  Limitation of trustee’s power in respect of copyright, patents etc.

 (1) Where:

 (a) the property of a bankrupt includes rights in respect of industrial property; and

 (b) the bankrupt is liable to pay royalties or a share of profits to a person in respect of those rights;

the trustee is not entitled:

 (c) to exercise those rights except upon condition that he or she pays to that person such sums by way of royalty or share of profits as would have been payable by the bankrupt; or

 (d) without the consent of that person or of the Court, to assign or transfer, or grant any licence or permission in respect of, those rights, except upon terms that will secure to that person payments by way of royalty or share of profits at a rate not less than that at which the bankrupt was liable to pay.

 (2) In this section:

industrial property means:

 (a) the copyright in any work;

 (b) a patent in respect of an invention;

 (c) a registered trade mark; or

 (d) the copyright in a registered design.

registered design means a design registered under a law of the Commonwealth relating to industrial designs.

registered trade mark means a trade mark registered under a law of the Commonwealth relating to trade marks.

139  Protection of trustee from personal liability in certain cases

 (1) Where:

 (a) the trustee has seized or disposed of any goods in the possession or on the premises of a bankrupt without notice of any claim by any person in respect of those goods; and

 (b) the goods were not, at the date of the bankruptcy, the property of the bankrupt;

the trustee is not personally liable for any loss or damage arising from the seizure or disposal, or for the costs of proceedings taken in respect of the seizure or disposal, unless the court in which the claim is made is of the opinion that the trustee has been guilty of negligence in respect of the seizure or disposal.

 (2) The trustee is not personally liable for any rates, land tax or municipal or other statutory charges imposed by or under a law of the Commonwealth or of a State or Territory of the Commonwealth upon or in respect of property forming part of the estate of the bankrupt, being rates, land tax or municipal or other statutory charges that fall due on or after the date of the bankruptcy, except to the extent, if any, of the rents and profits received by the trustee in respect of that property on or after the date of the bankruptcy.

 (3) Where a trustee of the estate of a bankrupt carries on a business previously carried on by the bankrupt, he or she is not personally liable for any payment in respect of long service leave or extended leave for which the bankrupt was liable or for any payment in respect of long service leave or extended leave to which a person employed by him or her in his or her capacity as trustee of the estate of the bankrupt, or the legal personal representative of such a person, becomes entitled after the date of the bankruptcy.

 (4) This section does not affect any liability of the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt other than personal liability.

Division 4AOrders in relation to property of entity controlled by bankrupt or from which bankrupt derived a benefit

139A  Trustee may apply to Court

  The trustee of a bankrupt’s estate may, at any time within 6 years after the date of the bankruptcy, apply to the Court for an order under this Division in relation to an entity (in this Division called the respondent entity).

139B  Application to be served on respondent entity

  An applicant under section 139A:

 (a) shall serve the application on the respondent entity; and

 (b) may serve the application on any other person or entity.

139C  Who may appear at hearing

  At the hearing of an application under section 139A:

 (a) the respondent entity may; and

 (b) any other person or entity may, with the leave of the Court;

appear, adduce evidence and make submissions.

139CA  Definition of examinable period

 (1) For the purposes of this Division, the examinable period is:

 (a) in the case of an application for an order in relation to a related entity of the bankrupt—the period beginning:

 (i) if, at a time or times during the period of 1 year beginning 5 years before the commencement of the bankruptcy, the bankrupt became insolvent—at that time, or at the first of those times, as the case may be; or

 (ii) in any other case—4 years before the commencement of the bankruptcy;

  and ending on the day on which the application is made; or

 (b) in any other case—the period beginning:

 (i) if, at a time or times during the period of 3 years beginning 5 years before the commencement of the bankruptcy, the bankrupt became insolvent—at that time, or at the first of those times, as the case may be; or

 (ii) in any other case—2 years before the commencement of the bankruptcy;

  and ending on the day on which the application is made.

 (2) For the purposes of subparagraphs (1)(a)(i) and (b)(i), a rebuttable presumption arises that a bankrupt became insolvent at a time during the period referred to in the relevant subparagraph if it is established that the bankrupt:

 (a) had not, in respect of that time, kept such books, accounts and records as are usual and proper in relation to the business carried on by the transferor and as sufficiently disclose the transferor’s business transactions and financial position; or

 (b) having kept such books, accounts and records, has not preserved them.

139D  Order relating to property of entity other than a natural person

 (1) Where, on an application under section 139A for an order in relation to a respondent entity other than a natural person, the Court is satisfied that:

 (a) the bankrupt supplied personal services to, or for or on behalf of, the respondent entity at a time or times, during the examinable period and before the end of the bankruptcy, when the bankrupt controlled the entity in relation to the supply of those services;

 (b) either:

 (i) the bankrupt received for those services no remuneration in money or other property; or

 (ii) the remuneration in money or other property that the bankrupt received for those services was substantially less in amount or value than a person supplying those services in similar circumstances might reasonably be expected to have received if the person had dealt with the entity at arm’s length in relation to the supply of those services;

 (c) during the examinable period, the entity acquired an estate in particular property as a direct or indirect result of, or of matters including, the supply by the bankrupt of those services;

 (d) the bankrupt used, or derived (whether directly or indirectly) a benefit from, the property at a time or times during the examinable period when the bankrupt controlled the entity in relation to the property; and

 (e) the entity still has an estate in the property;

subsections (2) and (3) have effect, whether or not the bankrupt has ever had an estate in the property.

 (2) The Court may, by order, vest in the applicant:

 (a) the entity’s estate in the whole, or in a specified part, of the property; or

 (b) a specified estate in the whole, or in a specified part, of the property, being an estate that could, by virtue of the entity’s estate in the property, be so vested by or on behalf of the entity.

 (3) The Court may make an order directing:

 (a) the execution of an instrument;

 (b) the production of documents of title; or

 (c) the doing of any other act or thing;

in order to give effect to an order under this section made on the application.

139DA  Order relating to property of natural person

  If, on an application under section 139A for an order in relation to a respondent entity that is a natural person, the Court is satisfied that:

 (a) during the examinable period, the entity acquired an estate in particular property as a direct or indirect result of financial contributions made by the bankrupt during that period; and

 (b) the bankrupt used, or derived (whether directly or indirectly) a benefit from, the property at a time or times during the examinable period; and

 (c) the entity still has the estate in the property;

the Court may make an order of a kind referred to in subsections 139D(2) and (3), whether or not the bankrupt has ever had an estate in the property.

139E  Order relating to net worth of entity other than a natural person

 (1) Where, on an application under section 139A for an order in relation to a respondent entity other than a natural person, the Court is satisfied that:

 (a) the bankrupt supplied personal services to, or for or on behalf of, the respondent entity at a time or times, during the examinable period and before the end of the bankruptcy, when the bankrupt controlled the entity in relation to the supply of those services;

 (b) either:

 (i) the bankrupt received for those services no remuneration in money or other property; or

 (ii) the remuneration in money or other property that the bankrupt received for those services was substantially less in amount or value than a person supplying those services in similar circumstances might reasonably be expected to have received if the person had dealt with the entity at arm’s length in relation to the supply of those services; and

 (c) the entity’s net worth at a particular time during the examinable period exceeded by a substantial amount what might reasonably be expected to have been the entity’s net worth at the lastmentioned time if those services had not been supplied;

subsection (2) has effect.

 (2) The Court may by order direct:

 (a) if the entity is a partnership—a partner or partners in the partnership; or

 (b) in any other case—the entity;

to pay to the applicant a specified amount not exceeding the amount referred to in paragraph (1)(c).

139EA  Order relating to increase in value of property of natural person

  If, on an application under section 139A for an order in relation to a respondent entity that is a natural person, the Court is satisfied that:

 (a) during the examinable period, the value of the entity’s interest in particular property increased as a direct or indirect result of financial contributions made by the bankrupt during that period; and

 (b) the bankrupt used, or derived (whether directly or indirectly) a benefit from, the property at a time or times during the examinable period;

the Court may, by order, direct the entity to pay to the applicant a specified amount not exceeding the amount by which the value of the entity’s interest in the property increased as a result of the financial contributions made by the bankrupt.

139F  Court to take account of interests of other persons

 (1) In considering whether or not to make under section 139D or 139DA a particular order relating to property in which the respondent entity has an estate, the Court shall take account of:

 (a) the nature and extent of any estate that any other person or entity has in the property and any hardship that the order might cause that other person or entity; and

 (b) the respondent entity’s current net worth and any hardship the order might cause the respondent entity’s creditors.

 (2) In considering whether or not to make a particular order under section 139E or 139EA, the Court shall take account of the respondent entity’s current net worth and any hardship the order might cause the entity’s creditors.

139G  Giving effect to orders under this Division

 (1) Where:

 (a) the Court makes an order under section 139D or 139DA vesting in a person an estate in property; and

 (b) a law of the Commonwealth, of a State, or of a Territory of the Commonwealth, requires the creation, transfer or transmission of estates in that property to be registered;

that estate vests in equity in the person by virtue of the order but does not so vest at law until the requirements of that law have been complied with.

 (2) Where the Court makes under section 139D or 139DA an order directing the execution of an instrument and:

 (a) a person has refused or failed to comply with the direction; or

 (b) for any other reason, the Court thinks it necessary to exercise its powers under this subsection;

the Court may, by order, appoint the Registrar:

 (c) to execute the instrument in the name of a person; and

 (d) to do all acts and things necessary to give effect to the instrument.

 (3) An order by the Court under section 139E or 139EA is enforceable as if it were an order for the payment of money made by the Court when exercising jurisdiction otherwise than under this Act.

139H  Entity entitled to claim in bankruptcy

 (1) Where, on an application under section 139A, the Court makes an order under section 139D or 139DA vesting in the applicant an estate in property, or an order under section 139E or 139EA directing the payment of a specified amount to the applicant, the respondent entity may claim for dividend in the bankruptcy in respect of the value of that property as at the making of the order, or in respect of the specified amount, as the case may be.

 (2) A claim under subsection (1) shall be postponed until all claims of the other creditors (including claims for interest on interestbearing debts in respect of a period after the date of the bankruptcy but not including claims under subsection 120(4)) have been satisfied.

Division 4BContribution by bankrupt and recovery of property

Subdivision APreliminary

139J  Objects of Division

  The objects of this Division are:

 (a) to require a bankrupt who derives income during the bankruptcy to pay contributions towards the bankrupt’s estate; and

 (b) to enable the recovery of certain money and property for the benefit of the bankrupt’s estate.

Subdivision BInterpretation

139K  Definitions

  In this Division, unless the contrary intention appears:

actual income threshold amount, at the time an assessment is made in relation to a contribution assessment period, means:

 (a) if the bankrupt does not have any dependants at that time—the base income threshold amount; or

 (b) if the bankrupt has one dependant at that time—the base income threshold amount increased by 18%; or

 (c) if the bankrupt has 2 dependants at that time—the base income threshold amount increased by 27%; or

 (d) if the bankrupt has 3 dependants at that time—the base income threshold amount increased by 32%; or

 (e) if the bankrupt has 4 dependants at that time—the base income threshold amount increased by 34%; or

 (f) if the bankrupt has more than 4 dependants at that time—the base income threshold amount increased by 36%.

assessment, in relation to a contribution assessment period, means the original assessment or a subsequent assessment in respect of that period.

base income threshold amount, at the time when an assessment is made in relation to a contribution assessment period, means:

 (a) for a contribution assessment period of one year—3.5 times the amount that, at that time, is specified in column 3, item 2, Table B, point 1064B1, Pension Rate Calculator A, in the Social Security Act 1991; or

 (b) for a contribution assessment period less than one year—a proportionally smaller amount based on the number of whole days in the period.

contribution assessment period, in relation to a bankrupt, means a period that:

 (a) begins on the day the bankrupt becomes a bankrupt or an anniversary of that day during the bankruptcy; and

 (b) ends one year after that day or anniversary, as the case requires, or if the bankrupt is discharged or the bankruptcy is annulled within that year, ends upon the discharge or annulment.

dependant, in relation to a bankrupt in relation to a contribution assessment period, means a person who satisfies all the following conditions:

 (a) the person resides with the bankrupt;

 (b) the person is wholly or partly dependent on the bankrupt for economic support;

 (c) the income derived (or likely to be derived) by the person during the contribution assessment period is not more than the amount prescribed by the regulations for the purposes of this paragraph.

For the purposes of this definition, income has its ordinary meaning.

derived means earned, derived or received from any source, whether within or outside Australia.

income, in relation to a bankrupt, has the meaning given by section 139L.

income tax includes Medicare levy.

original assessment, in relation to a contribution assessment period, means the assessment made by the trustee under subsection 139W(1) in respect of that period.

spouse, in relation to a bankrupt, includes a de facto partner of the bankrupt.

subsequent assessment, in relation to a contribution assessment period, means an assessment made by the trustee under subsection 139W(2) in respect of that period.

value, in relation to property referred to in a notice, means the market value of the property when the notice is given.

Subdivision CIncome

139L  Meaning of income

 (1) In this Division:

income, in relation to a bankrupt, has its ordinary meaning, subject to the following qualifications:

 (a) the following are income in relation to a bankrupt (whether or not they come within the ordinary meaning of “income”):

 (i) an annuity or pension paid to the bankrupt from a provident, benefit, superannuation, retirement or approved deposit fund;

 (ia) an annuity or pension paid to the bankrupt from an RSA;

 (ii) a payment to the bankrupt in consequence of a termination of any office or employment;

 (iii) an amount of annuity or pension received by the bankrupt under a policy of life insurance or endowment insurance;

 (iv) an amount received by the bankrupt as a beneficiary under a trust to the extent that the amount was paid out of income of the trust;

 (v) the value of a benefit that:

 (A) is provided in any circumstances by any person (the provider) to the bankrupt; and

 (B) is a benefit within the meaning of the Fringe Benefits Tax Assessment Act 1986 as in force at the beginning of 1 July 1992 (other than a benefit that would be an exempt benefit for the purposes of that Act if the provider were the employer of the bankrupt as an employee and the provider had provided the benefit in respect of the employment of the bankrupt);

  being that value as worked out in accordance with the provisions of that Act but subject to any modifications of any provisions of that Act made by the regulations under this Act;

 (vi) the value of a loan made to the bankrupt by an associated entity of the bankrupt, including:

 (A) a loan under which the loan money is not paid to the bankrupt, but is paid or applied at the bankrupt’s direction; and

 (B) a loan that is not enforceable at law or in equity;

 (vii) the amount of any money, or the value of any other consideration, received by a person other than the bankrupt from another person as a result of work done or services performed by the bankrupt, less any expenses (other than expenses of a capital nature) necessarily incurred by the firstmentioned person in connection with the work or services;

 (b) the following are not income in relation to a bankrupt (even if they come within the ordinary meaning of “income”):

 (i) an amount paid to the bankrupt:

 (A) from the Child Support Account established under the Child Support (Registration and Collection) Act 1988; or

 (B) from another source for the maintenance of children of whom the bankrupt has custody; or

 (iv) a payment to the bankrupt under:

 (A) a legal aid scheme or service established under a law of the Commonwealth or of a State or Territory of the Commonwealth; or

 (B) a legal aid scheme or service approved by the AttorneyGeneral for the purposes of paragraph 2(4)(a) of the Federal Court of Australia Regulations; or

 (C) any other legal aid scheme or service established to provide assistance to people on low incomes;

 (v) a payment or amount that the regulations provide is not income of the bankrupt.

pension includes a pension within the meaning of the Superannuation Industry (Supervision) Act 1993.

 (2) For the purposes of the application of the definition of income in subsection (1) to Subdivision HA, a reference in that definition to a bankrupt includes a reference to a person who has been discharged from bankruptcy.

Note: Subdivision HA deals with the supervised account regime.

139M  Derivation of income

 (1) Income is taken to be derived by a bankrupt for the purposes of this Division even though it is not actually received by the bankrupt because:

 (a) an amount is deducted from it, or it is wholly or partly otherwise applied, under a law of the Commonwealth, of a State or of a Territory; or

 (b) it is reinvested, accumulated or capitalised; or

 (c) it is dealt with on behalf of the bankrupt or as the bankrupt directs.

 (2) A reference in this Division to the income that a bankrupt is likely to derive during a contribution assessment period includes a reference to income that the bankrupt has derived during that period.

 (3) A reference in this Division to income derived by a bankrupt during a contribution assessment period includes a reference to income so derived in respect of work done or services performed by the bankrupt before that period or work to be done or services to be performed by the bankrupt after that period.

139N  Income varied by income tax payments and refunds and child support payments

 (1) The income that is likely to be derived, or was derived, by a bankrupt during a contribution assessment period:

 (a) is taken to be reduced by:

 (i) any amount that the bankrupt pays or is likely to be liable to pay, or paid or was liable to pay, as the case may be, during that period in respect of income tax (but not including any amount that is in respect of a provable debt); and

 (iii) if the bankrupt pays or is likely to be liable to pay, or paid or was liable to pay, as the case may be, during that period an amount for the support of a child pursuant to a maintenance agreement entered into under the Family Law Act 1975 or under a maintenance order—so much of that amount as does not exceed the maximum amount that, but for that agreement or order, the bankrupt could be, or could have been, liable to pay during that period in respect of child support under the Child Support (Assessment) Act 1989; and

 (b) is taken to be increased by any amount that the bankrupt receives or is likely to receive, or received or was entitled to receive, as the case may be, during that period as a refund of income tax.

 (2) A refund is not taken into account under paragraph (1)(b) if it relates to a year of income that ended before the date of the bankruptcy.

 (3) If a refund relates to a year of income that commenced before, but ended after, the date of the bankruptcy, then it is taken into account under paragraph (1)(b) only to the extent that the refund is attributable to the part of the year of income after the date of bankruptcy. For this purpose, the refund is apportioned on a time basis.

Subdivision DLiability of bankrupt to pay contributions

139P  Liability of bankrupt to pay contribution

 (1) Subject to section 139Q, if the income that a bankrupt is likely to derive during a contribution assessment period as assessed by the trustee under an original assessment exceeds the actual income threshold amount applicable in relation to the bankrupt when that assessment is made, the bankrupt is liable to pay to the trustee a contribution in respect of that period.

 (2) Subject to section 139Q, if the income that a bankrupt is likely to derive during a contribution assessment period as assessed by the trustee under an original assessment does not exceed the actual income threshold amount applicable in relation to the bankrupt when that assessment is made, the bankrupt is not liable to, but may if he or she so wishes, pay to the trustee a contribution in respect of that period.

139Q  Change in liability of bankrupt

 (1) If the income that a bankrupt is likely to derive, or derived, during a contribution assessment period as assessed by the trustee under a subsequent assessment exceeds the actual income threshold amount applicable in relation to the bankrupt when the subsequent assessment is made, the bankrupt is liable to pay to the trustee a contribution in respect of that period.

 (2) The liability of the bankrupt under subsection (1) in respect of a contribution assessment period is in substitution for any liability of the bankrupt in respect of that period under subsection 139P(1) or under any previous application of subsection (1) of this section and has effect despite subsection 139P(2).

 (3) If the income that a bankrupt is likely to derive, or derived, during a contribution assessment period as assessed by the trustee under a subsequent assessment does not exceed the actual income threshold amount applicable in relation to the bankrupt when the subsequent assessment is made:

 (a) the bankrupt is not liable to, but may if he or she so wishes, pay to the trustee a contribution in respect of that income; and

 (b) any liability that the bankrupt had under subsection 139P(1) or under subsection (1) of this section to pay a contribution in respect of that period is extinguished.

139R  Liability not affected by subsequent discharge

  Any liability of a bankrupt under section 139P or 139Q is not affected by his or her discharge from bankruptcy after the making of the assessment that gave rise to the liability.

139S  Contribution payable by bankrupt

  The contribution that a bankrupt is liable to pay in respect of a contribution assessment period is the amount worked out in accordance with the formula:

  

where:

Assessed income means the amount assessed by the trustee to be the income that the bankrupt is likely to derive, or derived, during the contribution assessment period.

Actual income threshold amount means the actual income threshold amount assessed by the trustee to be applicable in relation to the bankrupt when the assessment is made.

139T  Determination of higher income threshold in cases of hardship

 (1) If:

 (a) the trustee has made an assessment of a contribution that a bankrupt is liable to pay to the trustee for a contribution assessment period; and

 (b) the bankrupt considers that, if required to pay that contribution, he or she will suffer hardship for a reason or reasons set out in subsection (2);

the bankrupt may apply in writing to the trustee for the making of a determination under this section for that period.

 (2) The reasons are as follows:

 (a) the bankrupt or a dependant of the bankrupt suffers from an illness or disability that requires ongoing medical attention and the supply of medicines, and the bankrupt is required to meet a substantial proportion of the costs of that medical attention or those medicines from his or her income;

 (b) the bankrupt is required to make payments from his or her income to meet the cost of child daycare to enable the bankrupt to continue in employment or other work;

 (c) the bankrupt is living in rented accommodation that is not provided by:

 (i) the Commonwealth, a State or a Territory; or

 (ii) an authority of the Commonwealth, a State or a Territory; or

 (iii) a local government authority;

  and the bankrupt is required to pay the cost of that accommodation wholly or mainly from his or her income;

 (d) the bankrupt incurs substantial expense in travelling to and from the bankrupt’s place of employment or other work, whether by public transport or otherwise;

 (e) the spouse of the bankrupt, or another person residing with the bankrupt, who ordinarily contributes to the costs of maintaining the bankrupt’s household has become unable to contribute to those costs because of unemployment, illness or injury;

 (f) any other reason prescribed by the regulations.

 (3) The trustee must not make a determination under this section unless the bankrupt provides satisfactory evidence of the bankrupt’s income and expenses, and any other matters on which the bankrupt relies to establish the reasons for the application.

 (4) The trustee must decide the application as soon as practicable, and in any event not later than 30 days, after the day on which the application is received.

 (5) If the trustee does not make a decision on the application within that period of 30 days, the trustee is taken to have made a decision at the end of that period refusing the application.

 (6) If the trustee is satisfied that the bankrupt will suffer hardship if required to pay the contribution, the trustee may determine that, for the purposes of the application of section 139S in relation to the bankrupt in respect of the contribution assessment period, the actual income threshold amount that was applicable in relation to the bankrupt when the assessment was made is taken to have been increased to such amount as the trustee determines.

 (7) If the trustee is not satisfied that the bankrupt will suffer hardship if required to pay the contribution, the trustee must refuse the application.

 (8) If the trustee makes a determination under subsection (6), the trustee must make such assessment under section 139W as is necessary to give effect to the determination.

 (9) The trustee must give written notice to the bankrupt:

 (a) setting out the trustee’s decision on the application; and

 (b) referring to the evidence or other material on which the decision was based; and

 (c) giving the reasons for the decision.

 (10) The notice must include a statement to the effect that the bankrupt may request the InspectorGeneral to review the decision.

 (11) A contravention of subsection (10) in relation to a decision does not affect the validity of the decision.

 (12) The trustee’s decision under this section is reviewable under Subdivision G in the same way as an assessment made by the trustee.

Subdivision EProvision of information to trustee

139U  Bankrupt to provide evidence of income

 (1) A bankrupt must, as soon as practicable, and in any event not later than 21 days, after the end of a contribution assessment period, give to the trustee:

 (a) a statement:

 (i) setting out particulars of all the income that was derived by the bankrupt during that contribution assessment period; and

 (ia) setting out particulars of all the income that was derived by each dependant of the bankrupt during that contribution assessment period; and

 (ii) indicating what income (if any) the bankrupt expects to derive during the next contribution assessment period; and

 (iii) indicating what income (if any) the bankrupt expects each dependant of the bankrupt to derive during the next contribution assessment period; and

 (b) such books evidencing the derivation of the income referred to in subparagraph (a)(i) as are in the possession of the bankrupt or the bankrupt can readily obtain.

Penalty: Imprisonment for 6 months.

 (2) The particulars that a bankrupt is required to include in a statement given to the trustee under subparagraphs (1)(a)(i) and (ia) are all the particulars that are known to the bankrupt and any particulars that the bankrupt can readily obtain.

 (3) Without limiting the generality of paragraph (1)(b), the books that a bankrupt is required to give to the trustee under that paragraph in respect of a contribution assessment period include:

 (a) if the bankrupt received from his or her employer one or more pay slips or other documents evidencing salary or wages paid to him or her by that employer during that period—that document or each of those documents; and

 (b) any copy of a group certificate or payment summary (within the meaning of section 16170 in Schedule 1 to the Taxation Administration Act 1953) in the possession of the bankrupt that relates in whole or in part to that period; and

 (c) any statement provided to the bankrupt by an ADI or other financial institution that shows periodic payments made during that period to an account kept by the bankrupt (either alone or jointly with any other person) with that institution; and

 (d) any notice of assessment issued to the bankrupt under the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936 in respect of a year of income in which that period is included; and

 (e) if the bankrupt is in receipt of a pension, allowance or other benefit under a law of the Commonwealth, of a State or of a Territory—any letter or other document sent or given to the bankrupt by the Department or authority that administers the legislation or scheme under which the benefit is provided.

139V  Power of trustee to require bankrupt to provide additional evidence

  If the trustee has reasonable grounds to suspect that:

 (a) any particulars set out in the statement given by the bankrupt under subsection 139U(1) are false or misleading in a material respect; or

 (b) any material particulars have been omitted from that statement;

then, for the purpose of enabling the trustee to decide whether the particulars set out in the statement are correct, the trustee, by written notice given to the bankrupt, may require the bankrupt to give to the trustee within a specified period of not less than 14 days such information or books as are specified in the notice.

Subdivision FAssessments of income and contribution

139W  Assessment of bankrupt’s income and contribution

 (1) As soon as practicable after the start of each contribution assessment period in relation to a bankrupt, the trustee is to make an assessment of the income that is likely to be derived, or was derived, by the bankrupt during that period, of the actual income threshold amount that is applicable in relation to the bankrupt when the assessment is made and of the contribution (if any) that the bankrupt is liable to pay in respect of that period under section 139S.

 (2) If at any time, whether during or after a contribution assessment period, any one or more of the following paragraphs applies or apply:

 (a) the trustee is satisfied that the income that is likely to be derived, or was derived, by the bankrupt during that period is or was greater or less than the amount of that income as assessed by the last preceding assessment in respect of that period;

 (b) the base income threshold amount increased or decreased after the making of the last preceding assessment in respect of that period and before the end of that period;

 (c) the trustee is satisfied that the number of the bankrupt’s dependants increased or decreased after the making of the last preceding assessment and before the end of that period;

the trustee is to make a fresh assessment of the income that is likely to be derived, or was derived, by the bankrupt during that period, of the actual income threshold amount that is applicable in relation to the bankrupt when the assessment is made and of the contribution (if any) that the bankrupt is liable to pay in respect of that period.

 (3) The powers of the trustee under subsection (2) may be exercised on the trustee’s own initiative or at the bankrupt’s request, but the trustee is not required to consider whether to exercise those powers at the bankrupt’s request unless the bankrupt satisfies the trustee that there are reasonable grounds for the trustee to do so.

 (4) As soon as practicable after the making of an assessment the trustee must give to the bankrupt written notice setting out particulars of the assessment and informing the bankrupt about the possibility of a variation under section 139T.

139WA  No time limit on making assessment

 (1) An assessment under section 139W (including a fresh assessment referred to in subsection 139W(2)) for a contribution assessment period may be made at any time, including:

 (a) a time after the end of the contribution assessment period; or

 (b) a time after the bankrupt is discharged.

 (2) For the purpose of applying subsection (1), a reference in this Division to a bankrupt includes a reference to a former bankrupt.

139X  Basis of assessments

 (1) In making an assessment of the income that is likely to be derived, or was derived, by a bankrupt during a contribution assessment period the trustee may have regard to any information provided by the bankrupt or any other information in the trustee’s possession.

 (2) If the trustee considers that any information provided by the bankrupt is or may be incorrect, the trustee may disregard that information and may make an assessment on the basis of what the trustee considers to be the correct information.

139Y  Trustee may regard bankrupt as receiving reasonable remuneration

 (1) If:

 (a) the bankrupt is engaging or has engaged during a contribution assessment period in employment or other work or in activities that resemble employment or other work; and

 (b) the bankrupt does not receive or did not receive any remuneration in respect of the employment, work or activities or receives or received remuneration that is less than the remuneration (in this subsection called the reasonable remuneration) that:

 (i) in the case of employment where an industrial instrument prescribes rates or minimum rates of salary or wages for the employment—might reasonably be expected to be or to have been received by the bankrupt in respect of the employment by virtue of the industrial instrument; or

 (ii) in any other case—might reasonably be expected to be or to have been received by a person who engaged in similar employment, work or activities where there was no relationship or other connection between that person and the person for whom the employment, work or activities were carried out;

then, for the purpose of making an assessment, the trustee may determine that the bankrupt receives or received the reasonable remuneration in respect of the employment, work or activities.

 (2) If:

 (a) the bankrupt enters or entered during a contribution assessment period into any transaction that might reasonably be expected to produce or to have produced income; and

 (b) the bankrupt does not derive or did not derive any income from the transaction or derives or derived income that is less than the income (in this subsection called the reasonable income) that might reasonably be expected to be or to have been derived if the transaction were or had been entered into at arm’s length;

then, for the purpose of making an assessment, the trustee may determine that the bankrupt derives or derived the reasonable income from the transaction.

139Z  If bankrupt claims not to be in receipt of income

 (1) If a bankrupt:

 (a) does not provide information about whether he or she is likely to derive, or derived, income or a particular class of income during a contribution assessment period; or

 (b) claims not to be likely to derive, or not to have derived, any income or a particular class of income during a contribution assessment period;

but the trustee has reasonable grounds for believing that the bankrupt is likely to derive, or derived, income, or income of that class, during that period, then, for the purpose of making an assessment, the trustee may determine that the bankrupt is likely to derive, or derived, income, or income of that class, during that period and may also determine the amount of that income.

 (2) Without limiting the matters that a trustee may take into account for the purpose of making an assessment as mentioned in subsection (1) in respect of a contribution assessment period, the trustee may have regard to any employment or other work or other incomeproducing activities that were engaged in by the bankrupt before that period and may determine whether the bankrupt is likely to engage, or to have engaged, in similar employment, work or other incomeproducing activities during that period.

Subdivision GReview of assessment

139ZA  Internal review of assessment

 (1) The InspectorGeneral may review a decision of a trustee to make an assessment:

 (a) on the InspectorGeneral’s own initiative; or

 (b) if requested to do so by the bankrupt for reasons that appear to the InspectorGeneral to be sufficient to justify such a review.

 (2) The InspectorGeneral must review such a decision if requested to do so by the Ombudsman.

 (3) A request by the bankrupt to the InspectorGeneral for the review of such a decision must:

 (a) be in writing and lodged with the Official Receiver’s office not later than 60 days after the day on which the bankrupt is notified of the trustee’s assessment; and

 (b) be accompanied by:

 (i) a copy of the notice of assessment; and

 (ii) any documents on which the bankrupt relies in support of the request.

 (4) The Official Receiver must endorse on the request the date when it was lodged and must send the request and the accompanying documents to the InspectorGeneral as soon as practicable after they are received.

 (5) Within 60 days after the request is lodged, the InspectorGeneral must:

 (a) decide whether to review the decision; and

 (b) if the InspectorGeneral decides to review the decision—make his or her decision on the review.

139ZC  InspectorGeneral may request further information

 (1) For the purposes of the exercise of powers under this Subdivision, the InspectorGeneral may:

 (a) ask the bankrupt to provide such further information, either orally or in writing, in support of the request as the InspectorGeneral specifies; and

 (b) ask the trustee to provide such information, either orally or in writing, about the decision to make the assessment and the reasons for the decision as the InspectorGeneral specifies.

 (2) If any information is provided orally, the InspectorGeneral must record it in writing.

139ZD  Decision on review

  On a review of a decision, the InspectorGeneral has all the powers of the trustee and may either:

 (a) confirm the decision; or

 (b) set aside the decision and make a fresh assessment under subsection 139W(2).

139ZE  InspectorGeneral to notify bankrupt and trustee of decision

 (1) If the InspectorGeneral:

 (a) reviews a decision; or

 (b) refuses a request by a bankrupt for a review of a decision;

the InspectorGeneral must give written notice to the bankrupt, to the trustee and to the Official Receiver, of the InspectorGeneral’s decision on the review or on the request, as the case may be.

 (2) The notice must:

 (a) set out the decision; and

 (b) refer to the evidence or other material on which the decision was based; and

 (c) give the reasons for the decision.

 (3) In the case of a decision reviewing the trustee’s decision to make an assessment, the notice must also include a statement to the effect that, if the bankrupt or the trustee, is dissatisfied with the InspectorGeneral’s decision, application may, subject to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal Act 1975, be made to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal for review of the decision.

 (4) In the case of a decision refusing a request to review the trustee’s decision to make an assessment, the notice to the bankrupt must also include a statement to the effect that, if the bankrupt is dissatisfied with the InspectorGeneral’s decision, application may, subject to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal Act 1975, be made to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal for a review of the decision.

 (5) A contravention of subsection (3) or (4) in relation to a decision does not affect the validity of the decision.

 (6) If, within 60 days after lodgment of a request by a bankrupt for the review of the trustee’s decision to make an assessment, the InspectorGeneral has not given written notice to the bankrupt of his or her decision in accordance with subsection (1), the InspectorGeneral is taken to have reviewed the trustee’s decision and confirmed it under paragraph 139ZD(a).

 (7) If the InspectorGeneral makes a fresh assessment, the InspectorGeneral must, as soon as practicable, give to the bankrupt written notice setting out particulars of the fresh assessment.

 (8) This Division, apart from this Subdivision, applies to an assessment made by the InspectorGeneral as if it had been made by the trustee under subsection 139W(2).

139ZF  Review of assessment decisions

  An application may be made to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal for the review of:

 (a) a decision of the InspectorGeneral on the review of a decision by a trustee to make an assessment; or

 (b) a decision by the InspectorGeneral refusing a request to review a decision by a trustee to make an assessment.

Subdivision HWhen contribution payable

139ZG  Payment of contribution

 (1) Subject to subsection 139ZI(3), a contribution that a person is liable to pay under subsection 139P(1) or 139Q(1) is payable at such time as the trustee determines or, if the trustee permits the contribution to be paid by instalments, at such times and in such amounts as the trustee determines.

 (2) The liability of a person to pay a contribution under subsection 139P(1) or 139Q(1) is not affected by:

 (a) the making of an application by the person to the trustee under subsection 139T(1); or

 (b) the making by the person of a request to the InspectorGeneral for a review of the decision of the trustee to make the assessment that gave rise to the liability; or

 (c) the making of an application to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal for review of the decision of the InspectorGeneral.

 (3) The total of any contributions or instalments that are not paid by the bankrupt is recoverable by the trustee as a debt due to the estate of the bankrupt.

 (4) The trustee may, in connection with proceedings to recover the debt:

 (a) sign a certificate setting out the nature and the amount of the debt; and

 (b) file the certificate in the court in which the proceedings have been instituted.

 (5) In such proceedings, the certificate is prima facie evidence of the existence of the debt and the amount of the debt.

139ZH  If excess contribution paid

 (1) If:

 (a) a person has paid an amount in respect of the contribution that the person was assessed to be liable to pay in respect of a contribution assessment period; and

 (b) as a result of a subsequent assessment:

 (i) the person is not liable to pay a contribution in respect of that period; or

 (ii) the amount referred to in paragraph (a) exceeds the amount of the contribution that the person is liable to pay in respect of that period;

the person is not entitled to a refund of the amount paid or of the excess, as the case may be.

 (2) If a person has paid in respect of a contribution assessment period an amount that, because of a subsequent assessment made in respect of that period, the person was not liable to pay, the trustee is to apply that amount in or towards any contribution that the person is liable to pay in respect of a later contribution assessment period.

139ZI  Notice of determinations

 (1) If the trustee makes a determination under section 139ZG in respect of a person, the trustee must give to the person written notice setting out particulars of the determination.

 (2) A notice given to a person under subsection (1) may be contained in a notice of assessment.

 (3) The time at which a payment is to be made by a person as a result of a determination made under section 139ZG must not be earlier than 14 days after notice in relation to the determination is given to the person under subsection (1) of this section.

Subdivision HASupervised account regime

139ZIA  Objects

  The objects of this Subdivision are:

 (a) to improve the likelihood that a bankrupt will have sufficient money to pay contributions or instalments of contributions; and

 (b) to ensure that all monetary income received by the bankrupt is deposited to a single account (the supervised account); and

 (c) to enable the trustee to supervise withdrawals from the account.

139ZIB  Definitions

  In this Subdivision:

bankrupt includes a person who has been discharged from bankruptcy.

bankrupt to whom the supervised account regime applies means a bankrupt in respect of whom a determination under subsection 139ZIC(1) is in force.

constructive income receipt arrangement means an arrangement the effect of which is that income derived by a bankrupt is not actually received by the bankrupt because it is:

 (a) reinvested, accumulated or capitalised; or

 (b) dealt with on behalf of the bankrupt or as the bankrupt directs.

contribution means a contribution that a bankrupt is liable to pay under subsection 139P(1) or 139Q(1).

engage in conduct means:

 (a) do an act; or

 (b) omit to perform an act.

nonmonetary income receipt arrangement means an arrangement the effect of which is that income derived by a bankrupt is not actually received by the bankrupt in monetary form because it is derived in a nonmonetary form.

reviewable decision means a decision of the trustee of a bankrupt’s estate:

 (a) to make a subsection 139ZIC(1) determination; or

 (b) to refuse to revoke a subsection 139ZIC(1) determination; or

 (c) to specify a period in a supervised account notice for the purposes of subparagraph 139ZIE(1)(a)(ii); or

 (d) to refuse to specify a period in a supervised account notice for the purposes of subparagraph 139ZIE(1)(a)(ii); or

 (e) to specify requirements in a supervised account notice for the purposes of subparagraph 139ZIE(1)(a)(ix); or

 (f) to refuse to exercise the powers conferred by subsection 139ZIEA(1); or

 (g) to refuse to give a consent under subsection 139ZIG(3), 139ZIH(5), 139ZIHA(5) or 139ZII(3); or

 (h) to vary a consent given under subsection 139ZIG(3), 139ZIH(5), 139ZIHA(5) or 139ZII(3); or

 (i) to refuse to vary a consent given under subsection 139ZIG(3), 139ZIH(5), 139ZIHA(5) or 139ZII(3); or

 (j) to revoke a consent given under subsection 139ZIG(3), 139ZIH(5), 139ZIHA(5) or 139ZII(3).

supervised account, in relation to a bankrupt to whom the supervised account regime applies, means an account maintained by the bankrupt in accordance with a supervised account notice that is in force in relation to the bankrupt.

supervised account notice has the meaning given by subsection 139ZIE(1).

withdraw, in relation to an account, includes:

 (a) transfer out of; and

 (b) draw a cheque on; and

 (c) do any other thing that results in a debit from.

working day, in relation to a bankrupt, means a day that is not a Saturday, Sunday or a public holiday in the place where the bankrupt resides.

139ZIC  Trustee may determine that the supervised account regime applies to the bankrupt

 (1) The trustee of a bankrupt’s estate may, by written notice given to the bankrupt, determine that the supervised account regime applies to the bankrupt.

 (2) The trustee must not make a determination under subsection (1) in relation to the bankrupt unless, at the time the determination is made:

 (a) the bankrupt is liable to pay a contribution; and

 (b) either:

 (i) if the trustee has made a determination under section 139ZG permitting the contribution to be paid by instalments—the bankrupt has not paid the whole of an instalment at or before the time when it became payable; or

 (ii) if the trustee has made a determination under section 139ZG requiring the bankrupt to pay the contribution at a specified time—the bankrupt has not paid the whole of the contribution at or before the time when it became payable.

 (3) A notice under subsection (1) must be in the approved form.

 (4) A notice under subsection (1) must be accompanied by:

 (a) a supervised account notice relating to the bankrupt concerned; and

 (b) a statement setting out:

 (i) the effect of sections 139ZIE to 139ZIT; and

 (ii) such other information (if any) as is specified in the regulations.

139ZID  Revocation of determination

 (1) If a determination is in force under subsection 139ZIC(1) in relation to a bankrupt, the trustee may, by written notice given to the bankrupt, revoke the determination.

 (2) The trustee must not revoke the determination unless the trustee is satisfied, having regard to:

 (a) the past payment record of the bankrupt; and

 (b) any other relevant matters;

that the bankrupt will pay the whole of any current or future contributions or instalments of contributions at or before the time when they become payable.

 (3) The power conferred on the trustee by subsection (1) may be exercised:

 (a) on his or her own initiative; or

 (b) on the application of the bankrupt.

 (4) If, following the bankrupt’s application, the trustee refuses to revoke the determination, the trustee must give the bankrupt written notice of the refusal.

 (5) A notice under subsection (1) must be in the approved form.

139ZIDA  When determination ceases to be in force

Annulment

 (1) If:

 (a) a determination is in force under subsection 139ZIC(1) in relation to a bankrupt; and

 (b) the bankruptcy is annulled;

the determination ceases to be in force on the date of the annulment.

Discharge—no liability to pay contributions

 (2) If:

 (a) a determination is in force under subsection 139ZIC(1) in relation to a bankrupt; and

 (b) the bankrupt is discharged from the bankruptcy; and

 (c) at the time of the discharge, the bankrupt is not liable to pay a contribution;

the determination ceases to be in force at the time of the discharge.

Discharge—continuing liability to pay contributions

 (3) If:

 (a) a determination is in force under subsection 139ZIC(1) in relation to a bankrupt; and

 (b) the bankrupt is discharged from the bankruptcy; and

 (c) at the time of the discharge, the bankrupt is liable to pay a contribution;

the determination ceases to be in force when the bankrupt is no longer liable to pay a contribution.

139ZIE  Bankrupt must open and maintain supervised account

Supervised account notice

 (1) For the purposes of this Subdivision, a supervised account notice is a written notice that is issued by the trustee of a bankrupt’s estate and that:

 (a) requires the bankrupt, within:

 (i) 10 working days after the notice is given to the bankrupt; or

 (ii) such longer period (if any) as is specified in the notice;

  to open an account (a supervised account) that complies with the following requirements:

 (iii) the account is kept with an ADI;

 (iv) the account is kept in Australia;

 (v) the account is denominated in Australian currency;

 (vi) the account is held solely in the name of the bankrupt;

 (vii) deposits may be made to, and withdrawals may be made from, the account;

 (viii) the account is designed not to have a debit balance;

 (ix) such other requirements (if any) as are specified in the notice; and

 (b) requires the bankrupt to inform the ADI, when opening the account, that the account is a supervised account; and

 (c) requires the bankrupt, after the account is opened, to maintain the account for so long as the notice is in force.

 (2) A supervised account notice must be in the approved form.

Compliance with supervised account notice

 (3) A bankrupt to whom the supervised account regime applies must comply with a supervised account notice in force in relation to the bankrupt.

When supervised account notice ceases to be in force

 (4) A supervised account notice relating to a bankrupt ceases to be in force if the bankrupt ceases to be a bankrupt to whom the supervised account regime applies.

Note: A supervised account notice may be revoked under subsection 139ZIEA(1).

Trustee to be notified of account details

 (5) A bankrupt to whom the supervised account regime applies must, within 2 working days after opening a supervised account, give a written notice to the trustee setting out the following information about the supervised account:

 (a) the name of the ADI concerned;

 (b) the name in which the account is held;

 (c) the account number;

 (d) the BSB number concerned.

Offence

 (6) A person is guilty of an offence if:

 (a) the person is subject to a requirement under subsection (3) or (5); and

 (b) the person engages in conduct; and

 (c) the person’s conduct breaches the requirement.

Penalty for contravention of this subsection:  Imprisonment for 6 months.

139ZIEA  New supervised account

 (1) If a bankrupt is a bankrupt to whom the supervised account regime applies, the trustee may:

 (a) by written notice given to the bankrupt, revoke a supervised account notice relating to the bankrupt; and

 (b) issue a fresh supervised account notice relating to the bankrupt, and give the fresh notice to the bankrupt; and

 (c) by written notice given to the bankrupt, require the bankrupt, immediately after the account is opened in accordance with the fresh notice, to transfer:

 (i) the balance (if any) of the account maintained in accordance with the revoked notice;

  to:

 (ii) the account opened in accordance with the fresh notice.

 (2) The revocation under paragraph (1)(a) of the supervised account notice takes effect when the bankrupt opens the account in accordance with the fresh supervised account notice.

 (3) Notices under paragraphs (1)(a) and (c) may be set out in the same document.

 (4) The powers conferred on the trustee by subsection (1) may be exercised:

 (a) on his or her own initiative; or

 (b) on the application of the bankrupt.

 (5) If, following the bankrupt’s application, the trustee refuses to exercise the powers conferred by subsection (1), the trustee must give the bankrupt written notice of the refusal.

Offence

 (6) A person is guilty of an offence if:

 (a) the person is subject to a requirement under paragraph (1)(c); and

 (b) the person engages in conduct; and

 (c) the person’s conduct breaches the requirement.

Penalty for contravention of this subsection:  Imprisonment for 6 months.

139ZIF  Bankrupt’s monetary income to be deposited to supervised account

 (1) A bankrupt to whom the supervised account regime applies must ensure that all monetary income actually received by the bankrupt after the opening of the supervised account is deposited to the account:

 (a) if the income is received in the form of cash or cheque—within 5 working days of its receipt; or

 (b) in any other case—upon its receipt.

Cash refunds

 (2) For the purposes of subsection (1), if:

 (a) the bankrupt receives an amount of income in the form of cash; and

 (b) before the paragraph (a) amount is deposited to the supervised account, the bankrupt uses a part of that amount to make a refund;

the amount that the bankrupt must deposit to the supervised account is the paragraph (a) amount reduced by the part used as mentioned in paragraph (b).

 (3) For the purposes of subsection (1), if:

 (a) the bankrupt receives an amount of income in the form of cash; and

 (b) before the paragraph (a) amount is deposited to the supervised account, the bankrupt uses the whole of that amount to make a refund;

the bankrupt is taken not to have received the paragraph (a) amount.

Offence

 (4) A person is guilty of an offence if:

 (a) the person is subject to a requirement under subsection (1); and

 (b) the person engages in conduct; and

 (c) the person’s conduct breaches the requirement.

Penalty for contravention of this subsection:  Imprisonment for 12 months.

139ZIG  Trustee to supervise withdrawals from supervised account

General prohibition on withdrawals

 (1) A bankrupt to whom the supervised account regime applies must not:

 (a) make a withdrawal from the supervised account; or

 (b) authorise the making of a withdrawal from the supervised account.

Exceptions

 (2) Subsection (1) does not apply if the withdrawal is made:

 (a) in accordance with the consent of the trustee under subsection (3); or

 (b) to pay a contribution or an instalment of a contribution; or

 (c) to transfer an amount as required by a notice under paragraph 139ZIEA(1)(c); or

 (d) to make a refund; or

 (e) to reverse a credit previously made to the account where the credit arose from an error or the dishonour of a cheque; or

 (f) to discharge any of the bankrupt’s tax liabilities (within the meaning of the Taxation Administration Act 1953); or

 (g) to discharge the bankrupt’s liability to pay a tax (however described) imposed by or under a law of the Commonwealth, a State or a Territory; or

 (h) to recover from the bankrupt an amount equal to an amount of tax (however described) that the ADI concerned has paid or is liable to pay in connection with the operation of the account; or

 (i) to discharge a liability of the bankrupt to pay a fee or charge in connection with the operation of the account.

Trustee may consent to withdrawals

 (3) The trustee may, by written notice given to the bankrupt, consent to any of the following withdrawals from the supervised account:

 (a) a specified withdrawal;

 (b) withdrawals included in a specified class of withdrawals;

 (c) withdrawals up to a daily, weekly, fortnightly or monthly limit ascertained in accordance with the notice.

 (4) The trustee may, by written notice given to the bankrupt, vary or revoke a consent.

 (5) The powers conferred on the trustee by subsections (3) and (4) may be exercised:

 (a) on his or her own initiative; or

 (b) on the application of the bankrupt.

 (6) If, following the bankrupt’s application, the trustee refuses to exercise a power conferred by subsection (3) or (4), the trustee must give the bankrupt written notice of the refusal.

Offence

 (7) A person is guilty of an offence if:

 (a) the person is subject to a requirement under subsection (1); and

 (b) the person engages in conduct; and

 (c) the person’s conduct breaches the requirement.

Penalty: Imprisonment for 12 months.

Garnishee powers not affected

 (8) This section does not affect the exercise of powers conferred by:

 (a) section 139ZL of this Act; or

 (b) section 2605 in Schedule 1 to the Taxation Administration Act 1953; or

 (c) a similar provision in:

 (i) any other law of the Commonwealth; or

 (ii) a law of a State or a Territory.

139ZIH  Constructive income receipt arrangements

Bankrupt not to enter into new arrangements

 (1) A bankrupt to whom the supervised account regime applies must not enter into a constructive income receipt arrangement.

 (2) Subsection (1) does not apply if the bankrupt enters into the constructive income receipt arrangement in accordance with the consent of the trustee under subsection (5).

Bankrupt not to participate in existing arrangements

 (3) If a bankrupt was participating in a constructive income receipt arrangement immediately before becoming a bankrupt to whom the supervised account regime applies, the bankrupt must, as soon as practicable after becoming such a bankrupt, cease to participate in the arrangement.

 (4) Subsection (3) does not apply if the bankrupt continues to participate in the constructive income receipt arrangement in accordance with the consent of the trustee under subsection (5).

Consent

 (5) The trustee may, by written notice given to the bankrupt:

 (a) consent to the bankrupt entering into:

 (i) a specified constructive income receipt arrangement; or

 (ii) constructive income receipt arrangements included in a specified class of constructive income receipt arrangements; or

 (b) consent to the bankrupt continuing to participate in:

 (i) a specified constructive income receipt arrangement; or

 (ii) constructive income receipt arrangements included in a specified class of constructive income receipt arrangements.

 (6) The trustee may, by written notice given to the bankrupt, vary or revoke a consent.

 (7) The powers conferred on the trustee by subsections (5) and (6) may be exercised:

 (a) on his or her own initiative; or

 (b) on the application of the bankrupt.

 (8) If, following the bankrupt’s application, the trustee refuses to exercise a power conferred by subsection (5) or (6), the trustee must give the bankrupt written notice of the refusal.

Offence

 (9) A person is guilty of an offence if:

 (a) the person is subject to a requirement under subsection (1) or (3); and

 (b) the person engages in conduct; and

 (c) the person’s conduct breaches the requirement.

Penalty for contravention of this subsection:  Imprisonment for 12 months.

139ZIHA  Nonmonetary income receipt arrangements

Bankrupt not to enter into new arrangements

 (1) A bankrupt to whom the supervised account regime applies must not enter into a nonmonetary income receipt arrangement.

 (2) Subsection (1) does not apply if the bankrupt enters into the nonmonetary income receipt arrangement in accordance with the consent of the trustee under subsection (5).

Bankrupt not to participate in existing arrangements

 (3) If a bankrupt was participating in a nonmonetary income receipt arrangement immediately before becoming a bankrupt to whom the supervised account regime applies, the bankrupt must, as soon as practicable after becoming such a bankrupt, cease to participate in the arrangement.

 (4) Subsection (3) does not apply if the bankrupt continues to participate in the nonmonetary income receipt arrangement in accordance with the consent of the trustee under subsection (5).

Consent

 (5) The trustee may, by written notice given to the bankrupt:

 (a) consent to the bankrupt entering into:

 (i) a specified nonmonetary income receipt arrangement; or

 (ii) nonmonetary income receipt arrangements included in a specified class of nonmonetary income receipt arrangements; or

 (b) consent to the bankrupt continuing to participate in:

 (i) a specified nonmonetary income receipt arrangement; or

 (ii) nonmonetary income receipt arrangements included in a specified class of nonmonetary income receipt arrangements.

 (6) The trustee may, by written notice given to the bankrupt, vary or revoke a consent.

 (7) The powers conferred on the trustee by subsections (5) and (6) may be exercised:

 (a) on his or her own initiative; or

 (b) on the application of the bankrupt.

 (8) If, following the bankrupt’s application, the trustee refuses to exercise a power conferred by subsection (5) or (6), the trustee must give the bankrupt written notice of the refusal.

Offence

 (9) A person is guilty of an offence if:

 (a) the person is subject to a requirement under subsection (1) or (3); and

 (b) the person engages in conduct; and

 (c) the person’s conduct breaches the requirement.

Penalty for contravention of this subsection:  Imprisonment for 12 months.

139ZII  Cash income

 (1) A bankrupt to whom the supervised account regime applies must not receive income in the form of cash.

 (2) Subsection (1) does not apply if the income was received in accordance with the consent of the trustee under subsection (3).

Consent

 (3) The trustee may, by written notice given to the bankrupt, consent to the bankrupt receiving in the form of cash:

 (a) a specified item of income; or

 (b) items of income included in a specified class of items of income.

 (4) The trustee may, by written notice given to the bankrupt, vary or revoke a consent.

 (5) The powers conferred on the trustee by subsections (3) and (4) may be exercised:

 (a) on his or her own initiative; or

 (b) on the application of the bankrupt.

 (6) If, following the bankrupt’s application, the trustee refuses to exercise a power conferred by subsection (3) or (4), the trustee must give the bankrupt written notice of the refusal.

Offence

 (7) A person is guilty of an offence if:

 (a) the person is subject to a requirement under subsection (1); and

 (b) the person engages in conduct; and

 (c) the person’s conduct breaches the requirement.

Penalty for contravention of this subsection:  Imprisonment for 12 months.

139ZIIA  Keeping of books

  If:

 (a) a person is a bankrupt to whom the supervised account regime applies; and

 (b) the person has been discharged from the bankruptcy;

section 277A applies in relation to the person as if:

 (c) the person were a bankrupt within the meaning of that section; and

 (d) the person had been discharged from the bankruptcy when the person ceases to be a bankrupt to whom the supervised account regime applies.

139ZIJ  Injunctions

Restraining injunctions

 (1) If a bankrupt has engaged, is engaging or is proposing to engage, in any conduct in contravention of this Subdivision, the Court may, on the application of the trustee, grant an injunction:

 (a) restraining the bankrupt from engaging in the conduct; and

 (b) if, in the Court’s opinion, it is desirable to do so—requiring the bankrupt to do something.

Performance injunctions

 (2) If:

 (a) a bankrupt has refused or failed, or is refusing or failing, or is proposing to refuse or fail, to do an act or thing; and

 (b) the refusal or failure was, is or would be a contravention of this Subdivision;

the Court may, on the application of the trustee, grant an injunction requiring the bankrupt to do that act or thing.

139ZIK  Interim injunctions

Grant of interim injunction

 (1) If an application is made to the Court for an injunction under section 139ZIJ, the Court may, before considering the application, grant an interim injunction restraining a bankrupt from engaging in conduct of a kind referred to in that section.

No undertakings as to damages

 (2) The Court is not to require an applicant for an injunction under section 139ZIJ, as a condition of granting an interim injunction, to give any undertakings as to damages.

139ZIL  Discharge etc. of injunctions

  The Court may discharge or vary an injunction granted under this Subdivision.

139ZIM  Certain limits on granting injunctions not to apply

Restraining injunctions

 (1) The power of the Court under this Subdivision to grant an injunction restraining a bankrupt from engaging in conduct of a particular kind may be exercised:

 (a) if the Court is satisfied that the bankrupt has engaged in conduct of that kind—whether or not it appears to the Court that the bankrupt intends to engage again, or to continue to engage, in conduct of that kind; or

 (b) if it appears to the Court that, if an injunction is not granted, it is likely that the bankrupt will engage in conduct of that kind—whether or not the bankrupt has previously engaged in conduct of that kind and whether or not there is an imminent danger of substantial damage to any person if the bankrupt engages in conduct of that kind.

Performance injunctions

 (2) The power of the Court to grant an injunction requiring a bankrupt to do an act or thing may be exercised:

 (a) if the Court is satisfied that the bankrupt has refused or failed to do that act or thing—whether or not it appears to the Court that the bankrupt intends to refuse or fail again, or to continue to refuse or fail, to do that act or thing; or

 (b) if it appears to the Court that, if an injunction is not granted, it is likely that the bankrupt will refuse or fail to do that act or thing—whether or not the bankrupt has previously refused or failed to do that act or thing and whether or not there is an imminent danger of substantial damage to any person if the bankrupt refuses or fails to do that act or thing.

139ZIN  Other powers of the Court unaffected

  The powers conferred on the Court under this Subdivision are in addition to, and not instead of, any other powers of the Court, whether conferred by this Act or otherwise.

139ZIO  InspectorGeneral may review trustee’s decision

Reviewable decisions

 (1) The InspectorGeneral may review a reviewable decision:

 (a) on the InspectorGeneral’s own initiative; or

 (b) if requested to do so by the bankrupt for reasons that appear to the InspectorGeneral to be sufficient to justify doing so.

 (2) The InspectorGeneral must review a reviewable decision if requested to do so by the Ombudsman.

Request by bankrupt

 (3) A request by the bankrupt to the InspectorGeneral for the review of a reviewable decision must:

 (a) be in writing and lodged with the Official Receiver’s office not later than 60 days after the day on which the decision first came to the notice of the bankrupt; and

 (b) be accompanied by:

 (i) a copy of any relevant documents issued or given by the trustee under this Subdivision; and

 (ii) any other documents on which the bankrupt relies in support of the request.

 (4) The Official Receiver must:

 (a) endorse on the request the date when it was lodged; and

 (b) send the request and the accompanying documents to the InspectorGeneral as soon as practicable after they are received.

Time limit for review

 (5) Within 60 days after the request is lodged, the InspectorGeneral must:

 (a) decide whether to review the decision; and

 (b) if the InspectorGeneral decides to review the decision—make his or her decision on the review.

139ZIP  InspectorGeneral may request further information

 (1) For the purposes of the exercise of powers in relation to a review, or a request for a review, of a reviewable decision, the InspectorGeneral may:

 (a) ask the bankrupt to provide such further relevant information, either orally or in writing, as the InspectorGeneral specifies; and

 (b) ask the trustee to provide such information, either orally or in writing, about the decision and the reasons for the decision as the InspectorGeneral specifies.

 (2) If any information is provided orally, the InspectorGeneral must record it in writing.

139ZIR  InspectorGeneral’s decision on review

 (1) On a review of a reviewable decision, the InspectorGeneral has all the powers of the trustee and may:

 (a) confirm the decision; or

 (b) vary the decision; or

 (c) set aside the decision; or

 (d) set aside the decision and make a decision in substitution for the decision so set aside.

Application of this Subdivision to InspectorGeneral’s decision

 (2) This Subdivision (apart from sections 139ZIO to 139ZIT), applies to a decision made by the InspectorGeneral as if it had been made by the trustee under this Subdivision.

139ZIS  InspectorGeneral to notify bankrupt and trustee of decision

 (1) If the InspectorGeneral:

 (a) reviews a reviewable decision; or

 (b) refuses a request by a bankrupt for a review of a reviewable decision;

the InspectorGeneral must give written notice to:

 (c) the bankrupt; and

 (d) the trustee; and

 (e) the Official Receiver;

of the InspectorGeneral’s decision on the review or on the request, as the case may be.

 (2) The notice must:

 (a) set out the decision; and

 (b) give the reasons for the decision.

Notification of right of review by AAT

 (3) In the case of a decision on the review of a reviewable decision, the notice must also include a statement to the effect that, if the bankrupt or the trustee is dissatisfied with the InspectorGeneral’s decision, application may, subject to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal Act 1975, be made to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal for review of the decision.

 (4) In the case of a decision refusing a request to review a reviewable decision, the notice to the bankrupt must also include a statement to the effect that, if the bankrupt is dissatisfied with the InspectorGeneral’s decision, application may, subject to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal Act 1975, be made to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal for a review of the decision.

 (5) A breach of subsection (3) or (4) in relation to a decision does not affect the validity of the decision.

InspectorGeneral taken to have reviewed and confirmed decision

 (6) If, within 60 days after lodgment of a request by a bankrupt for the review of a reviewable decision, the InspectorGeneral has not given written notice to the bankrupt of his or her decision in accordance with subsection (1), the InspectorGeneral is taken to have reviewed the trustee’s decision and confirmed it under paragraph 139ZIR(1)(a).

139ZIT  AAT review of decisions

  An application may be made to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal for the review of:

 (a) a decision of the InspectorGeneral on the review of a reviewable decision; or

 (b) a decision by the InspectorGeneral refusing a request to review a reviewable decision.

Subdivision ICollection of money or property by Official Receiver from person other than the bankrupt

139ZJ  Definition

  In this Subdivision:

bankrupt includes a person who has been discharged from bankruptcy.

139ZK  Persons to whom Subdivision applies

 (1) This Subdivision applies to a person:

 (a) from whom any money is due or accruing, or may become due, to a bankrupt; or

 (b) who holds, or may subsequently hold, money for or on account of a bankrupt; or

 (c) who holds, or may subsequently hold, money on account of some other person for payment to or on behalf of a bankrupt; or

 (d) who has authority from some other person to pay money to or on behalf of a bankrupt; or

 (e) who is liable to pay money or transfer property wholly or principally in consideration of personal services supplied by a bankrupt after the commencement of the bankruptcy, whether the services were supplied to the firstmentioned person or to some other person; or

 (f) who has received money or property wholly or principally in consideration of personal services supplied by a bankrupt after the commencement of the bankruptcy, whether the services were supplied to the firstmentioned person or to some other person.

 (2) In subsection (1):

personal services, in relation to a bankrupt, means personal services as defined by subsection 5(1), whether or not supplied for the payment of money, or the provision of other consideration, to the bankrupt.

 (3) If, apart from this subsection, money would not be due, or would not be repayable on demand, to a person, or the obligation to transfer property to a person would not arise, unless a condition were fulfilled, then, for the purposes of this section, the money is taken to be due or to be repayable on demand, or the obligation to transfer the property to the person is taken to arise, as the case may be, even though the condition has not been fulfilled.

139ZL  Official Receiver may require persons to make payments

 (1) If a bankrupt is liable to pay to the trustee a contribution under section 139P or 139Q, the Official Receiver:

 (a) if the Official Trustee is the trustee—on the initiative of the Official Receiver; or

 (b) if a registered trustee is the trustee—on application by the trustee;

may require a person to whom this Subdivision applies, by written notice given to the person, to make a payment or payments to the trustee in accordance with this section in or towards the discharge of the liability of the bankrupt to make the contribution.

 (2) The notice must set out the facts and circumstances, and in particular must specify the money or property, because of which the Official Receiver considers that this Subdivision applies to the person to whom the notice is given.

 (3) The notice may either:

 (a) require payment of so much of the money, or of the value of the property, as does not exceed the amount, or the total of the amounts, of the contribution that the bankrupt is liable to pay; or

 (b) in the case of a person who is liable to pay money to or on behalf of the bankrupt, require the person, out of each payment that the person becomes liable from time to time to make, to pay such amount as is set out in the notice until the liability of the bankrupt to pay the contribution has been discharged.

 (4) The notice may either:

 (a) require a payment to be made immediately the money becomes due or is held, the authority becomes exercisable, the liability arises or the money or property is received, as the case requires; or

 (b) require a payment to be made at a time or within a period set out in the notice, not being a time that occurs, or a period that commences, before the money becomes due or is held, the authority becomes exercisable, the liability arises or the money or property is received, as the case requires.

 (5) After the Official Receiver has given a notice to a person under subsection (1), the Official Receiver may at any time, by a further notice given to the person, revoke or amend the firstmentioned notice.

 (6) If the Official Receiver gives a notice under this section, the Official Receiver must send a copy of the notice to the bankrupt and, if a registered trustee is the trustee, to the trustee.

 (7) A notice to be given under this section to the Commonwealth, a State or a Territory, or to an authority of the Commonwealth, of a State or of a Territory, is taken to be duly given if it is given to a person who, by any law, regulation, appointment or authority, has the function of paying, or in fact pays, money on behalf of a Department of the Commonwealth, of that State or of that Territory, or on behalf of that authority, as the case may be.

 (8) If a person is required by a notice under this section to pay to the trustee the value of any property, the requirement is taken to be complied with if the property is transferred to the trustee.

 (9) A person making a payment or transferring property in accordance with this section is taken to have been acting under the authority of the bankrupt and of all other persons concerned and is entitled to be indemnified out of the estate of the bankrupt in respect of the payment or transfer.

 (10) An amount payable by a person to the trustee under this section is recoverable by the trustee as a debt by action against the person in a court of competent jurisdiction.

139ZM  Power of Court to set aside notice

 (1) If the Court, on application by a person to whom a notice has been given under section 139ZL or by any other interested person, is satisfied that this Subdivision does not apply to the person on the basis of the alleged facts and circumstances set out in the notice, the Court may make an order setting aside the notice.

 (2) A notice that has been set aside is taken not to have been given.

139ZN  Charge over property

 (1) If a notice under section 139ZL is given to a person to whom this Subdivision applies because the person is liable to transfer, or has received, any property as mentioned in paragraph 139ZK(1)(e) or (f):

 (a) the property is charged with the liability of the person to make payments as required by the notice; and

 (b) if the person makes the payments or transfers the property to the trustee, the property ceases to be subject to the charge.

 (2) Subject to subsection (3), a charge under subsection (1) has priority over any existing or subsequent mortgage, lien, charge or other encumbrance over the property in favour of an associated entity of the bankrupt, and has that priority despite any other law of the Commonwealth or any law of a State or Territory.

 (3) A charge under subsection (1) does not have priority over a mortgage, lien, charge or other encumbrance in favour of an associated entity of the bankrupt if that entity satisfies the Court that that mortgage, lien, charge or other encumbrance arose from a transaction that was entered into at arm’s length and for valuable and adequate consideration provided by that entity.

 (4) If any property being land is subject to a charge under subsection (1), the Official Receiver may certify by signed writing that the land is subject to a charge under that subsection and may lodge the certificate with the RegistrarGeneral, Registrar of Titles or other proper officer of the State or Territory in which the land is situated.

 (5) The officer with whom the certificate is lodged may register the charge as nearly as practicable in the way in which mortgages over land are registered under the law in force in the State or Territory in which the land is situated.

 (6) The trustee has power to sell any property over which a charge exists under subsection (1) and, if the property is so sold, then, subject to any charges that have priority over the firstmentioned charge, the proceeds of the sale are, to the extent of the charge, to be applied in or towards the discharge of the liability to make a payment or payments to the trustee of the person to whom the notice was given.

139ZO  Failure to comply with notice

 (1) A person who refuses or fails to comply with a notice under section 139ZL is guilty of an offence punishable upon conviction by imprisonment for a period not exceeding 6 months.

 (2) If a person is convicted of an offence against subsection (1) in relation to the refusal or failure of the convicted person or another person to comply with a notice under section 139ZL, the court that convicted the person may, in addition to imposing a penalty on the convicted person, order that person to pay to the trustee an amount not exceeding the amount, or the total of the amounts, that the convicted person or the other person, as the case may be, refused or failed to pay to the trustee in accordance with the notice.

139ZP  Employer not to dismiss or injure bankrupt because of giving of notice

 (1) If a notice under section 139ZL is given to the employer of the bankrupt, the employer must not dismiss the bankrupt, injure the bankrupt in his or her employment, or alter the position of the bankrupt to the bankrupt’s prejudice, because of the giving of the notice.

Penalty: Imprisonment for 6 months.

 (2) In a prosecution for an offence against subsection (1), it is not necessary for the prosecutor to prove that the defendant’s reason for the action charged was the giving of the notice but it is a defence to the prosecution if the defendant proves that the action was not taken because of the giving of the notice.

 (3) If an employer is convicted of an offence against subsection (1) constituted by dismissing a bankrupt, the court that convicted the employer may order the employer:

 (a) to reinstate the bankrupt to the position that the bankrupt occupied immediately before the dismissal or a position no less favourable than the firstmentioned position; and

 (b) to pay to the bankrupt the whole or part of the wages lost by the bankrupt because of the dismissal.

Subdivision JCollection of money or property by Official Receiver from party to transaction that is void against the trustee

139ZQ  Official Receiver may require payment

 (1) If a person has received any money or property as a result of a transaction that is void against the trustee of a bankrupt under Division 3, the Official Receiver:

 (a) if the Official Trustee is the trustee—on the initiative of the Official Receiver; or

 (b) if a registered trustee is the trustee—on application by the trustee;

may require the person, by written notice given to the person, to pay to the trustee an amount equal to whichever of the following is applicable:

 (c) if:

 (i) the transaction is void against the trustee under section 128B or 128C; and

 (ii) the transaction is by way of a contribution to an eligible superannuation plan for the benefit of a person (the beneficiary) who may or may not be the bankrupt; and

 (iii) the beneficiary is a member of the eligible superannuation plan;

  whichever is the lesser of the following:

 (iv) the money or the value of the property received;

 (v) the beneficiary’s withdrawal benefit in relation to the eligible superannuation plan;

 (d) in any other case—the money or the value of the property received.

 (2) The notice must set out the facts and circumstances because of which the Official Receiver considers that the transaction is void against the trustee.

 (3) The notice may:

 (a) require the amount to be paid at a time or within a period set out in the notice; or

 (b) require the amount to be paid at such times, and in such instalments, as are set out in the notice.

 (4) After the Official Receiver has given a notice to a person under subsection (1), the Official Receiver may at any time, by a further notice given to the person, revoke or amend the firstmentioned notice.

 (5) If the Official Receiver gives a notice under this section, the Official Receiver must send a copy of the notice to the bankrupt and, if a registered trustee is the trustee, to the trustee.

 (6) A notice to be given under this section to the Commonwealth, a State or a Territory, or to an authority of the Commonwealth, of a State or of a Territory, is taken to be duly given if it is given to a person who, by any law, regulation, appointment or authority, has the function of paying, or in fact pays, money on behalf of a Department of the Commonwealth, of that State or of that Territory, or on behalf of the authority, as the case may be.

 (7) If a person is required by a notice under this section to pay to the trustee the value of any property, the requirement is taken to be complied with if the property is transferred to the trustee.

 (8) An amount payable by a person to the trustee under this section is recoverable by the trustee as a debt by action against the person in a court of competent jurisdiction.

 (9) For the purposes of subparagraph (1)(c)(ii), disregard a benefit that is payable in the event of the death of a person.

 (10) In this section:

contribution has the same meaning as in Subdivision B of Division 3.

eligible superannuation plan has the same meaning as in Subdivision B of Division 3.

member of an eligible superannuation plan has the same meaning as in Subdivision B of Division 3.

withdrawal benefit has the same meaning as in Subdivision B of Division 3.

139ZR  Charge over property

 (1) If a notice under section 139ZQ is given to a person in respect of any property:

 (a) the property is charged with the liability of the person to make payments to the trustee as required by the notice; and

 (b) if the person makes the payments or transfers the property to the trustee, the property ceases to be subject to the charge.

 (2) Subject to subsection (3), a charge under subsection (1) has priority over any existing or subsequent mortgage, lien, charge or other encumbrance over the property in favour of an associated entity of the bankrupt, and has that priority despite any other law of the Commonwealth or any law of a State or Territory.

 (3) A charge under subsection (1) does not have priority over a mortgage, lien, charge or other encumbrance in favour of an associated entity of the bankrupt if that entity satisfies the Court that that mortgage, lien, charge or other encumbrance arose from a transaction that was entered into at arm’s length and for valuable and adequate consideration provided by that entity and is not void against the trustee under Division 3.

 (4) If any property being land is subject to a charge under subsection (1), the Official Receiver may certify by signed writing that the land is subject to a charge under that subsection and may lodge the certificate with the RegistrarGeneral, Registrar of Titles or other proper officer of the State or Territory in which the land is situated.

 (5) The officer with whom the certificate is lodged may register the charge as nearly as practicable in the way in which mortgages over land are registered under the law in force in the State or Territory in which the land is situated.

 (6) The trustee has power to sell any property over which a charge exists under subsection (1) and, if the property is so sold, then, subject to any charges that have priority over the firstmentioned charge, the proceeds of the sale are, to the extent of the charge, to be applied in or towards the discharge of the liability to make a payment or payments to the trustee of the person to whom the notice was given.

139ZS  Power of Court to set aside notice

 (1) If the Court, on application by a person to whom a notice has been given under section 139ZQ or by any other interested person, is satisfied that this Subdivision does not apply to the person on the basis of the alleged facts and circumstances set out in the notice, the Court may make an order setting aside the notice.

 (2) A notice that has been set aside is taken not to have been given.

139ZT  Failure to comply with notice

 (1) A person who refuses or fails to comply with a notice under section 139ZQ is guilty of an offence punishable upon conviction by imprisonment for a period not exceeding 6 months.

 (2) If a person is convicted of an offence against subsection (1) in relation to the refusal or failure of the convicted person or another person to comply with a notice under section 139ZQ, the court that convicted the person may, in addition to imposing a penalty on the convicted person, order that person to pay to the trustee an amount not exceeding the amount, or the total of the amounts, that the convicted person or the other person, as the case may be, refused or failed to pay to the trustee in accordance with the notice.

Subdivision KRolledover superannuation interests etc.

139ZU  Order relating to rolledover superannuation interests etc.

 (1) If, on application by the trustee of a bankrupt’s estate, the Court is satisfied that:

 (a) a transaction is void against the trustee of the bankrupt’s estate under section 128B or 128C; and

 (b) the transaction was by way of a contribution to an eligible superannuation plan (the first plan) for the benefit of a person (the beneficiary) who may or may not be the bankrupt; and

 (c) the beneficiary’s withdrawal benefit in relation to the first plan falls short of the amount of the money, or the value of the property, received as a result of the transaction; and

 (d) the beneficiary has a superannuation interest in another eligible superannuation plan; and

 (e) the superannuation interest referred to in paragraph (d) is attributable, in whole or in part, to the rollover or transfer, after the transaction referred to in paragraph (a) happened, of the whole or a part of the beneficiary’s superannuation interest in the first plan;

the Court may, by order, direct the trustee of the other eligible superannuation plan to pay to the trustee of the bankrupt’s estate a specified amount not exceeding whichever is the lesser of the following:

 (f) the amount of the shortfall referred to in paragraph (c);

 (g) the beneficiary’s withdrawal benefit in relation to the other eligible superannuation plan.

 (2) The Court must not make an order under subsection (1) unless it is satisfied that it is in the interests of the creditors of the bankrupt to do so.

 (3) For the purposes of paragraph (1)(a), it is immaterial whether the transaction occurred before, at or after the commencement of this section.

 (4) For the purposes of paragraph (1)(b), disregard a benefit that is payable in the event of the death of a person.

 (5) For the purposes of paragraph (1)(c), if the beneficiary does not have a superannuation interest in an eligible superannuation plan, the beneficiary is taken to have a nil withdrawal benefit in relation to the plan.

 (6) For the purposes of paragraph (1)(e), it is immaterial whether the rollover or transfer occurred directly or indirectly through one or more interposed eligible superannuation plans.

 (7) An applicant under subsection (1) must give a copy of the application to:

 (a) the trustee of the other eligible superannuation plan; and

 (b) the beneficiary.

 (8) At the hearing of an application under subsection (1):

 (a) the trustee of the other eligible superannuation plan; and

 (b) the beneficiary.

may appear, adduce evidence and make submissions.

 (9) For the purposes of sections 128E, 128F and 128J, an order under this section is taken to relate to:

 (a) the transaction referred to in paragraph (1)(a) of this section; and

 (b) the beneficiary’s superannuation interest referred to in paragraph (1)(d) of this section.

139ZV  Enforcement of order

  An order by the Court under section 139ZU is enforceable as if it were an order for the payment of money made by the Court when exercising jurisdiction otherwise than under this Act.

139ZW  Definitions

  In this Subdivision:

contribution has the same meaning as in Subdivision B of Division 3.

eligible superannuation plan has the same meaning as in Subdivision B of Division 3.

superannuation interest has the same meaning as in Subdivision B of Division 3.

trustee of an eligible superannuation plan has the same meaning as in Subdivision B of Division 3.

withdrawal benefit has the same meaning as in Subdivision B of Division 3.

Division 5Distribution of property

140  Declaration and distribution of dividends

 (1) The trustee of the estate of a bankrupt shall, subject to this section, with all convenient speed, declare and distribute dividends amongst the creditors who have proved their debts.

 (2) Subject to the retention of such sums as are necessary to meet the costs of administration or to give effect to the provisions of this Act, the trustee shall distribute as dividend all moneys in hand.

 (3) Before declaring the first dividend, the trustee must give written notice of the trustee’s intention to declare the dividend to anyone the trustee knows of who claims, or might claim, to be a creditor but has not lodged a proof of debt.

 (4) The trustee shall, in a notice published or sent in pursuance of subsection (3), specify a reasonable period within which creditors may lodge their proofs of debts.

 (5) The trustee shall, before declaring a dividend (other than the first dividend or the final dividend) send notice of his or her intention to do so to each person who, to his or her knowledge, claims to be, or might claim to be, a creditor but has not lodged a proof of debt and has not been sent a notice under this section in relation to the declaration of a previous dividend.

 (6) The trustee shall, in a notice sent in pursuance of subsection (5), specify a reasonable period within which creditors may lodge their proofs of debts.

 (7) Where the trustee has sent a notice in pursuance of subsection (3) or (5) of this section in relation to the declaration of a dividend, the trustee shall not declare the dividend until after the expiration of 21 days after the expiration of the period specified in the notice.

 (8) Subject to subsections (9) and (10), where the trustee declares a dividend, he or she shall pay each creditor who has proved his or her debt the amount due to the creditor and send the creditor a statement in accordance with the approved form in relation to the realization and distribution of the estate.

 (9) Where, but for this subsection, the amount due to a creditor in respect of a dividend would be less than $10 or, if a greater amount is, as at the beginning of the day on which the dividend is declared, prescribed by the regulations for the purposes of this subsection, that greater amount, the trustee need not pay that dividend to the creditor.

 (10) Where a creditor has furnished to the trustee an authority in writing to pay a dividend due to the creditor to another person, the dividend payable to the creditor may be paid, and the statement to be sent to the creditor in pursuance of subsection (8) may be sent, to that person.

 (11) This section has effect subject to an order under section 90SS or 114 of the Family Law Act 1975 (which deal with interlocutory injunctions).

141  Joint and separate dividends

  Where one partner of a firm becomes bankrupt, a creditor to whom the bankrupt is indebted jointly with the other partners of the firm or any of them shall not receive a dividend out of the separate property of the bankrupt until all the separate creditors have received the full amount of their respective debts.

142  Apportionment of expenses of administration of joint and separate estates

  Where joint and separate estates are being administered, the expenses of and incidental to the administration of the estates shall be fairly apportioned by the trustee between the joint and separate estates, having regard to the work done for, and the benefit received by, each estate.

143  Provision to be made for creditors residing at a distance etc.

  In the calculation and distribution of a dividend, the trustee shall make provision for:

 (a) debts provable in bankruptcy appearing from the bankrupt’s statement of affairs or otherwise to be due to persons resident in places so distant from the place where the trustee is acting that in the ordinary course of communication those persons would not have had sufficient time to lodge their proofs of debt; and

 (b) debts provable in bankruptcy in respect of which proofs of debt have been lodged but have not been admitted.

144  Right of creditor who has not proved debt before declaration of dividend

  A creditor who has not proved his or her debt before the declaration of a dividend is entitled to be paid, out of any available money for the time being in the hands of the trustee, dividends that he or she has failed to receive before that money is applied to the payment of a future dividend, but he or she is not entitled to disturb the distribution of a dividend declared before he or she proved his or her debt.

145  Final dividend

 (1) Subject to this section, when the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt has realized all the property of the bankrupt, or so much of it as can, in his or her opinion, be realized without needlessly protracting the trusteeship, he or she shall declare and distribute a final dividend.

 (2) The trustee shall distribute as the final dividend all moneys realized and not previously distributed and shall distribute the final dividend without regard to any debt that had not been proved at the time when he or she declared the final dividend.

 (3) The trustee shall, before declaring the final dividend, give notice, in the manner prescribed by the regulations, to each person who to his or her knowledge, claims to be, or might claim to be, a creditor but has not proved his or her debt that, if the person does not prove his or her debt within the period specified in the notice, the trustee will proceed to declare a final dividend without regard to his or her claim.

 (4) The trustee shall, in a notice sent to a person in pursuance of subsection (3), allow a reasonable period within which the person may prove his or her debt.

 (5) The Court may, on the application of a person claiming to be a creditor, extend the period within which the person may prove his or her debt.

 (6) Where the trustee has sent a notice in pursuance of subsection (3) in relation to the declaration of the final dividend, the trustee shall not declare the dividend until after the expiration of 21 days after the expiration of the period specified in the notice or, if the Court, under subsection (5), extends the period within which a person may prove his or her debt, until after the expiration of 21 days after the expiration of that extended period.

146  Distribution of dividends where bankrupt fails to file statement of affairs

  Where a bankrupt has failed to file a statement of his or her affairs as required by this Act, the Court may, on the application of the trustee, upon such terms as it thinks fit, order that distribution of dividends amongst the creditors who have proved their debts shall proceed in accordance with this Division as if the bankrupt had filed a statement of his or her affairs and those creditors had been stated to be creditors in it.

147  No action for dividend

 (1) An action for a dividend does not lie against the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt but, if the trustee neglects or refuses to pay a dividend to a creditor, the Court, on the application of the creditor, may, if it thinks fit, order the trustee to pay the dividend and may also order that the trustee pay interest on the dividend for the time that it is withheld and the costs of the application.

 (2) Where the Court orders the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt to pay interest on a dividend or to pay the costs of an application under subsection (1), the trustee is personally liable for, and is not entitled to be reimbursed by the estate in respect of, the payment of that interest or those costs.

Part VIIDischarge and annulment

Division 1Preliminary

148  Misleading conduct by bankrupt

  For the purposes of this Part, a bankrupt is taken to have engaged in misleading conduct in relation to a person in respect of a particular amount (in this section called the relevant amount) if:

 (a) the bankrupt, either alone or jointly with any other person, obtained credit to the extent of the relevant amount from the firstmentioned person without informing that person that he or she was an undischarged bankrupt; or

 (b) the bankrupt, either alone or jointly with any other person, obtained goods or services from the firstmentioned person:

 (i) by giving a bill of exchange or cheque drawn, or a promissory note made, by the bankrupt, either alone or jointly with another person, being a bill, cheque or note under which the relevant amount is payable; or

 (ii) by giving 2 or more such instruments under which the total of the amounts payable is equal to the relevant amount;

  without informing the firstmentioned person that he or she was an undischarged bankrupt; or

 (c) the bankrupt, either alone or jointly with any other person, entered into a hirepurchase agreement with the firstmentioned person, or entered into an agreement for the leasing or hiring of any goods from the firstmentioned person, being a hirepurchase agreement or agreement for the leasing or hiring of goods under which the total of the amounts payable is equal to the relevant amount, without informing the firstmentioned person that he or she was an undischarged bankrupt; or

 (d) the bankrupt, either alone or jointly with any other person, obtained goods or services from the firstmentioned person by promising to pay that person or another person the relevant amount, or amounts the total of which is equal to the relevant amount, without informing the firstmentioned person that he or she was an undischarged bankrupt; or

 (e) the bankrupt, either alone or jointly with any other person, obtained the relevant amount, or amounts the total of which is equal to the relevant amount, from the firstmentioned person by promising to supply goods to, or render services for, that person or another person without informing the firstmentioned person that he or she was an undischarged bankrupt; or

 (f) the bankrupt carried on business under an assumed name, in the name of another person or, either alone or in partnership, under a firm name and:

 (i) in the course of the carrying on of that business the bankrupt, or, if the bankrupt carried on the business in partnership under a firm name, the partnership, dealt with the firstmentioned person; and

 (ii) the bankrupt did not inform the firstmentioned person that he or she was an undischarged bankrupt.

Division 2Discharge by operation of law

Subdivision ADischarge after certain period

149  Automatic discharge

 (1) Subject to section 149A, a bankrupt is, by force of this subsection, discharged from bankruptcy in accordance with this section.

 (2) If:

 (a) the bankrupt became a bankrupt before the commencement of section 27 of the Bankruptcy Amendment Act 1991; and

 (b) immediately before the commencement of that section, either:

 (i) paragraph 149(3)(c) of the Bankruptcy Act 1966 as amended applied in relation to the bankrupt; or

 (ii) an order under subsection 149(8) or (12) of the Bankruptcy Act 1966 as amended was in force in relation to the bankrupt;

the bankrupt is discharged at the end of the period of 3 years from:

 (c) the date on which the bankrupt filed his or her statement of affairs; or

 (d) the date of commencement of that section;

whichever is the later.

 (3) If the bankrupt became a bankrupt before the commencement of section 27 of the Bankruptcy Amendment Act 1991, and subsection (2) does not apply in relation to the bankrupt, the bankrupt is discharged at:

 (a) the end of the period of 3 years from the date on which the bankrupt filed his or her statement of affairs; or

 (b) the commencement of that section;

whichever is the later.

 (4) If the bankrupt becomes a bankrupt after the commencement of section 27 of the Bankruptcy Amendment Act 1991, the bankrupt is discharged at the end of the period of 3 years from the date on which the bankrupt filed his or her statement of affairs.

149A  Bankruptcy extended when objection made

 (1) If an objection to the discharge of a bankrupt has taken effect in accordance with section 149G, then, unless the objection is withdrawn or cancelled, the reference in whichever of subsections 149(2), (3) and (4) applies in relation to the bankrupt to the period of 3 years from the date on which the bankrupt filed his or her statement of affairs is taken to be a reference to the prescribed number of years from the prescribed date.

 (2) For the purposes of subsection (1):

 (a) the prescribed number of years is:

 (i) if the objection was made on a ground, or on grounds that included a ground, referred to in paragraph 149D(1)(ab), (ac), (ad), (d), (da), (e), (f), (g), (h), (ha), (ia), (k) or (ma)—8 years; or

 (ii) in any other case—5 years; and

 (b) the prescribed date is:

 (i) if the objection was made on a ground, or on grounds that included a ground, referred to in paragraph 149D(1)(a) or (h)—the date on which the bankrupt returned to Australia; or

 (ii) in any other case—the date on which the bankrupt filed his or her statement of affairs.

 (3) If the objection is withdrawn or cancelled:

 (a) the objection is taken never to have been made; and

 (b) if:

 (i) the period specified in whichever of subsections 149(2), (3) and (4) applies in relation to the bankrupt has ended; and

 (ii) no other objection against the discharge of the bankrupt is in effect;

  the bankrupt is taken to be discharged under section 149 immediately the objection is withdrawn or cancelled.

Subdivision BObjections

149B  Objection to discharge

 (1) Subject to the following provisions of this Subdivision, at any time before a bankrupt is discharged from bankruptcy under section 149, the trustee may file with the Official Receiver a written notice of objection to the discharge.

 (2) The trustee of a bankrupt’s estate must file a notice of objection to the discharge if the trustee believes:

 (a) that doing so will help make the bankrupt discharge a duty that the bankrupt has not discharged; and

 (b) that there is no other way for the trustee to induce the bankrupt to discharge any duties that the bankrupt has not discharged.

149C  Form of notice of objection

 (1) A notice of objection must:

 (a) set out the ground or each of the grounds of objection, being a ground or grounds set out in subsection 149D(1) but not being a ground or grounds of a previous objection to the discharge that was cancelled; and

 (b) refer to the evidence or other material that, in the opinion of the trustee, establishes that ground or each of those grounds; and

 (c) state the reasons of the trustee for objecting to the discharge on that ground or those grounds.

 (1A) Paragraph (1)(c) does not apply to a ground specified in paragraph 149D(1)(ab), (d), (da), (e), (f), (g), (h), (ha), (ia), (k) or (ma).

 (2) A notice of objection is not invalid merely because it does not state the ground or grounds of objection precisely as set out in subsection 149D(1) provided that the ground or grounds can reasonably be identified from the terms of the notice.

149D  Grounds of objection

 (1) The grounds of objection that may be set out in a notice of objection are as follows:

 (a) the bankrupt has, whether before, on or after the date of the bankruptcy, left Australia and has not returned to Australia;

 (aa) any transfer is void against the trustee in the bankruptcy because of section 120 or 122;

 (ab) any transfer is void against the trustee in the bankruptcy because of section 121;

 (ac) any transfer is void against the trustee in the bankruptcy because of section 128B;

 (ad) any transfer is void against the trustee in the bankruptcy because of section 128C;

 (b) after the date of the bankruptcy, the bankrupt contravened section 206A of the Corporations Act 2001 (disqualification from managing corporations);

 (c) after the date of the bankruptcy the bankrupt engaged in misleading conduct in relation to a person in respect of an amount that, or amounts the total of which, exceeded $3,000;

 (d) the bankrupt, when requested in writing by the trustee to provide written information about the bankrupt’s property, income or expected income, failed to comply with the request;

 (da) after the date of the bankruptcy, the bankrupt intentionally provided false or misleading information to the trustee;

 (e) the bankrupt failed to disclose any particulars of income or expected income as required by a provision of this Act referred to in subsection 6A(1) or by section 139U;

 (f) the bankrupt failed to pay to the trustee an amount that the bankrupt was liable to pay under section 139ZG;

 (g) at any time during the period of 5 years immediately before the commencement of the bankruptcy, or at any time during the bankruptcy, the bankrupt:

 (i) spent money but failed to explain adequately to the trustee the purpose for which the money was spent; or

 (ii) disposed of property but failed to explain adequately to the trustee why no money was received as a result of the disposal or what the bankrupt did with the money received as a result of the disposal;

 (h) while the bankrupt was absent from Australia he or she was requested by the trustee to return to Australia by a particular date or within a particular period but the bankrupt failed to return by that date or within that period;

 (ha) the bankrupt intentionally failed to disclose to the trustee a liability of the bankrupt that existed at the date of the bankruptcy;

 (i) the bankrupt has failed, whether intentionally or not, to disclose to the trustee a liability of the bankrupt that existed at the date of the bankruptcy;

 (ia) the bankrupt failed to comply with subparagraph 77(1)(a)(ii);

 (j) the bankrupt failed to comply with paragraph 77(1)(bb) or (bc) or subsection 80(1);

 (k) the bankrupt refused or failed to sign a document after being lawfully required by the trustee to sign that document;

 (l) the bankrupt failed to attend a meeting of his or her creditors without having first obtained written approval of the trustee not to attend or without having given to the trustee a reasonable explanation for the failure;

 (m) the bankrupt failed to attend an interview or examination for the purposes of this Act without having given a reasonable explanation to the trustee for the failure;

 (ma) the bankrupt intentionally failed to disclose to the trustee the bankrupt’s beneficial interest in any property;

 (n) the bankrupt failed, whether intentionally or not, to disclose to the trustee the bankrupt’s beneficial interest in any property.

 (2) This section has effect subject to section 304A.

149F  Copy of notice of objection to be given to bankrupt

 (1) As soon as practicable after a notice of objection is filed by the trustee, the trustee must give a copy of the notice to the bankrupt together with a notice to the effect that the bankrupt may request the InspectorGeneral to review the decision of the trustee to file the notice of objection.

 (2) A notice given to the bankrupt under subsection (1) must set out the effect of subsection 149K(3).

 (3) A contravention of this section does not affect the validity of the objection.

149G  Date of effect of objection

  An objection takes effect at the beginning of the day on which details of the notice of objection are entered in the National Personal Insolvency Index.

149H  Trustee ceasing to object on some grounds

 (1) If at any time before a bankrupt is discharged the trustee ceases to object to the discharge on a particular ground, the trustee must give the Official Receiver a notice specifying the ground and give the bankrupt a copy of the notice.

 (3) If there is no longer an objection on any ground, the objection ceases to have effect at the beginning of the last day when details of a notice under subsection (1) are entered in the National Personal Insolvency Index.

 (4) If one or more grounds of objection remain, the objection continues to have effect on the remaining ground or grounds.

149J  Withdrawal of objection

 (1) If at any time before a bankrupt is discharged the trustee withdraws the objection, the trustee must give the Official Receiver a notice of the withdrawal of the objection and give the bankrupt a copy of the notice.

 (3) The withdrawal takes effect at the beginning of the day when details of a notice under subsection (1) are entered in the National Personal Insolvency Index.

Subdivision CReview of objection

149K  Internal review of objection

 (1) The InspectorGeneral may review a decision of the trustee to file a notice of objection:

 (a) on the InspectorGeneral’s own initiative; or

 (b) if requested to do so by the bankrupt for reasons that appear to the InspectorGeneral to be sufficient to justify such a review.

 (2) The InspectorGeneral must review such a decision if requested to do so by the Ombudsman.

 (3) A request by the bankrupt to the InspectorGeneral for the review of such a decision must:

 (a) be in writing and lodged with the Official Receiver’s office not later than 60 days after the day on which the bankrupt is notified of the trustee’s objection; and

 (b) be accompanied by:

 (i) a copy of the notice of objection; and

 (ii) any documents on which the bankrupt relies in support of the request.

 (4) The Official Receiver must endorse on the request the date when it was lodged and must send the request and the accompanying documents to the InspectorGeneral as soon as practicable after they are received.

 (5) Within 60 days after the request is lodged, the InspectorGeneral must:

 (a) decide whether to review the decision; and

 (b) if the InspectorGeneral decides to review the decision—make his or her decision on the review.

149M  InspectorGeneral may request further information

 (1) For the purposes of the exercise of powers under this Subdivision, the InspectorGeneral may:

 (a) ask the bankrupt to provide such further information, either orally or in writing, in support of the request as the InspectorGeneral specifies; and

 (b) ask the trustee who filed the notice of objection to provide such information, either orally or in writing, about the decision to file the notice and the reasons for the decision as the InspectorGeneral specifies.

 (2) If any information is provided orally, the InspectorGeneral must record it in writing.

149N  Decision on review

 (1) On a review of a decision, if the InspectorGeneral is satisfied that:

 (a) the ground or grounds on which the objection was made was not a ground or were not grounds specified in subsection 149D(1); or

 (b) there is insufficient evidence to support the existence of the ground or grounds of objection; or

 (c) the reasons given for objecting on that ground or those grounds do not justify the making of the objection; or

 (d) a previous objection that was made on that ground or those grounds, or on grounds that included that ground or those grounds, was cancelled;

the InspectorGeneral must cancel the objection.

 (1A) An objection must not be cancelled under subsection (1) if:

 (a) the objection specifies at least one special ground; and

 (b) there is sufficient evidence to support the existence of at least one special ground specified in the objection; and

 (c) the bankrupt fails to establish that the bankrupt had a reasonable excuse for the conduct or failure that constituted the special ground.

For this purpose, special ground means a ground specified in paragraph 149D(1)(ab), (d), (da), (e), (f), (g), (h), (ha), (ia), (k) or (ma).

 (1B) In applying subsection (1A), no notice is to be taken of any conduct of the bankrupt after the time when the ground concerned first commenced to exist.

 (2) The cancellation does not take effect until:

 (a) the end of the period within which an application may be made to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal for the review of the decision of the InspectorGeneral; or

 (b) if such an application is made—the decision of the Tribunal is given.

 (3) If the InspectorGeneral is not satisfied as mentioned in subsection (1), the InspectorGeneral must confirm the decision.

149P  InspectorGeneral to notify bankrupt and trustee of decision

 (1) If the InspectorGeneral:

 (a) reviews a decision; or

 (b) refuses a request by a bankrupt for a review of a decision;

the InspectorGeneral must give written notice to the bankrupt, to the trustee and to the Official Receiver, of the InspectorGeneral’s decision on the review or on the request, as the case may be.

 (2) The notice must:

 (a) set out the decision; and

 (b) refer to the evidence or other material on which the decision was based; and

 (c) give the reasons for the decision.

 (3) In the case of a decision reviewing the decision to file a notice of objection, the notice must also include a statement to the effect that, if the bankrupt, or the trustee, is dissatisfied with the InspectorGeneral’s decision, application may, subject to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal Act 1975, be made to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal for review of the decision.

 (4) In the case of a decision refusing a request to review the decision to file a notice of objection, the notice to the bankrupt must also include a statement to the effect that, if the bankrupt is dissatisfied with the InspectorGeneral’s decision, application may, subject to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal Act 1975, be made to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal for a review of the decision.

 (5) A contravention of subsection (3) or (4) in relation to a decision does not affect the validity of the decision.

 (6) If, within 60 days after lodgment of a request by a bankrupt for the review of the trustee’s decision to file a notice of objection, the InspectorGeneral has not given written notice to the bankrupt of his or her decision in accordance with subsection (1), the InspectorGeneral is taken to have reviewed the decision and confirmed it under subsection 149N(3).

149Q  Review of decisions

  An application may be made to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal for the review of:

 (a) a decision of the InspectorGeneral on the review of a decision of the trustee to file a notice of objection; or

 (b) a decision of the InspectorGeneral refusing a request to review a decision of the trustee to file a notice of objection.

Division 4Provisions applicable to all discharges

152  Discharged bankrupt to give assistance

  A discharged bankrupt must, even though discharged, give such assistance as the trustee reasonably requires in the realization and distribution of such of his or her property as is vested in the trustee.

Penalty: Imprisonment for 6 months.

153  Effect of discharge

 (1) Subject to this section, where a bankrupt is discharged from a bankruptcy, the discharge operates to release him or her from all debts (including secured debts) provable in the bankruptcy, whether or not, in the case of a secured debt, the secured creditor has surrendered his or her security for the benefit of creditors generally.

Note: The operation of this section in relation to accumulated HEC debts and semester debts under the Higher Education Funding Act 1988 is affected by section 106YA of that Act.

 (2) The discharge of a bankrupt from a bankruptcy does not:

 (a) release the bankrupt from:

 (i) a debt on a recognizance; or

 (ii) a debt with which the bankrupt is chargeable at the suit of the sheriff or other public officer on a bail bond entered into for the appearance of a person prosecuted for an offence against a law of the Commonwealth or of a State or Territory of the Commonwealth; or

 (aa) release the bankrupt from liability to pay an amount to the trustee under subsection 139ZG(1); or

 (b) release the bankrupt from a debt incurred by means of fraud or a fraudulent breach of trust to which he or she was a party or a debt of which he or she has obtained forbearance by fraud; or

 (c) subject to any order of the Court made under subsection (2A), release the bankrupt from any liability under a maintenance agreement or maintenance order;

Note: A discharged bankrupt remains liable under any pecuniary penalty order because such liabilities are not provable in bankruptcy, see subsection 82(3A).

 (2A) The Court may order that the discharge of a bankrupt from bankruptcy shall operate to release the bankrupt, to such extent and subject to such conditions as the Court thinks fit, from liability to pay arrears due under a maintenance agreement or maintenance order.

 (3) The discharge of a bankrupt from a bankruptcy does not affect the right of a secured creditor, or any person claiming through or under him or her, to realize or otherwise deal with his or her security:

 (a) if the secured creditor has not proved in the bankruptcy for any part of the secured debt—for the purpose of obtaining payment of the secured debt; or

 (b) if the secured creditor has proved in the bankruptcy for part of the secured debt—for the purpose of obtaining payment of the part of the secured debt for which he or she has not proved in the bankruptcy;

and, for the purposes of enabling the secured creditor or a person claiming through or under him or her so to realize or deal with his or her security, but not otherwise, the secured debt, or the part of the secured debt, as the case may be, shall be deemed not to have been released by the discharge of the bankrupt.

 (4) The discharge of a bankrupt from a bankruptcy does not release from any liability a person who, at the date on which the bankrupt became a bankrupt:

 (a) was a partner or a cotrustee with the bankrupt or was jointly bound or had made a joint contract with the bankrupt; or

 (b) was surety or in the nature of a surety for the bankrupt.

 (5) Where a bankrupt has been discharged from a bankruptcy, all proceedings taken in or in respect of the bankruptcy shall be deemed to have been validly taken.

Division 5Annulment of bankruptcy

153A  Annulment on payment of debts

 (1) If the trustee is satisfied that all the bankrupt’s debts have been paid in full, the bankruptcy is annulled, by force of this subsection, on the date on which the last such payment was made.

 (1A) In determining whether there has been full payment of a debt that bears interest, the interest must be reckoned up to and including the date on which the debt (including interest) is paid.

 (2) The trustee must, before the end of the period of 2 days beginning on that date, give to the Official Receiver a written certificate setting out the former bankrupt’s name and bankruptcy number and the date of the annulment.

Penalty: 5 penalty units.

Note: See also section 277B (about infringement notices).

 (3) Subsection (2) is an offence of strict liability.

Note: For strict liability, see section 6.1 of the Criminal Code.

 (4) For the purposes of this section, if a debt has been proved by a creditor but the creditor cannot be found or cannot be identified, the debt may be paid to the Official Receiver and, if so paid, is taken for the purposes of this section to have been paid in full to the creditor.

 (4A) Money received by the Official Receiver under subsection (4) is received on behalf of the Commonwealth.

 (5) If money is paid to the Official Receiver under subsection (4), the provisions of subsections 254(3) and (4) apply in relation to that money as if it had been paid to the Commonwealth by a trustee under subsection 254(2).

 (6) In this section:

bankrupt’s debts means all debts that have been proved in the bankruptcy and includes interest payable on such of those debts as bear interest, and the costs, charges and expenses of the administration of the bankruptcy, including the remuneration and expenses of the trustee.

153B  Annulment by Court

 (1) If the Court is satisfied that a sequestration order ought not to have been made or, in the case of a debtor’s petition, that the petition ought not to have been presented or ought not to have been accepted by the Official Receiver, the Court may make an order annulling the bankruptcy.

 (2) In the case of a debtor’s petition, the order may be made whether or not the bankrupt was insolvent when the petition was presented.

 (3) The trustee must, before the end of the period of 2 days beginning on the day the trustee becomes aware of the order, give to the Official Receiver a written certificate setting out the former bankrupt’s name and bankruptcy number and the date of the annulment.

Penalty: 5 penalty units.

Note: See also section 277B (about infringement notices).

 (4) Subsection (3) is an offence of strict liability.

Note: For strict liability, see section 6.1 of the Criminal Code.

154  Effect of annulment

 (1) If the bankruptcy of a person (in this section called the former bankrupt) is annulled under this Division:

 (a) all sales and dispositions of property and payments duly made, and all acts done, by the trustee or any person acting under the authority of the trustee or the Court before the annulment are taken to have been validly made or done; and

 (b) the trustee may apply the property of the former bankrupt still vested in the trustee in payment of the costs, charges and expenses of the administration of the bankruptcy, including the remuneration and expenses of the trustee; and

 (c) subject to subsections (3), (6) and (7), the remainder (if any) of the property of the former bankrupt still vested in the trustee reverts to the bankrupt.

 (2) If the property of the former bankrupt referred to in paragraph (1)(b) is insufficient to meet the costs, charges and expenses referred to in that paragraph, the amount of the deficiency is a debt due by the former bankrupt to the trustee and is recoverable by the trustee by action against the former bankrupt in a court of competent jurisdiction.

 (3) If an application is made to the Court by a person claiming an interest in property referred to in paragraph (1)(c), the Court, after hearing such persons as it thinks fit, may make an order, either unconditionally or on such conditions as the Court considers just and equitable, for the vesting of the property in, or delivery of the property to, a person in whom, or to whom, it seems to the Court to be just and equitable that it should be vested or delivered, or to a trustee for that person.

 (4) Subject to subsection (5), if an order vesting property in a person is made under subsection (3), the property vests immediately in the person without any conveyance, transfer or assignment.

 (5) If:

 (a) the property to which such an order relates is property the transfer of which is required by a law of the Commonwealth, of a State or of a Territory to be registered; and

 (b) that law enables the registration of such an order;

the property, even though it vests in equity in the person named in the order, does not vest in that person at law until the requirements of that law have been complied with.

 (6) The Court may make an order directing the trustee not to pay or transfer the property, or a specified part of the property, referred to in paragraph (1)(c) to the former bankrupt if:

 (a) an application is made for an order under this subsection by a person mentioned in subsection (6A); and

 (b) the Court is satisfied that:

 (i) proceedings are pending under a proceeds of crime law; and

 (ii) property of the former bankrupt may:

 (A) become subject to a forfeiture order or interstate forfeiture order made in the proceedings; or

 (B) be required to satisfy a pecuniary penalty order or interstate pecuniary penalty order made in the proceedings.

 (6A) For the purposes of paragraph (6)(a), the application may be made by:

 (a) in the case of pending proceedings in relation to a forfeiture order or a pecuniary penalty order under the Proceeds of Crime Act 2002—the Commonwealth proceeds of crime authority that is, or that is proposed to be, the responsible authority for the application for the order under that Act; or

 (b) in the case of pending proceedings under a corresponding law—a person who is entitled to apply for an interstate confiscation order under the corresponding law.

 (7) The Court, on application made to it, may vary or revoke an order made under subsection (6).

Part VIIITrustees

Division 1Appointment and official name

154A  Application to become a registered trustee

 (1) An individual may apply to the InspectorGeneral to be registered as a trustee.

 (2) The application must be in the approved form.

 (3) The application must be accompanied by:

 (a) any information or documents prescribed by the regulations; and

 (b) the fee determined by the Minister by legislative instrument.

 (4) The application is properly made if subsections (2) and (3) are complied with.

155  Processing of an application

 (1) After receiving a properly made application, the InspectorGeneral must convene a committee to consider the application.

 (2) The committee must consist of:

 (a) the InspectorGeneral; and

 (b) an APS employee; and

 (c) a registered trustee chosen by the Insolvency Practitioners’ Association of Australia (A.C.N. 002 472 362).

 (3) The committee must consider the application and interview the applicant.

Note: The regulations may provide for the way in which the committee must do its work: see section 315.

155A  Committee’s decision on an application

Time limit for decision

 (1) Within 60 days of interviewing the applicant, the committee must decide whether the applicant should be registered as a trustee or not.

Exam to assess suitability

 (1A) For the purpose of deciding whether the applicant should be registered, the Committee may require the applicant to sit for an exam.

Mandatory decision in favour of registration

 (2) The committee must decide that the applicant should be registered if the committee is satisfied that the applicant:

 (a) has the qualifications, experience, knowledge and abilities prescribed by the regulations; and

 (b) will take out insurance against liabilities that the applicant may incur working as a registered trustee; and

 (c) has not been convicted, within 10 years before making the application, of an offence involving fraud or dishonesty; and

 (d) has not been a bankrupt or a party (as debtor) to a debt agreement or Part X administration within 10 years before making the application; and

 (e) has not had his or her registration as a trustee cancelled within 10 years before making the application on the ground that:

 (i) he or she contravened any conditions imposed by a committee on his or her practice as a registered trustee; or

 (ii) he or she failed to exercise the powers of a registered trustee properly; or

 (iii) he or she failed to carry out the duties of a registered trustee properly; or

 (iv) he or she failed to properly carry out the duties of an administrator in relation to a debt agreement; and

 (f) has not had his or her registration as a debt agreement administrator cancelled under section 186K, within 10 years before making the application, on the ground that he or she failed to properly carry out the duties of an administrator in relation to a debt agreement; and

 (g) has not had his or her registration as a debt agreement administrator cancelled, within 10 years before making the application, as a result of an order under section 185ZCA.

Discretion to decide in favour of registration

 (3) If the committee considers that the applicant is suitable to be registered as a trustee, it may decide that the applicant should be registered even if it is not satisfied that the applicant has the qualifications, experience, knowledge and abilities prescribed by the regulations for the purposes of paragraph (2)(a).

Mandatory decision against registration

 (4) The committee must decide that the applicant should not be registered if it is satisfied that the applicant:

 (a) will not take out insurance against liabilities that the applicant may incur working as a registered trustee; or

 (b) has been convicted, within 10 years before making the application, of an offence involving fraud or dishonesty; or

 (c) has been a bankrupt or a party (as debtor) to a debt agreement or a Part X administration within 10 years before making the application; or

 (d) has had his or her registration as a trustee cancelled within 10 years before making the application on the ground that:

 (i) he or she contravened any conditions imposed by a committee on his or her practice as a registered trustee; or

 (ii) he or she failed to exercise the powers of a registered trustee properly; or

 (iii) he or she failed to carry out the duties of a registered trustee properly; or

 (iv) he or she failed to properly carry out the duties of an administrator in relation to a debt agreement; or

 (e) has had his or her registration as a debt agreement administrator cancelled under section 186K, within 10 years before making the application, on the ground that he or she failed to properly carry out the duties of an administrator in relation to a debt agreement; or

 (f) has had his or her registration as a debt agreement administrator cancelled, within 10 years before making the application, as a result of an order under section 185ZCA.

 (4A) The Committee must decide that the applicant should not be registered if the Committee is not satisfied that the applicant has the ability (including knowledge) to perform satisfactorily the duties of a registered trustee.

Conditions on registration

 (5) If the committee decides that the applicant should be registered, it may decide that specified conditions should apply to the applicant’s practice as a registered trustee.

Report of decision

 (6) The committee must give the applicant and the InspectorGeneral a report on all of its decisions relating to the application, and the reasons for them.

Review of decision

 (7) The applicant may apply to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal for review of a decision of the committee.

155B  Effect of committee’s decision

  The InspectorGeneral must give effect to all of the committee’s decisions, subject to paragraph 155C(1)(b).

155C  Registration as a trustee

 (1) The InspectorGeneral must register the applicant as a trustee if:

 (a) the committee has decided that the applicant should be registered; and

 (b) the applicant has paid the fee determined by the Minister by legislative instrument.

 (2) The InspectorGeneral registers an applicant by entering in the National Personal Insolvency Index the details relating to the applicant that are prescribed in the regulations.

 (3) After registering a person as a trustee, the InspectorGeneral must give the person a certificate of registration.

 (4) The registration has effect for 3 years.

155D  Extension of registration

 (1) The InspectorGeneral must extend the registration of a person as trustee for three years from the expiry of the person’s registration if:

 (a) the person applies in writing to the InspectorGeneral for the extension before the person’s registration expires; and

 (b) the person has paid the fee determined by the Minister by legislative instrument (and any late payment penalty under subsection (3) of this section).

 (2) The InspectorGeneral must not extend the registration of a person if:

 (a) the person owes a total of more than $50 for the following:

 (i) charge under the Bankruptcy (Estate Charges) Act 1997 (the estate charge);

 (ii) penalty under section 281 of this Act in respect of that charge; and

 (b) the InspectorGeneral notified the person of the unpaid estate charge at least 14 days before the due date for payment of the charge under subsection (3) on the extension of the registration.

 (3) The fee for an extension of registration is due for payment one month before the expiry of the registration. If the fee is not paid by then, an additional amount equal to 20% of the fee is payable by the trustee by way of penalty.

155E  Application for change of conditions on practising as a registered trustee

 (1) If a committee has decided under this Division that conditions should apply to a person’s practice as a registered trustee, the person may apply to the InspectorGeneral for the conditions to be changed or removed.

 (2) The application must be in the approved form.

 (3) The application must be accompanied by any information or documents prescribed by the regulations.

 (3A) The application is properly made if subsections (2) and (3) are complied with.

 (4) After receiving a properly made application, the InspectorGeneral must convene a committee to consider the application.

 (5) The committee must consist of:

 (a) the InspectorGeneral; and

 (b) an APS employee; and

 (c) a registered trustee chosen by the Insolvency Practitioners’ Association of Australia (A.C.N. 002 472 362).

 (6) The committee must consider the application and interview the applicant.

Note: The regulations may provide for the way in which the committee must do its work: see section 315.

155F  Decision on application for change of conditions

 (1) Within 60 days of interviewing the applicant, the committee must:

 (a) decide that the conditions on the applicant’s practice as a registered trustee should not be changed; or

 (b) decide that specified modifications should be made to the conditions that apply to the applicant’s practice as a registered trustee.

Note: See the definition of modifications in subsection 5(1).

 (2) The committee must give the applicant and the InspectorGeneral a report of its decision relating to the application, and the reasons for the decision.

 (3) The applicant may apply to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal for review of the committee’s decision.

 (4) The InspectorGeneral must give effect to the committee’s decision.

155G  Voluntary termination of registration

 (1) A person who is a registered trustee may give the InspectorGeneral a written request that the person cease to be registered as a trustee.

 (2) The person ceases to be registered as a trustee when the InspectorGeneral accepts the request.

155H  Consideration of involuntary termination of registration

 (1) The InspectorGeneral may ask a registered trustee to give the InspectorGeneral a written explanation why the trustee should continue to be registered, if the InspectorGeneral believes that:

 (a) the trustee no longer has a qualification or ability that is prescribed by the regulations made for the purposes of paragraph 155A(2)(a); or

 (aa) the trustee no longer has the ability (including knowledge) to perform satisfactorily the duties of a registered trustee; or

 (b) the trustee has been convicted of an offence involving fraud or dishonesty since registration as a trustee; or

 (c) the trustee is not insured against liabilities that the trustee may incur, or has incurred, working as a registered trustee; or

 (d) the trustee is no longer practising as a registered trustee; or

 (e) the trustee has contravened any conditions imposed by the committee on the trustee’s practice; or

 (f) the trustee has failed to exercise powers of a registered trustee properly or has failed to carry out the duties of a registered trustee properly; or

 (fa) if the trustee is or was the administrator of a debt agreement—the trustee has failed to properly carry out the duties of an administrator in relation to a debt agreement; or

 (g) the trustee has failed to comply with a standard prescribed for the purposes of subsection (5).

 (2) If the InspectorGeneral does not receive an explanation within a reasonable time, or is not satisfied by the explanation, the InspectorGeneral must convene a committee to consider whether the trustee should continue to be registered.

 (3) The committee must consist of:

 (a) the InspectorGeneral; and

 (b) an APS employee; and

 (c) a registered trustee chosen by the Insolvency Practitioners’ Association of Australia (A.C.N. 002 472 362).

 (4) In considering whether the trustee should continue to be registered, the committee must take into account the matters mentioned in paragraphs (1)(a) to (g).

Note: The regulations may provide for the way in which the committee must do its work: see section 315.

 (5) The regulations may prescribe standards applicable to the exercise of powers, or the carrying out of duties, of registered trustees.

155I  Decision on involuntary termination of registration

 (1) The committee must:

 (a) decide that the trustee should continue to be registered; or

 (b) decide that the trustee should cease to be registered.

 (2) The committee may decide under paragraph (1)(a) that:

 (a) the trustee should continue to be registered unconditionally; or

 (b) the trustee should continue to be registered on the condition that:

 (i) the trustee meets specified conditions; or

 (ii) specified conditions are imposed on the trustee’s practice; or

 (iii) specified modifications are made to conditions on the trustee’s practice.

Note: See the definition of modifications in subsection 5(1).

 (3) The committee may decide under paragraph (1)(b) that:

 (a) the trustee should cease to be registered unconditionally; or

 (b) the trustee should cease to be registered if the trustee fails to meet specified conditions.

 (4) The committee must give the trustee and the InspectorGeneral a report of its decision relating to the application, and the reasons for the decision.

 (5) The trustee may apply to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal for review of the committee’s decision.

 (6) The InspectorGeneral must give effect to the committee’s decision.

Note: Sections 176 and 182 specify other circumstances in which a trustee may involuntarily cease to be registered.

155J  After termination of registration

 (1) If a person ceases to be registered as a trustee for any reason, the person must give his or her certificate of registration to the InspectorGeneral before the end of the period of 7 days beginning on the day the person ceased to be registered.

Penalty: 5 penalty units.

Note: See also section 277B (about infringement notices).

 (1A) Subsection (1) is an offence of strict liability.

Note: For strict liability, see section 6.1 of the Criminal Code.

 (1B) Subsection (1) does not apply if the person has a reasonable excuse.

Note: A defendant bears an evidential burden in relation to the matter in subsection (1B) (see subsection 13.3(3) of the Criminal Code).

 (2) A person who ceases to be registered is not entitled to a refund of all or part of any registration fee that the person had paid.

155K  Payment of fees etc. for application, registration and extension

  If a person gives the Commonwealth a cheque or payment order in payment of a fee under section 154A, 155C or 155D, the amount is taken not to be paid until the cheque or payment order is paid by the institution on which it is drawn.

156A  Consent to act as trustee

 (1) A registered trustee may, by instrument signed by him or her and filed with the Official Receiver, consent to act:

 (a) as the trustee of the estate of the debtor specified in the instrument in the event that the debtor becomes a bankrupt; or

 (b) as the trustee of the joint and separate estates of such of the debtors specified in the instrument, being members of a partnership or joint debtors who are not in partnership with one another, as may become bankrupts, or, if only one of those debtors becomes a bankrupt, as the trustee of the estate of that debtor.

 (2) An instrument under subsection (1) shall be in accordance with the approved form.

 (3) Where:

 (a) at the time when a debtor becomes a bankrupt, a registered trustee has, under subsection (1), consented to act as the trustee of the estate of the debtor and the consent has not been revoked, the registered trustee becomes, at that time, by force of this subsection, the trustee of the estate of the bankrupt; and

 (b) at the time when 2 or more debtors, being members of a partnership or joint debtors who are not in partnership with one another, become bankrupts, a registered trustee has, under subsection (1), consented to act as the trustee of the joint and separate estates of those debtors and the consent has not been revoked, the registered trustee becomes, at that time, by force of this subsection, the trustee of the joint and separate estates of those bankrupts.

 (4) A creditor may file with the Court an application for the removal by the Court of a trustee of the estate of a bankrupt, being a trustee who is the trustee of that estate by virtue of subsection (3), on the ground:

 (a) that the trustee is not fit to act as trustee; or

 (b) that the connection of the trustee with, or the relation of the trustee to, the bankrupt is likely to make it difficult for him or her to act with impartiality in the interests of the creditors generally.

 (5) Where an application under subsection (4) is filed, the Court may, if a ground specified in that subsection is established, remove the trustee from office and may appoint another registered trustee to be trustee in his or her place.

 (5A) If the Court removes the trustee and appoints another trustee, the creditor who applied for the removal must give the Official Receiver written notice of the removal and appointment as soon as practicable.

 (6) Where the Court appoints a person as trustee under subsection (5), the Official Receiver must issue to the person a certificate of appointment.

 (7) The appointment of a trustee under subsection (5) takes effect from and including the date on which the Court makes the appointment or such later date as the Court directs.

157  Appointment of trustees

 (1) Where a debtor becomes a bankrupt, the creditors may, if the Official Trustee is the trustee of the estate of the bankrupt, by resolution, at a meeting of creditors, appoint a registered trustee to the office of trustee of the estate of the bankrupt in place of the Official Trustee.

 (2) The person (in this section referred to as the relevant trustee) who is the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt at the time of an appointment, under subsection (1), of a registered trustee as the trustee, or as one of the trustees, of the estate shall, as early as practicable, notify the registered trustee, in writing, that he or she has been so appointed.

 (3) If the registered trustee appointed under subsection (1) informs the relevant trustee in writing, within 10 days after he or she is notified by the relevant trustee of his or her appointment, that he or she accepts the office, the Official Receiver shall issue to him or her a certificate of appointment.

 (4) The appointment of a trustee under subsection (1) takes effect from and including the date of the certificate of appointment issued by the Official Receiver.

 (5) If the registered trustee appointed under subsection (1) does not so inform the relevant trustee within 10 days after he or she is notified by the relevant trustee of his or her appointment, he or she shall be deemed to have declined the appointment, and the relevant trustee shall, unless the resolution of creditors has made provision for the contingency, convene another meeting of creditors as soon as practicable for the purpose of appointing, under subsection (1), another registered trustee to the office of trustee.

 (6) A creditor may file with the Court an objection to an appointment of a person under this section on the ground:

 (a) that the appointment was not made in good faith by a majority in value of the creditors voting;

 (b) that the person appointed is not fit to act as trustee; or

 (c) that his or her connexion with, or relation to, the bankrupt or his or her estate or a particular creditor is likely to make it difficult for him or her to act with impartiality in the interests of the creditors generally.

 (7) Where such an objection is filed, the Court may, if any of the grounds specified in subsection (6) is established, cancel the appointment and may appoint another registered trustee to be trustee in his or her place.

 (7A) If the Court cancels the appointment of a trustee and appoints another trustee, the creditor who filed the objection must give the Official Receiver written notice of the cancellation and appointment as soon as practicable.

 (8) Where the Court appoints a person as trustee under subsection (7), the Official Receiver must issue to the person a certificate of appointment.

 (9) The appointment of a trustee under subsection (7) takes effect from and including the date on which the Court makes the appointment or such later date as the Court directs.

158  Appointment of more than one trustee etc.

 (1) The creditors may, if they think fit, appoint 2 or more registered trustees jointly, or jointly and severally, to the office of trustee, and in either such case the property of the bankrupt vests in those registered trustees as joint tenants.

 (2) The creditors may, if they think fit, appoint registered trustees to act as trustees in succession in the event of one or more of the registered trustees appointed declining to act or ceasing for any reason to hold the office of trustee.

 (3) In this section, a reference to a registered trustee, in relation to the appointment of a trustee of the estate of a bankrupt, includes a reference to a registered trustee who is, by virtue of subsection 156A(3), the trustee of the estate of the bankrupt.

159  Vacancy in office of trustee

 (1) The creditors may, at a meeting of the creditors, fill any vacancy in the office of trustee.

 (2) An Official Receiver shall, on the requisition of a creditor, summon a meeting of creditors for the purpose of filling such a vacancy.

 (3) For the purposes of this section, an office of trustee shall be deemed to be vacant notwithstanding that it is for the time being filled by the Official Trustee by reason of the operation of section 160.

 (4) The provisions of sections 157 and 158 apply, so far as they are capable of application, to and in relation to the appointment of a new trustee under this section.

160  Official Trustee to be trustee when no registered trustee is trustee

  If at any time there is no registered trustee who is the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt, the Official Trustee shall, by force of this section, be the trustee of the estate.

161  Trustee may act in official name

 (1) The trustee of the estate of a bankrupt may sue and be sued by the prescribed official name and may, by that name, hold, dispose of or acquire property of every description, make contracts, enter into engagements binding on the trustee and his or her successors in office and do all other acts and things necessary or expedient to be done in the execution of his or her office.

 (2) For the purposes of subsection (1), the prescribed official name is “The Trustee (or Trustees) of the Property of (name of bankrupt), a Bankrupt”.

 (3) This section applies to proceedings under the Family Law Act 1975 in a corresponding way to the way in which it applies to a suit.

 (4) If:

 (a) a person (the first trustee) ceases to be the trustee of a bankrupt’s estate; and

 (b) proceedings to which the first trustee was a party were pending under the Family Law Act 1975 immediately before the cessation; and

 (c) another person (the second trustee) becomes the first trustee’s successor in office;

the second trustee is, by force of this subsection, substituted for the first trustee as a party to the proceedings.

161A  Registered trustee to notify InspectorGeneral of certain events

 (1) If a registered trustee is convicted of an offence involving fraud or dishonesty, the registered trustee must give the InspectorGeneral written notice of the conviction and the nature of the offence as soon as practicable.

 (2) If a registered trustee becomes a bankrupt, or enters as debtor into an insolvency administration, under the law of a foreign country, the registered trustee must give the InspectorGeneral written notice of the fact as soon as practicable.

Division 2Remuneration and costs

161B  Trustee’s remuneration—minimum entitlement

 (1) If the total remuneration payable to the trustee under section 162 would be less than the following amount (the statutory minimum):

 (a) $5,000;

 (b) if another amount is prescribed by the regulations for the purposes of this paragraph—that other amount;

the trustee is entitled to be paid, from the funds in the bankrupt’s estate, additional remuneration equal to the shortfall.

 (1A) The statutory minimum is increased by 8.4% if the trustee’s remuneration is consideration for a taxable supply (within the meaning of the A New Tax System (Goods and Services Tax) Act 1999).

162  Trustee’s remuneration—general

 (1) Subject to section 161B, the remuneration of the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt may be fixed, from time to time, by resolution of the creditors or, if the creditors so resolve, by the committee of inspection.

 (2) Where the remuneration of the trustee is to be, in whole or in part, a commission upon moneys received by the trustee, the trustee is entitled to commission upon all moneys received by the trustee (other than moneys received in the carrying on of a business of the bankrupt by him or her or under his or her supervision) at a rate not exceeding the rate prescribed by the regulations for the purposes of this subsection.

 (3) Where the trustee carries on a business of the bankrupt, or a business is carried on by the bankrupt under the supervision of the trustee, the trustee may be paid additional remuneration in the form either of a periodical payment based on, or a commission at the rate prescribed by the regulations for the purposes of this subsection on, the amount by which the estate is increased by reason of the carrying on of that business by him or her or under his or her supervision.

 (4) If the remuneration of the trustee is not fixed by the creditors or the committee of inspection, the trustee may, in the circumstances prescribed by the regulations, make an application, in accordance with the regulations, to the InspectorGeneral for the InspectorGeneral to decide the trustee’s remuneration.

 (4A) If an application is made to the InspectorGeneral under subsection (4), the InspectorGeneral must, by writing, decide the trustee’s remuneration, having regard to the matters prescribed by the regulations.

 (4B) The InspectorGeneral must give written notice of his or her decision under subsection (4A) to the trustee and to the bankrupt and creditors.

 (5A) The trustee must not withdraw funds from the bankrupt’s estate in respect of his or her remuneration at intervals of less than one week.

 (6) Where a trustee receives remuneration for his or her services, a payment in respect of the performance by another person of the ordinary duties that are required by this Act to be performed by the trustee shall not be allowed in his or her accounts unless the payment was authorized by resolution of the creditors or by the committee of inspection.

 (6A) The trustee must, in relation to the trustee’s remuneration, give such notices to the bankrupt and creditors as are required by the regulations.

 (7) This section does not apply in relation to the Official Trustee.

163  Remuneration of the Official Trustee

 (1) The Official Trustee is to be remunerated as determined by the Minister by legislative instrument.

 (2) An amount equal to each amount of remuneration received by the Official Trustee shall be paid to the Commonwealth.

Note: The remuneration may be in respect of work the Official Trustee does as trustee of the estate of a bankrupt or in respect of work done in any other situation under this Act (such as where the Official Trustee acts as a trustee as a result of a personal insolvency agreement).

163A  Costs and expenses of Official Receiver

 (1) If any Official Receiver exercises any power under this Act in relation to a bankrupt, the costs and expenses of the Official Receiver in connection with the exercise of the power are taken to be costs and expenses of the administration of the estate of the bankrupt.

 (2) If any Official Receiver exercises any power under this Act at the request of the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt, the trustee is to pay to the Official Receiver the fee determined by the Minister by legislative instrument.

 (3) Money received by the Official Receiver under subsection (2) is received on behalf of the Commonwealth.

164  Two or more trustees acting in succession

 (1) If one person acts as a trustee of the estate of a bankrupt after another person has acted as the trustee, their remuneration and expenses are to be divided between them, if necessary, on a basis:

 (a) that they agree on; and

 (b) that is endorsed by a resolution passed at a meeting of the creditors.

 (2) When a person (the earlier trustee) ceases to be the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt because another person (the later trustee) has become trustee, the earlier trustee must:

 (a) prepare an account of his or her receipts and payments (including remuneration and expenses) for the period that he or she was trustee; and

 (b) keep a copy of the account; and

 (c) give each creditor a copy of the account; and

 (d) give the later trustee a copy of the account and any other accounts the earlier trustee has received from a person who was the trustee before the earlier trustee.

 (3) The later trustee must allow an authorised employee to inspect at any reasonable time an account received from the earlier trustee.

165  Trustee not to accept extra benefit etc.

 (1) A trustee of the estate of a bankrupt shall not:

 (a) make an arrangement for receiving, or accept, from the bankrupt or any other person, in connexion with the bankruptcy, any gift, remuneration or pecuniary or other consideration or benefit beyond the remuneration fixed in accordance with this Act;

 (b) make an arrangement for giving up, or give up, a part of his or her remuneration to the bankrupt or any other person;

 (c) except as provided by this Act, directly or indirectly derive any profit or advantage from a transaction, sale or purchase for or on account of the estate or any gift, profit or advantage from a creditor; or

 (d) except with the leave of the Court, directly or indirectly become the purchaser of any part of the estate.

 (2) A trustee who contravenes subsection (1) is guilty of contempt of court.

 (3) This section has effect subject to section 161B.

166  Payment to third parties

  The trustee must, in relation to the payment for services provided by another person in relation to the administration of a bankrupt’s estate, give such notices to the bankrupt and creditors of the bankrupt as are required by the regulations.

167  Review of remuneration etc.

Trustee’s remuneration

 (1) The regulations may make provision for and in relation to:

 (a) the InspectorGeneral reviewing decisions of the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt to withdraw, or to propose to withdraw, funds from the estate for payment of the trustee’s remuneration; and

 (b) the bankrupt or a creditor of the bankrupt applying for the review.

Payment to third parties

 (2) The regulations may make provision for and in relation to:

 (a) the InspectorGeneral reviewing a bill of costs for services provided by a person (the third party) in relation to the administration of a bankrupt’s estate; and

 (b) the trustee of the estate applying for the review.

Content of regulations

 (3) The regulations may provide for:

 (a) the powers available to the InspectorGeneral in relation to the review; and

 (b) the trustee or the third party to provide information or documents to the InspectorGeneral; and

 (c) the decisions that may be made by the InspectorGeneral in relation to the review; and

 (d) the notification of decisions made by the InspectorGeneral.

Repayment—trustee

 (4) The regulations may provide that, if the InspectorGeneral is satisfied that a withdrawal by the trustee of funds from the estate of the bankrupt for payment of the trustee’s remuneration exceeds the amount of remuneration the trustee is entitled to under this Division, the InspectorGeneral may require the trustee to repay the excess to that estate.

 (5) The amount of the excess is recoverable by the InspectorGeneral, as a debt due to the estate of the bankrupt, by action against the trustee in a court of competent jurisdiction.

Appeal to the Court

 (6) The trustee, the bankrupt or a creditor of the bankrupt may appeal to the Court from a decision of the InspectorGeneral in relation to the review. In addition, if the review is of the kind mentioned in subsection (2), the third party may also appeal to the Court from a decision of the InspectorGeneral in relation to the review.

Interpretation

 (7) Subsections (3) and (4) do not limit subsections (1) and (2).

Division 3Accounts and audits

168  Trustee not to pay moneys into private account

 (1) A trustee of the estate of a bankrupt shall not pay into a private account any moneys received by him or her as trustee.

Penalty: 10 penalty units.

Note: See also section 277B (about infringement notices).

 (2) Subsection (1) is an offence of strict liability.

Note: For strict liability, see section 6.1 of the Criminal Code.

169  Trustee to pay moneys into bank account

 (1) A trustee of the estate of a bankrupt must pay all money received by him or her on account of the estate to the credit of a single interest bearing bank account that complies with the requirements (if any) specified in the regulations.

 (1A) The trustee must only pay into the account money received by the trustee on account of the estate of a bankrupt, but he or she may pay in money received on account of more than one estate.

 (1B) The trustee is entitled, in his or her personal capacity, to each payment of interest on the account, less an amount equal to the bank fees or charges (if any) paid or payable on the account during the period to which the interest relates.

 (1C) If, under subsection (1B), the trustee is only entitled to part of a payment of interest, the rest of that payment:

 (a) if the account contains money from only one estate—forms part of that estate; or

 (b) if the account contains money from more than one estate—forms part of those estates in proportion to the respective amounts of money held in the account on account of each of those estates.

 (1D) Interest on money in the bank account is not subject to taxation under a law of the Commonwealth, a State or a Territory except as provided in Part 2 of the Bankruptcy (Estate Charges) Act 1997.

 (2) If a trustee of the estate of a bankrupt keeps in his or her hands any money exceeding $50 received on behalf of the estate for a period exceeding 5 days (excluding any day on which the branch of the bank at which the estate bank account is kept is not open for business), then, unless he or she satisfies the Court that his or her reason for retaining the money was sufficient:

 (a) he or she is liable to pay interest at the rate of 20% per annum on the amount by which the amount so retained exceeds $50; and

 (b) the Court may remove him or her from his or her office of trustee.

 (3) Where a trustee is so removed from office, the Court may make such order with respect to his or her remuneration for his or her services as a trustee as the Court thinks proper and may further order that he or she pay expenses incurred by the creditors in consequence of his or her removal.

 (4) This section does not apply in relation to the Official Trustee.

 (5) In this section:

bank means an ADI or any other bank.

170  Trustee to give Official Receiver and bankrupt information etc.

 (1) The trustee of the estate of a bankrupt (not being the Official Trustee) shall give the Official Receiver such information, access to and facilities for inspecting the bankrupt’s books and generally such assistance as is necessary for enabling the Official Receiver to perform his or her duties.

 (2) The trustee shall, at the request of the bankrupt, furnish to the bankrupt information reasonably required by the bankrupt concerning his or her property or affairs.

170A  Annual return

 (1) If, during a financial year, the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt administered the estate, the trustee must, within the period of 35 days after the end of that year, give the InspectorGeneral a return, in the approved form, in relation to the administration of that estate during that year.

Penalty: 5 penalty units.

Note: See also section 277B (about infringement notices).

 (2) Subsection (1) is an offence of strict liability.

Note: For strict liability, see section 6.1 of the Criminal Code.

 (3) This section does not apply in relation to the Official Trustee.

171  Trustee to give and obtain receipts

 (1) The trustee of the estate of a bankrupt must issue a receipt in respect of a payment into the estate if asked to do so by the person making the payment.

 (2) The trustee must, wherever practicable, obtain a receipt for a payment made out of the estate.

173  Books to be kept by trustee

 (1) The trustee of the estate of a bankrupt shall keep such accounts and records as are necessary to exhibit a full and correct account of the administration of the estate and shall permit a creditor of the bankrupt to inspect, at all reasonable times, either personally or by an agent, the accounts and records relating to that estate.

Penalty: 5 penalty units.

Note: See also section 277B (about infringement notices).

 (2) Subsection (1) is an offence of strict liability.

Note: For strict liability, see section 6.1 of the Criminal Code.

174  Trustee’s books when trading

  Where the trustee carries on a business previously carried on by the bankrupt, he or she shall keep such accounts and records as are usual and proper in relation to the carrying on of a business of that kind and shall permit a creditor of the bankrupt to inspect, at all reasonable times, either personally or by an agent, those accounts and records.

175  Audit of trustee’s accounts

 (1) The InspectorGeneral may, on his or her own initiative or at the request of a creditor or the bankrupt, audit an account referred to in section 173 or cause it to be audited by an appropriate person.

 (5) For the purposes of an audit under this section, the trustee shall produce to the person carrying out the audit as and when required such books and information as that person requires.

Penalty: 5 penalty units.

Note: See also section 277B (about infringement notices).

 (5A) Subsection (5) is an offence of strict liability.

Note: For strict liability, see section 6.1 of the Criminal Code.

 (6) The cost of an audit under this section shall be borne by the estate.

176  Court may order trustee to make good loss caused by breach of duty

 (1) Where, on application by the InspectorGeneral or by a creditor who has or had a debt provable in the bankruptcy, the Court is satisfied that a person who is or has been a trustee of a bankrupt’s estate has been guilty (whether before or after the commencement of this section) of breach of duty in relation to the bankrupt’s estate or affairs, subsection (2) applies.

 (2) The Court may make any one or more of the following orders:

 (a) an order directing the person to make good any loss that the bankrupt’s estate has sustained because of the person’s breach of duty;

 (b) if the person is a registered trustee—an order directing the InspectorGeneral to cancel the person’s registration as a trustee;

 (c) any other order that the Court considers just and equitable in the circumstances.

Division 4Control over trustees

177  Control of creditors over trustees

 (1) Subject to this Act, in the administration of the estate of a bankrupt, the trustee shall have regard to any lawful directions given by resolution of the creditors at a meeting of the creditors or by the committee of inspection.

178  Appeal to Court against trustee’s decision etc.

 (1) If the bankrupt, a creditor or any other person is affected by an act, omission or decision of the trustee, he or she may apply to the Court, and the Court may make such order in the matter as it thinks just and equitable.

 (2) The application must be made not later than 60 days after the day on which the person became aware of the trustee’s act, omission or decision.

179  Control of trustees by the Court

 (1) The Court may, on the application of the InspectorGeneral, a creditor or the bankrupt, inquire into the conduct of a trustee in relation to a bankruptcy and may do one or both of the following:

 (a) remove the trustee from office; and

 (b) make such order as it thinks proper.

 (2) The InspectorGeneral or a creditor may at any time require a trustee to answer an inquiry in relation to the bankrupt’s estate or affairs.

Division 5Vacation of office

180  Resignation of trustee

  The Court may, subject to such terms and conditions as it thinks just, accept the resignation of a registered trustee from the office of trustee of an estate.

181  Removal of trustee

  The creditors may, by resolution, at a meeting of which not less than 7 days’ notice has been given, remove a registered trustee appointed by them, or a registered trustee who is, by virtue of subsection 156A(3), the trustee of the estate of the bankrupt concerned, and may at the same or a subsequent meeting appoint another registered trustee to be trustee in his or her place.

181A  Streamlined method for replacing trustee

 (1) The current trustee of a bankrupt’s estate may, with the written consent of another trustee (either a registered trustee or the Official Trustee), nominate the other trustee as the new trustee of the estate.

 (2) The current trustee must give notice of the nomination to all the creditors who would be entitled under section 64A to receive notice of a meeting of creditors.

 (3) The notice must:

 (a) specify a date (at least 10 days after the notice is given) from which it is proposed that the new trustee will become the trustee of the estate; and

 (b) state that any creditor may, by written notice to the trustee at least 2 days before the specified date, object to the nomination taking effect without there being a meeting of creditors.

 (4) If no creditor lodges a written notice of objection with the current trustee at least 2 days before the specified date, then the new trustee replaces the current trustee as trustee of the estate, on the date specified in the notice.

 (5) For the purposes of this Act, the new trustee is treated as having been appointed by the creditors.

 (6) A certificate signed by the new trustee stating any matter relating to the replacement of the former trustee under this section is prima facie evidence of the matter.

182  Bankruptcy of trustee etc.

 (1) If a registered trustee becomes bankrupt, becomes a party (as debtor) to a debt agreement or signs an authority under section 188, the trustee’s registration is cancelled.

 (4) Where a person registered as a trustee dies, the person (the affected person) administering the estate of the deceased person must, before the end of the period of 28 days beginning on the day the affected person started to administer the estate, give written notice of that death to the Official Receiver.

Penalty: 5 penalty units.

Note: See also section 277B (about infringement notices).

 (5) Subsection (4) is an offence of strict liability.

Note: For strict liability, see section 6.1 of the Criminal Code.

183  Release of registered trustee by the Court

 (1) A trustee may apply to the Court for an order of release from the trusteeship of an estate.

 (2) Where the Court is satisfied that the trustee:

 (a) has realized all the property of the bankrupt or so much of it as can be realized without unduly protracting the trusteeship or has distributed a final dividend;

 (b) has ceased to act by reason of the approval of a composition or scheme of arrangement under Division 6 of Part IV; or

 (c) has resigned or has been removed from office;

the Court may make the order sought.

 (3) In hearing the application, the Court must also consider any objection to the order sought that is made by the InspectorGeneral, the Official Receiver, a creditor or any other interested person.

 (4) An order of release under this section:

 (a) discharges the trustee from all liability in respect of any act done or default made by him or her in the administration of the estate of the bankrupt; and

 (b) if the trustee has not already resigned or been removed from office, operates to remove him or her from office.

 (5) An order of release under this section may be revoked by the Court on proof that it was obtained by fraud or by suppression or concealment of a material fact.

 (6) Where a trustee has died, the person administering the estate of the trustee may apply to the Court for an order releasing the trustee’s estate from any claims arising out of the trustee’s administration of an estate of which he or she was trustee and, upon such an application, the Court may make such order as it thinks proper in the circumstances.

 (7) This section does not apply in relation to the Official Trustee.

184  Release of registered trustee by operation of law after 7 years

 (1) If the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt:

 (a) is a registered trustee; and

 (b) has not already been released from being trustee of the estate under section 183;

the trustee is released at the end of 7 years from the date on which the Official Receiver entered in the National Personal Insolvency Index the fact that the administration of the estate was finalised.

 (3) The release of a trustee from the trusteeship of an estate by force of this section has the same effect as an order of release under section 183.

184A  Release of the Official Trustee

 (1) Where the Official Trustee becomes the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt upon the release of a registered trustee under section 183 or 184, the Official Trustee does not become personally liable, by reason of its so becoming the trustee, in respect of an act done, default made or liability incurred by a prior trustee.

 (2) The Official Trustee is released from being trustee of the estate of a bankrupt at the end of 7 years from the date on which the Official Receiver entered in the National Personal Insolvency Index the fact that the administration of the estate was finalised.

Part IXDebt agreements

Division 1Introduction

185  Definitions

  In this Part, unless the contrary intention appears:

accountfreezing notice means a notice under subsection 186LB(2).

affected creditor means:

 (a) in relation to a proposal to vary or terminate a debt agreement—a creditor who is a party (as creditor) to the agreement; or

 (b) in relation to a debt agreement proposal—a creditor who would be a party to the proposed debt agreement if it were made.

applicable deadline:

 (a) in relation to a debt agreement proposal, means:

 (i) if Official Receiver accepted the proposal for processing in December—the end of the 42nd day after the acceptance; or

 (ii) otherwise—the end of the 35th day after the Official Receiver accepted the proposal for processing; or

 (b) in relation to a proposal to vary a debt agreement, means:

 (i) if the proposal was given to the Official Receiver in December—the end of the 42nd day after the proposal was given; or

 (ii) otherwise—the end of the 35th day after the proposal was given to the Official Receiver; or

 (c) in relation to a proposal to terminate a debt agreement, means:

 (i) if the proposal was given to the Official Receiver in December—the end of the 21st day after the proposal was given; or

 (ii) otherwise—the end of the 14th day after the proposal was given to the Official Receiver.

bank means an ADI or any other bank.

basic eligibility test has the meaning given by section 186A.

debt agreement activities of a company means the activities of the company in connection with:

 (a) debt agreement proposals for which the company is to be the administrator; and

 (b) debt agreements for which the company is the administrator.

designated 6month arrears default has the meaning given by subsection 185LC(3).

externallyadministered body corporate has the same meaning as in the Corporations Act 2001.

frozen debt means a debt that:

 (a) is owed by a debtor who has given a debt agreement proposal that has been accepted by the Official Receiver for processing; and

 (b) would be a provable debt in relation to the proposed debt agreement if it were made;

but does not include a debt arising under a maintenance agreement or maintenance order (whenever entered into or made).

provable debt, in relation to a debt agreement, means a debt that would have been provable in bankruptcy if the debtor had become a bankrupt when the acceptance of the relevant debt agreement proposal for processing was recorded in the National Personal Insolvency Index.

registered debt agreement administrator means a person who is registered under section 186D as a debt agreement administrator.

working day means a day that is not:

 (a) a Saturday or a Sunday; or

 (b) a public holiday in any place in Australia.

Division 2Debt agreement proposals

185C  Giving a debt agreement proposal to the Official Receiver

Giving a debt agreement proposal

 (1) A debtor who is insolvent may give the Official Receiver a written proposal for a debt agreement.

Requirements for a debt agreement proposal

 (2) A debt agreement proposal must:

 (aa) be in the approved form; and

 (a) identify the debtor’s property that is to be dealt with under the agreement; and

 (b) specify how the property is to be dealt with; and

 (c) authorise a specified person (being the Official Trustee, a registered trustee or another person) to deal with the identified property in the way specified; and

 (d) provide that:

 (i) all provable debts in relation to the agreement rank equally; and

 (ii) if the total amount paid by the debtor under the agreement in respect of those provable debts is insufficient to meet those provable debts in full, those provable debts are to be paid proportionately; and

 (e) provide that a creditor is not entitled to receive, in respect of a provable debt, more than the amount of the debt; and

 (f) provide that the amount of a provable debt in relation to the agreement is to be ascertained as at the time when the acceptance of the proposal for processing is recorded on the National Personal Insolvency Index; and

 (g) if a creditor is a secured creditor—provide that, if the creditor does not realise the creditor’s security while the agreement is in force, the creditor is taken, for the purposes of working out the amount payable to the creditor under the agreement, to be a creditor only to the extent (if any) by which the amount of the provable debt exceeds the value of the creditor’s security; and

 (h) if a creditor is a secured creditor—provide that, if the creditor realises the creditor’s security while the agreement is in force, the creditor is taken, for the purposes of working out the amount payable to the creditor under the agreement, to be a creditor only to the extent of any balance due to the creditor after deducting the net amount realised; and

 (i) be signed by the debtor; and

 (j) specify the date on which the debtor signed the proposal.

 (2A) A debt agreement proposal must not provide for the transfer of property (other than money) to a creditor.

 (2B) A debt agreement proposal given to the Official Receiver must be accompanied by an explanatory statement in the approved form containing such information as the form requires.

 (2C) The debtor’s subsection (2B) statement may be set out in the same document as the debtor’s debt agreement proposal.

 (2D) If the person specified under paragraph (2)(c) is not the debtor, the debt agreement proposal given to the Official Receiver must be accompanied by a certificate signed by the person to the effect that:

 (a) the person consents to being specified under that paragraph; and

 (b) the person has given the debtor the information prescribed by the regulations; and

 (c) having regard to:

 (i) the circumstances in existence at the time when the debtor’s statement of affairs was signed by the debtor; and

 (ii) any other relevant matters;

  the person has reasonable grounds to believe that the debtor is likely to be able to discharge the obligations created by the agreement as and when they fall due; and

 (d) the person has reasonable grounds to believe that all information required to be set out in the debtor’s statement of affairs has been set out in that statement; and

 (e) the person has reasonable grounds to believe that all information required to be set out in the debtor’s subsection (2B) statement has been set out in that statement.

 (2E) A debt agreement proposal must not be given jointly by 2 or more debtors.

 (2F) If a debt agreement proposal is expressed to be subject to the occurrence of a specified event within a specified period after the debt agreement proposal is accepted, the specified period must not be longer than 7 days.

What a debt agreement proposal may include

 (3) A debt agreement proposal may provide for any matter relating to the debtor’s financial affairs.

If the person specified under paragraph (2)(c) is not the Official Trustee, the proposal may also provide for the remuneration of that person.

Remuneration of administrator

 (3A) If a debt agreement proposal provides for the remuneration of the person specified under paragraph (2)(c), the debt agreement proposal must:

 (a) provide that the total remuneration of the person specified under paragraph (2)(c) is an amount equal to a specified percentage (the overall remuneration percentage) of the total amount payable by the debtor under the agreement in respect of provable debts; and

 (b) provide that, if the debtor pays an amount (the individual debt repayment amount) under the agreement in respect of those provable debts:

 (i) the debtor must also pay to the person specified under paragraph (2)(c) an amount (the individual remuneration amount) ascertained in accordance with the agreement; and

 (ii) the individual remuneration amount must not exceed the overall remuneration percentage of the individual debt repayment amount; and

 (iii) the person specified under paragraph (2)(c) must apply the individual remuneration amount towards the discharge of the person’s entitlement to remuneration under the agreement.

When a debtor cannot give a debt agreement proposal

 (4) A debtor cannot give the Official Receiver a debt agreement proposal at a particular time (the proposal time) if:

 (a) at any time in the 10 years immediately before the proposal time the debtor:

 (i) has been a bankrupt; or

 (ii) has been a party (as debtor) to a debt agreement; or

 (iii) has given an authority under section 188; or

 (b) at the proposal time the debtor’s unsecured debts total more than:

 (i) the threshold amount; or

 (ii) if the regulations prescribe a greater amount for this purpose—the amount prescribed; or

 (c) at the proposal time, the value of the debtor’s property that would be divisible among creditors if the debtor were bankrupt is more than the threshold amount; or

 (d) the debtor’s after tax income (see subsection (5)) in the year beginning at the proposal time is likely to exceed threequarters of the threshold amount.

 (4A) Subparagraph (4)(a)(i) does not apply in relation to a bankruptcy that has been annulled under section 153B.

 (5) In this section:

after tax income, in relation to a debtor and a year, means the amount that is likely to be the taxable income of the debtor for the year less the income tax and the medicare levy imposed on that taxable income (worked out treating the year as a year of income if it is not actually a year of income).

Note: For the purposes of this definition, taxable income, income tax and year of income have the same meanings as in the Income Tax Assessment Act 1936, and medicare levy means the levy imposed by the Medicare Levy Act 1986.

threshold amount, in relation to a particular time, means 7 times the amount that, at that time, is specified in column 3, item 2, Table B, point 1064B1, Pension Rate Calculator A, in the Social Security Act 1991.

unsecured debt includes the amount by which the value of a debt exceeds the value of a security given for the debt.

185D  Statement of affairs to be given with a debt agreement proposal

 (1) A debtor who gives the Official Receiver a debt agreement proposal must give the Official Receiver a statement of the debtor’s affairs with the proposal.

Note: Section 6A sets out requirements for statements of affairs.

 (2) The debtor or an affected creditor may, without fee and either personally or by an agent:

 (a) inspect the statement of affairs; and

 (b) obtain a copy of, or make extracts from, the statement of affairs.

 (3) If the approved form for a statement of affairs indicates that particular information in the statement will not be made available to the public, the Official Receiver must ensure that the information is not made available under this section to a person other than the debtor (or an agent of the debtor).

 (4) The Official Receiver may refuse to allow a person access under this section to particular information in a debtor’s statement of affairs on the ground that access to that information would jeopardise, or be likely to jeopardise, the safety of any person.

 (5) The debtor’s statement of affairs may be set out in the same document as the debtor’s subsection 185C(2B) statement.

 (6) This section does not limit subsection 185C(2B).

185E  Accepting a debt agreement proposal for processing

 (1) If the person specified under paragraph 185C(2)(c) is the debtor, the Official Receiver must, before accepting the debt agreement proposal for processing, give the debtor the information prescribed by the regulations.

 (2) If a debtor gives the Official Receiver a debt agreement proposal, the Official Receiver may accept the proposal for processing if:

 (a) the Official Receiver is satisfied that subsections 185C(2), (2A), (2B), (2E) and (4) have been complied with; and

 (b) if the person specified under paragraph 185C(2)(c) is not the debtor—the Official Receiver is satisfied that subsection 185C(2D) has been complied with; and

 (c) if the debt agreement proposal is expressed to be subject to the occurrence of a specified event within a specified period after the debt agreement proposal is accepted—the Official Receiver is satisfied that subsection 185C(2F) has been complied with; and

 (d) if the proposal provides for the remuneration of the person specified under paragraph 185C(2)(c)—the Official Receiver is satisfied that subsection 185C(3A) has been complied with; and

 (e) the Official Receiver is satisfied that the statement of affairs accompanying the proposal is in order.

 (2AA) The Official Receiver must not accept a debt agreement proposal for processing unless the proposal was given to the Official Receiver within 14 days after the day on which the debtor signed the proposal.

 (2A) If the person specified under paragraph 185C(2)(c) is not:

 (a) a registered debt agreement administrator; or

 (b) a registered trustee;

the Official Receiver must not accept the debt agreement proposal unless the Official Receiver is satisfied that the person passes the basic eligibility test.

 (2B) If the person specified under paragraph 185C(2)(c) is not the debtor, the Official Receiver must not accept the debt agreement proposal for processing unless:

 (a) the person is a registered debt agreement administrator; or

 (b) the person is a registered trustee; or

 (c) both:

 (i) the person is the administrator of not more than 5 debt agreements; and

 (ii) no declaration is in force in relation to the person under section 186M.

 (2C) If:

 (a) the person specified under paragraph 185C(2)(c) in relation to a debt agreement proposal (the first debt agreement proposal) is not:

 (i) a registered debt agreement administrator; or

 (ii) a registered trustee; and

 (b) the person is specified under that paragraph in relation to one or more other debt agreement proposals;

the Official Receiver must not accept the first debt agreement proposal for processing if the person would become the administrator of more than 5 debt agreements if it were assumed that:

 (c) the first debt agreement proposal is accepted; and

 (d) those other debt agreement proposals are accepted.

 (3) The Official Receiver must not accept a debt agreement proposal for processing if the Official Receiver thinks that the creditors’ interests would be better served by not accepting the proposal for processing.

 (4) A debtor who gives the Official Receiver a debt agreement proposal may apply to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal for review of the Official Receiver’s decision on whether to accept the proposal for processing.

 (5) If the Official Receiver accepts a debt agreement proposal for processing, the Official Receiver must process the proposal in accordance with section 185EA.

185EA  Processing of debt agreement proposal

Processing of proposals by the Official Receiver

 (1) If the Official Receiver is required by subsection 185E(5) to process a debt agreement proposal, the Official Receiver must write to each of the affected creditors who is known to the Official Receiver, asking each affected creditor to indicate whether the proposal should be accepted.

Writing to creditors to deal with a proposal

 (2) When writing to each affected creditor under subsection (1) about a debt agreement proposal, the Official Receiver must:

 (a) provide the creditor with a copy of:

 (i) the debt agreement proposal; and

 (ii) the debtor’s subsection 185C(2B) statement; and

 (b) ask the creditor to give a written statement setting out whether or not the debt agreement proposal should be accepted; and

 (c) inform the creditor of the person to whom the statement should be given and of the need to give the statement before the applicable deadline.             

 (3) The paragraph (2)(b) statement must be in the approved form.

185EB  Inspection of creditor’s statement

  If an affected creditor gives a paragraph 185EA(2)(b) statement:

 (a) the debtor; or

 (b) any other affected creditor;

may, without fee and either personally or by an agent:

 (c) inspect the statement; and

 (d) obtain a copy of, or make extracts from, the statement.

185EC  Acceptance of a debt agreement proposal

Acceptance in writing

 (1) A debt agreement proposal is accepted if:

 (a) the Official Receiver writes to affected creditors of a debtor under section 185EA; and

 (b) a majority in value of the creditors who reply before the applicable deadline state that the proposal should be accepted.

Timing of acceptance

 (2) A debt agreement proposal that is accepted under subsection (1) is taken to be accepted at the applicable deadline.

Value of a creditor

 (3) In assessing, for the purposes of paragraph (1)(b), the value of a creditor who is a related entity of the debtor, any debt that was assigned to the creditor is taken to have a value equal to the value of the consideration that the creditor gave for the assignment.

 (4) For the purposes of paragraph (1)(b), the value of a creditor is to be assessed as at the time when the acceptance of the debt agreement proposal for processing was recorded on the National Personal Insolvency Index.

 (5) For the purposes of paragraph (1)(b), a secured creditor is taken to be a creditor only to the extent (if any) by which the amount of the debt owing to the creditor exceeds the value of the creditor’s security.

185ED  Cancellation of acceptance of debt agreement proposal for processing

Scope

 (1) This section applies if:

 (a) the Official Receiver has accepted a debt agreement proposal for processing; and

 (b) the applicable deadline has not arrived.

Cancellation

 (2) The Official Receiver may cancel the acceptance of the debt agreement proposal for processing if:

 (a) the Official Receiver becomes aware that one or more affected creditors were not disclosed in the debtor’s statement of affairs; or

 (b) the Official Receiver becomes aware that:

 (i) the debtor’s statement of affairs; or

 (ii) the debtor’s subsection 185C(2B) statement;

  was deficient because it omitted a material particular or because it was incorrect in a material particular; or

 (c) the Official Receiver becomes aware of a material change in the debtor’s circumstances that:

 (i) was not foreshadowed in the debtor’s subsection 185C(2B) statement or the debtor’s statement of affairs; and

 (ii) in the opinion of the Official Receiver, is capable of affecting an affected creditor’s decision whether or not to accept the proposal; or

 (d) the Official Receiver becomes aware of a matter that, if it had been known to the Official Receiver at the time of acceptance of the debt agreement proposal for processing, would have resulted in a refusal of acceptance on the grounds that subsection 185C(4) had not been complied with.

Notification of cancellation

 (3) If the Official Receiver cancels the acceptance of a debt agreement proposal for processing, the Official Receiver must give written notice of the cancellation, and the reasons for it, to:

 (a) the debtor; and

 (b) affected creditors who are known to the Official Receiver.

Review

 (4) If the Official Receiver decides to cancel the acceptance of a debt agreement proposal for processing, the debtor may apply to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal for review of the decision.

185F  Effect of accepting a debt agreement proposal for processing

 (1) After acceptance of a debt agreement proposal for processing is recorded in the National Personal Insolvency Index:

 (a) a creditor cannot apply for enforcement of, or enforce, a remedy against the debtor’s person or property in respect of a frozen debt; and

 (b) a sheriff must not take action, or further action, to execute, or sell property under, any process issued by a court to enforce payment of a frozen debt owed by the debtor; and

 (c) a person who is entitled under a law of the Commonwealth, or of a State or Territory of the Commonwealth, to retain or deduct money from money that is or will be owing or payable to the debtor must not retain or deduct money;

until any of the following events occurs:

 (d) in a case where:

 (i) the applicable deadline arrives; and

 (ii) the proposal has not been accepted;

  the arrival of the applicable deadline;

 (e) in a case where:

 (i) the proposal is accepted; and

 (ii) the proposal is not expressed to be subject to the occurrence of a specified event within a specified period after the proposal is accepted; and

 (iii) details of the debt agreement are entered on the National Personal Insolvency Index;

  the entry of those details on the National Personal Insolvency Index;

 (f) in the case where:

 (i) the proposal is accepted; and

 (ii) the proposal is expressed to be subject to the occurrence of a specified event within a specified period after the proposal is accepted; and

 (iii) that event occurs within that period; and

 (iv) details of the debt agreement are entered on the National Personal Insolvency Index;

  the entry of those details on the National Personal Insolvency Index;

 (g) in the case where:

 (i) the proposal is accepted; and

 (ii) the proposal is expressed to be subject to the occurrence of a specified event within a specified period after the proposal is accepted; and

 (iii) that event does not occur within that period;

  the end of that period;

 (h) in a case where the Official Receiver cancels the acceptance of the proposal for processing—the cancellation of the acceptance;

 (i) in a case where the proposal lapses—the lapse of the proposal.

 (2) Subsection (1) does not prevent a creditor from:

 (a) starting a legal proceeding in respect of a frozen debt; or

 (b) taking a fresh step in such a proceeding (except to enforce a judgment).

 (3) Subsection (1) does not prevent a creditor from applying for enforcement of, or enforcing, a remedy against the debtor’s person or property in respect of a liability under a proceeds of crime law.

185G  Lapsing of a debt agreement proposal

  A debt agreement proposal lapses if:

 (b) the Official Receiver accepts the proposal for processing and writes to affected creditors about it, but no replies are received before the applicable deadline; or

 (c) the debtor dies after giving the proposal to the Official Receiver but before a debt agreement is made on the basis of the proposal.

Note: Section 185H deals with the making of a debt agreement.

Division 3Making a debt agreement

185H  Making a debt agreement

 (1) This section sets out the 2 situations in which a debt agreement is made.

Unconditional debt agreement proposals

 (2) If:

 (a) a debt agreement proposal is accepted; and

 (b) the proposal is not expressed to be subject to the occurrence of a specified event within a specified period after the proposal is accepted;

then:

 (c) the Official Receiver must enter details of the debt agreement concerned on the National Personal Insolvency Index; and

 (d) the debt agreement is made in the terms of the proposal when those details are so entered.

Note: Section 185EC explains how a proposal is accepted.

Conditional debt agreement proposals

 (3) If:

 (a) a debt agreement proposal is accepted; and

 (b) the proposal is expressed to be subject to the occurrence of a specified event within a specified period after the proposal is accepted; and

 (c) the event occurs within that period;

then:

 (d) the Official Receiver must enter details of the debt agreement concerned on the National Personal Insolvency Index; and

 (e) the debt agreement is made in the terms of the proposal when those details are so entered.

Note: Section 185EC explains how a proposal is accepted.

185I  Parties to a debt agreement

  The parties to a debt agreement are:

 (a) the debtor; and

 (b) the creditors to whom the debtor owed provable debts.

185K  Prevention of proceedings relating to debts

 (1) While a debt agreement is in force and details of it are entered on the National Personal Insolvency Index, a creditor cannot:

 (a) present a creditor’s petition against the debtor; or

 (b) proceed further with a creditor’s petition that was presented against the debtor before details of the debt agreement were entered in the Index; or

 (c) enforce a remedy against the debtor’s person or property, or start or take a fresh step in legal proceedings, in respect of a provable debt.

 (2) Paragraph (1)(c) does not prevent a creditor from enforcing a remedy against the debtor or the debtor’s property for a liability under one or more of the following:

 (a) a maintenance agreement;

 (b) a maintenance order;

 (c) a proceeds of crime law.

 (3) While a debt agreement is in force and details of it are entered on the National Personal Insolvency Index:

 (a) a sheriff must not take action, or further action, to execute, or sell property under, any process issued by a court to enforce payment of a provable debt owed by the debtor; and

 (b) a person who is entitled under a law of the Commonwealth, or of a State or Territory, to retain or deduct money from money that is or will be owing or payable to the debtor must not retain or deduct money.

Division 3ADuties of administrators

185LA  Duties of an administrator—general

  The duties of an administrator of a debt agreement include:

 (a) dealing with the debtor’s property in the manner specified in the debt agreement; and

 (b) giving information about the administration of the debt agreement to the debtor if the debtor makes a reasonable request for the information; and

 (c) giving information about the administration of the debt agreement to a creditor who:

 (i) is a party to the debt agreement; and

 (ii) makes a reasonable request for the information.

185LB  Administrator to notify creditors of a 3month arrears default by a debtor

 (1) If a 3month arrears default by a debtor occurs at a particular time in relation to a debt agreement, the administrator of the debt agreement must notify, in writing, each creditor who is a party to the debt agreement of that occurrence within 10 working days of that occurrence.

 (2) The administrator of a debt agreement is not required to give a notification under subsection (1) in respect of a 3month arrears default (the first default) if:

 (a) one or more other 3month arrears defaults by the debtor have occurred in relation to the debt agreement; and

 (b) the 3month period to which the first default relates overlaps with the 3month period to which any of those other 3month arrears defaults relate; and

 (c) a notification under subsection (1) has already been given in respect of any of those other 3month arrears defaults.

 (3) For the purposes of this section, a 3month arrears default by a debtor occurs at a particular time (the test time) in relation to a debt agreement if:

 (a) at the beginning of the 3month period ending immediately before the test time, one or more payments in respect of provable debts became due and payable by the debtor under the debt agreement; and

 (b) throughout that 3month period, the debtor was in arrears in respect of any or all of those payments.

185LC  Administrator to notify Official Receiver of a designated 6month arrears default by a debtor

 (1) If a designated 6month arrears default by a debtor occurs at particular time in relation to a debt agreement, the administrator of the debt agreement must notify, in writing, the Official Receiver of that occurrence within 10 working days of that occurrence.

 (2) The administrator of a debt agreement is not required to give a notification under subsection (1) in relation to the debt agreement if the administrator has already given such a notification in relation to the debt agreement.

 (3) For the purposes of this Part, a designated 6month arrears default by a debtor occurs at a particular time (the test time) in relation to a debt agreement if:

 (a) both of the following apply:

 (i) before the test time, one or more payments in respect of provable debts became due and payable by the debtor under the debt agreement;

 (ii) at no time during the 6month period ending immediately before the test time were any obligations in respect of those payments discharged; or

 (b) both of the following apply:

 (i) at the test time, the obligations created by the debt agreement have not been discharged;

 (ii) the last of those obligations should have been discharged at a time 6 months before the test time.

185LD  Administrator to maintain separate bank account

 (1) A person who is:

 (a) either:

 (i) a registered debt agreement administrator; or

 (ii) a registered trustee; and

 (b) the administrator of one or more debt agreements;

must pay all money received by the person from debtors under those debt agreements to the credit of a single interestbearing bank account that:

 (c) bears:

 (i) the person’s own name; and

 (ii) the words “—Debt Agreement Administration Trust Account”; and

 (d) complies with such other requirements (if any) as are specified in the regulations.

 (2) The person must only pay into the account money received by the person from debtors under debt agreements.

 (3) The person is entitled, in his or her personal capacity, to each payment of interest on the account, less an amount equal to the bank fees or charges (if any) paid or payable on the account during the period to which the interest relates.

 (4) Interest on money in the account is not subject to taxation under a law of the Commonwealth, a State or a Territory except as provided in Part 2 of the Bankruptcy (Estate Charges) Act 1997.

185LE  Administrator to keep accounts etc.

 (1) An administrator of a debt agreement must:

 (a) keep such accounts, books and records as are necessary to give a full and correct account of the administration of the debt agreement; and

 (b) if required to do so by the InspectorGeneral—make those accounts and records available for inspection by the InspectorGeneral; and

 (c) if required to do so by the InspectorGeneral—answer any inquiries about the debt agreement; and

 (d) cooperate with any inquiry or investigation made by the InspectorGeneral under paragraph 12(1)(bb).

 (2) If an administrator of one or more debt agreements is to be remunerated under those debt agreements, the administrator must:

 (a) maintain a separate record of:

 (i) money received by the administrator from the debtors in relation to those debt agreements; and

 (ii) payments made by the administrator in relation to those debt agreements; and

 (iii) the balance of money held by the administrator in relation to those debt agreements; and

 (b) if the administrator maintains an account under subsection 185LD(1)—at least once every 45 days, reconcile the balance held in the subsection 185LD(1) account with the corresponding record maintained under paragraph (a).

185LEA  Annual return

 (1) If, during a financial year, an administrator of a debt agreement administered the agreement, the administrator must, within the period of 35 days after the end of that year, give the InspectorGeneral a return, in the approved form, in relation to the administration of that agreement during that year.

Penalty: 5 penalty units.

Note: See also section 277B (about infringement notices).

 (2) Subsection (1) is an offence of strict liability.

Note: For strict liability, see section 6.1 of the Criminal Code.

185LF  Succession of administrator

Scope

 (1) This section applies if:

 (a) a person (the earlier administrator) ceases to be the administrator of a debt agreement; and

 (b) another person (the later administrator) becomes the administrator of the debt agreement in place of the earlier administrator.

Duty

 (2) The earlier administrator must:

 (a) prepare an account of:

 (i) money received by the earlier administrator from the debtor in relation to the debt agreement; and

 (ii) payments made by the earlier administrator in relation to the debt agreement; and

 (b) keep a copy of the account; and

 (c) give the later administrator:

 (i) a copy of the account; and

 (ii) a copy of any other accounts the earlier administrator received from a person who was the administrator of the debt agreement before the earlier administrator.

185LG  Duties of an administrator in relation to debt agreements—extended meaning

 (1) For the purposes of this Act, a duty of an administrator under this Act is taken to be a duty of an administrator in relation to a debt agreement, even if the duty does not relate to a particular debt agreement.

 (2) If a person signs a certificate under subsection 185C(2D) in relation to a debt agreement proposal:

 (a) the person must ensure that the certificate is correct; and

 (b) for the purposes of this Act, the requirement set out in paragraph (a) is taken to be a duty of an administrator in relation to a debt agreement.

 (3) For the purposes of this Act, a requirement set out in subsection 185LF(2) or 185N(5) is taken to be a duty of an administrator in relation to a debt agreement.

Division 4Varying a debt agreement

185M  Varying a debt agreement

Proposing to vary a debt agreement

 (1) A debtor or creditor who is a party to a debt agreement may give the Official Receiver a written proposal to vary the agreement.

 (1A) The proposal must be in the approved form.

 (1B) The proposal must be accompanied by an explanatory statement in the approved form containing such information as the form requires.

 (1C) The subsection (1B) statement may be set out in the same document as the proposal.

Processing a proposal to vary a debt agreement

 (2) The Official Receiver must process the proposal in accordance with section 185MA if the Official Receiver is satisfied that subsections (1A) and (1B) of this section have been complied with.

Varying the agreement

 (3) If the proposal is accepted, the agreement is varied in the way set out in the proposal.

Note: Section 185MC explains how a proposal is accepted.

185MA  Procedures for dealing with proposals to vary debt agreements

Processing of proposals by the Official Receiver

 (1) If the Official Receiver is required by subsection 185M(2) to process a proposal to vary a debt agreement, the Official Receiver must write to each of the affected creditors who is known to the Official Receiver, asking each affected creditor to indicate whether the proposal should be accepted.

Writing to creditors to deal with a proposal

 (2) When writing to each affected creditor under subsection (1) about a proposal to vary a debt agreement, the Official Receiver must:

 (a) provide the creditor with a copy of:

 (i) the proposal; and

 (ii) the relevant subsection 185M(1B) statement; and

 (b) ask the creditor to give a written statement setting out whether or not the proposal should be accepted; and

 (c) inform the creditor of the person to whom the statement should be given and of the need to give the statement before the applicable deadline.

 (3) The paragraph (2)(b) statement must be in the approved form.

185MB  Inspection of creditor’s statement

  If an affected creditor gives a paragraph 185MA(2)(b) statement:

 (a) the debtor; or

 (b) any other affected creditor;

may, without fee and either personally or by an agent:

 (c) inspect the statement; and

 (d) obtain a copy of, or make extracts from, the statement.

185MC  Acceptance of a proposal to vary a debt agreement

Acceptance in writing

 (1) A proposal to vary a debt agreement is accepted if:

 (a) the Official Receiver writes to affected creditors of a debtor under section 185MA; and

 (b) a majority in value of the creditors who reply before the applicable deadline state that the proposal should be accepted.

Timing of acceptance

 (2) A proposal that is accepted under subsection (1) is taken to be accepted at the applicable deadline.

Value of a creditor

 (3) In assessing, for the purposes of paragraph (1)(b), the value of a creditor who is a related entity of the debtor, any debt that was assigned to the creditor is taken to have a value equal to the value of the consideration that the creditor gave for the assignment.

 (4) For the purposes of paragraph (1)(b), the value of a creditor is to be assessed as at the time when the acceptance of the relevant debt agreement proposal for processing was recorded on the National Personal Insolvency Index.

 (5) For the purposes of paragraph (1)(b), a secured creditor is taken to be a creditor only to the extent (if any) by which the amount of the debt owing to the creditor exceeds the value of the creditor’s security.

185MD  Withdrawal of proposal to vary a debt agreement

Scope

 (1) This section applies if:

 (a) a proposal to vary a debt agreement is given under section 185M; and

 (b) the applicable deadline has not arrived; and

 (c) the proposal has not been accepted.

Withdrawal of proposal

 (2) If:

 (a) the Official Receiver becomes aware that the relevant subsection 185M(1B) statement was deficient because it omitted a material particular or because it was incorrect in a material particular; or

 (b) the Official Receiver becomes aware of a material change in circumstances that:

 (i) was not foreshadowed in the relevant subsection 185M(1B) statement; and

 (ii) in the opinion of the Official Receiver, is capable of affecting an affected creditor’s decision whether or not to accept the proposal;

the Official Receiver may declare in writing that the proposal is withdrawn.

Notification of withdrawal

 (3) If the Official Receiver makes a declaration under subsection (2), the Official Receiver must give written notice of the declaration, and the reasons for it, to:

 (a) the debtor; and

 (b) affected creditors who are known to the Official Receiver.

Review

 (4) If the Official Receiver decides to make a declaration under subsection (2), the debtor or an affected creditor may apply to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal for review of the decision.

Division 5Ending a debt agreement

185N  End of debt agreement on discharge of obligations under agreement

Time of end of debt agreement

 (1) A debt agreement ends when all the obligations that it created have been discharged, unless the agreement has been terminated earlier under section 185P, 185Q, 185QA or 185R.

Keeping surplus property that was subject to an agreement

 (2) When a debt agreement ends under subsection (1), the debtor is entitled to any property that was subject to the debt agreement but that was not required by the agreement to be distributed to creditors.

Example: Rhea entered into a debt agreement that required her to sell her boat and car and to pay her creditors $15,000 from the proceeds. The debt agreement ended when she sold her boat and car for $16,000 and paid her creditors $15,000. She may keep the remaining $1,000 received from the sale.

Certificate of the end of a debt agreement

 (3) If a debt agreement ends under subsection (1), the Official Receiver must give the debtor a certificate to that effect.

Evidentiary value of certificate

 (4) The certificate is prima facie evidence of the facts stated in it.

Notification of end of debt agreement

 (5) If a debt agreement ends under subsection (1), the person who was the administrator of the agreement immediately before it ended must, within 5 working days after the end of the agreement, notify the Official Receiver, in writing, of the end of the agreement.

 (6) A notification under subsection (5) must be in the approved form.

185NA  Release of debtor from debts

Time and effect of release

 (1) When a debt agreement ends under subsection 185N(1), the debtor is released from provable debts from which the debtor would have been released if the debtor had been discharged from bankruptcy immediately after the acceptance of the relevant debt agreement proposal for processing was recorded on the National Personal Insolvency Index.

Limits on release

 (2) The release ceases to operate if the debt agreement is declared void by the Court.

 (3) The release does not:

 (a) release anyone else from a debt that he or she owes jointly with the debtor; or

 (b) release a guarantor from the guarantee that the guarantor gave for the debtor’s debt.

185P  Terminating a debt agreement by accepting a proposal

Proposing to terminate a debt agreement

 (1) The debtor (or the debtor’s personal representative if the debtor has died) or a creditor who is bound by a debt agreement may give the Official Receiver a written proposal to terminate the agreement.

 (1A) The proposal must be in the approved form.

 (1B) A proposal must be accompanied by an explanatory statement in the approved form containing such information as the form requires.

 (1C) The subsection (1B) statement may be set out in the same document as the proposal.

Processing a proposal to terminate debt agreement

 (2) The Official Receiver must process the proposal in accordance with section 185PA if the Official Receiver is satisfied that subsections (1A) and (1B) of this section have been complied with.

Termination of the debt agreement when the proposal is accepted

 (3) The debt agreement is terminated when the proposal is accepted.

Note: Section 185PC explains how a proposal is accepted.

185PA  Procedures for dealing with proposals to terminate debt agreements

Processing of proposals by the Official Receiver

 (1) If the Official Receiver is required by subsection 185P(2) to process a proposal to terminate a debt agreement, the Official Receiver must write to each of the affected creditors who is known to the Official Receiver, asking each affected creditor to indicate whether the proposal should be accepted.

Writing to creditors to deal with a proposal

 (2) When writing to each affected creditor under subsection (1) about a proposal to terminate a debt agreement, the Official Receiver must:

 (a) provide the creditor with a copy of:

 (i) the proposal; and

 (ii) the relevant subsection 185P(1B) statement; and

 (b) ask the creditor to give a written statement setting out whether or not the proposal should be accepted; and

 (c) inform the creditor of the person to whom the statement should be given and of the need to give the statement before the applicable deadline.

 (3) The paragraph (2)(b) statement must be in the approved form.

185PB  Inspection of creditor’s statement

  If an affected creditor gives a paragraph 185PA(2)(b) statement:

 (a) the debtor; or

 (b) any other affected creditor;

may, without fee and either personally or by an agent:

 (c) inspect the statement; and

 (d) obtain a copy of, or make extracts from, the statement.

185PC  Acceptance of a proposal to terminate a debt agreement

Acceptance in writing

 (1) A proposal to terminate a debt agreement is accepted if:

 (a) the Official Receiver writes to affected creditors of a debtor under section 185PA; and

 (b) a majority in value of the creditors who reply before the applicable deadline state that the proposal should be accepted.

Timing of acceptance

 (2) A proposal that is accepted under subsection (1) is taken to be accepted at the applicable deadline.

Value of a creditor

 (3) In assessing, for the purposes of paragraph (1)(b), the value of a creditor who is a related entity of the debtor, any debt that was assigned to the creditor is taken to have a value equal to the value of the consideration that the creditor gave for the assignment.

 (4) For the purposes of paragraph (1)(b), the value of a creditor is to be assessed as at the time when the acceptance of the relevant debt agreement proposal for processing was recorded on the National Personal Insolvency Index.

 (5) For the purposes of paragraph (1)(b), a secured creditor is taken to be a creditor only to the extent (if any) by which the amount of the debt owing to the creditor exceeds the value of the creditor’s security.

185PD  Withdrawal of proposal to terminate a debt agreement

Scope

 (1) This section applies if:

 (a) a proposal to terminate a debt agreement is given under section 185P; and

 (b) the applicable deadline has not arrived; and

 (c) the proposal has not been accepted.

Withdrawal of proposal

 (2) If:

 (a) the Official Receiver becomes aware that the relevant subsection 185P(1B) statement was deficient because it omitted a material particular or because it was incorrect in a material particular; or

 (b) the Official Receiver becomes aware of a material change in circumstances that:

 (i) was not foreshadowed in the relevant subsection 185P(1B) statement; and

 (ii) in the opinion of the Official Receiver, is capable of affecting an affected creditor’s decision whether or not to accept the proposal;

the Official Receiver may declare in writing that the proposal is withdrawn.

Notification of withdrawal

 (3) If the Official Receiver makes a declaration under subsection (2), the Official Receiver must give written notice of the declaration, and the reasons for it, to:

 (a) the debtor; and

 (b) affected creditors who are known to the Official Receiver.

Review

 (4) If the Official Receiver decides to make a declaration under subsection (2), the debtor or an affected creditor may apply to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal for review of the decision.

185Q  Terminating a debt agreement by order of the Court

Applying for an order

 (1) Any of the following persons may apply to the Court for an order terminating a debt agreement:

 (a) the debtor (or the debtor’s personal representative if the debtor has died);

 (b) a creditor of the debtor;

 (c) the Official Receiver.

Simultaneous application for a sequestration order

 (2) A creditor may include an application for a sequestration order in an application for an order terminating a debt agreement.

Effect of applying for a sequestration order

 (3) For the purposes of this Act, making an application for a sequestration order under subsection (2) is taken to be presenting a creditor’s petition against the debtor, but subsection 43(1), sections 44 and 47, subsections 52(1) and (2) and Part XIA do not apply in relation to the application.

Prerequisites for making an order terminating a debt agreement

 (4) The Court may make an order terminating a debt agreement if it is satisfied:

 (a) that the debtor (or the debtor’s personal representative if the debtor has died) has failed to carry out a term of the agreement and that it is in the creditors’ interest to terminate the agreement; or

 (b) that carrying out the agreement would cause injustice or undue delay to the creditors or the debtor (or the debtor’s estate if the debtor has died); or

 (c) that for any other reason the agreement should be terminated and that it is in the creditors’ interest to do so.

Sequestration order

 (5) If the Court makes an order terminating a debt agreement, the Court may also make a sequestration order if a creditor applied for the sequestration order.

185QA  Terminating a debt agreement—designated 6month arrears default

 (1) If:

 (a) the administrator of a debt agreement notifies the Official Receiver that a designated 6month arrears default by the debtor has occurred; and

 (b) the Official Receiver is satisfied that the designated 6month arrears default has occurred;

the Official Receiver must:

 (c) declare in writing that the agreement is terminated; and

 (d) record the declaration on the National Personal Insolvency Index.

 (2) The debt agreement is terminated when the declaration is recorded on the National Personal Insolvency Index.

185R  Terminating a debt agreement by the bankruptcy of the debtor

  A debt agreement is terminated if the debtor becomes a bankrupt.

Note: Despite section 185K, there are a number of ways in which a debtor who is a party to a debt agreement could become bankrupt. For example, the debtor could become bankrupt on a debtor’s petition if the Court gave permission for the debtor to present, or join in presenting, the petition, or the debtor could become bankrupt as a result of the presentation of a petition against a partnership.

185S  Validity of things done under a debt agreement that was terminated

  If a debt agreement is terminated under section 185P, 185Q, 185QA or 185R, anything that was done in good faith under the agreement by a person before the person had notice of the termination:

 (a) is valid; and

 (b) cannot be voided by a trustee under section 120, 121 or 122 (whether applying of its own force or under subsection 188A(4)).

Division 6Voiding a debt agreement

185T  Applying for an order declaring a debt agreement void

Persons who may apply for an order

 (1) The debtor (or the debtor’s personal representative if the debtor has died), a creditor or the Official Receiver may apply to the Court for an order declaring that all, or a specified part, of a debt agreement is void.

Grounds for applying for an order

 (2) A person mentioned in subsection (1) may apply for an order only if:

 (a) there is doubt on a specific ground that all or part of the debt agreement was not made in accordance with this Part or does not comply with this Part; or

 (b) the statement of affairs lodged with the debt agreement was deficient because it omitted a material particular or because it was incorrect in a material particular.

Time limit on applying for an order

 (3) A person cannot apply for an order declaring a debt agreement void after all the obligations created by the agreement have been discharged.

Simultaneous application for a sequestration order

 (4) A creditor may include an application for a sequestration order in an application for an order declaring all or part of a debt agreement void.

Effect of applying for a sequestration order

 (5) For the purposes of this Act, making an application for a sequestration order under subsection (4) is taken to be presenting a creditor’s petition against the debtor, but subsection 43(1), sections 44 and 47, subsections 52(1) and (2) and Part XIA do not apply in relation to the application.

185U  Making an order declaring a debt agreement void

Power to make order

 (1) On an application under section 185T, the Court may make an order declaring a debt agreement void.

Limit on declaring debt agreement void on grounds of noncompliance with this Part

 (2) The Court must not declare all or part of a debt agreement void on the ground that it does not comply with this Part if the agreement or part of the agreement complies substantially with this Part.

Declaring a debt agreement void on grounds of deficient statement of affairs

 (3) The Court must not declare all or part of a debt agreement void on the ground that the statement of affairs lodged with the debt agreement was deficient, unless the Court is satisfied that it is in the creditors’ interests to declare the agreement or part of the agreement void.

Sequestration order

 (4) If the Court makes an order declaring all of a debt agreement void, the Court may also make a sequestration order if a creditor applied for the sequestration order.

Ancillary orders

 (5) If the Court makes an order declaring all or part of a debt agreement void, the Court may make such other orders as the Court thinks fit.

 (6) An order under subsection (5) may be an order directing a person to pay another person compensation of such amount as is specified in the order. This subsection does not limit subsection (5).

185V  Validity of things done under a debt agreement that was declared void

  If a debt agreement is declared void, anything that was done in good faith under the agreement by a person before the person had notice of the declaration:

 (a) is valid; and

 (b) cannot be voided by a trustee under section 120, 121 or 122 (whether applying of its own force or under subsection 231(2)).

Division 7General provisions relating to debt agreements

185W  Court directions to the Official Receiver

 (1) Any of the following persons may apply to the Court for an order directing the Official Receiver or another person how to exercise the Official Receiver’s powers under this Part:

 (a) a debtor who is a party to a debt agreement (or the debtor’s personal representative if the debtor has died);

 (b) a creditor who is a party to a debt agreement;

 (c) the Official Receiver.

 (2) On an application under subsection (1), the Court may make an order directing the Official Receiver or another person how to exercise the Official Receiver’s powers under this Part.

185X  No stamp duty payable on a debt agreement

  Stamp duty under a State or Territory law is not payable on a debt agreement or a variation of a debt agreement.

185XA  Secured creditors

  Nothing in this Division affects the right of a secured creditor to realise or otherwise deal with the creditor’s security.

185Y  Money received by administrator to be held on trust

 (1) If the administrator of a debt agreement receives money from the debtor under the agreement, the money is taken to have been received by the administrator on trust to be dealt with in the way specified in the debt agreement.

 (2) Subsection (1) does not apply to a person if the person is both the debtor under, and the administrator of, the debt agreement.

185Z  Remuneration of administrator

 (1) The administrator of a debt agreement may be remunerated as provided in the agreement (see subsections 185C(3) and (3A)).

 (2) Subsection (1) does not apply to the Official Trustee.

Note: For the remuneration payable to the Official Trustee, see section 163.

185ZA  Notification of death of administrator

 (1) If the administrator in relation to a debt agreement dies, the person (the affected person) administering the estate of the deceased person must, before the end of the period of 28 days beginning on the day the affected person started to administer the estate, give written notice of that death to the Official Receiver.

Penalty: 5 penalty units.

Note: See also section 277B (about infringement notices).

 (2) Subsection (1) is an offence of strict liability.

Note: For strict liability, see section 6.1 of the Criminal Code.

185ZB  Official Trustee to replace an administrator who dies etc.

 (1) If the administrator of a debt agreement dies, the Official Trustee becomes the replacement administrator of that debt agreement.

 (2) If:

 (a) a person who is the administrator of a debt agreement is registered under Division 8; and

 (b) the person ceases to be so registered;

then:

 (c) the person ceases to be the administrator of that debt agreement; and

 (d) the Official Trustee becomes the replacement administrator of that debt agreement.

 (3) If:

 (a) a person who is the administrator of a debt agreement is a registered trustee; and

 (b) the person ceases to be a registered trustee;

then:

 (c) the person ceases to be the administrator of that debt agreement; and

 (d) the Official Trustee becomes the replacement administrator of that debt agreement.

 (4) If:

 (a) a person is the administrator of a debt agreement; and

 (b) under section 186M, the person becomes ineligible to act as the administrator of the debt agreement;

then:

 (c) the person ceases to be the administrator of that debt agreement; and

 (d) the Official Trustee becomes the replacement administrator of that debt agreement.

 (5) If, under section 185ZCB, the Court removes the administrator of a debt agreement from office, the Official Trustee becomes the replacement administrator of that debt agreement.

 (6) If, under subsection (1), (2), (3), (4) or (5), the Official Trustee becomes the replacement administrator of a debt agreement, the Official Receiver must notify the parties to the debt agreement that:

 (a) the Official Trustee is the replacement administrator until further notice; and

 (b) (if applicable) the Official Receiver intends to appoint another person as the new administrator.

185ZC  Official Receiver may appoint a new administrator

 (1) If the parties to a debt agreement have not already varied the agreement to appoint a new administrator, the Official Receiver may appoint another person to be the administrator of the agreement in place of the Official Trustee.

 (2) An appointment must be in writing.

 (3) The Official Receiver must give written notice of the appointment to the parties to the debt agreement.

 (4) The Official Receiver cannot revoke an appointment under subsection (1).

 (5) This section does not prevent the appointment of another person as administrator by variation of the debt agreement.

185ZCA  Court may order administrator to make good loss caused by breach of duty

 (1) This section applies if, on application by:

 (a) the InspectorGeneral; or

 (b) a creditor who is or has been a party to a debt agreement;

the Court is satisfied that a person who is or has been an administrator of the debt agreement has committed a breach of duty in relation to the debt agreement.

 (2) The Court may make any one or more of the following orders:

 (a) an order directing the person to make good any loss that a creditor has sustained because of the person’s breach of duty;

 (b) if the person is a registered debt agreement administrator—an order directing the InspectorGeneral to cancel the person’s registration as a debt agreement administrator;

 (c) any other order that the Court considers just and equitable in the circumstances.

185ZCB  Control of administrators by the Court

  If a debt agreement is in force, the Court may, on the application of:

 (a) the InspectorGeneral; or

 (b) the debtor; or

 (c) a creditor;

inquire into the conduct of the administrator, and may do either or both of the following:

 (d) remove the administrator from office;

 (e) make such order as it thinks proper.

185ZD  Remuneration of administrator

  A person who becomes the administrator in relation to a debt agreement under section 185ZC is entitled to so much of the remuneration (if any) provided for in the agreement as has not already been paid to the previous administrator, or any of the previous administrators.

Division 8Registration of debt agreement administrators etc.

Subdivision AIntroduction

186A  Basic eligibility test

Individuals

 (1) For the purposes of this Division, an individual passes the basic eligibility test at a particular time (the test time) unless:

 (a) at any time during the 10year period ending at the test time, the individual was:

 (i) an insolvent under administration; or

 (ii) a party (as a debtor) to a debt agreement; or

 (b) at any time during the 10year period ending at the test time, the individual was convicted of an offence involving fraud or dishonesty; or

 (c) at the test time, the individual is disqualified from managing corporations under Part 2D.6 of the Corporations Act 2001; or

 (d) at any time during the 10year period ending at the test time, the individual’s registration as a liquidator was cancelled under subsection 1292(2) or (3) of the Corporations Act 2001; or

 (e) at any time during the 10year period ending at the test time, the individual’s registration as a trustee ceased under section 155I for a reason specified in paragraph 155H(1)(a), (aa), (b), (e), (f), (fa) or (g); or

 (f) at any time during the 10year period ending at the test time, the individual’s registration as a debt agreement administrator was cancelled under section 186K on the ground that:

 (i) the individual contravened a condition that applied in relation to that registration; or

 (ii) the individual failed to properly carry out the duties of an administrator in relation to a debt agreement; or

 (g) at any time during the 10year period ending at the test time, the individual’s registration as a debt agreement administrator was cancelled as a result of an order under section 185ZCA; or

 (h) at any time during the 10year period ending at the test time, a declaration was made under section 186M in relation to the individual; or

 (i) at any time during the 10year period ending at the test time, a determination in relation to the individual was made under subregulation 9.06(3) of the Bankruptcy Regulations 1996 as in force before the commencement of this section.

 (2) Subparagraph (1)(a)(i) does not apply in relation to a bankruptcy that has been annulled under section 153B.

Companies

 (3) For the purposes of this Division, a company passes the basic eligibility test at a particular time (the test time) unless:

 (a) at any time during the 10year period ending at the test time, the company was an externallyadministered body corporate; or

 (b) at any time during the 10year period ending at the test time, the company was convicted of an offence involving fraud or dishonesty; or

 (c) at any time during the 10year period ending at the test time, the company’s registration as a debt agreement administrator was cancelled under section 186L on the ground that:

 (i) the company contravened a condition that applied in relation to that registration; or

 (ii) the company failed to properly carry out the duties of an administrator in relation to a debt agreement; or

 (d) at any time during the 10year period ending at the test time, the company’s registration as a debt agreement administrator was cancelled as a result of an order under section 185ZCA; or

 (e) at any time during the 10year period ending at the test time, a declaration was made under section 186M in relation to the company; or

 (f) at the test time, a director of the company does not pass the basic eligibility test; or

 (g) at any time during the 10year period ending at the test time, a determination in relation to the company was made under subregulation 9.06(3) of the Bankruptcy Regulations 1996 as in force before the commencement of this section.

Subdivision BRegistration of debt agreement administrators

186B  Application for registration as a debt agreement administrator

 (1) An individual or company may apply to the InspectorGeneral to be registered as a debt agreement administrator.

 (2) The application must:

 (a) be in the approved form; and

 (b) be accompanied by such information and documents (if any) as are specified in the regulations; and

 (c) if the application is not by way of renewal—be accompanied by the fee determined by the Minister by legislative instrument; and

 (d) if the application is by way of renewal—be made before the expiry of the applicant’s existing registration as a debt agreement administrator.

186C  InspectorGeneral must approve or refuse to approve registration application

 (1) After considering an application made under section 186B, the InspectorGeneral must, within 60 days of receiving the application:

 (a) approve the application; or

 (b) refuse to approve the application.

Approval of application made by an individual

 (2) If:

 (a) the applicant is an individual; and

 (b) the application is not by way of renewal;

the InspectorGeneral must approve the application if the InspectorGeneral is satisfied that the applicant:

 (c) passes the basic eligibility test; and

 (d) has the ability (including the knowledge) to satisfactorily perform the duties of an administrator in relation to debt agreements; and

 (e) has such qualifications and experience (if any) as are prescribed by the regulations.

Otherwise the InspectorGeneral must refuse to approve the application.

 (3) If:

 (a) the applicant is an individual; and

 (b) the application is by way of renewal;

the InspectorGeneral must approve the application.

Approval of application made by a company

 (4) If:

 (a) the applicant is a company; and

 (b) the application is not by way of renewal;

the InspectorGeneral must approve the application if the InspectorGeneral is satisfied that the applicant:

 (c) passes the basic eligibility test; and

 (d) has the ability to satisfactorily perform the duties of an administrator in relation to debt agreements.             

Otherwise the InspectorGeneral must refuse to approve the application.

 (5) If:

 (a) the applicant is a company; and

 (b) the application is by way of renewal;

the InspectorGeneral must approve the application.

Guidelines

 (6) In deciding whether to approve an application made under section 186B, the InspectorGeneral must have regard to any relevant guidelines in force under section 186Q.

Notice of decision

 (7) If the InspectorGeneral refuses to approve an application made under section 186B, the InspectorGeneral must give the applicant a written notice of the refusal, and the reasons for it.

Review

 (8) If the InspectorGeneral decides to refuse to approve an application made under section 186B, the applicant may apply to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal for review of the decision.

Conditions of registration

 (9) If the InspectorGeneral approves an application under section 186B, the InspectorGeneral may decide that, if the applicant is registered as a debt agreement administrator under section 186D, the applicant’s registration as a debt agreement administrator is subject to specified conditions.

 (10) If the InspectorGeneral makes a decision under subsection (9), the InspectorGeneral must give the applicant a written notice of the decision and the reasons for it.

 (11) If the InspectorGeneral makes a decision under subsection (9), the applicant may apply to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal for review of the decision.

 (12) In subsection (11):

decision has the same meaning as in the Administrative Appeals Tribunal Act 1975.

186D  Registration as a debt agreement administrator

 (1) This section applies if:

 (a) the InspectorGeneral approves an application under section 186C; and

 (b) the applicant has paid the fee determined by the Minister by legislative instrument.

 (2) The InspectorGeneral must register the applicant as a debt agreement administrator by entering on the National Personal Insolvency Index the details relating to the applicant that are prescribed by the regulations.

 (3) After registering the applicant as a debt agreement administrator, the InspectorGeneral must give the applicant a certificate of registration.

186E  Duration of registration as a debt agreement administrator

  Subject to this Division and section 185ZCA, if a person is registered under section 186D as a debt agreement administrator, the registration remains in force for:

 (a) if the registration is not by way of renewal—3 years beginning when the person’s details are entered on the National Personal Insolvency Index; or

 (b) if the registration is by way of renewal—3 years beginning immediately after the person’s existing registration as a debt agreement administrator expires.

186F  Conditions of registration—general

 (1) This section applies to a person if the person is a registered debt agreement administrator.

 (2) The InspectorGeneral may, by written notice given to the person, impose specified conditions on the person’s registration as a debt agreement administrator.

186G  Condition of registration—companies

 (1) This section applies to a company if the company is a registered debt agreement administrator.

 (2) It is a condition of the company’s registration as a debt agreement administrator that each individual who takes overall responsibility for managing the company’s debt agreement activities must be:

 (a) a registered debt agreement administrator; or

 (b) a registered trustee.

 (3) Subsection (2) does not limit subsection 186C(9) or section 186F.

186H  Application to change or remove registration conditions

 (1) If there are conditions on a person’s registration as a debt agreement administrator, the person may apply to the InspectorGeneral for the conditions to be changed or removed.

 (2) The application must:

 (a) be in the approved form; and

 (b) be accompanied by such information and documents (if any) as are specified in the regulations.

 (3) After considering an application made under subsection (1), the InspectorGeneral must:

 (a) decide that the conditions on the applicant’s registration as a debt agreement administrator should not be changed or removed; or

 (b) decide that specified modifications should be made to the conditions imposed on the applicant’s registration as a debt agreement administrator.

Note: See the definition of modifications in subsection 5(1).

Notice of decision

 (4) If the InspectorGeneral decides that the conditions on the applicant’s registration as a debt agreement administrator should not be changed or removed, the InspectorGeneral must give the applicant a written notice of the decision, and the reasons for it.

 (5) If the InspectorGeneral decides that specified modifications should be made to the conditions imposed on the applicant’s registration as a debt agreement administrator, the InspectorGeneral must give the applicant a written notice of the decision, and the reasons for it.

Review

 (6) The applicant may apply to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal for review of a decision of the InspectorGeneral made under this section.

 (7) In subsection (6):

decision has the same meaning as in the Administrative Appeals Tribunal Act 1975.

Subdivision CSurrender and cancellation of registration as a debt agreement administrator

186J  Surrender of registration as a debt agreement administrator

 (1) This section applies to a person if the person is a registered debt agreement administrator.

 (2) The person may, by written notice given to the InspectorGeneral, request the InspectorGeneral to accept the surrender of the person’s registration as a debt agreement administrator.

 (3) A request under subsection (2) must be in the approved form.

 (4) The person ceases to be registered as a debt agreement administrator when the InspectorGeneral accepts the request.

 (5) If the InspectorGeneral accepts a request given under subsection (2), the InspectorGeneral must remove the person’s registration details from the National Personal Insolvency Index.

186K  Cancellation of an individual’s registration as a debt agreement administrator

Scope

 (1) This section applies in relation to an individual if the individual is a registered debt agreement administrator.

Individual no longer passes the basic eligibility test

 (2) The InspectorGeneral must cancel the individual’s registration as a debt agreement administrator if the InspectorGeneral is satisfied that the individual no longer passes the basic eligibility test.

Other grounds for cancellation of registration

 (3) The InspectorGeneral may ask the individual to give the InspectorGeneral a written explanation why the individual should continue to be registered as a debt agreement administrator, if the InspectorGeneral has reasonable grounds to believe that:

 (a) the individual no longer has the ability (including the knowledge) to satisfactorily perform the duties of an administrator in relation to a debt agreement; or

 (b) the individual has failed to properly carry out the duties of an administrator in relation to a debt agreement; or

 (c) the individual no longer has the qualifications or experience prescribed by regulations made for the purposes of paragraph 186C(2)(e); or

 (d) the individual has contravened a condition of the individual’s registration.

 (4) If:

 (a) the InspectorGeneral does not receive an explanation within 28 days of requesting it; or

 (b) receives an explanation, but is not satisfied with it;

the InspectorGeneral may cancel the individual’s registration as a debt agreement administrator.

Notice of cancellation

 (5) If the InspectorGeneral cancels, under subsection (2) or (4), an individual’s registration as a debt agreement administrator, the InspectorGeneral must give the individual written notice of the cancellation, and the reasons for it.

Removal of registration details

 (6) If the InspectorGeneral cancels, under subsection (2) or (4), an individual’s registration as a debt agreement administrator, the InspectorGeneral must remove the individual’s registration details from the National Personal Insolvency Index.

Guidelines

 (7) In deciding whether to cancel, under subsection (2) or (4), an individual’s registration as a debt agreement administrator, the InspectorGeneral must have regard to any relevant guidelines in force under section 186Q.

Review

 (8) If the InspectorGeneral decides to cancel, under subsection (2) or (4), an individual’s registration as a debt agreement administrator, the individual may apply to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal for review of the decision.

186L  Cancellation of a company’s registration as a debt agreement administrator

Scope

 (1) This section applies in relation to a company if the company is a registered debt agreement administrator.

Company no longer passes the basic eligibility test

 (2) The InspectorGeneral must cancel the company’s registration as a debt agreement administrator if the InspectorGeneral is satisfied that the company no longer passes the basic eligibility test.

Other grounds for cancellation of registration

 (3) The InspectorGeneral may ask the company to give the InspectorGeneral a written explanation why the company should continue to be registered as a debt agreement administrator, if the InspectorGeneral has reasonable grounds to believe that:

 (a) the company no longer has the ability to satisfactorily perform the duties of an administrator in relation to a debt agreement; or

 (b) the company has failed to properly carry out the duties of an administrator in relation to a debt agreement; or

 (c) the company has contravened a condition of the company’s registration.

 (4) If:

 (a) the InspectorGeneral does not receive an explanation within 28 days of requesting it; or

 (b) receives an explanation, but is not satisfied with it;

the InspectorGeneral may cancel the company’s registration as a debt agreement administrator.

Notice of cancellation

 (5) If the InspectorGeneral cancels, under subsection (2) or (4), a company’s registration as a debt agreement administrator, the InspectorGeneral must give the company written notice of the cancellation, and the reasons for it.

Removal of registration details

 (6) If the InspectorGeneral cancels, under subsection (2) or (4), a company’s registration as a debt agreement administrator, the InspectorGeneral must remove the company’s registration details from the National Personal Insolvency Index.

Guidelines

 (7) In deciding whether to cancel, under subsection (2) or (4), a company’s registration as a debt agreement administrator, the InspectorGeneral must have regard to any relevant guidelines in force under section 186Q.

Review

 (8) If the InspectorGeneral decides to cancel, under subsection (2) or (4), a company’s registration as a debt agreement administrator, the company may apply to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal for review of the decision.

186LA  InspectorGeneral may obtain information about debt agreement administration trust accounts

Scope

 (1) This section applies to a bank if:

 (a) the InspectorGeneral believes on reasonable grounds that:

 (i) a person who is or was an administrator of a debt agreement holds or held an account with the bank; and

 (ii) the account was kept, or purportedly kept, in compliance with subsection 185LD(1); and

 (b) the InspectorGeneral has asked the person:

 (i) under subsection 186K(3) or 186L(3), to give the InspectorGeneral a written explanation why the person should continue to be registered as a debt agreement administrator; or

 (ii) under subsection 155H(1), to give the InspectorGeneral a written explanation why the person should continue to be registered as a trustee; and

 (c) if subparagraph (b)(ii) applies—the InspectorGeneral asked for the explanation on the basis of paragraph 155H(1)(fa).

Requirement

 (2) The InspectorGeneral may, by written notice given to the bank, require the bank to give to the InspectorGeneral, within the period and in the manner specified in the notice, such information about the account as is specified in the notice.

Offence

 (3) A person commits an offence if:

 (a) the person has been given a notice under subsection (2); and

 (b) the person omits to do an act; and

 (c) the omission contravenes a requirement in the notice.

Penalty for contravention of this subsection: 60 penalty units.

186LB  Accountfreezing notices—debt agreement administration trust accounts

Scope

 (1) This section applies to a bank if:

 (a) the InspectorGeneral believes on reasonable grounds that:

 (i) a person who is or was an administrator of a debt agreement holds or held an account with the bank; and

 (ii) the account was kept, or purportedly kept, in compliance with subsection 185LD(1); and

 (b) at a particular time (the show cause time), the InspectorGeneral asked the person:

 (i) under subsection 186K(3) or 186L(3), to give the InspectorGeneral a written explanation why the person should continue to be registered as a debt agreement administrator; or

 (ii) under subsection 155H(1), to give the InspectorGeneral a written explanation why the person should continue to be registered as a trustee; and

 (c) if subparagraph (b)(ii) applies—the InspectorGeneral asked for the explanation on the basis of paragraph 155H(1)(fa).

Giving of freezing notice

 (2) The InspectorGeneral may, by written notice (an accountfreezing notice) given to the bank within 42 days after the show cause time, direct the bank not to:

 (a) make a withdrawal from the account; or

 (b) permit the making of a withdrawal from the account;

except:

 (c) in accordance with the written consent of the InspectorGeneral; or

 (d) to recover from the accountholder an amount equal to an amount of tax (however described) that the bank has paid or is liable to pay in connection to the operation of the account; or

 (e) to discharge a liability of the accountholder to pay a fee or charge in relation to the operation of the account; or

 (f) in such circumstances (if any) as are specified in the regulations.

Duration of freezing notice

 (3) An accountfreezing notice given to a bank:

 (a) comes into force when the notice is given to the bank; and

 (b) remains in force for:

 (i) 42 days after the show cause time; or

 (ii) if a shorter period is specified in the notice—that shorter period.

Extension of 42day period

 (4) The Court may, on application by the InspectorGeneral, extend, or further extend, the 42day period referred to in subsection (2) or subparagraph (3)(b)(i).

Revocation of freezing notice

 (5) If an accountfreezing notice is in force in relation to a bank, the InspectorGeneral may, by written notice given to the bank, revoke the accountfreezing notice.

Copy of accountfreezing notice to be given to accountholder etc.

 (6) If the InspectorGeneral gives or revokes an accountfreezing notice that relates to an account, the InspectorGeneral must give a copy of the accountfreezing notice or the revocation notice, as the case may be, to the holder of the account.

 (7) A failure to comply with subsection (6) does not affect the validity of the accountfreezing notice or the revocation notice, as the case may be.

Consent of InspectorGeneral

 (8) A consent under paragraph (2)(c) may be:

 (a) unconditional; or

 (b) subject to such conditions (if any) as are specified in the notice of consent.

 (9) If the InspectorGeneral decides to refuse to give a consent under paragraph (2)(c), an application may be made to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal for review of the decision.

186LC  Power of court to set aside accountfreezing notices

 (1) If the Court, on application by:

 (a) a bank to whom an accountfreezing notice has been given; or

 (b) the accountholder whose account is affected by an accountfreezing notice; or

 (c) any other interested person;

is satisfied that the InspectorGeneral was not authorised to give the notice, the Court may make an order setting aside the notice.

 (2) An accountfreezing notice that is set aside is taken not to have been given.

186LD  Judicial enforcement of accountfreezing notices

 (1) If the Court is satisfied that a bank has breached, or is proposing to breach, an accountfreezing notice, the Court may, on application of the InspectorGeneral, make any or all of the following orders:

 (a) an order directing the bank to comply with that notice;

 (b) any other order that the Court thinks appropriate.

 (2) The Court may discharge or vary an order granted under this section.

186LE  Protection of bank

  No criminal or civil proceedings lie against a bank because of anything done (or not done) by the bank in good faith:

 (a) in compliance with an accountfreezing notice; or

 (b) in connection with, or incidental to, the bank’s compliance with an accountfreezing notice.

Subdivision DIneligibility of a person to act as a debt agreement administrator

186M  InspectorGeneral may declare a person ineligible to act as an administrator

 (1) This section applies to a person if:

 (a) the person is or was the administrator of a debt agreement; and

 (b) the person is not:

 (i) a registered debt agreement administrator; or

 (ii) a registered trustee.

 (2) The InspectorGeneral may ask the person to give the InspectorGeneral a written explanation why the person should continue to be eligible to act as an administrator of debt agreements, if the InspectorGeneral has reasonable grounds to believe that the person has failed to properly carry out the duties of an administrator in relation to the debt agreement.

 (3) If:

 (a) the InspectorGeneral does not receive an explanation within 28 days of requesting it; or

 (b) receives an explanation, but is not satisfied with it;

the InspectorGeneral may declare that the person is ineligible, for a period of 3 years, to act as an administrator of debt agreements.

 (4) If the InspectorGeneral makes a declaration under subsection (3), the InspectorGeneral must give the person written notice of the declaration, and the reasons for it.

Guidelines

 (5) In deciding whether to make a declaration under subsection (3), the InspectorGeneral must have regard to any relevant guidelines in force under section 186Q.

Review

 (6) If the InspectorGeneral decides to make a declaration under subsection (3) in relation to a person, the person may apply to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal for review of the decision.

Subdivision EMiscellaneous

186N  Return of certificate of registration

Surrender of registration as a debt agreement administrator

 (1) A person commits an offence if:

 (a) the person has been given a certificate of registration under subsection 186D(3); and

 (b) the person gives a notice under subsection 186J(2) surrendering the person’s registration as a debt agreement administrator; and

 (c) the person does not return the certificate of registration to the InspectorGeneral before the end of the period of 7 days beginning on the day the InspectorGeneral accepts the notice.

Penalty: 5 penalty units.

Note: See also section 277B (about infringement notices).

 (2) Subsection (1) does not apply if the person has a reasonable excuse.

Note: A defendant bears an evidential burden in relation to the matter in subsection (2) (see subsection 13.3(3) of the Criminal Code).

Cancellation of an individual’s registration as a debt agreement administrator

 (3) An individual commits an offence if:

 (a) the individual has been given a certificate of registration under subsection 186D(3); and

 (b) the individual’s registration as a debt agreement administrator is cancelled under section 186K; and

 (c) the individual does not return the certificate of registration to the InspectorGeneral before the end of the period of 7 days beginning on the day the individual is given a notice under subsection 186K(5) in relation to the cancellation.

Penalty: 5 penalty units.

Note: See also section 277B (about infringement notices).

 (4) Subsection (3) does not apply if the individual has a reasonable excuse.

Note: A defendant bears an evidential burden in relation to the matter in subsection (4) (see subsection 13.3(3) of the Criminal Code).

Cancellation of a company’s registration as a debt agreement administrator

 (5) A company commits an offence if:

 (a) the company has been given a certificate of registration under subsection 186D(3); and

 (b) the company’s registration as a debt agreement administrator is cancelled under section 186L; and

 (c) the company does not return the certificate of registration to the InspectorGeneral before the end of the period of 7 days beginning on the day the company is given a notice under subsection 186L(5) in relation to the cancellation.

Penalty: 5 penalty units.

Note: See also section 277B (about infringement notices).

 (6) Subsection (5) does not apply if the company has a reasonable excuse.

Note: A defendant bears an evidential burden in relation to the matter in subsection (6) (see subsection 13.3(3) of the Criminal Code).

Cancellation by court order of registration as a debt agreement administrator

 (6A) A person commits an offence if:

 (a) the person has been given a certificate of registration under subsection 186D(3); and

 (b) the person’s registration as a debt agreement administrator is cancelled as a result of an order under section 185ZCA; and

 (c) the person does not return the certificate of registration to the InspectorGeneral before the end of the period of 7 days beginning on the day of the cancellation.

Penalty: 5 penalty units.

Note: See also section 277B (about infringement notices).

 (6B) Subsection (6A) does not apply if the person has a reasonable excuse.

Note: A defendant bears an evidential burden in relation to the matter in subsection (6A) (see subsection 13.3(3) of the Criminal Code).

Strict liability

 (7) Subsections (1), (3), (5) and (6A) are offences of strict liability.

Note: For strict liability, see section 6.1 of the Criminal Code.

186P  Cessation of registration as a debt agreement administrator—no refund of fees

 (1) This section applies if a person ceases to be registered as a debt agreement administrator.

 (2) The person is not entitled to a refund of all or part of a fee paid by the person in relation to the person’s registration as a debt agreement administrator.

186Q  Guidelines relating to InspectorGeneral’s powers

  The InspectorGeneral may, by legislative instrument, formulate guidelines for the purposes of the following provisions:

 (a) subsection 186C(6);

 (b) subsection 186K(7);

 (c) subsection 186L(7);

 (d) subsection 186M(5).

Note: For consultation requirements, see Part 3 of the Legislative Instruments Act 2003.

Part XPersonal insolvency agreements

Division 1Interpretation

187  Interpretation

 (1) In this Part, unless the contrary intention appears:

controlling trustee, in relation to a debtor whose property is subject to control under Division 2, means the person who is the controlling trustee under section 188 or 192.

debtor means a person who is insolvent.

divisible property, in relation to a personal insolvency agreement executed by a debtor, means the property, other than property that was acquired by, or devolved on, the debtor on or after the day on which he or she executed the agreement, that would be divisible amongst his or her creditors under Part VI if he or she had become a bankrupt on that day.

 (1A) Without limiting the definition of debtor in subsection (1), a reference in this Part to a debtor shall, unless the contrary intention appears, be read as including a reference to a person who is for the time being insolvent, even if the person may ultimately cease to be insolvent.

 (2) In this Part, a reference, in relation to a personal insolvency agreement, to a provable debt shall be read as a reference to a debt or liability that would have been a provable debt in the debtor’s bankruptcy if the debtor had become a bankrupt on the day on which he or she executed the personal insolvency agreement.

187A  Application of Part to joint debtors

  This Part applies, with the prescribed modifications (if any), in relation to joint debtors, whether partners or not.

Division 2Meeting of creditors and control of debtor’s property

188  Debtor may authorise trustee or solicitor to be controlling trustee

 (1) A debtor who desires that his or her affairs be dealt with under this Part without his or her estate being sequestrated and:

 (a) is personally present or ordinarily resident in Australia;

 (b) has a dwellinghouse or place of business in Australia;

 (c) is carrying on business in Australia, either personally or by means of an agent or manager; or

 (d) is a member of a firm or partnership carrying on business in Australia by means of a partner or partners or of an agent or manager;

may sign an authority in accordance with the approved form naming and authorising a registered trustee, a solicitor or the Official Trustee to call a meeting of the debtor’s creditors and to take control of the debtor’s property.

 (2) An authority signed by a debtor under this section is not effective for the purposes of this Part unless:

 (a) if the person authorised is a registered trustee or solicitor—the person has consented in writing to exercise the powers given by the authority; and

 (aa) if the person authorised is the Official Trustee—an Official Receiver has given the debtor written approval to name the Official Trustee in the authority.

 (2AA) If the person authorised is a registered trustee or a solicitor, then, before the person consents to exercise the powers given by the authority, the person must give the debtor the information prescribed by the regulations.

 (2AB) If the person authorised is the Official Trustee, then, before the Official Receiver gives approval to name the Official Trustee in the authority, the Official Receiver must give the debtor the information prescribed by the regulations.

 (2A) The regulations may prescribe the circumstances in which a person (other than the Official Trustee or a registered trustee) is ineligible to act as a controlling trustee under this Part.

 (2B) An authority signed by a debtor under this section is not effective for the purposes of this Part if, at the time the authority is signed, the person authorised:

 (a) is not the Official Trustee or a registered trustee; and

 (b) is ineligible, under the regulations, to act as a controlling trustee under this Part.

 (2C) If the person authorised is a registered trustee or solicitor, the authority signed by the debtor under this section is not effective for the purposes of this Part unless, before the person authorised consents to exercise the powers given by the authority, the debtor gives to the person authorised:

 (a) a statement of the debtor’s affairs; and

 (b) a proposal for dealing with them under this Part.

Note: Section 6A sets out requirements for statements of affairs.

 (2D) If the person authorised is the Official Trustee, the authority signed by the debtor under this section is not effective for the purposes of this Part unless, before an Official Receiver gives approval to name the Official Trustee in the authority, the debtor gives to the Official Receiver:

 (a) a statement of the debtor’s affairs; and

 (b) a proposal for dealing with them under this Part.

Note: Section 6A sets out requirements for statements of affairs.

 (2E) A proposal for dealing with the debtor’s affairs under this Part must include a draft personal insolvency agreement.

Note: Section 188A sets out requirements for personal insolvency agreements.

 (3) An authority under this section that is effective for the purposes of this Part is not revocable by the debtor.

 (4) Subject to subsection 192(1), a debtor cannot give an authority within 6 months of giving another authority, unless the Court grants leave to do so.

 (5) A registered trustee or solicitor who consents to exercise the powers given by an authority must, within 2 working days of consenting, give a copy of:

 (a) the authority; and

 (b) the debtor’s statement of affairs;

to the Official Receiver.

 (5A) For the purposes of subsection (5), a working day is a day that is not a Saturday, Sunday or public holiday in the place where the registered trustee or solicitor consented to exercise the powers given by the authority.

 (6) When an authority becomes effective, the person authorised by it becomes the controlling trustee.

188A  Personal insolvency agreement

Requirements for a personal insolvency agreement

 (1) A personal insolvency agreement is a deed that:

 (a) is expressed to be entered into under this Part; and

 (b) complies with subsection (2).

 (2) A personal insolvency agreement must:

 (a) identify the debtor’s property (whether or not already owned by the debtor when he or she executes the agreement) that is to be available to pay creditors’ claims; and

 (b) specify how the property is to be dealt with; and

 (c) identify the debtor’s income (whether or not already derived by the debtor when he or she executes the agreement) that is to be available to pay creditors’ claims; and

 (d) specify how the income is to be dealt with; and

 (e) specify the extent (if any) to which the debtor is to be released from his or her provable debts; and

 (f) specify the conditions (if any) for the agreement to come into operation; and

 (g) specify the circumstances in which, or the events on which, the agreement terminates; and

 (h) specify the order in which proceeds of realising the property referred to in paragraph (a) are to be distributed among creditors; and

 (i) specify the order in which income referred to in paragraph (c) is to be distributed among creditors; and

 (j) specify whether or not the antecedent transactions provisions of this Act apply to the debtor; and

 (k) make provision for a person or persons to be trustee or trustees of the agreement; and

 (l) provide that the debtor will execute such instruments and generally do all such acts and things in relation to his or her property and income as is required by the agreement.

 (3) Subsection (2) does not limit the provisions that may be included in a personal insolvency agreement.

Antecedent transactions provisions

 (4) If a personal insolvency agreement specifies that the antecedent transactions provisions of this Act apply to the debtor, sections 120 to 125 apply, with any modifications prescribed by the regulations, in relation to the debtor as if:

 (a) a creditor’s petition had been presented against the debtor on the day on which the special resolution requiring the execution of the agreement was passed; and

 (b) a sequestration order had been made against the debtor on that petition on the day on which the debtor executed the agreement; and

 (c) the trustee of the agreement were the trustee in the debtor’s bankruptcy.

 (5) In the application, by virtue of subsection (4), of the provisions referred to in that subsection:

 (a) a reference to the property of the bankrupt is to be read as a reference to the divisible property of the debtor; and

 (b) a reference to a provable debt is to be read as a reference to a provable debt within the meaning of this Part; and

 (c) a reference to the end of the bankruptcy is to be read as a reference to the end of the personal insolvency agreement.

Definition

 (6) In this section:

income has the meaning given by section 139L.

188B  Inspection of statement of debtor’s affairs

 (1) This section applies to the following documents relating to a debtor:

 (a) a copy of a statement of the debtor’s affairs given to an Official Receiver under subsection 188(5);

 (b) a statement of the debtor’s affairs given to the Official Receiver under subsection 188(2D).

 (2) A person who states in writing that he or she is a creditor of the debtor, may, without fee:

 (a) inspect, personally or by an agent, the document; and

 (b) obtain a copy of, or make extracts from, the document.

 (3) A person who does not state in writing that he or she is a creditor of the debtor, may, on payment of the fee determined by the Minister by legislative instrument:

 (a) inspect, personally or by an agent, the document; and

 (b) obtain a copy of, or make extracts from, the document.

 (4) The debtor may, without fee and either personally or by an agent:

 (a) inspect the document; or

 (b) obtain a copy of, or make extracts from, the document.

 (5) If the approved form for a statement of affairs indicates that particular information in the statement will not be made available to the public, then the Official Receiver must ensure that the information is not made available under this section to any person (other than the debtor or an agent of the debtor).

 (6) The Official Receiver may refuse to allow a person access under this section to particular information in a debtor’s statement of affairs on the ground that access to that information would jeopardise, or be likely to jeopardise, the safety of any person.

189  Control of property of a debtor who has given authority under section 188

 (1) When an authority given by a debtor under section 188 becomes effective, the property of the debtor becomes subject to control under this Division.

 (1A) The control continues until one of the following events happens:

 (a) the creditors resolve at a meeting called under this Part that the property cease to be subject to control;

 (b) the debtor and a trustee execute a personal insolvency agreement following a special resolution of creditors;

 (d) 4 months pass since the authority under section 188 became effective;

 (e) the Court, under section 208, releases the property from control;

 (f) the debtor becomes a bankrupt;

 (g) the debtor dies.

 (1B) The trustee must notify the Official Receiver in writing within 7 days after the trustee becomes aware that the control has ended because of an event specified in subsection (1A).

 (2) A debtor whose property is subject to control under this Division:

 (a) shall not remove, dispose of or deal with any of his or her property except with the consent of the controlling trustee;

 (b) shall furnish to the controlling trustee such information with respect to any of the debtor’s examinable affairs as the controlling trustee requires; and

 (c) shall comply with any direction given to him or her by the controlling trustee with respect to his or her property or affairs.

Penalty: Imprisonment for 12 months.

 (3) A disposal of, or dealing with, property by a debtor in contravention of subsection (2) is not invalid by reason only of that contravention.

189AAA  Stay of proceedings relating to creditor’s petition until meeting of debtor’s creditors

 (1) If:

 (a) an authority signed by a debtor under section 188 has become effective; and

 (b) either:

 (i) a creditor’s petition was presented against the debtor before the authority became effective; or

 (ii) a creditor’s petition is presented against the debtor after the authority became effective but before the first or only meeting of the debtor’s creditors called under the authority;

proceedings relating to that petition are, by force of this subsection, stayed until:

 (c) the conclusion of the meeting; or

 (d) the adjournment of the meeting;

whichever is the earlier.

 (2) This section does not limit subsection 206(1).

189AA  Court orders with effect during period of control of debtor’s property

 (1) The Court may make an order that has effect while the property of the debtor is subject to control:

 (a) discharging an order made at any time against the person or property of the debtor under a law relating to the imprisonment of fraudulent debtors; or

 (b) staying a civil or criminal legal process begun at any time against the person or property of the debtor for the debtor’s failure:

 (i) to pay a debt that would be provable if the debtor were bankrupt; or

 (ii) to pay a pecuniary penalty payable as a result of the failure to pay a debt that would be provable if the debtor were bankrupt; or

 (iii) to obey an order of a court to pay a debt that would be provable if the debtor were bankrupt; or

 (c) if the debtor has been imprisoned under a law described in paragraph (a) or for a failure described in paragraph (b)—releasing the debtor from custody.

 (2) Paragraph (1)(b) does not allow the Court to stay any proceedings under a proceeds of crime law.

189AB  Charge over debtor’s property that is subject to control

Creation of charge

 (1) When the debtor’s property becomes subject to control under this Division, the debtor’s property is charged with:

 (a) the debtor’s unsecured debts at the time the debtor signed the authority under section 188; and

 (b) any amount by which the debtor’s secured debts exceeded the value of the property secured for payment of the debts at the time the debtor signed the authority under section 188.

Charge continues despite changing ownership of charged property

 (2) Subject to subsections (3) and (9), the charge is not affected by any change of ownership of the charged property.

Certain other charges have priority

 (3) The charge created by subsection (1) is subject to:

 (a) any charge or encumbrance that was on the debtor’s property immediately before the debtor signed the authority under section 188; and

 (b) any charge or encumbrance acquired in good faith and for market value by a person who did not have notice of the charge created by subsection (1).

Priority over some other charges

 (4) The charge created by subsection (1) has priority over a charge or encumbrance that is not described in subsection (3).

Registration of charge

 (5) The controlling trustee may register a charge created by subsection (1) over particular property if a law of the Commonwealth, or of a State or Territory, provides for registration of a charge over that sort of property.

Effect of registration of charge

 (6) If the trustee registers the charge over particular property, a person who acquires the property or an interest in the property after the charge is registered is taken to have notice of the charge for the purposes of subsections (3) and (9).

Controlling trustee may sell charged property

 (7) The controlling trustee may sell property that is subject to a charge under subsection (1).

Application of proceeds of sale

 (8) Any proceeds from the sale of charged property that are not needed to meet a charge or encumbrance that has higher priority than the charge created by subsection (1) are the debtor’s property.

End of charge on property that is sold

 (9) A charge created by subsection (1) ceases to have effect in relation to property if the property is acquired by a person:

 (a) in good faith for consideration at least as valuable as the market value of the property without notice of the charge; or

 (b) from the controlling trustee in a sale under subsection (7).

Charge ends when property ceases to be subject to control

 (10) Unless it has already ceased to have effect under subsection (9), the charge ceases to have effect when control of the debtor’s property ends under subsection 189(1A).

Meaning of debtor’s property

 (11) In this section:

debtor’s property has the meaning given in subsection 190(5).

189AC  Right of indemnity for controlling trustee

 (1) The controlling trustee is entitled to be indemnified out of the debtor’s property for:

 (a) his or her remuneration; and

 (b) any costs, charges or expenses properly and reasonably incurred by the controlling trustee while the debtor’s property was subject to control under this Division.

 (2) To secure a right of indemnity under subsection (1), the controlling trustee has a lien on the debtor’s property.

 (3) A lien under subsection (2) ceases to have effect if the debtor becomes a bankrupt.

189A  Report and declaration by controlling trustee

 (1) The controlling trustee must prepare a report:

 (a) summarising and commenting on the information about the debtor’s affairs that is available to the controlling trustee; and

 (b) stating whether the controlling trustee believes that the creditors’ interests would be better served:

 (i) by accepting the debtor’s proposal for dealing with his or her affairs under this Part; or

 (ii) by the bankruptcy of the debtor; and

 (c) naming each creditor who was identified as a related entity of the debtor in the debtor’s statement of affairs.

 (2) The trustee must:

 (a) give a copy of the report to the Official Receiver and to each of the creditors; and

 (b) keep a copy of the report.

Declaration of relationships

 (3) The controlling trustee must make a written declaration stating whether the debtor is a related entity of:

 (a) the controlling trustee; or

 (b) a related entity of the controlling trustee.

 (4) The controlling trustee must:

 (a) give a copy of the declaration to the Official Receiver; and

 (b) give a copy of the declaration to each of the creditors at the same time as the controlling trustee gives a copy of the subsection (1) report to each creditor; and

 (c) keep a copy of the declaration.

189B  Controlling trustee to prepare statement about possible resolutions

 (1) A controlling trustee under an authority under section 188 must prepare a written statement about the special resolutions under section 204 that may reasonably be expected to be passed at a meeting of creditors called under the authority.

 (2) The trustee must:

 (a) give a copy of the statement to the Official Receiver and to each of the creditors; and

 (b) keep a copy of the statement.

190  Duties and powers of controlling trustee

 (1) The controlling trustee must call a meeting of the debtor’s creditors under this Division.

 (2) The controlling trustee is empowered:

 (a) to take immediate control of the debtor’s property and affairs;

 (b) to make such inquiries and investigations in connexion with the debtor’s property and examinable affairs as the trustee considers necessary;

 (c) to carry on a business of the debtor if, in the opinion of the trustee, it will be in the interests of the creditors to do so; and

 (d) to deal with the debtor’s property in any way that will, in the opinion of the trustee, be in the interests of the creditors.

 (3A) For the purpose of exercising the powers conferred by subsection (2), a trustee may, with the consent in writing of the debtor, obtain such advice or assistance as the trustee considers desirable.

 (4) For the purposes of exercising his or her powers under this section, the trustee may act in the name of the debtor as if he or she had been duly appointed by the debtor to be his or her lawful attorney to exercise those powers.

 (4A) The controlling trustee or any person affected by an act or omission of the controlling trustee may apply to the Court for directions on a matter connected with control of the debtor’s property under this Division.

 (4B) The Court may make any orders it thinks just on a matter raised by an application.

 (5) In this section, debtor’s property, in relation to a debtor who has given an authority under section 188, means the property of the debtor that would be divisible amongst his or her creditors under Part VI (other than Subdivision B of Division 2) if a sequestration order had been made against him or her on the day on which he or she signed the authority, and includes property that has been acquired by, or has devolved on, the debtor on or after that day, but, if a personal insolvency agreement is executed by him or her in accordance with a special resolution of a meeting of creditors called in accordance with the authority, does not include property that is acquired by, or devolves on, him or her on or after the day on which he or she executes the agreement.

190A  Additional duties of controlling trustee

 (1) The duties of the controlling trustee include the following:

 (a) notifying the debtor’s creditors of the giving by the debtor of an authority under section 188;

 (b) giving information about the administration of the controlling trusteeship to a creditor who makes a reasonable request for it;

 (c) taking whatever action is practicable to try to ensure that the debtor discharges all of the debtor’s duties under this Act;

 (d) considering whether the debtor has committed an offence against this Act;

 (e) referring to the InspectorGeneral or to relevant law enforcement authorities any evidence of an offence by the debtor against this Act;

 (f) making appropriate inquiries and investigations in connection with the debtor’s property and examinable affairs;

 (g) disclosing to creditors any material personal interests held by the trustee that could conflict with the proper exercise of his or her powers or the proper performance of his or her functions;

 (h) exercising powers and performing functions in a commercially sound way;

 (i) exercising powers and performing functions in an impartial and independent manner.

191  Payments to protect property etc.

  Without prejudice to the powers conferred on a controlling trustee by section 190, the trustee may, at any time while the property of the debtor is subject to his or her control, make any payments from the debtor’s money that, in the opinion of the trustee, it is necessary to pay for the purpose of safeguarding the value of his or her property or any of it or of avoiding forfeiture or determination of any interest or rights of the debtor in or to property.

192  Changing the controlling trustee

 (1) If a registered trustee or solicitor who has consented to exercise the powers given by an authority under section 188:

 (a) dies; or

 (b) ceases to be a registered trustee or solicitor; or

 (c) becomes incapable of exercising his or her powers under this Part; or

 (d) gives the Official Trustee a written request to be relieved of duties under this Part;

then:

 (e) the Official Trustee becomes the controlling trustee; and

 (f) the debtor may sign a new authority under section 188.

 (2) If the debtor signs a new authority under section 188 naming a registered trustee or solicitor, the registered trustee or solicitor becomes the controlling trustee when he or she consents to exercise the powers given by the authority.

 (3) If:

 (a) a meeting of creditors or the Court nominates a registered trustee or the Official Trustee to be the trustee of a personal insolvency agreement; and

 (b) the nominated trustee is not already the controlling trustee;

the nominated trustee becomes the controlling trustee when the nominated trustee consents to act as trustee of the agreement.

 (4) A person who becomes the controlling trustee under this section:

 (a) has the same powers and duties as the person originally authorised by the debtor under section 188; and

 (b) is taken for the purposes of this Division to have done any act or thing duly done earlier by an earlier controlling trustee.

194  Time for calling meeting

 (1) The meeting that is to be called under an authority under section 188 must be held:

 (a) not more than 25 working days after the relevant consent or approval was given; or

 (b) if the relevant consent or approval was given in December—not more than 30 working days after the relevant consent or approval was given.

 (2) For the purposes of subsection (1), the relevant consent or approval is:

 (a) if the person authorised is a registered trustee or solicitor—the consent of the person to exercise the powers given by the authority; or

 (b) if the person authorised is the Official Trustee—the approval given by the Official Receiver to name the Official Trustee in the authority.

 (3) For the purposes of subsection (1), a working day is a day that is not a Saturday, Sunday or public holiday in the place where the meeting is to be held.

194A  Statement of affairs and declarations of relationships to be tabled at meeting

Scope

 (1) This section applies to a meeting that is called under an authority under section 188.

Debtor’s statement of affairs

 (2) The controlling trustee must table at the meeting a copy of the debtor’s statement of affairs.

 (3) If, assuming that the debtor had been required, immediately before the start of the meeting, to prepare a statement of affairs, that statement would have differed in one or more material respects from the statement given by the debtor under subsection 188(2C) or (2D), the debtor must table at the meeting a written statement identifying those differences.

Controlling trustee’s declaration

 (4) The controlling trustee must table at the meeting a copy of the declaration made by the controlling trustee under subsection 189A(3).

 (5) If, assuming that the controlling trustee had been required, immediately before the start of the meeting, to make a declaration stating whether the debtor is a related entity of:

 (a) the controlling trustee; or

 (b) a related entity of the controlling trustee;

that declaration would have differed in one or more material respects from the declaration made by the controlling trustee under subsection 189A(3), the controlling trustee must table at the meeting a written statement identifying those differences.

195  Debtor to attend meeting

 (1) The debtor shall, unless prevented by illness or other sufficient cause, attend the meeting.

 (2) At the meeting, the debtor must help the person presiding to the best of the debtor’s knowledge and ability.

 (3) The debtor shall, at the meeting, answer, to the best of his or her knowledge and ability, all questions put to him or her by the controlling trustee or by a creditor with respect to his or her conduct and examinable affairs.

 (3A) Where the Official Trustee is the controlling trustee, subsection (3) applies as if the reference in that subsection to the controlling trustee were a reference to an Official Receiver or a person authorized in writing by an Official Receiver to act on behalf of the Official Trustee at the meeting.

 (4) The failure of the debtor to attend the meeting does not affect the validity of any resolution passed at the meeting.

196  Procedure for calling and holding meeting

  Division 5 of Part IV applies, with any modifications prescribed by the regulations, in relation to a meeting called under an authority under section 188 as if:

 (a) the debtor who signed the authority were bankrupt; and

 (b) the controlling trustee were the trustee in the bankruptcy.

204  Resolution for personal insolvency agreement

 (1) The creditors may, at a meeting called in pursuance of an authority under section 188, by special resolution:

 (a) where the debtor’s property is subject to control under this Division, resolve that the debtor’s property be no longer subject to control under this Division;

 (b) require the debtor to execute a personal insolvency agreement; or

 (d) require the debtor to present a debtor’s petition within 7 days from the day on which the resolution was passed.

 (2) A special resolution requiring a debtor to execute a personal insolvency agreement must specify the provisions to be included in the agreement.

 (3) If a special resolution requiring the debtor to execute a personal insolvency agreement has been passed, the creditors must, by resolution, nominate a trustee or trustees to be trustee or trustees of the agreement.

 (5) The creditors may, in nominating a trustee or trustees for the purposes of subsection (3):

 (a) nominate 2 or more trustees to hold the office of trustee jointly, or jointly and severally; and

 (b) nominate trustees to be trustees of the personal insolvency agreement in succession in the event of one or more of the trustees nominated declining to act or ceasing for any reason to hold the office of trustee.

 (6) Property of the debtor that vests in 2 or more trustees of a personal insolvency agreement, whether nominated to hold the office jointly, or jointly and severally, vests in those trustees as joint tenants.

 (7) In this section:

trustee means registered trustee or Official Trustee.

205  Duties of sheriff after receiving notice of signing of authority under section 188 etc.

 (1) Subject to this section, where notice in writing of the signing by a debtor of an authority under section 188, of the calling of a meeting of creditors of a debtor in pursuance of this Division or of the passing of a special resolution under section 204 requiring a debtor to execute a personal insolvency agreement or present a debtor’s petition is given to a sheriff, the sheriff:

 (a) shall refrain:

 (i) from taking any action to sell property of the debtor in pursuance of any process of execution issued by or on behalf of a creditor; and

 (ii) from taking any action on behalf of a creditor to attach a debt due to the debtor; and

 (b) shall not:

 (i) pay to the creditor by whom, or on whose behalf, the process of execution was issued, or to any person on his or her behalf, the proceeds of the sale of property of the debtor that has been sold in pursuance of any such process or any moneys seized, or paid to avoid seizure or sale of property of the debtor, in pursuance of any such process; or

 (ii) pay to the creditor, or to any person on his or her behalf, any moneys received as a result of the attachment of the debt due to the debtor.

 (2) Where a notice is given under subsection (1) to a sheriff, a creditor who has issued a process of execution, or on whose behalf a process of execution has been issued, against property of the debtor, or who has taken action, or on whose behalf action has been taken, to attach a debt due to the debtor, in respect of a liability of the debtor under a maintenance agreement or maintenance order (whether entered into or made, as the case may be, before or after the commencement of this section) may give to the sheriff a written notice setting out details of the maintenance agreement or maintenance order, and, upon the giving of the notice, subsection (1) ceases to apply in relation to the process of execution or attachment, as the case may be.

 (3) Subject to this section, where notice in writing of the signing by a debtor of an authority under section 188, of the calling of a meeting of creditors of a debtor in pursuance of this Division or of the passing of a special resolution under section 204 requiring a debtor to execute a personal insolvency agreement or present a debtor’s petition is given to the registrar or other appropriate officer of a court:

 (a) to which the proceeds of the sale of property of the debtor or other moneys have been paid by a sheriff in pursuance of a process of execution issued, by or on behalf of a creditor, against property of the debtor; or

 (b) to which moneys have been paid in pursuance of proceedings instituted, by or on behalf of a creditor, to attach a debt due to the debtor;

any of those proceeds or moneys not paid out of court shall not be paid to the creditor or to any person on his or her behalf.

 (4) Where a notice is given under subsection (3) to the registrar or other appropriate officer of any court, a creditor who has issued a process of execution, or on whose behalf a process of execution has been issued, against property of the debtor, or who has taken action, or on whose behalf action has been taken, to attach a debt due to the debtor, in respect of a liability of the debtor under a maintenance agreement or maintenance order (whether entered into or made, as the case may be, before or after the commencement of this section) may give to the registrar or other officer a written notice setting out details of the maintenance agreement or maintenance order, and, upon the giving of the notice, subsection (3) ceases to apply in relation to the process of execution or the attachment, as the case may be.

 (5) Subsection (1) does not prevent the sheriff from selling property, taking action to attach a debt or paying the proceeds of the sale of property or other moneys to a creditor or a person on his or her behalf, and subsection (3) does not prevent moneys in court from being paid out of court to a creditor or a person on his or her behalf, if:

 (a) having received notice of the signing by the debtor of an authority under section 188, the sheriff, registrar or other officer does not, within 42 days from the date on which the debtor signed the authority, receive notice of the passing of a special resolution under section 204 requiring the debtor to execute a personal insolvency agreement or present a debtor’s petition;

 (b) having received notice that a meeting of creditors of the debtor has been called, the sheriff, registrar or other officer does not, within 7 days from the date for which the meeting was called, receive notice of the passing of a special resolution referred to in paragraph (a) or of the adjournment of the meeting;

 (c) having received notice of the adjournment of a meeting of creditors of the debtor, the sheriff, registrar or other officer does not, within 7 days from the date to which the meeting was adjourned, receive notice of the passing of a special resolution referred to in paragraph (a) or of the further adjournment of the meeting; or

 (d) having received notice of the passing of a special resolution referred to in paragraph (a), the sheriff, registrar or other officer does not, within 21 days from the date on which the resolution was passed, receive notice that the personal insolvency agreement required to be executed has been duly executed or that the debtor has presented a debtor’s petition.

 (6) Where:

 (a) the sheriff, in pursuance of subsection (1) of this section or of subsection 119(1) or (2), refrains from taking action to sell property of a debtor (being real property), the debtor executes a personal insolvency agreement, and the property vests in the trustee of the agreement; or

 (b) a sheriff, in pursuance of subsection (1), refrains from taking action to sell property of a debtor (being real property), the debtor becomes a bankrupt and the property vests in the trustee in the bankruptcy;

the costs of the execution are a first charge on that property.

 (7) A failure by the sheriff to comply with a provision of this section does not affect the title of a person who purchases property of a debtor in good faith under a sale by the sheriff in pursuance of a process of execution issued by or on behalf of a creditor.

205A  Duties of sheriff after receiving notice of execution of personal insolvency agreement etc.

 (4) Subject to this section, where:

 (a) the sheriff is satisfied:

 (i) that a debtor has executed a personal insolvency agreement; and

 (ii) that:

 (A) property of the debtor in his or her possession under a process of execution issued by or on behalf of a creditor; or

 (B) proceeds of the sale of property of the debtor or other moneys in his or her possession, being proceeds of the sale of property sold, whether before or after the execution of the agreement, in pursuance of any such process or moneys seized, or paid to avoid seizure or sale of property of the debtor, whether before or after the execution of the agreement, in pursuance of any such process; or

 (C) moneys in his or her possession as a result of the attachment, by or on behalf of a creditor, of a debt due to the debtor;

  is not, or are not, subject to the the agreement;

  the sheriff shall deliver that property, or pay those proceeds or other moneys, as the case requires, to the debtor or to a person authorized by the debtor in writing for the purpose; or

 (b) the registrar or other appropriate officer of a court is satisfied:

 (i) that a debtor has executed a personal insolvency agreement; and

 (ii) that:

 (A) proceeds of the sale of property of the debtor or other moneys in court, being proceeds of sale or other moneys paid into court, whether before or after the execution of the agreement, by a sheriff in pursuance of a process of execution issued, by or on behalf of a creditor, against property of the debtor; or

 (B) moneys in court that have been paid into court, whether before or after the execution of the agreement, in pursuance of proceedings instituted, by or on behalf of a creditor, to attach a debt due to the debtor;

  are not subject to the the agreement;

  the registrar or other officer shall pay those proceeds or other moneys, as the case requires, to the debtor or to a person authorized by the debtor in writing for the purpose.

 (5) The sheriff, registrar or other officer of a court shall not, in pursuance of subsection (4):

 (a) in the case of the sheriff—deliver property or pay the proceeds of the sale of property or other moneys; or

 (b) in the case of the registrar or other officer—pay moneys in court;

to the debtor or to a person authorized by the debtor unless:

 (c) 21 days have elapsed since the day on which the personal insolvency agreement was executed; and

 (d) the sheriff, registrar or other officer, as the case may be, is satisfied that application has not been made to the Court for an order to set aside or terminate the agreement or that the application, or each application, made for such an order has been withdrawn or dismissed.

 (6) Subject to this section, where:

 (a) the sheriff is satisfied:

 (i) that a debtor has executed a personal insolvency agreement; and

 (ii) that:

 (A) property of the debtor in his or her possession under a process of execution issued by or on behalf of a creditor; or

 (B) proceeds of the sale of property of the debtor or other moneys in his or her possession, being proceeds of the sale of property sold, whether before or after the execution of the agreement, in pursuance of any such process or moneys seized, or paid to avoid seizure or sale of property of the debtor, whether before or after the execution of the agreement, in pursuance of any such process; or

 (C) moneys in his or her possession as a result of the attachment, by or on behalf of a creditor, of a debt due to the debtor;

  is, or are, subject to the the agreement;

  the sheriff shall deliver that property, or pay those proceeds or other moneys, as the case requires, to the trustee of the agreement; or

 (b) the registrar or other appropriate officer of a court is satisfied:

 (i) that a debtor has executed a personal insolvency agreement; and

 (ii) that:

 (A) proceeds of the sale of property of the debtor or other moneys in court, being proceeds of sale or other moneys paid into court, whether before or after the execution of the agreement, by a sheriff in pursuance of a process of execution issued, by or on behalf of a creditor, against property of the debtor; or

 (B) moneys in court that have been paid into court, whether before or after the execution of the agreement, in pursuance of proceedings instituted, by or on behalf of a creditor, to attach a debt due to the debtor;

  are subject to the the agreement;

  the registrar or other officer shall pay those proceeds or other moneys, as the case requires, to the trustee of the agreement.

 (7) The sheriff, registrar or other officer of a court shall not, in pursuance of subsection (6):

 (a) in the case of the sheriff—deliver property or pay the proceeds of the sale of property or other moneys; or

 (b) in the case of the registrar or other officer—pay moneys in court;

to the trustee of the agreement unless:

 (c) 21 days have elapsed since the day on which the personal insolvency agreement was executed; and

 (d) the sheriff, registrar or other officer, as the case may be, is satisfied that application has not been made to the Court for an order to set aside or terminate the agreement or that the application, or each application, made for such an order has been withdrawn or dismissed.

 (8) Where property is, or the proceeds of the sale of property or other moneys are, required by subsection (4) or (6) to be delivered or paid to the trustee of a personal insolvency agreement or to a debtor or a person authorized by the debtor, the costs of the execution or attachment, as the case may be, are a first charge on that property or those proceeds of sale or other moneys, as the case may be.

 (9) For the purpose of giving effect to the charge referred to in subsection (8), the sheriff, registrar or other officer of a court may retain, on behalf of the creditor entitled to the benefit of the charge, such amount from the proceeds of sale or other moneys referred to in that subsection as he or she thinks necessary for the purpose.

 (10) Where a sheriff, registrar or other officer of a court has, in pursuance of subsection (4) or (6), delivered property or paid moneys to the trustee of a personal insolvency agreement or to the debtor or a person authorized by a debtor, the creditor who issued the process of execution or instituted the attachment proceedings, or on whose behalf the process was issued or the proceedings instituted, as the case may be, may prove under the agreement as an unsecured creditor as if the execution or attachment, as the case may be, had not taken place.

 (12) Where:

 (a) property has been delivered by a sheriff, or the proceeds of the sale of property or other moneys have been paid by a sheriff, registrar or other officer of a court:

 (i) to a debtor, or a person authorised by the debtor under subsection (4); or

 (ii) to the trustee of a personal insolvency agreement under subsection (6); and

 (b) the property was in the possession of the sheriff, or the proceeds of the sale of the property or the other moneys were in the possession of the sheriff or paid into court, as the case may be, under or in pursuance of a process of execution issued, or proceedings to attach a debt instituted, by or on behalf of a creditor in respect of a liability of the debtor under a maintenance agreement or maintenance order (whether entered into or made, as the case may be, before or after the commencement of this section);

the trustee, debtor or other person, as the case may be, to whom the property has been delivered, or those proceeds or other moneys have been paid, shall deliver that property, or pay those proceeds or other moneys, as the case requires, to that creditor.

 (13) A failure by a sheriff to comply with a provision of this section does not affect the title of a person who purchases property of a debtor in good faith under a sale by the sheriff in pursuance of a process of execution issued by or on behalf of a creditor.

206  Court may adjourn hearing of petition where creditors have passed resolution for personal insolvency agreement

 (1) Where:

 (a) a meeting of creditors has, in accordance with this Part, passed a special resolution requiring a debtor to execute a personal insolvency agreement; and

 (b) a creditor’s petition was presented against the debtor before the passing of the resolution or is presented against him or her after the passing of the resolution but before the agreement has been duly executed;

the Court may, upon application by the debtor, a creditor or a person nominated as trustee of the proposed agreement, if it appears to the Court that it would be for the advantage of the creditors that the debtor’s affairs be administered under the agreement, adjourn the hearing of the petition for such period as it considers necessary to allow the agreement to be executed and, if the agreement is duly executed within that period, shall dismiss the petition.

 (2) Where a creditor’s petition is presented against a debtor who has been required by special resolution of a meeting of creditors to execute a personal insolvency agreement, the creditor who presents the petition must, as soon as practicable, give notice in writing of that fact to the person who has been nominated as trustee of the agreement and to the Official Receiver.

207  Surrender of security etc. where secured creditor has voted

 (1) Where a secured creditor has estimated the value of his or her security for the purposes of voting at a meeting of creditors at which a special resolution requiring the debtor to execute a personal insolvency agreement was passed:

 (a) he or she is not entitled to estimate the value of the security for the purposes of proving part of his or her debt under the agreement at any other amount except with the approval of the Court; and

 (b) he or she shall, upon request in writing by the trustee of a personal insolvency agreement executed in accordance with the special resolution, surrender the security upon payment of the amount at which he or she has estimated the value of his or her security for the purposes of voting or, if the Court has approved his or her estimating the value of his or her security at another amount under paragraph (a), upon payment of that other amount.

 (2) The Court shall not grant its approval under paragraph (1)(a) unless it is satisfied that:

 (a) the estimate made for the purposes of voting was made in good faith on a mistaken basis; or

 (b) the value of the security has changed since that estimate was made.

 (3) Subject to subsection (4), where a secured creditor has voted at a meeting of creditors at which a special resolution referred to in subsection (1) was passed in respect of the whole of his or her debt without having surrendered his or her security:

 (a) he or she shall be deemed to have estimated his or her security as having no value; and

 (b) he or she shall, upon request in writing by the trustee of a personal insolvency agreement executed in accordance with the special resolution, surrender the security.

 (4) The Court may, upon application by a secured creditor to whom subsection (3) applies, if it is satisfied that his or her failure to estimate the value of his or her security was due to inadvertence, upon such terms as the Court considers just and equitable:

 (a) relieve him or her from the obligation to surrender the security; and

 (b) permit him or her to estimate its value for the purposes of proving part of his or her debt under the personal insolvency agreement.

 (5) Subject to subsection (4), if a creditor referred to in subsection (1) or (3) fails to comply with a request in writing under that subsection, the trustee by whom the request was made may apply to the Court for an order requiring the creditor to surrender the security to which the request related and the Court may make an order accordingly.

 (6) The right conferred on a secured creditor under section 90, as applied in relation to personal insolvency agreements, to realize his or her security and prove for the balance due to him or her is not exercisable where the trustee of such an agreement has requested the surrender of the security under this section.

208  Termination of control of debtor’s property by the Court

  The Court may make an order releasing the debtor’s property from control under this Division if:

 (a) an interested person applies to the Court for such an order; and

 (b) the Court is satisfied that special circumstances justify it making the order.

209  Acts of controlling trustee to bind trustee of subsequent personal insolvency agreement or bankruptcy

  Where:

 (a) a debtor signs an authority under section 188; and

 (b) subsequently a personal insolvency agreement is entered into by the debtor or the debtor becomes a bankrupt;

all payments made, acts and things done, transactions entered into and liabilities incurred by the controlling trustee in good faith in exercise of his or her powers under this Part are binding on the trustee of the personal insolvency agreement or in the bankruptcy, as the case may be.

210  Other provisions about controlling trustee

  Part VIII, with any modifications prescribed by the regulations, applies in relation to the controlling trustee in relation to a debtor as if:

 (a) the debtor were a bankrupt; and

 (b) the controlling trustee were the trustee of the estate of the bankrupt debtor.

211  Other provisions about debtor

 (1) Sections 77, 77A, 77C, 77D, 77E, 77F, 78 (other than paragraphs 78(1)(a), (b) and (c)) and 81, with any modifications prescribed by the regulations, apply in relation to a debtor whose property is subject to control under this Division as if:

 (a) the debtor were a bankrupt; and

 (b) the controlling trustee were the trustee of the estate of the bankrupt debtor.

 (2) Section 78 (other than paragraphs 78(1)(d) and (f)), with any modifications prescribed by the regulations, applies in relation to a debtor whose property is subject to control under this Division as if the debtor were a debtor against whom a bankruptcy notice has been presented.

Division 3General provisions

215  Eligibility to be trustee of personal insolvency agreement

  Only a registered trustee or the Official Trustee can be a trustee of a personal insolvency agreement.

215A  Nomination or appointment of trustee of personal insolvency agreement

 (1) A resolution that is passed at a meeting of creditors and purports to:

 (a) nominate one or more persons under subsection 204(3) to be a trustee or trustees; or

 (b) appoint a person under subsection 220(1) to a vacant office of trustee of a personal insolvency agreement;

is void unless the person or each of the persons gave written consent before the meeting to act as a trustee of the agreement.

 (1A) As soon as possible after the resolution is passed, each person (except the Official Trustee) nominated or appointed by the resolution must give to the Official Receiver a copy of the consent that relates to that person.

 (2) Where, if this subsection had not been enacted, a resolution purporting to nominate a person or persons, or to appoint a person, would, because of a particular matter, be void by virtue of subsection (1), the Court may, on the application of the person, or of any of the persons, as the case may be, or of any other interested person, by order declare the resolution not to be void merely because of that matter.

 (3) Before a resolution is passed at a meeting of creditors that nominates one or more persons under subsection 204(3) to be a trustee or trustees:

 (a) the person or each of those persons must make a written declaration stating whether the debtor is a related entity of:

 (i) the person concerned; or

 (ii) a related entity of the person concerned; and

 (b) the person or each of those persons must:

 (i) give his or her declaration to the controlling trustee; and

 (ii) keep a copy of his or her declaration; and

 (c) the controlling trustee must table at the meeting a copy of each declaration given to the controlling trustee; and

 (d) the controlling trustee must give a copy of each such declaration to each of the creditors at the same time as the controlling trustee gives a copy of the subsection 189A(1) report to each creditor.

 (4) Before a resolution is passed at a meeting of creditors that appoints a person under subsection 220(1) to a vacant office of trustee of a personal insolvency agreement:

 (a) the person must make a written declaration stating whether the debtor is a related entity of:

 (i) the person; or

 (ii) a related entity of the person; and

 (b) the person must:

 (i) give his or her declaration to the person presiding at the meeting; and

 (ii) keep a copy of his or her declaration; and

 (c) the person presiding at the meeting must table at the meeting a copy of the declaration.

216  Execution of personal insolvency agreements

 (1) A personal insolvency agreement must be executed by the debtor and the trustee within 21 days from the day on which the special resolution requiring the debtor to execute the agreement was passed.

 (2) The execution of the agreement by the debtor and by the trustee shall be attested by a witness.

217  Failure of trustee to execute personal insolvency agreement

 (1) Where a personal insolvency agreement is not executed, as required by section 216, by the registered trustee, or a registered trustee, nominated in a resolution of a meeting of creditors under section 204 to be the trustee, or a trustee, as the case requires, of the agreement, a meeting of creditors called for the purpose, in accordance with the regulations, by any creditor or the debtor may, by resolution, nominate any other registered trustee in the place of that registered trustee.

 (2) If the agreement is not executed by the registered trustee so nominated within 7 days from the date on which the resolution was passed or within such further period as the Court, on application made before the expiration of that period of 7 days, allows, the Court may, upon application by a creditor, nominate any registered trustee who is prepared to accept the office to be trustee in the place of the registered trustee who did not execute the agreement as required by section 216.

 (3) A registered trustee so nominated by the Court shall execute the agreement within 7 days from the date on which the trustee was so nominated or within such further period as the Court, on application made before the expiration of that period of 7 days, allows.

218  Notice of execution of personal insolvency agreement

 (1) The trustee of a personal insolvency agreement entered into in pursuance of this Part shall:

 (a) notify each creditor of the debtor as soon as practicable after the debtor and the trustee have executed the agreement; and

 (b) within 2 days after the execution of the agreement by the debtor and the trustee—file a copy of the agreement in the office of the Official Receiver.

 (2) The trustee commits an offence if the trustee fails to comply with a requirement under paragraph (1)(b).

Penalty: 5 penalty units.

Note: See also section 277B (about infringement notices).

 (2A) Subsection (2) is an offence of strict liability.

Note: For strict liability, see section 6.1 of the Criminal Code.

 (3) A trustee must notify creditors under paragraph (1)(a) in the way prescribed by the regulations.

219  Trustee may sue, be sued etc. by official name

 (1) The trustee of a personal insolvency agreement entered into in pursuance of this Part may sue and be sued by the prescribed official name and may, by that name, hold, dispose of or acquire property of every description, make contracts, enter into engagements binding on the trustee and his or her successors in office and do all other acts and things necessary or expedient to be done in the execution of the office of trustee.

 (2) For the purposes of subsection (1), the prescribed official name is “The Trustee (or Trustees) of the Property of (name of debtor), a Debtor”.

220  Filling of vacancy in office of trustee after execution of personal insolvency agreement etc.

 (1) Where a vacancy occurs in the office of trustee of a personal insolvency agreement entered into under this Part, a meeting of creditors called for the purpose may, by resolution, appoint a registered trustee to the vacant office.

 (2) Where, at any time, a vacancy exists in an office of trustee of such a personal insolvency agreement, the Court may, on the application of the debtor, a creditor or an Official Receiver:

 (a) appoint to the vacant office a registered trustee who is willing to accept the appointment; or

 (b) appoint the Official Trustee or a registered trustee, being a registered trustee who is willing so to act, to act as trustee until the vacant office is filled by a meeting of creditors.

 (3) The appointment of a trustee to a vacant office of trustee by a meeting of creditors shall be deemed to have taken effect as from the date on which the vacancy in the office occurred, except where the Official Trustee or a registered trustee has been appointed to act as trustee under paragraph (2)(b), in which case the appointment takes effect on the date on which it is made.

 (4) The appointment of a registered trustee to a vacant office of trustee by the Court shall be deemed to have taken effect as from the date on which the vacancy in the office occurred.

 (5) Where, under this section, the Official Trustee or a registered trustee is appointed to an office of trustee or to act as trustee:

 (a) all property to which the personal insolvency agreement relates that is vested in the former trustee, alone or jointly with another trustee, shall, subject to subsection (6), vest in the Official Trustee or that registered trustee, as the case may be, alone or jointly with any continuing trustee, as the case may be, without any conveyance, assignment or transfer, as from the date on which the appointment takes effect or is deemed to have taken effect; and

 (b) the Official Trustee or that registered trustee, as the case may be, has the same rights, powers, duties and liabilities as if the Official Trustee or that registered trustee, as the case may be, had been an original trustee, but is not personally liable in respect of any act done, omission made or liability incurred by a prior trustee.

 (6) Where a law of the Commonwealth or of a State or Territory of the Commonwealth requires the transmission of property to be registered, and enables a trustee so appointed to be registered as the owner of any such property to which the personal insolvency agreement relates, that property, notwithstanding that it vests in equity in the trustee by virtue of this section, does not vest in the trustee at law until the requirements of that law have been complied with.

221  Sequestration order where debtor fails to attend meeting, execute personal insolvency agreement etc.

 (1) Where:

 (a) a debtor has failed, without sufficient cause, to attend a meeting of creditors called under an authority signed by him or her under section 188;

 (aa) a debtor has contravened subsection 189(2);

 (b) a debtor, having been required by a special resolution of a meeting of creditors called in pursuance of such an authority to execute a personal insolvency agreement, has failed without sufficient cause to execute the agreement within the time prescribed by this Act; or

 (c) a meeting of creditors called in pursuance of such an authority has not, within 4 months from the date for which the meeting was called, passed one of the special resolutions referred to in subsection 204(1);

the Court may, if it thinks fit, on the application of the InspectorGeneral, a creditor or the controlling trustee, forthwith make a sequestration order against the estate of the debtor.

 (2) The Court may, if it thinks fit, dispense with service on the debtor of notice of an application under this section, either unconditionally or subject to conditions.

 (3) Subject to subsection (4), the making of an application under this section in respect of a debtor shall, for the purposes of this Act, be deemed to be equivalent to the presentation of a creditor’s petition against the debtor.

 (4) The provisions of subsection 43(1), sections 44 and 47, subsections 52(1) and (2) and Part XIA do not apply in relation to an application under this section, but, on the hearing of such an application, the Court shall require proof (which may be given by affidavit) of the matters stated in the application and, unless service has been dispensed with by the Court, of service of the application on the debtor.

221A  Variation of personal insolvency agreement

Variation by special resolution of creditors

 (1) The creditors, with the written consent of the debtor, may vary a personal insolvency agreement by special resolution at a meeting called for the purpose.

Variation by trustee

 (2) The trustee, with the written consent of the debtor, may, in writing, propose a variation of a personal insolvency agreement.

 (3) The trustee must give notice of the proposed variation to all the creditors who would be entitled under section 64A (as that section applies in accordance with section 223A) to receive notice of a meeting of creditors.

 (4) The notice must:

 (a) include a statement of the reasons for the variation and the likely impact it will have on creditors (if it takes effect); and

 (b) specify a date (at least 14 days after the notice is given) from which it is proposed that the variation will take effect; and

 (c) state that any creditor may, by written notice to the trustee at least 2 days before the specified date, object to the variation taking effect without there being a meeting of creditors.

 (5) If no creditor lodges a written notice of objection with the trustee at least 2 days before the specified date, then the proposed variation takes effect on the date specified in the notice.

 (6) A certificate signed by the trustee stating any matter relating to a proposed variation under subsection (2) is prima facie evidence of the matter.

222  Court may set aside personal insolvency agreement

Setting aside on grounds of unreasonableness etc.

 (1) If a personal insolvency agreement is in force, the Court may, on application by:

 (a) the InspectorGeneral; or

 (b) the trustee; or

 (c) a creditor;

make an order setting the agreement aside if the Court is satisfied that:

 (d) the terms of the agreement are unreasonable or are not calculated to benefit the creditors generally; or

 (e) for any other reason, the agreement ought to be set aside.

Setting aside on grounds of noncompliance with this Part etc.

 (2) If a personal insolvency agreement is in force, the Court may, on application by:

 (a) the InspectorGeneral; or

 (b) the trustee; or

 (c) a creditor; or

 (d) the debtor;

make an order setting the agreement aside if the Court is satisfied that:

 (e) the agreement was not entered into in accordance with this Part; or

 (f) the agreement does not comply with the requirements of this Part.

 (3) The Court must not make an order setting aside a personal insolvency agreement on the ground that it does not comply with the requirements of this Part if the agreement complies substantially with those requirements.

 (4) The Court must not make an order under subsection (2) unless the application for the order is made before all the obligations that the personal insolvency agreement created have been discharged.

Setting aside on grounds of false or misleading information etc.

 (5) If a personal insolvency agreement is in force, the Court may, on application by:

 (a) the InspectorGeneral; or

 (b) the trustee; or

 (c) a creditor;

make an order setting the agreement aside if the Court is satisfied that:

 (d) the debtor has given false or misleading information in answer to a question put to the debtor with respect to any of the debtor’s conduct or examinable affairs at the meeting of creditors at which the resolution requiring the debtor to execute the agreement was passed; or

 (e) the debtor has:

 (i) omitted a material particular from the statement of the debtor’s affairs given under subsection 188(2C) or (2D); or

 (ii) included an incorrect and material particular in that statement; or

 (f) the debtor was subject to a requirement under subsection 194A(3) to table a statement, and the debtor has:

 (i) omitted a material particular from that statement; or

 (ii) included an incorrect and material particular in that statement; or

 (g) the controlling trustee has:

 (i) omitted a material particular from the declaration given by the controlling trustee under subsection 189A(3); or

 (ii) included an incorrect and material particular in that declaration; or

 (h) the controlling trustee was subject to a requirement under subsection 194A(5) to table a statement, and the controlling trustee has:

 (i) omitted a material particular from that statement; or

 (ii) included an incorrect and material particular in that statement; or

 (i) a person who became the trustee of the agreement has:

 (i) omitted a material particular from the declaration given by the person under subsection 215A(3) or (4); or

 (ii) included an incorrect and material particular in that declaration.

 (6) The Court must not make an order under subsection (5) unless it is satisfied that it would be in the interests of the creditors to do so.

 (7) The Court must not make an order under subsection (5) unless the application for the order is made before all the obligations that the personal insolvency agreement created have been discharged.

Ancillary orders

 (8) If the Court makes an order under subsection (1), (2) or (5), the Court may make such other orders as the Court thinks fit.

 (9) An order under subsection (8) may be an order directing a person to pay another person compensation of such amount as is specified in the order. This subsection does not limit subsection (8).

Application for sequestration order

 (10) The trustee or a creditor may include in an application under subsection (1), (2) or (5) an application for a sequestration order against the estate of the debtor. If the Court, on the firstmentioned application, makes an order under this section setting the personal insolvency agreement aside, it may, if it thinks fit, immediately make the sequestration order sought.

 (11) The making of an application by the trustee or a creditor for a sequestration order under this section is taken, for the purposes of this Act, to be equivalent to the presentation of a creditor’s petition against the debtor, but the provisions of subsection 43(1), sections 44 and 47, subsections 52(1) and (2) and Part XIA do not apply in relation to such an application.

Court may dispense with service on debtor of notice of application

 (12) The Court may, if it thinks fit, dispense with service on the debtor of notice of an application by the InspectorGeneral, the trustee or a creditor under this section, either unconditionally or subject to conditions.

222A  Termination of personal insolvency agreement by trustee

 (1) The trustee of a personal insolvency agreement may, in writing, propose the termination of the agreement if the trustee is satisfied that the debtor is in default.

 (2) The trustee must give notice of the proposed termination to all the creditors who would be entitled under section 64A (as that section applies in accordance with section 223A) to receive notice of a meeting of creditors.

 (3) The notice must:

 (a) include a statement of the reasons for the termination and the likely impact it will have on creditors (if it takes effect); and

 (b) specify a date (at least 14 days after the notice is given) from which it is proposed that the termination will take effect; and

 (c) state that any creditor may, by written notice to the trustee at least 2 days before the specified date, object to the termination taking effect without there being a meeting of creditors.

 (4) If:

 (a) the debtor is in default; and

 (b) no creditor lodges a written notice of objection with the trustee at least 2 days before the specified date;

then the proposed termination takes effect on the date specified in the notice.

 (5) For the purposes of this section, the debtor is in default if, and only if:

 (a) the debtor has failed to carry out or comply with a term of the personal insolvency agreement; or

 (b) if the debtor has died—the debtor or the person administering the estate of the debtor has failed to carry out or comply with a term of the agreement.

 (6) A certificate signed by the trustee stating any matter relating to a proposed termination under this section is prima facie evidence of the matter.

222B  Termination of personal insolvency agreement by creditors

 (1) The creditors may, by resolution at a meeting called for the purpose, terminate a personal insolvency agreement if:

 (a) the debtor is in default; and

 (b) before the passage of the resolution, the trustee of the agreement tabled at the meeting a written declaration to the effect that the trustee is satisfied that the debtor is in default.

 (2) The creditors may, by special resolution at a meeting called for the purpose, terminate the personal insolvency agreement if:

 (a) property of the debtor is covered by a restraining order or a forfeiture order; or

 (b) a pecuniary penalty order made against the debtor is in force.

 (3) However:

 (a) paragraph (2)(a) does not apply if, when the personal insolvency agreement was made, the restraining order or forfeiture order already covered the property in question; and

 (b) paragraph (2)(b) does not apply if, when the personal insolvency agreement was made, the pecuniary penalty order was already in force against the debtor.

 (4) For the purposes of this section, the debtor is in default if, and only if:

 (a) the debtor has failed to carry out or comply with a term of the personal insolvency agreement; or

 (b) if the debtor has died—the debtor or the person administering the estate of the debtor has failed to carry out or comply with a term of the agreement.

222C  Court may terminate personal insolvency agreement

 (1) If a personal insolvency agreement is in force, the Court may, on application by:

 (a) the trustee; or

 (b) a creditor; or

 (c) the debtor; or

 (d) if the debtor has died—the person administering the estate of the debtor;

make an order terminating the agreement if the Court is satisfied:

 (e) that:

 (i) the debtor; or

 (ii) if the debtor has died—the debtor or the person administering the estate of the debtor;

  has failed to carry out or comply with a term of the agreement; or

 (f) that the agreement cannot be proceeded with without injustice or undue delay to:

 (i) the creditors; or

 (ii) the debtor; or

 (iii) if the debtor has died—the estate of the debtor; or

 (g) that, for any other reason, the agreement ought to be terminated.

 (2) The Court must not make an order terminating a personal insolvency agreement on the ground specified in paragraph (1)(e) or (g) unless it is satisfied that it would be in the interests of the creditors to do so.

Ancillary orders

 (3) If the Court makes an order terminating a personal insolvency agreement, the Court may make such other orders as the Court thinks fit.

 (4) An order under subsection (3) may be an order directing a person to pay another person compensation of such amount as is specified in the order. This subsection does not limit subsection (3).

Application for sequestration order

 (5) The trustee or a creditor may include in an application under subsection (1) an application for a sequestration order against the estate of the debtor. If the Court, on the firstmentioned application, makes an order under this section terminating the personal insolvency agreement, it may, if it thinks fit, immediately make the sequestration order sought.

 (6) The making of an application by the trustee or a creditor for a sequestration order under this section is taken, for the purposes of this Act, to be equivalent to the presentation of a creditor’s petition against the debtor, but the provisions of subsection 43(1), sections 44 and 47, subsections 52(1) and (2) and Part XIA do not apply in relation to such an application.

Court may dispense with service on debtor of notice of application

 (7) The Court may, if it thinks fit, dispense with service on the debtor of notice of an application by the trustee or a creditor under this section, either unconditionally or subject to conditions.

222D  Termination of personal insolvency agreement by occurrence of terminating event

  A personal insolvency agreement is terminated by the occurrence of any circumstance or event on the occurrence of which the agreement provides that it is to terminate.

223  Calling of meetings after the first meeting

 (1) The controlling trustee or the trustee of a personal insolvency agreement:

 (a) may call such meetings of the creditors as he or she considers necessary or desirable for the purposes of this Part; and

 (b)  shall call meetings of the creditors at such times as the creditors, by resolution, direct and whenever requested in writing to call such a meeting by not less than onefourth in value of the creditors.

 (3) If, at any time, there is no trustee of a personal insolvency agreement, any creditor or the debtor may call a meeting of creditors (other than the meeting referred to in section 194) for the purposes of appointing a trustee of the agreement.

223A  Rules in relation to meetings

 (1) Division 5 of Part IV applies, with any modifications prescribed by the regulations, in relation to a meeting called under section 223 as if:

 (a) the debtor who signed the authority under section 188 were bankrupt; and

 (b) the person who called the meeting were the trustee in the bankruptcy.

 (2) Section 195 applies, with any modifications prescribed by the regulations, in relation to a meeting called under section 223 as if references in section 195 to the controlling trustee included references to the trustee of a personal insolvency agreement.

224  Validity of acts if personal insolvency agreement set aside or terminated

Scope

 (1) This section applies if a personal insolvency agreement is:

 (a) set aside by the Court; or

 (b) terminated.

Validity of acts

 (2) All payments made, acts and things done and transactions entered into in good faith under, or for the purposes of, the agreement by:

 (a) the trustee; or

 (b) any other person;

before he or she had notice of the order of the Court or of the termination of the agreement, as the case may be, are valid and effectual and are not liable to be set aside by the trustee of a later personal insolvency agreement or in a subsequent bankruptcy.

224A  Notice that a personal insolvency agreement has been set aside, varied or terminated

 (1) If a personal insolvency agreement is terminated or varied by a resolution or special resolution at a meeting of creditors called for the purpose, the trustee of the agreement must, before the end of the period of 2 days beginning on the day of the termination or variation, file a copy of the resolution or special resolution in the office of the Official Receiver.

Penalty: 5 penalty units.

Note: See also section 277B (about infringement notices).

 (2) If a personal insolvency agreement is varied in accordance with subsection 221A(5), the trustee of the agreement must, before the end of the period of 2 days beginning on the day of the variation, file a copy of the variation in the office of the Official Receiver.

Penalty: 5 penalty units.

Note: See also section 277B (about infringement notices).

 (3) If a personal insolvency agreement is terminated by the occurrence of any circumstance or event on the occurrence of which the deed provides that it is to terminate, the trustee of the agreement must, before the end of the period of 2 days beginning on the day of the termination, give written notice of that fact to the Official Receiver.

Penalty: 5 penalty units.

Note: See also section 277B (about infringement notices).

 (4) If:

 (a) the Court makes an order setting aside or terminating a personal insolvency agreement; and

 (b) a registered trustee was the trustee of the personal insolvency agreement;

the registered trustee must, before the end of the period of 2 days beginning on the day the trustee becomes aware of the order, give written notice of the order to the Official Receiver.

Penalty: 5 penalty units.

Note: See also section 277B (about infringement notices).

 (5) If:

 (a) the Court makes an order setting aside or terminating a personal insolvency agreement; or

 (b) a personal insolvency agreement is terminated otherwise than because of an order of the Court;

the trustee of the personal insolvency agreement must give written notice of the order or termination to each of the creditors within 2 working days of the making of the order or of the termination, as the case may be.

Penalty: 5 penalty units.

Note: See also section 277B (about infringement notices).

 (6) For the purposes of subsection (5), a working day is a day that is not a Saturday, Sunday or public holiday in:

 (a) in the case of an order made by the Court—the place where the order is made; or

 (b) in the case of a termination otherwise than because of an order of the Court:

 (i) if the trustee of the personal insolvency agreement has only one office—the place where that office is located; or

 (ii) if the trustee of the personal insolvency agreement has 2 or more offices—the place where the principal office is located.

 (7) Subsections (1), (2), (3), (4) and (5) are offences of strict liability.

Note: For strict liability, see section 6.1 of the Criminal Code.

225  Evidence of personal insolvency agreement, resolution etc.

 (1) A personal insolvency agreement that purports to have been executed by the debtor and by the trustee, and to have been attested in accordance with this Part, shall, unless and until the contrary is proved, be deemed to have been duly executed and attested.

 (2) A certificate of the passing of a special resolution under section 204 signed in accordance with that section is prima facie evidence that the meeting was duly convened and held and that the special resolution specified in the certificate was duly passed at the meeting.

 (3) A certificate of the passing of a resolution (not being a special resolution) under section 204 signed in accordance with that section is prima facie evidence that the resolution specified in the certificate was duly passed at the meeting.

 (4) The minutes of a meeting held under this Part signed in accordance with section 203 are prima facie evidence of the proceedings at the meeting.

226  Creditor may inspect personal insolvency agreement etc.

 (1) A person who states in writing that he or she is a creditor of a debtor who has executed a personal insolvency agreement under this Part may, at all reasonable times, inspect without fee, personally or by an agent, the agreement, the statement of the debtor’s affairs given under subsection 188(2C) or (2D) and the proofs of debt of creditors and may make copies of, or take extracts from, the agreement, the statement and the proofs.

 (3) A person who states in writing that he or she is a creditor of a debtor who has executed a personal insolvency agreement under this Part may without fee, and any other person may on payment of the fee determined by the Minister by legislative instrument, inspect, personally or by an agent, any document filed under this Part in the office of the Official Receiver in relation to the debtor, and may make copies of, or take extracts from, the document.

 (4) Any person is entitled, on payment of the fee determined by the Minister by legislative instrument, to obtain an office copy of any document filed under this Part in the office of the Official Receiver.

227  Stamp duty not payable on personal insolvency agreements etc. entered into under this Part

  Stamp duty is not payable under a law of a State or Territory on:

 (a) an authority under section 188; or

 (b) a personal insolvency agreement.

229  Personal insolvency agreement to bind all creditors

 (1) A personal insolvency agreement that:

 (a) is entered into in accordance with this Part; and

 (b) complies with the requirements of this Part;

is, upon being duly executed by the debtor and the trustee, binding on all the creditors of the debtor.

 (2) If a personal insolvency agreement has become binding on the creditors of the debtor, it is not competent for a creditor, so long as the agreement remains valid:

 (a) to present a creditor’s petition against the debtor, or to proceed with such a petition presented before the agreement became so binding, in respect of a provable debt; or

 (b) to enforce any remedy against the person or property of the debtor in respect of a provable debt; or

 (c) to commence any legal proceeding in respect of a provable debt or take any fresh step in such a proceeding.

 (3) This section does not:

 (a) affect the right of a secured creditor to realise or otherwise deal with the creditor’s security; or

 (b) prevent a creditor, after all the obligations that a personal insolvency agreement created have been discharged, from taking any proceeding or enforcing any remedy in respect of a provable debt from which the debtor is not released by the operation of the agreement.

 (4) This section does not prevent a creditor from enforcing any remedy against:

 (a) a debtor who has executed a personal insolvency agreement; or

 (b) any property of such a debtor that is not subject to the agreement;

in respect of any liability of the debtor under a maintenance agreement or maintenance order (whether entered into or made, as the case may be, before or after the commencement of this subsection).

230  Release of provable debts

 (1) If a personal insolvency agreement provides for a debtor to be released from a provable debt, the agreement operates to release the debtor from that provable debt unless the agreement is set aside or terminated under this Part.

 (2) Subsection (1) has effect subject to subsections (3), (4) and (5).

Exceptions

 (3) Subsection (1) does not operate to release the debtor from a debt that would not be released by his or her discharge from bankruptcy if he or she had become a bankrupt on the day on which he or she executed the personal insolvency agreement.

 (4) Subsection (1) does not affect the right of a secured creditor, or a person claiming through or under a secured creditor, to realise or otherwise deal with the creditor’s security:

 (a) if the secured creditor has not proved under the agreement for any part of the secured debt—for the purpose of obtaining payment of the secured debt; or

 (b) if the secured creditor has proved under the agreement for part of the secured debt—for the purpose of obtaining payment of the part of the secured debt for which the creditor has not proved under the agreement;

and, for the purposes of enabling the secured creditor, or a person claiming through or under a secured creditor, so to realise or deal with the creditor’s security, but not otherwise, the secured debt, or the part of the secured debt, as the case may be, is taken not to have been released.

 (5) A personal insolvency agreement does not release from any liability a person who, at the date on which the debtor executed the agreement, was:

 (a) a partner or a cotrustee with the debtor; or

 (b) jointly bound or had made a joint contract with the debtor; or

 (c) surety or in the nature of a surety for the debtor.

231  Application of general provisions of Act to personal insolvency agreements

 (1) Sections 77, 77A, 77AA, 77C, 77D, 77E, 77F, 78 (other than paragraphs 78(1)(a), (b) and (c)) and 81 apply, with the prescribed modifications (if any), in relation to a debtor who has executed a personal insolvency agreement as if:

 (a) the debtor were a bankrupt; and

 (b) the trustee of the agreement were the trustee of the estate of the bankrupt debtor.

 (2) Section 78 (other than paragraphs 78(1)(d) and (f)) applies, with the prescribed modifications (if any), in relation to a debtor who has executed a personal insolvency agreement as if the debtor were a debtor against whom a bankruptcy notice has been presented.

 (3) Subsection 58(4) and sections 60, 61, 62, 70, 71, 72, 82 to 118, 127 to 130 and 133 to 139H, Subdivisions I and J of Division 4B of Part VI and sections 140 to 147 apply, with the prescribed modifications (if any), in relation to such an agreement as if:

 (a) a creditor’s petition had been presented against the debtor by whom the agreement was executed on the day on which the special resolution requiring the execution of the agreement was passed; and

 (b) a sequestration order had been made against him or her on that petition on the day on which he or she executed the agreement; and

 (c) the trustee of the agreement were the trustee in his or her bankruptcy.

 (4) In the application, by virtue of subsections (1), (2) and (3), of the provisions referred to in those subsections:

 (a) a reference to the property of the bankrupt is to be read as a reference to the divisible property of the debtor; and

 (b) a reference to a provable debt is to be read as a reference to a provable debt within the meaning of this Part; and

 (c) a reference to the end of the bankruptcy is to be read as a reference to the end of the personal insolvency agreement.

 (5) Part VIII applies, with any modifications prescribed by the regulations, in relation to a trustee of a personal insolvency agreement as if:

 (a) the debtor by whom the agreement was executed were a bankrupt; and

 (b) the trustee of the agreement were the trustee in his or her bankruptcy.

 (6) If, after taking into account the prescribed modifications and the provisions of subsection (4), a provision specified in subsection (1), (2), (3) or (5) is incapable of application in relation to a personal insolvency agreement, or the trustee of such an agreement, as the case requires, or is inconsistent with this Part, that provision does not so have application.

 (7) This Division does not empower the Court to stay any proceedings under a proceeds of crime law.

231A  Right of debtor to remaining property

 (1) The debtor to whom a personal insolvency agreement relates is entitled to any property remaining after payment in full of:

 (a) the costs, charges and expenses of the administration of the agreement; and

 (b) all provable debts; and

 (c) interest on interestbearing provable debts.

 (2) The Court may make an order directing the trustee not to pay or transfer the property, or a specified part of the property, referred to in subsection (1), to the debtor if:

 (a) an application is made for an order under this subsection by a person mentioned in subsection (2A); and

 (b) the Court is satisfied that proceedings are pending under a proceeds of crime law; and

 (c) the Court is satisfied that property of the debtor may:

 (i) become subject to a forfeiture order or interstate forfeiture order made in the proceedings; or

 (ii) be required to satisfy a pecuniary penalty order or interstate pecuniary penalty order made in the proceedings.

 (2A) For the purposes of paragraph (2)(a), the application may be made by:

 (a) in the case of pending proceedings in relation to a forfeiture order or a pecuniary penalty order under the Proceeds of Crime Act 2002—the Commonwealth proceeds of crime authority that is, or that is proposed to be, the responsible authority for the application for the order under that Act; or

 (b) in the case of pending proceedings under a corresponding law—a person who is entitled to apply for an interstate confiscation order under the corresponding law.

 (3) The Court, on application made to it, may vary or revoke an order made under subsection (2).

232  Certificate relating to discharge of obligations

 (1) If the trustee of a personal insolvency agreement is satisfied that all the obligations that the agreement created have been discharged, the trustee must, on written request by the debtor, give the debtor a certificate signed by the trustee to that effect.

 (2) A certificate signed by a trustee under this section is prima facie evidence of the facts stated in it.

Part XIAdministration of estates of deceased persons in bankruptcy

 

244  Administration of estates under this Part upon petition by creditor

 (1) Subject to this section, where:

 (a) a debt of not less than $5,000 was owing by a deceased person at the time of his or her death to a creditor, or debts amounting in the aggregate to not less than that amount were so owing to any 2 or more creditors;

 (b) a debt incurred by the legal personal representative of a deceased person of not less than $5,000 is owing to a creditor, or debts so incurred amounting in the aggregate to not less than that amount are owing to any 2 or more creditors; or

 (c) a debt of not less than $5,000, or debts amounting in the aggregate to not less than that amount, which a deceased person would have been liable to pay to a creditor or any 2 or more creditors if he or she had not died becomes or become owing after his or her death;

the creditor or creditors to whom the debt or debts is or are owing may present a petition to the Court for an order for the administration of the estate of the deceased person (in this section referred to as the deceased debtor) under this Part.

 (2) Subject to subsection (3), a secured creditor shall, for the purposes of subsection (1), be deemed to be a creditor only to the extent, if any, by which the amount of the debt owing to him or her exceeds the value of his or her security.

 (3) A secured creditor may present, or join in presenting, a petition under this section as if he or she were an unsecured creditor if he or she includes in the petition a statement that he or she is willing to surrender his or her security for the benefit of creditors generally in the event of an order for the administration of the estate under this Part being made.

 (4) Where a petitioning creditor is a secured creditor, he or she shall set out in the petition particulars of his or her security.

 (5) A petition under this section shall be verified by the affidavit of a person who has knowledge of the facts.

 (6) A petition under this section shall not be presented unless:

 (a) the debt, or each of the debts, in respect of which it is presented:

 (i) is a liquidated sum due at law or in equity or partly at law and partly in equity; and

 (ii) is payable immediately or at a certain future time; and

 (b) at the time of his or her death, the deceased debtor:

 (i) was personally present or ordinarily resident in Australia;

 (ii) had a dwellinghouse or place of business in Australia;

 (iii) was carrying on business in Australia, either personally or by means of an agent or manager; or

 (iv) was a member of a firm or partnership carrying on business in Australia by means of a partner or partners, or of an agent or manager.

 (7) Where a secured creditor has presented, or joined in presenting, a petition under this section as if he or she were an unsecured creditor, he or she shall, upon request in writing by the trustee within 3 months after the making of an order for the administration of the estate under this Part, surrender his or her security to the trustee for the benefit of the creditors generally.

 (8) A secured creditor to whom subsection (7) applies who fails to surrender his or her security when requested to do so by the trustee in accordance with that subsection is guilty of contempt of court.

 (9) Subject to subsection (10), a sealed copy of the petition shall be served upon the legal personal representative of the deceased debtor or, if there is no legal personal representative, upon such person as the Court directs.

 (10) The Court may, if it is satisfied that there is no legal personal representative of the deceased debtor and that there are special circumstances that justify its so doing, by order dispense with service of the petition, either unconditionally or subject to conditions.

 (11) At the hearing of the petition, the Court shall require proof of:

 (a) the matters stated in the petition (for which purpose the Court may accept the affidavit verifying the petition as sufficient);

 (b) service of the petition, unless service of the petition has been dispensed with; and

 (c) the fact that the debt or debts to which the petition relates is or are still owing;

and if it is satisfied with the proof of those matters, may make an order that the estate be administered under this Part.

 (12) If the Court is not satisfied with the proof of any of those matters or is of the opinion that for other sufficient cause the order sought ought not be made, it may dismiss the petition.

 (13) Where proceedings have been commenced in a court for the administration of a deceased person’s estate under a law of a State or Territory, a petition for an order under this section in relation to the estate shall not be presented by a creditor except by leave of the Court and on such terms and conditions (if any) as the Court thinks fit.

 (14) If the Court makes an order that the estate be administered under this Part, the creditor who obtained the order must, before the end of the period of 2 days beginning on the day the order was made, give a copy of the order to the Official Receiver.

Penalty: 5 penalty units.

Note: See also section 277B (about infringement notices).

 (15) Subsection (14) is an offence of strict liability.

Note: For strict liability, see section 6.1 of the Criminal Code.

245  Debtor dying after presentation of creditor’s petition

 (1) Subject to subsection (2), where a person against whom a creditor’s petition has been presented under Part IV dies after he or she has been served with the petition but before a sequestration order has been made on the petition or the petition has been dismissed, an order may be made on that petition for the administration of his or her estate under this Part.

 (2) The matters of which the Court is to require proof before making such an order in a case to which subsection (1) applies are those of which the Court would have required proof before making a sequestration order on the petition if the deceased person had not died.

 (3) If the Court makes an order that the estate be administered under this Part, the creditor who obtained the order must, before the end of the period of 2 days beginning on the day the order was made, give a copy of the order to the Official Receiver.

Penalty: 5 penalty units.

Note: See also section 277B (about infringement notices).

 (4) Subsection (3) is an offence of strict liability.

Note: For strict liability, see section 6.1 of the Criminal Code.

246  Statement of deceased debtor’s affairs etc. by legal personal representative

 (1) Where an order is made under section 244 or 245 for the administration of the estate of a deceased person under this Part, and there is a legal personal representative of the deceased person, the legal personal representative shall, within 28 days from the day on which he or she is notified of the making of the order:

 (a) make out a statement of the deceased person’s affairs and of his or her administration of the deceased person’s estate; and

 (b) give a copy of the statement to the Official Receiver.

Penalty: 25 penalty units.

Note: See also section 277B (about infringement notices).

 (1A) Subsection (1) is an offence of strict liability.

Note: For strict liability, see section 6.1 of the Criminal Code.

 (4) The cost of making out and filing such a statement shall be borne by the estate.

 (5) A person who states in writing that he or she is a creditor of the estate may, without fee, and any other person may, on payment of the fee determined by the Minister by legislative instrument, inspect, personally or by an agent, the statement filed under this section in respect of a deceased person, and make copies of, or take extracts from, the statement.

 (6) If the trustee of the estate is a registered trustee, the Official Receiver must give the trustee a copy of the order and a copy of the statement of affairs.

247  Petition for administration under this Part by person administering deceased person’s estate

 (1) Subject to this section, a person administering the estate of a deceased person may present a petition for an order for the administration of the estate under this Part, accompanied by a statement, in duplicate, of the deceased person’s affairs and of his or her administration of the deceased person’s estate.

 (1A) Upon hearing the petition, the Court may make, or refuse to make, the order sought as it thinks fit.

 (2) A petition under this section shall not be presented unless, at the time of his or her death, the deceased person:

 (a) was personally present or ordinarily resident in Australia;

 (b) had a dwelling house or place of business in Australia;

 (c) was carrying on business in Australia, either personally or by means of an agent or manager; or

 (d) was a member of a firm or partnership carrying on business in Australia by means of a partner or partners, or of an agent or manager.

 (3) If the Court makes an order upon hearing the petition, the person administering the estate of the deceased person must, before the end of the period of 2 days beginning on the day the order was made, give a copy of the order to the Official Receiver.

Penalty: 5 penalty units.

Note: See also section 277B (about infringement notices).

 (4) Subsection (3) is an offence of strict liability.

Note: For strict liability, see section 6.1 of the Criminal Code.

247A  Commencement of administration under Part

 (1) Administration of the estate of a deceased person under this Part by virtue of an order made by the Court under section 244 or 247 after the commencement of this section shall be deemed to have relation back to, and to have commenced at:

 (a) if the deceased person was on the day of his or her death unable to pay his or her debts as they became due from his or her own moneys and had committed any act or acts of bankruptcy within the period of 6 months immediately preceding the day on which he or she died—the time of the commission of that act, or the first of those acts, as the case may be;

 (b) if the deceased person was on the day of his or her death unable to pay his or her debts as they became due from his or her own moneys, but had not committed any act of bankruptcy within the period of 6 months immediately preceding the day on which he or she died—the time of his or her death; or

 (c) if the deceased person was on the day of his or her death able to pay his or her debts as they became due from his or her own moneys—the time of the presentation of the petition on which the order was made.

 (2) Administration of the estate of a deceased person under this Part by virtue of an order made by the Court under section 245 on a creditor’s petition shall be deemed to have relation back, and to have commenced at, the time of the commission of the earliest act of bankruptcy committed by the deceased person within the period of 6 months immediately preceding the date on which the petition was presented.

248  Application of Act in relation to administrations under this Part

 (1) Subject to this section, subsection 47(2), sections 49 to 51 (inclusive), subsections 52(4) and (5), section 62, Division 5 of Part IV, sections 70 to 76 (inclusive), section 79, sections 81 to 114 (inclusive), sections 117 to 130 (inclusive), sections 132 to 139H (inclusive), Subdivisions I and J of Division 4B of Part VI and sections 140 to 147 (inclusive) and sections 156A to 184 (inclusive) apply, with any modifications prescribed by the regulations, in relation to proceedings under this Part and the administration of estates under this Part.

 (3) Subject to the regulations, in the application of the provisions specified in subsection (1) in relation to proceedings under this Part and the administration of estates of deceased persons under this Part:

 (a) a reference to a sequestration order shall be read as a reference to an order for administration of an estate under this Part;

 (b) a reference to bankruptcy shall be read as a reference to administration under this Part;

 (c) a reference to the property of the bankrupt shall be read as a reference to the divisible property of the estate as defined by subsection 249(6);

 (d) a reference to the date of the bankruptcy or to the date on which a person became a bankrupt shall be read as a reference to the date on which the order for administration under this Part was made;

 (da) a reference to the commencement of the bankruptcy shall be read as a reference to the time at which administration of the estate under this Part is, by virtue of section 247A, to be deemed to have commenced;

 (e) a reference to a bankrupt shall be read as a reference to a deceased person in respect of whose estate an order for administration under this Part has been made and as including a reference to the estate of that deceased person; and

 (f) a reference to the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt shall be read as a reference to the trustee of the estate of a deceased person in respect of whose estate an order for administration under this Part has been made.

 (4) If, after taking into account the prescribed modifications and the provisions of subsection (3), a provision specified in subsection (1) is incapable of application in relation to proceedings under this Part or the administration of estates under this Part, or is inconsistent with this Part, that provision does not so have application.

248A  Consolidation of proceedings

 (1) Where orders have been made, whether before or after the commencement of this section, for the administration under this Part of the estates of 2 or more members of a partnership or 2 or more persons jointly liable for a debt, the Court may consolidate the proceedings upon such terms as it thinks fit.

 (2) Where:

 (a) a member of a partnership has become, whether before or after the commencement of this section, a bankrupt or 2 or more members of a partnership have become, whether before or after the commencement of this section, bankrupts; and

 (b) an order has been made, whether before or after the commencement of this section, for the administration under this Part of the estate of another member of the partnership or orders have been made, whether before or after the commencement of this section, for the administration under this Part of the estates of 2 or more other members of the partnership;

the Court may consolidate the proceedings upon such terms as it thinks fit.

 (3) Where:

 (a) one of the persons jointly liable for a debt has become, whether before or after the commencement of this section, a bankrupt or 2 or more of the persons jointly liable for a debt have become, whether before or after the commencement of this section, bankrupts; and

 (b) an order has been made, whether before or after the commencement of this section, for the administration under this Part of the estate of another person jointly liable for the debt or orders have been made, whether before or after the commencement of this section, for the administration under this Part of the estates of 2 or more persons jointly liable for the debt;

the Court may consolidate the proceedings upon such terms as it thinks fit.

 (4) Where the Court makes an order under subsection (1), (2) or (3), section 110 applies in the administration under this Act of all the estates (whether estates of bankrupts or of deceased debtors) to which that order relates.

 (5) Where the Court makes an order under subsection (1), (2) or (3) in relation to 2 or more estates, the Court may, in the order:

 (a) declare a specified date to be, for the purpose of the application of the provisions of Division 3 of Part VI in the administration of the joint estate, the date on which all the petitions relevant to the administration of those estates shall be deemed to have been presented;

 (b) declare a specified date to be, for that purpose, the date of the bankruptcy in respect of each of those estates being administered in bankruptcy and the date on which each order for administration under this Part was made in respect of those estates being administered under this Part; and

 (c) declare a specified time to be, for that purpose, the time that is the commencement of the bankruptcy in respect of each of those estates being administered in bankruptcy and the time at which the administration under this Part of each of those estates being administered under this Part (other than an estate in respect of which the order for its administration under this Part was made before the commencement of this section) is, by virtue of section 247A, to be deemed to have commenced;

and, if the Court does so, those estates shall be administered accordingly.

249  Vesting of property on making of order

 (1) Subject to this Act, where an order is made for the administration of the estate of a deceased person under this Part:

 (a) the divisible property of the estate, not being afteracquired property, vests forthwith in the Official Trustee or, if when the order is made, a registered trustee is trustee of the estate of the deceased person under this Act, in that registered trustee; and

 (b) afteracquired property of the estate vests, as soon as it is acquired by, or devolves on, the estate, in the Official Trustee or, if a registered trustee is trustee of the estate of the deceased person under this Act, in that registered trustee;

and is divisible amongst the creditors of the deceased person and of his or her estate in accordance with this Act.

 (2) Where a law of the Commonwealth or of a State or Territory of the Commonwealth requires the transmission of property to be registered and enables the trustee of the estate of a deceased person under this Act to be registered as the owner of any such property that is part of the divisible property of the estate, that property, notwithstanding that it vests in equity in the trustee by virtue of this section, does not so vest at law until the requirements of that law have been complied with.

 (3) Except as provided by this Act, after an order has been made for the administration of the estate of a deceased person under this Part, it is not competent for a creditor:

 (a) to enforce any remedy against the estate in respect of a debt provable in the administration; or

 (b) except with the leave of the Court and on such terms as the Court thinks fit, to commence any legal proceedings in respect of such a debt or take any fresh step in such a proceeding.

 (4) After an order has been made for the administration of the estate of a deceased person under this Part, distress for rent shall not be levied or proceeded with against the divisible property of the estate, whether or not the deceased person was a tenant of the landlord by whom the distress is sought to be levied.

 (4A) Nothing in this section shall be taken to prevent a creditor from enforcing any remedy against the estate of a deceased person in relation to which the Court has made an order for administration under this Part, or against any property of such an estate that is not part of the divisible property of the estate, in respect of any liability of the estate under a maintenance agreement or maintenance order (whether entered into or made, as the case may be, before or after the commencement of this subsection).

 (5) Nothing in this section affects the right of a secured creditor to realize or otherwise deal with his or her security.

 (6) For the purposes of this section, where the administration of the estate of a deceased person under this Part is, by virtue of section 247A, to be deemed to have commenced before the death of the deceased person, the divisible property of the estate comprises:

 (a) property that formed part of the estate upon the death of the deceased person other than:

 (i) property that, if the deceased person had not died and a sequestration order had been made against him or her immediately before his or her death, would not have been divisible amongst his or her creditors under Part VI; or

 (ii) so much of:

 (A) the proceeds of a policy of life assurance or endowment assurance; or

 (B) a payment from a regulated superannuation fund (within the meaning of the Superannuation Industry (Supervision) Act 1993) or an approved deposit fund (within the meaning of that Act); or

 (BAA) a payment from an exempt public sector superannuation scheme (within the meaning of that Act); or

 (BA) a payment from an RSA;

  as would not have been divisible among the creditors of the deceased person under Part VI if:

 (C) the deceased person had not died; and

 (D) a sequestration order had been made against the deceased person immediately before his or her death; and

 (E) the amount concerned had been paid immediately before his or her death;

 (b) property that was or is acquired by, or devolved or devolves on, the estate after the death of the deceased person and before an order releasing the estate from administration under this Part is made, not being property that, if the deceased person had not died and a sequestration order had been made against him or her immediately before his or her death, would not have been divisible amongst his or her creditors under Part VI;

 (c) the capacity to exercise, and to take proceedings for exercising, all such powers in, over or in respect of property as might have been exercised by the legal personal representative of the deceased person for the benefit of the estate at any time before an order releasing the estate from administration under this Part is made;

 (d) property that forms part of the divisible property of the estate by virtue of section 251 and any amount for which a person is liable to account to the trustee of the estate under subsection 251(2);

 (e) if, immediately before the death of the deceased person, any property was owned by the deceased person and another person or other persons as joint tenants—an amount equal to the value of the improvements (if any) made to that property wholly or principally by or at the expense of the deceased person after, or not earlier than 2 years before, the commencement of administration of his or her estate under this Part;

 (f) property (other than property that formed part of the estate of the deceased person upon his or her death) that belonged to, or was vested in, the deceased person at the commencement of administration of his or her estate under this Part or was acquired by, or devolved on, the deceased person after the commencement of administration of his or her estate under this Part and before his or her death, not being property that, if he or she had not died and a sequestration order had been made against him or her at the commencement of administration of his or her estate under this Part, would not have been divisible amongst his or her creditors under Part VI; and

 (g) the capacity to exercise, and take proceedings for exercising, all such powers in, over or in respect of property as might have been exercised by the deceased person for his or her own benefit at the commencement of administration of his or her estate under this Part, or at any time after commencement of administration of his or her estate under this Part and before his or her death.

 (7) For the purposes of this section, where the administration of the estate of a deceased person is under this Part, by virtue of section 247A, to be deemed to have commenced at the time of his or her death, the divisible property of the estate comprises:

 (a) property that formed part of the estate upon the death of the deceased person other than:

 (i) property that, if the deceased person had not died and a sequestration order had been made against him or her immediately before his or her death, would not have been divisible amongst his or her creditors under Part VI; or

 (ii) so much of:

 (A) the proceeds of a policy of life assurance or endowment assurance; or

 (B) a payment from a regulated superannuation fund (within the meaning of the Superannuation Industry (Supervision) Act 1993) or an approved deposit fund (within the meaning of that Act); or

 (BAA) a payment from an exempt public sector superannuation scheme (within the meaning of that Act); or

 (BA) a payment from an RSA;

  as would not have been divisible among the creditors of the deceased person under Part VI if:

 (C) the deceased person had not died; and

 (D) a sequestration order had been made against the deceased person immediately before his or her death; and

 (E) the amount concerned had been paid immediately before his or her death;

 (b) property that was or is acquired by, or devolved or devolves on, the estate after the death of the deceased person and before an order releasing the estate from administration under this Part is made, not being property that, if the deceased person had not died and a sequestration order had been made against him or her immediately before his or her death, would not have been divisible amongst his or her creditors under Part VI;

 (c) the capacity to exercise, and to take proceedings for exercising, all such powers in, over or in respect of property as might have been exercised by the legal personal representative of the deceased person for the benefit of the estate at any time before an order releasing the estate from administration under this Part is made;

 (d) property that forms part of the divisible property of the estate by virtue of section 251 and any amount for which a person is liable to account to the trustee of the estate under subsection 251(2); and

 (e) if, immediately before the death of the deceased person, any property was owned by the deceased person and another person or other persons as joint tenants—an amount equal to the value of the improvements (if any) made to that property wholly or principally by or at the expense of the deceased person after, or not earlier than 2 years before, the commencement of administration of his or her estate under this Part.

 (8) For the purposes of this section, where the administration of the estate of a deceased person under this Part is, by virtue of section 247A, to be deemed to have commenced after the death of the deceased person, the divisible property of the estate comprises:

 (a) property that formed part of the estate at the commencement of administration of the estate under this Part other than:

 (i) property that, if the deceased person had not died and a sequestration order had been made against him or her at that time, would not have been divisible amongst his or her creditors under Part VI; or

 (ii) so much of:

 (A) the proceeds of a policy of life assurance or endowment assurance; or

 (B) a payment from a regulated superannuation fund (within the meaning of the Superannuation Industry (Supervision) Act 1993) or an approved deposit fund (within the meaning of that Act); or

 (BAA) a payment from an exempt public sector superannuation scheme (within the meaning of that Act); or

 (BA) a payment from an RSA;

  as would not have been divisible among the creditors of the deceased person under Part VI if:

 (C) the deceased person had not died; and

 (D) a sequestration order had been made against the deceased person at that time; and

 (E) the amount concerned had been paid at that time;

 (b) property that was or is acquired by, or devolved or devolves on, the estate after the commencement of administration under this Part and before an order releasing the estate from administration under this Part is made, not being property that, if the deceased person had not died and a sequestration order had been made against him or her at the commencement of administration of his or her estate under this Part, would not have been divisible amongst his or her creditors under Part VI;

 (c) the capacity to exercise, and to take proceedings for exercising, all such powers in, over or in respect of property as might have been exercised by the legal personal representative of the deceased person for the benefit of the estate at the commencement of administration under this Part or at any time after that time and before an order releasing the estate from administration under this Part is made; and

 (d) property that forms part of the divisible property of the estate by virtue of section 251 and any amount for which a person is liable to account to the trustee of the estate under subsection 251(2).

 (9) The value of any improvements made to property owned by a deceased person in respect of whose estate an order is made for administration under this Part and another person or other persons as joint tenants shall, for the purposes of paragraph (6)(e) or (7)(e), be determined as at the date of the death of the deceased person.

 (10) In this section:

afteracquired property, in relation to an estate, means property that is acquired by, or devolves on, the estate of the deceased person on or after the day on which the order for the administration of the estate under this Part is made, being property that is part of the divisible property of the estate.

commencement of administration, in relation to the administration of the estate of a deceased person under this Part, means the time at which the administration of the estate under this Part is, by virtue of section 247A, to be deemed to have commenced.

249A  Charge over property owned in joint tenancy

 (1) Where:

 (a) an amount equal to the value of improvements made to property owned by a deceased person in respect of whose estate an order is made for administration under this Part and another person or other persons as joint tenants forms, for the purposes of section 249, part of the divisible property of the estate of the deceased person; and

 (b) the property is owned by that other person, or is owned (whether as joint tenants or otherwise) by all or some of those other persons and no other person, on the day on which the order for the administration of the estate under this Part is made;

there is created, by force of this subsection, a charge on that property to secure the payment of that amount.

 (2) The charge created on property by subsection (1):

 (a) is subject to every charge or encumbrance to which the property was subject immediately before the time at which the order for administration under this Part was made;

 (b) subject to subsection (3), has priority over all other charges or encumbrances whatsoever; and

 (c) subject to subsection (3), is not affected by any change of ownership of the property.

 (3) A charge created by subsection (1) on any property:

 (a) ceases to have effect in respect of the property upon the sale of the property to a bona fide purchaser for value who, at the time of the purchase, has no notice of the charge; and

 (b) is postponed in favour of a further charge, or an encumbrance, on the property acquired bona fide and for value by a person who, at the time of the acquisition, had no notice of the firstmentioned charge.

 (4) Where a charge is created by subsection (1) on property of a particular kind and the provisions of any law of the Commonwealth or of a State or Territory provide for the registration of charges over property of that kind, the trustee of the estate may cause the charge to be registered under the provisions of that law and, if he or she does so, a person who purchases or otherwise acquires the property, or an interest in the property, after registration of the charge shall, for the purposes of subsection (3), be deemed to have notice of the charge.

250  Effect of order under Part where deceased person was bankrupt

 (1) Where an order is made for the administration of the estate of a deceased person under this Part who was, at the time of his or her death, a bankrupt:

 (a) property:

 (i) that was acquired by, or devolved on, the deceased person on or after the date of the bankruptcy; and

 (ii) that is divisible amongst the creditors of the deceased person, but had not been distributed amongst the creditors in the bankruptcy before the date on which the order was made;

  shall (subject to any disposition of that property made by the trustee in the bankruptcy without knowledge of the presentation of the petition on which the order was made and subject also to section 126 in its application to the administration of deceased estates under this Part by virtue of section 248) vest forthwith in the trustee of the estate of the deceased person;

 (b) property:

 (i) that is acquired by, or devolves on, the estate of the deceased person on or after the date of the making of the order; and

 (ii) that is divisible amongst the creditors of the estate under this Part;

  vests in the trustee of the estate of the deceased person under this Part as soon as it is acquired by, or devolves on, the estate;

 (c) the trustee in the bankruptcy:

 (i) shall be deemed to be a creditor in the administration of the estate of the deceased person under this Part in respect of any unsatisfied balance of his or her expenses or remuneration in the bankruptcy, the liabilities incurred by him or her in administering the estate in the bankruptcy and the debts proved in the bankruptcy (whether or not those debts are entitled to priority, or are postponed, in the bankruptcy);

 (ii) shall rank equally with the ordinary unsecured creditors of the estate of the deceased person in its administration under this Part; and

 (iii) may, where he or she has lodged a proof of debt in the administration under this Part, amend that proof of debt, without the consent of the trustee of the estate of the deceased person under this Part, for the purpose of adding:

 (A) his or her expenses in the bankruptcy that have, or his or her remuneration in the earlier bankruptcy that has, accrued after the proof of debt was lodged;

 (B) liabilities incurred by him or her in administering the estate in the bankruptcy after the proof of debt was lodged; or

 (C) debts proved in the bankruptcy after the proof of debt was lodged;

  or, with the consent of the trustee of the estate of the deceased person, for any other purpose;

 (d) a charge or charging order that, by virtue of subsection 118(9), is void as against the trustee in the bankruptcy continues to be void as against that trustee; and

 (e) a transaction that, by virtue of section 120, 121, 122, 128B or 128C, is void as against the trustee in the bankruptcy continues to be void as against that trustee.

 (2) Where:

 (a) the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt who has died receives, after the death of the bankrupt, notice of the presentation of a creditor’s petition against the deceased bankrupt, being a petition that was presented before he or she died; or

 (b) the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt who has died receives notice of the presentation of a petition for the administration of the estate of the deceased bankrupt under this Part;

the trustee shall hold the afteracquired property of the deceased bankrupt that is then in the possession of the trustee, or the proceeds thereof, until the petition has been dealt with by the Court or has lapsed.

 (3) Where the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt who has died receives, after the death of the bankrupt, notice of the reference to the Court of a debtor’s petition against the deceased bankrupt, being a petition that was presented before he or she died, the trustee shall hold the afteracquired property of the deceased bankrupt that is then in the possession of the trustee, or the proceeds thereof, until the Court has dealt with the petition.

 (4) Where the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt who has died is holding afteracquired property of the deceased bankrupt, or the proceeds of any such property, in pursuance of subsection 59(2) or (3) or subsection (2) or (3) of this section and an order is made for the administration of the estate of the deceased bankrupt under this Part, the trustee shall:

 (a) in a case where the trustee is also the trustee in relation to the administration of the estate of the deceased bankrupt under this Part—hold all such property, and the proceeds of such property, as trustee in relation to the administration of the estate of the deceased bankrupt under this Part; or

 (b) in any other case—deliver all such property, and pay the proceeds of such property, to the trustee in relation to the administration of the estate of the deceased bankrupt under this Part.

 (5) Where a law of the Commonwealth or of a State or Territory of the Commonwealth requires the transmission of property to be registered, and enables the trustee in relation to the administration of the estate of a deceased person under this Part to be registered as the owner of any such property that is part of the property of the estate, that property, notwithstanding that it vests in equity in the trustee by virtue of subsection (1), does not vest in the trustee at law until the requirements of that law have been complied with.

 (6) In subsections (2), (3) and (4), afteracquired property, in relation to a deceased bankrupt, means such of the property that was acquired by, or devolved on, the bankrupt on or after the date of the bankruptcy and before he or she died or that was acquired by, or devolved on, the estate of the bankrupt after his or her death, being property divisible among the creditors of the deceased bankrupt, as has not been distributed amongst the creditors in the bankruptcy.

251  Real property devised by will that vests directly in devisee to form part of estate in certain cases

 (1) Subject to this section, where an order for the administration of the estate of a deceased person under this Part is made within 12 months after the death of that person, any real property of the deceased person devised by his or her will which, under a law of a State or Territory, vests, either upon the death of that person or upon compliance with a law of the State or Territory relating to the registration of interests in land, directly in the devisee, forms part of the divisible property of the estate.

 (2) Where, before the making of such an order, the devisee has disposed of the property devised, or has mortgaged or charged it, for valuable consideration, to a person acting in good faith, the property does not form part of the divisible property of the estate, or forms part of the divisible property of the estate subject to the mortgage or charge, as the case requires, but the devisee is liable to account to the trustee of the estate for the proceeds of the disposal of the property or for an amount equal to the amount for which it is mortgaged or charged, as the case requires.

252  Liability of legal personal representative

 (1) A payment or transfer of property made by the legal personal representative of a deceased person:

 (a) after service on him or her of a petition under this Part in respect of the estate of that person;

 (b) in a case to which subsection 245(1) applies, after he or she has knowledge of the presentation of a petition against that person; or

 (c) after a petition is presented under section 247 in respect of the estate of that person;

does not, if an order for the administration of the estate of that person is made under this Part on that petition, operate as a discharge to the legal personal representative as between himself or herself and the trustee.

 (2) Except as provided by subsection (1), nothing in this Part shall be taken to impose on the legal personal representative of a deceased person any liability for any payment or transfer of property made, or any act or thing done, in good faith by the legal personal representative before an order for administration of the estate of the deceased person is made under this Part.

252A  Annulment on payment of debts

 (1) If the trustee of the estate of a deceased person is satisfied that all the debts of the estate of a deceased person have been paid in full, the order for the administration of the estate under this Part is annulled, by force of this subsection, on the date on which the last such payment was made.

 (2) The trustee must, before the end of the period of 2 days beginning on that date, give to the Official Receiver a written certificate setting out the name and the administration number of the estate and the date of the annulment.

Penalty: 5 penalty units.

Note: See also section 277B (about infringement notices).

 (3) Subsection (2) is an offence of strict liability.

Note: For strict liability, see section 6.1 of the Criminal Code.

 (4) For the purposes of this section, if a debt has been proved by a creditor but the creditor cannot be found or cannot be identified, the debt may be paid to the Official Receiver and, if so paid, is taken for the purposes of this section to have been paid in full to the creditor.

 (4A) Money received by the Official Receiver under subsection (4) is received on behalf of the Commonwealth.

 (5) If money is paid to the Official Receiver under subsection (4), the provisions of subsections 254(3) and (4) apply in relation to that money as if it had been paid to the Commonwealth by a trustee under subsection 254(2).

 (6) In this section:

debts of the estate of a deceased person means all debts that have been proved in the administration of the estate and includes interest payable on such of those debts as bear interest, and the costs, charges and expenses of the administration of the estate, including the remuneration and expenses of the trustee.

252B  Annulment by Court

  If the Court is satisfied that an order for the administration of the estate of a deceased person under this Part ought not to have been made, the Court may make an order annulling the administration of the estate under this Part.

252C  Effect of annulment

 (1) If the administration of the estate of a deceased person under this Part is annulled under section 252A or 252B:

 (a) all sales and dispositions of property and payments duly made, and all acts done, by the trustee of the estate under this Part or any person acting under the authority of the trustee or the Court before the annulment are taken to have been validly made or done; and

 (b) the trustee may apply the property still vested in the trustee in connection with the administration of the estate in payment of the costs, charges and expenses of the administration of the estate, including the remuneration and expenses of the trustee; and

 (c) subject to subsection (2), the remainder (if any) of the property still vested in the trustee in connection with the administration of the estate reverts to the estate of the deceased person.

 (2) If an application is made to the Court by a person claiming an interest in property referred to in paragraph (1)(c), the Court, after hearing such persons as it thinks fit, may make an order, either unconditionally or on such conditions as the Court considers just and equitable, for the vesting of the property in, or delivery of the property to, a person in whom, or to whom, it seems to the Court to be just and equitable that it should be vested or delivered, or to a trustee for that person.

 (3) Subject to subsection (4), if an order vesting property in a person is made under subsection (2), the property vests immediately in the person without any conveyance, transfer or assignment.

 (4) If:

 (a) the property to which such an order relates is property the transfer of which is required by a law of the Commonwealth, of a State or of a Territory to be registered; and

 (b) that law enables the registration of such an order;

the property, even though it vests in equity in the person named in the order, does not vest in that person at law until the requirements of that law have been complied with.

Part XIAFarmers’ debts assistance

 

253A  Interpretation

  In this Part, the relevant authority, in relation to a stay under a proclaimed law in its application in relation to a person or the estate of a deceased person, means the person administering the proclaimed law by or under which the stay was or is in force.

253B  Law of State or Territory may be proclaimed

  Where a law of a State or Territory (including a law that came into operation before the commencement of this section):

 (a) provides for the giving of financial assistance for the purpose of discharging debts of persons who are farmers within the meaning of the Loan (Farmers’ Debt Adjustment) Act 1935; or

 (c) gives effect to the agreement between the Commonwealth and the States the execution of which, on behalf of the Commonwealth, was approved by the States Grants (Rural Adjustment) Act 1976 or that agreement as subsequently amended (including that agreement as amended by the agreement between the Commonwealth, the States and the Northern Territory the execution of which, on behalf of the Commonwealth, was approved by the States and Northern Territory Grants (Rural Adjustment) Act 1979 or that lastmentioned agreement as subsequently amended); or

 (d) gives effect to the agreement between the Commonwealth and the States and the Northern Territory the execution of which, on behalf of the Commonwealth, was approved by the States and Northern Territory Grants (Rural Adjustment) Act 1985 or that agreement as subsequently amended; or

 (e) gives effect to an agreement between the Commonwealth and a State or the Northern Territory whose execution, on behalf of the Commonwealth, was approved by the States and Northern Territory Grants (Rural Adjustment) Act 1988, or that agreement as subsequently amended;

the GovernorGeneral may, by Proclamation, specify the law as a law in relation to which this Part applies.

253C  Notice about stay under proclaimed law

  The relevant authority may give to the Official Receiver a written notice that a stay under a proclaimed law applies to a person specified in the notice.

253E  Relevant authority may apply for stay of proceedings under certain petitions

 (1) If:

 (a) a creditor’s petition is presented against a person (whether alone or jointly with another person) or against a partnership of which a person is a member; or

 (b) a debtor’s petition is presented against a partnership of which a person is a member and that person is not one of the partners presenting the petition;

and a stay under a proclaimed law applies in relation to that person, the relevant authority may, at any time before a sequestration order is made on the creditor’s petition or before the debtor’s petition is accepted by the Official Receiver, as the case may be, apply to the Court for an order staying all or any proceedings under the petition, and the Court may, if it thinks fit, upon such terms and conditions as it thinks proper, stay all or any proceedings under the petition.

 (2) If a petition is presented under section 244 or section 247 for an order for the administration of the estate of a deceased person and a stay under a proclaimed law applies in relation to the estate, the relevant authority may, at any time before the order is made, apply to the Court for an order staying all or any proceedings under the petition, and the Court may, if it thinks fit, upon such terms and conditions as it thinks proper, stay all or any proceedings under the petition.

 (3) An order made under this section may provide that the stay is to be of indefinite duration or for such period as the Court thinks fit.

253F  Relevant authority may be heard on application relating to debtor’s petition

 (1) The relevant authority may appear and be heard at the hearing of:

 (a) an application under subsection 55(6A) for leave to present a petition against a debtor in relation to whom a stay applies under a proclaimed law; or

 (b) an application under subsection 56A(7) by a person to whom a stay under a proclaimed law applies for the Court’s permission to join in presenting a petition against a partnership; or

 (c) an application under subsection 57(8) by a person in relation to whom a stay under a proclaimed law applies for leave to join in presenting a petition under section 57.

 (2) The relevant authority may appear in person or be represented by a barrister or solicitor.

Part XIIUnclaimed dividends or moneys

 

254  Payment of unclaimed moneys to the Commonwealth

 (1) In this section, trustee means:

 (a) a trustee of the estate of a bankrupt; or

 (aa) the administrator of a debt agreement; or

 (b) a trustee of a personal insolvency agreement; or

 (c) a trustee of a composition or a scheme of arrangement; or

 (d) a trustee of the estate of a deceased person in respect of which an order has been made under Part XI of this Act;

and includes the Official Trustee.

 (2) Where a trustee has under his or her control:

 (a) any dividends or other moneys that have remained unclaimed for a period exceeding 6 months; or

 (b) any moneys that it is proposed not to distribute or pay to any person;

he or she shall forthwith pay those moneys to the Commonwealth.

 (2A) Where:

 (a) the Court has, after the presentation of a creditor’s petition against a debtor, directed the Official Trustee, an Official Receiver or a registered trustee to take control of the property of the debtor;

 (b) the petition has been withdrawn or dismissed;

 (c) the Official Trustee, Official Receiver or registered trustee, as the case may be, has moneys under its control in pursuance of the direction; and

 (d) it is not reasonably practicable to pay those moneys to the person entitled to them;

the Official Trustee, Official Receiver or registered trustee, as the case may be, shall pay those moneys to the Commonwealth.

 (3) A person who claims to be entitled to any moneys that have been paid to the Commonwealth by a trustee in pursuance of subsection (2) or (2A) may apply to the Court for an order under this subsection declaring him or her to be so entitled and, if the Court is satisfied that the applicant is entitled to those moneys or a part of those moneys, it may make an order accordingly.

 (4) Upon receipt by the Official Receiver of an office copy of an order under subsection (3), the Official Receiver shall pay to the person in whose favour the order was made the amount specified in the order out of moneys lawfully available for the purpose.

Part XIIIEvidence

 

255  Record of proceedings or evidence

 (1) A transcript or electronic or magnetic recording that purports to be a record of proceedings under section 77C or 81, or of proceedings before a court, is to be taken to be a record of that kind, unless the contrary is proved.

 (2) The transcript or recording is admissible as evidence of the matters described by a person whose words are recorded in the transcript or recording, unless the Court, or a court in which the transcript is sought to be introduced, makes an order to the contrary.

 (3) The cost of preparing a transcript or recording is an expense of administration of the estate of the bankrupt or debtor to which the matters recorded relate.

256  Evidence of matters stated in notices published in Gazette

  A copy of the Gazette containing any notice inserted in it in pursuance of this Act is prima facie evidence of the matters stated in the notice.

257  Evidence of proceedings at meetings of creditors or committee of inspection

  The minutes of proceedings at a meeting of creditors or of a committee of inspection under this Act, signed by a person describing himself or herself as, or appearing to have been, chair of the meeting is prima facie evidence of those proceedings.

258  Presumption about due convening of meetings etc.

  Subject to this Act, unless the contrary is shown:

 (a) a meeting of creditors or of a committee of inspection in respect of which minutes of proceedings have been signed by a person describing himself or herself as, or appearing to have been, chair of the meeting shall be deemed to have been duly convened and held; and

 (b) all resolutions passed or proceedings taken at such a meeting shall be deemed to have been duly passed or taken.

262  Swearing of affidavits

 (1) An affidavit to be used for the purposes of this Act may be sworn within the Commonwealth or a Territory of the Commonwealth before a person authorized to administer oaths for the purposes of the High Court or the Supreme Court of a State or Territory of the Commonwealth, a Judge of a Court having jurisdiction under this Act, an Official Receiver, a justice of the peace, a commissioner for affidavits or a commissioner for declarations.

 (2) An affidavit to be used for the purposes of this Act may be sworn at a place outside the Commonwealth and the Territories of the Commonwealth before:

 (aa) a Commissioner of the High Court authorized to administer oaths in that place for the purposes of the High Court;

 (a) a commissioner of the Supreme Court of a State or Territory of the Commonwealth for taking affidavits empowered and authorized to act in that place;

 (b) an Australian Diplomatic Officer or an Australian Consular Officer, as defined by the Consular Fees Act 1955, exercising his or her function in that place;

 (ba) an employee of the Commonwealth who is:

 (i) authorised under paragraph 3(c) of the Consular Fees Act 1955; and

 (ii) exercising his or her function in that place;

 (bb) an employee of the Australian Trade Commission who is:

 (i) authorised under paragraph 3(d) of the Consular Fees Act 1955; and

 (ii) exercising his or her function in that place;

 (c) a notary public exercising his or her function in that place; or

 (d) a person qualified to administer an oath in that place, being a person certified by a person mentioned in any of paragraphs (aa) to (c), or by the superior court of that place, to be so qualified.

Part XIVOffences

 

263  Concealment etc. of property etc.

 (1) A person shall not:

 (a) with intent to defraud the creditors of:

 (i) a bankrupt;

 (ii) a deceased person or the estate of a deceased person; or

 (iii) a debtor who has executed a personal insolvency agreement, a deed of assignment or a deed of arrangement;

  conceal property of the bankrupt, of the deceased person or his or her estate or of the debtor;

 (b) receive property:

 (i) from a bankrupt or a debtor who has executed a personal insolvency agreement, a deed of assignment or a deed of arrangement or a person on behalf of a bankrupt or such a debtor;

 (ii) from the legal personal representative of a deceased person; or

 (iii) from a debtor who subsequently becomes a bankrupt or executes such an agreement or deed, or a person on behalf of such a debtor;

  with intent to defraud, or to assist the bankrupt, the legal personal representative or the debtor to defraud, the creditors of the bankrupt, of the deceased person or his or her estate or of the debtor;

 (c) with intent to defraud, insert or cause to be inserted in the Gazette or in a newspaper an advertisement purporting to be under this Act without authority or knowing it to be false in any particular; or

 (d) with intent to defraud:

 (i) in any proceedings in bankruptcy;

 (ii) in connexion with the administration of the estate of a deceased person; or

 (iii) in connexion with the administration of a debtor’s affairs under a personal insolvency agreement, a deed of assignment, a deed of arrangement, a composition or a scheme of arrangement;

  make a false claim or a declaration or statement of account that is untrue in any particular or lodge a proof of debt that is untrue in any particular.

Penalty: Imprisonment for 5 years.

 (2) A person is guilty of an offence if:

 (a) the person disposes of, receives, removes, retains or conceals property that has been seized:

 (i) as part of the property of a bankrupt; or

 (ii) as part of the estate of a deceased person; or

 (iii) under a personal insolvency agreement, a deed of assignment; and

 (b) the firstmentioned person knows that the property has been so seized.

Penalty: Imprisonment for 1 year.

 (3) In this section:

composition does not include a composition entered into for the purposes of a proclaimed law.

deceased person means a deceased person in respect of whose estate an order for administration has been made under Part XI of this Act.

deed of arrangement does not include a deed of arrangement executed for the purposes of a proclaimed law.

scheme of arrangement does not include a scheme of arrangement made or entered into for the purposes of a proclaimed law.

263A  False affidavits

  A person who intentionally makes a false statement in an affidavit to be used for the purposes of this Act is guilty of an offence and is punishable:

 (a) upon summary conviction—by a fine not exceeding $200, or imprisonment for a period not exceeding 6 months, or both; or

 (b) upon conviction on indictment—by imprisonment for a period not exceeding 4 years.

263C  False claims about a creditor’s entitlement to vote

 (1) A creditor must not give to the trustee a voting document knowing or reckless that the document is false or misleading in a material particular.

Penalty: Imprisonment for 6 months.

 (2) In this section:

give includes cause to be given.

trustee means:

 (a) a trustee in a bankruptcy; or

 (b) a trustee of a composition or scheme of arrangement under Division 6 of Part IV; or

 (d) a controlling trustee as defined in Part X; or

 (e) a trustee of a personal insolvency agreement under Part X; or

 (f) a trustee of an estate being administered under Part XI.

voting document means:

 (a) a statement that is:

 (i) described in section 64D, as that section applies of its own force, or as it is applied by another provision of this Act; and

 (ii) given to the trustee at or before a meeting called for the purposes of Part IV, X or XI; or

 (b) a form that is:

 (i) described in section 64E, as that section applies of its own force, or as it is applied by another provision of this Act; and

 (ii) given to the trustee at or before a meeting called for the purposes of Part IV, X or XI.

264A  Failure of person to attend before the Court etc.

 (1) This section applies to a person who:

 (a) is served, whether before or after the commencement of this subsection, with a summons under this Act to attend for examination under a provision of this Act (other than section 81), or to appear as a witness before the Court, and is tendered a reasonable sum for expenses; or

 (b) is not a relevant person within the meaning of section 81 but is served, whether before or after the commencement of this section, with a summons to attend for examination under that section and is tendered a reasonable sum for expenses; or

 (c) is a relevant person within the meaning of section 81 and is served, on or after the commencement of this section, with a summons to attend for examination under that section.

 (1A) A person to whom this section applies must not, after the commencement of this section:

 (a) fail to attend as required by the summons served on the person; or

 (b) fail to appear and report from day to day, unless excused or released from further attendance by the Court, the Registrar or the magistrate, as the case may be.

Penalty: Imprisonment for 6 months.

 (1B) Subsection (1A) does not apply if the person has a reasonable excuse.

Note: A defendant bears an evidential burden in relation to the matter in subsection (1B) (see subsection 13.3(3) of the Criminal Code).

 (2) Nothing in this section limits the power of the Court to punish persons for contempt of court, but a person shall not be punished under this section and for contempt of court in respect of the same act or omission.

264B  Arrest of person failing to attend before the Court etc.

 (1) Subject to subsection (2), where a person who is served, whether before or after the commencement of this section, with a summons referred to in subsection 264A(1):

 (a) fails to attend before the Court, the Registrar or the magistrate, as the case may be, as required by the summons; or

 (b) fails to appear and report himself or herself from day to day as required by the Court, the Registrar or magistrate, as the case may be;

the Court, the Registrar or the magistrate, as the case may be, may, on proof by affidavit of the service of the summons, issue a warrant for the apprehension of the person.

 (2) The Court, the Registrar or the magistrate shall not issue a warrant under subsection (1) for the apprehension of a person mentioned in paragraph 264A(1)(a) or (b) who has failed to attend for examination under a provision of this Act, or to appear as a witness before the Court, as required by a summons under this Act unless the Court, the Registrar or the magistrate, as the case may be, is satisfied, on proof by affidavit, that the person was tendered a reasonable sum for expenses.

 (3) A warrant issued under subsection (1) authorizes the apprehension of the person and his or her being brought before the Court, the Registrar or the magistrate, as the case may be, and his or her detention in custody until he or she is released by order of the Court, the Registrar or the magistrate, as the case may be.

 (4) A warrant issued under subsection (1) may be executed by a constable and a constable executing the warrant has the power to break and enter any place or building for the purpose of executing the warrant.

 (5) The Court, the Registrar or the magistrate, as the case may be, may order a person apprehended under this section to pay the costs of the apprehension.

 (6) The apprehension of a person under this section does not relieve him or her from any liability incurred by him or her by reason of his or her failure to attend before the Court, the Registrar or the magistrate, as the case may be.

264C  Refusal to be sworn or give evidence etc.

 (1) A person appearing before the Court, the Registrar or a magistrate for the purpose of being examined under this Act, or appearing as a witness before the Court, shall not:

 (a) refuse or fail to be sworn or to make an affirmation;

 (b) refuse or fail to answer a question which he or she is required to answer by the Court, the Registrar or the magistrate, as the case may be; or

 (c) refuse or fail to produce any books that he or she is required by the Court, the Registrar or the magistrate, as the case may be, or by a summons under this Act, to produce.

Penalty: $1,000 or imprisonment for 6 months, or both.

 (1A) Subsection (1) does not apply if the person has a reasonable excuse.

Note: A defendant bears an evidential burden in relation to the matter in subsection (1A) (see subsection 13.3(3) of the Criminal Code).

 (2) Nothing in this section limits the power of the Court to punish persons for contempt of court, but a person shall not be punished under this section and for contempt of court in respect of the same act or omission.

264D  Prevarication or evasion in the course of examination

 (1) Where a person who is being examined before the Court, the Registrar or a magistrate under this Act is guilty of prevarication or evasion, the person commits an offence punishable upon conviction by a fine not exceeding $1,000 or imprisonment for 6 months, or both.

 (2) Nothing in this section limits the power of the Court to punish persons for contempt of court, but a person shall not be punished under this section and for contempt of court in respect of the same conduct.

264E  Offences in relation to Registrar or magistrate conducting an examination

 (1) A person shall not:

 (a) insult or disturb a Registrar or magistrate before whom an examination under this Act is being held;

 (b) interrupt an examination under this Act before a Registrar or magistrate;

 (c) create a disturbance, or take part in creating or continuing a disturbance, in or near a place where an examination under this Act is being held before a Registrar or magistrate;

 (d) use insulting or threatening language towards a Registrar or magistrate before whom an examination under this Act is being held; or

 (e) by writing or speech use words calculated:

 (i) to influence improperly a Registrar or magistrate before whom an examination under this Act is being held; or

 (ii) to bring a Registrar or magistrate before whom an examination under this Act is being held into disrepute.

Penalty: $1,000 or imprisonment for 6 months, or both.

 (2) For the purposes of an offence against subsection (1), strict liability applies to the following physical elements of circumstance of the offence:

 (a) that the Registrar or magistrate is a Registrar or magistrate before whom an examination under this Act is being held;

 (b) that the examination is an examination under this Act being held before a Registrar or magistrate.

Note: For strict liability, see section 6.1 of the Criminal Code.

265  Failure of bankrupt or debtor to disclose property etc.

 (1) A bankrupt:

 (a) shall fully and truly disclose to the trustee all of the property of the bankrupt, and its value;

 (b) shall fully and truly disclose to the trustee particulars of any disposition of property made by him or her within the period of 2 years immediately preceding the date on which he or she became a bankrupt;

 (c) shall not refuse or fail to comply with a direction by the trustee to deliver to the trustee property in the possession of the bankrupt, being all or part of the property of the bankrupt;

 (ca) shall fully and truly disclose to the trustee such information about any of the bankrupt’s conduct and examinable affairs as the trustee requires;

 (d) shall not refuse or fail to tell the trustee where the books (including books of an associated entity of the bankrupt) relating to the bankrupt’s examinable affairs may be found;

 (e) shall not refuse or fail to comply with a direction by the trustee to deliver to the trustee books (including books of an associated entity of the bankrupt) that are in the possession of the bankrupt and relate to any of the bankrupt’s examinable affairs;

 (f) shall not omit any material particular from a statement relating to any of the bankrupt’s examinable affairs;

 (g) shall, if he or she knows that a person has lodged a proof of debt in the bankruptcy that is false, forthwith inform the trustee of the fact; and

 (h) shall give to the trustee a full and proper explanation of any loss or depreciation of any of his or her assets or part of any of his or her assets that occurred within the period of 2 years immediately preceding the date on which he or she became a bankrupt.

Penalty: Imprisonment for 1 year.

 (1A) A bankrupt is taken to have complied with paragraph (1)(a), (b) or (ca) if he or she has fully and truly disclosed to the best of his or her knowledge and belief as required by that paragraph.

Note: A defendant bears an evidential burden in relation to the matter in subsection (1A) (see subsection 13.3(3) of the Criminal Code).

 (2) A bankrupt shall be deemed to have complied with paragraph (1)(b) in respect of any property if he or she shows that that property has been disposed of in the ordinary way of his or her business or in meeting the ordinary expenses of his or her family.

Note: See also subsection 5(6).

 (3) A bankrupt shall not, with the intention of obtaining the consent of his or her creditors or any of them to any matter relating to any of the bankrupt’s examinable affairs, make a false representation or commit any fraud.

Penalty: Imprisonment for 5 years.

 (4) A person who, after the presentation of a petition on which, or by virtue of the presentation of which, he or she becomes a bankrupt:

 (a) conceals or removes any part of his or her property to the value of $20 or more;

 (b) conceals a debt due to or by him or her;

 (c) conceals, parts with, destroys, mutilates, falsifies, alters or makes a false entry in, or omits a material particular from, a book (including a book of an associated entity of the person) affecting or relating to any of the person’s examinable affairs;

 (d) attempts to account for any part of his or her property by falsely stating that he or she has incurred a loss or expense;

 (e) otherwise than in the ordinary way of his or her business, disposes of, or gives security over, property that he or she has obtained on credit and for which he or she has not paid; or

 (f) prevents the production of a book (including a book of an associated entity of the person) affecting or relating to any of the person’s examinable affairs;

is guilty of an offence and is punishable, upon conviction, by imprisonment for a period not exceeding 1 year.

 (5) A person who, after the presentation of a petition on which, or by virtue of the presentation of which, he or she becomes a bankrupt, either alone or jointly with another person:

 (a) obtains property by fraud; or

 (b) incurs any debt or liability by fraud;

is guilty of an offence and is punishable, upon conviction, by imprisonment for a period not exceeding 5 years.

 (6) Subsections (4) and (5) extend to an act or omission done or made after the commencement of this Act where the petition was presented before the commencement of this Act but do not apply to an act or omission done or made after the person by whom it was done or made has been discharged from the bankruptcy or after his or her bankruptcy has been annulled.

 (7) A person who has become a bankrupt after the commencement of this Act and, within 12 months before the presentation of the petition on which, or by virtue of the presentation of which, he or she became a bankrupt, has done any of the things specified in any of paragraphs (4)(a) to (f) or paragraph (5)(a) or (b), whether before or after the commencement of this Act, is guilty of an offence and is punishable, upon conviction, by imprisonment for a period not exceeding the maximum period of imprisonment applicable to the doing of that thing under subsection (4) or subsection (5), as the case may be.

 (8) A person who has become a bankrupt and, within 2 years before he or she became a bankrupt and after the commencement of this Act, has contracted a debt provable in the bankruptcy without having at the time of contracting it any reasonable or probable ground of expectation, after taking into consideration his or her other liabilities (if any), of being able to pay the debt, is guilty of an offence and is punishable, upon conviction, by imprisonment for a period not exceeding 1 year.

 (9) It is a defence to a charge under this section (not being a charge under paragraph (1)(c) or (e) or subsection (3), (5) or (8)) if the defendant proves that the act or omission to which the charge relates was done or made without intent to defraud any of his or her creditors.

265A  Offences relating to exercise of powers under section 77A or 130

 (1) A person shall not refuse or fail to comply with a requirement under section 77A or 130.

 (1A) Subsection (1) does not apply if the person has a reasonable excuse.

Note: A defendant bears an evidential burden in relation to the matter in subsection (1A) (see subsection 13.3(3) of the Criminal Code).

 (2) A person shall not, in purported compliance with a requirement under section 77A or 130, give information, or make a statement, that is, to the person’s knowledge, false or misleading in a material particular.

 (3) A person shall not:

 (a) obstruct or hinder a person in the exercise of a power under section 77A; or

 (b) obstruct or hinder a person who is executing a warrant issued under section 130.

 (3A) Subsection (3) does not apply if the person has a reasonable excuse.

Note: A defendant bears an evidential burden in relation to the matter in subsection (3A) (see subsection 13.3(3) of the Criminal Code).

 (4) The occupier, or person in charge, of premises that a person enters under a warrant issued under section 130 shall provide to the lastmentioned person all reasonable facilities and assistance for the effective exercise of his or her powers under the warrant.

Penalty: Imprisonment for 12 months.

266  Disposing or charging of property by person who becomes, or has become, a bankrupt

 (1) A person who, after the presentation of a petition on which, or by virtue of the presentation of which, he or she becomes a bankrupt disposes of, or creates a charge on, any property with intent to defraud his or her creditors is guilty of an offence and is punishable, upon conviction, by imprisonment for a period not exceeding 5 years.

 (2) Subsection (1) does not apply to the disposal of, or the creation of a charge on, property after the person by whom the disposal is effected or the charge is created is discharged from bankruptcy or after his or her bankruptcy has been annulled.

 (3) A person who has become a bankrupt after the commencement of this Act and, within 12 months before the presentation of the petition on which, or by virtue of the presentation of which, he or she became a bankrupt and after the commencement of this Act, has disposed of, or created a charge on, any property with intent to defraud his or her creditors is guilty of an offence and is punishable, upon conviction, by imprisonment for a period not exceeding 5 years.

267  False declaration by debtor or bankrupt

 (1) This section applies to a declaration contained in a statement that:

 (a) is filed under paragraph 54(1)(a) or (2)(a); or

 (aa) accompanies a declaration presented under section 54A; or

 (b) accompanies a petition presented under paragraph 55(2)(b) or subsection 56B(1); or

 (c) is filed under paragraph 56F(1)(a) or (b); or

 (d) accompanies a petition presented under subsection 57(1); or

 (da) is given to the Official Receiver under section 77CA; or

 (e) is given to the Official Receiver under:

 (i) subsection 185C(2B); or

 (ii) subsection 185M(1B); or

 (iii) subsection 185P(1B); or

 (ea) is given to the Official Receiver under section 185D with a debt agreement proposal; or

 (f) is given under subsection 188(2C) or (2D).

 (2) A person must not make a declaration to which this section applies that the person knows to be false.

Penalty: Imprisonment for 12 months.

267B  Failure of person to provide information

 (1) A person must not refuse or fail to comply with a notice given to the person under subsection 6A(3), subsection 77C(1) or section 77CA or 139V.

Penalty: Imprisonment for 12 months.

 (2) Subsection (1) does not apply if the person has a reasonable excuse.

Note: A defendant bears an evidential burden in relation to the matter in subsection (2) (see subsection 13.3(3) of the Criminal Code).

267D  Failure of person to attend

 (1) A person who is required by a notice under subsection 77C(1) to attend before the Official Receiver or an authorised officer and to whom an advance is offered in accordance with subsection 77E(1) must not:

 (a) fail to attend as required by the notice; or

 (b) fail to appear and report from day to day, unless excused or released from further attendance by the Official Receiver or authorised officer, as the case may be.

Penalty: Imprisonment for 6 months.

 (2) Subsection (1) does not apply if the person has a reasonable excuse.

Note: A defendant bears an evidential burden in relation to the matter in subsection (2) (see subsection 13.3(3) of the Criminal Code).

267E  Arrest of person failing to attend before Official Receiver or authorised officer

 (1) Subject to subsection (2), if a person who is required by a notice under subsection 77C(1) to attend before the Official Receiver or an authorised officer:

 (a) fails to attend as required by the notice; or

 (b) fails to appear and report from day to day, as required by the Official Receiver or authorised officer;

the Registrar, on proof by affidavit of the service of the notice, may issue a warrant for the arrest of the person.

 (2) The Registrar must not issue a warrant under subsection (1) for the arrest of a person unless:

 (a) the Registrar is satisfied, on proof by affidavit, that the person was offered an advance in accordance with subsection 77E(1); or

 (b) both:

 (i) the person is or has been a bankrupt; and

 (ii) the person’s attendance was required for the purpose of giving evidence or producing books relating to the person’s bankruptcy.

 (3) A warrant issued under subsection (1) authorises the arrest of the person and his or her being brought before the Registrar, and his or her detention in custody until he or she is released by order of the Registrar.

 (4) A warrant issued under subsection (1) may be executed by a constable, and a constable executing the warrant has the power to break in and enter any premises for the purpose of executing the warrant.

 (5) The Registrar may order a person arrested under this section to pay the costs of the arrest.

 (6) The arrest of a person under this section does not relieve the person from any liability incurred because of his or her failure to attend before the Official Receiver or authorised officer.

267F  Refusal to be sworn or give evidence etc.

 (1) A person attending before the Official Receiver or an authorised officer as required by a notice under subsection 77C(1) must not:

 (a) refuse or fail to be sworn or to make an affirmation; or

 (b) refuse or fail to answer a question that the person is required to answer by the Official Receiver or authorised officer, as the case may be; or

 (c) refuse or fail to produce any books that the person is required by the notice to produce.

Penalty: Imprisonment for 6 months.

 (2) Subsection (1) does not apply if the person has a reasonable excuse.

Note: A defendant bears an evidential burden in relation to the matter in subsection (2) (see subsection 13.3(3) of the Criminal Code).

267G  Prevarication or evasion in the course of giving evidence

  Where a person who is giving evidence before the Official Receiver or an authorised officer as required by a notice under subsection 77C(1) is guilty of prevarication or evasion, the person is guilty of an offence punishable upon conviction by imprisonment for a period not exceeding 6 months.

268  Offences in relation to personal insolvency agreements

 (1) A debtor shall not knowingly give a false or misleading answer to a question put to him or her at a meeting called under Part X.

Penalty: Imprisonment for 1 year.

 (2) A debtor who has executed a personal insolvency agreement under Part X:

 (a) shall fully and truly disclose to the trustee of the agreement all the property subject to the agreement and its value;

 (b) shall not refuse or fail to comply with a direction of the trustee of the agreement to deliver up to the trustee property subject to the agreement that is in the possession of the debtor;

 (ba) shall fully and truly disclose to the trustee of the agreement such information about any of the debtor’s conduct and examinable affairs as the trustee requires;

 (c) shall not refuse or fail to comply with a direction by the trustee of the agreement:

 (i) to tell the trustee where books (including books of an associated entity of the debtor) relating to any of the debtor’s examinable affairs may be found; or

 (ii) to deliver to the trustee such books that are in the possession of the debtor;

 (d) shall not omit any material particular from a statement relating to any of the debtor’s examinable affairs;

 (e) shall, if he or she knows that a person has lodged a proof of debt under the agreement that is false, forthwith inform the trustee of the fact;

 (f) shall execute such instruments and do all such acts and things in relation to property subject to the agreement and its realization as are required by this Act or by the trustee or as are ordered by the Court upon the application of the trustee; and

 (g) shall aid to the utmost of his or her power in the administration of his or her property and affairs under the agreement.

Penalty: Imprisonment for 1 year.

 (2A) A debtor is taken to have complied with paragraph (2)(a) or (ba) if he or she has fully and truly disclosed to the best of his or her knowledge and belief as required by that paragraph.

Note: A defendant bears an evidential burden in relation to the matter in subsection (2A) (see subsection 13.3(3) of the Criminal Code).

 (3) A debtor who has executed a personal insolvency agreement under Part X shall not make a false representation or commit any fraud with the intention of obtaining the consent of his or her creditors or any of them to any matter relating to any of the debtor’s examinable affairs.

Penalty: Imprisonment for 5 years.

 (4) Subsections (2) and (3) do not apply to an act or omission that is done or made after:

 (a) all the obligations that the personal insolvency agreement created have been discharged; or

 (b) the personal insolvency agreement has been set aside or terminated.

Note: A defendant bears an evidential burden in relation to the matter in subsection (4) (see subsection 13.3(3) of the Criminal Code).

 (5) If a personal insolvency agreement specifies that the antecedent transactions provisions of this Act apply to the debtor, the debtor must fully and truly disclose to the trustee of the agreement particulars of any disposition of property made by him or her within the period of 2 years immediately preceding the date on which he or she signed the authority under section 188 authorizing the calling of the meeting of his or her creditors at which the resolution requiring the execution of the agreement was passed.

Penalty: Imprisonment for 1 year.

 (5A) A debtor is taken to have complied with subsection (5) if he or she has fully and truly disclosed to the best of his or her knowledge and belief as required by that subsection.

Note: A defendant bears an evidential burden in relation to the matter in subsection (5A) (see subsection 13.3(3) of the Criminal Code).

 (6) A debtor shall be deemed to have complied with subsection (5) in respect of any property if he or she shows that that property has been disposed of in the ordinary way of his or her business or in meeting the ordinary expenses of his or her family.

Note: See also subsection 5(6).

 (7) A debtor who has signed an authority under section 188, and has, within 12 months before the date on which he or she signed that authority and after the commencement of this Act:

 (a) done any of the things specified in any of paragraphs 265(4)(a) to (f) or paragraph 265(5)(a) or (b); or

 (b) disposed of, or created a charge on, any property with intent to defraud his or her creditors;

is guilty of an offence and is punishable, upon conviction, if the offence relates to the doing of a thing specified in paragraph 265(5)(a) or (b) or a thing specified in paragraph (b) of this subsection, by imprisonment for a period not exceeding 5 years or, in any other case, by imprisonment for a period not exceeding 1 year.

 (8) It is a defence to a charge under this section (not being a charge under paragraph (2)(b) or (c) or subsection (3) of this section or a charge relating to the doing of a thing specified in paragraph 265(5)(a) or (b) or paragraph (7)(b) of this section) if the defendant proves that the act or omission to which the charge relates was done or made without intent to defraud any of his or her creditors.

269  Bankrupt or debtor who is a party to a debt agreement obtaining credit etc. without disclosing bankruptcy or debt agreement

 (1) An undischarged bankrupt or a debtor who is a party to a debt agreement shall not:

 (a) either alone or jointly with another person, obtain credit to the extent of $3,000 or more from a person without informing that person that he or she is an undischarged bankrupt or a party to a debt agreement (as the case requires);

 (aa) either alone or jointly with another person, obtain goods or services from a person:

 (i) by giving a bill of exchange or cheque drawn, or a promissory note made, by him or her either alone or jointly with another person, being a bill, cheque or note under which the sum payable is $3,000 or more; or

 (ii) by giving 2 or more such instruments under which the sums payable amount in the aggregate to $3,000 or more;

  without informing that person that he or she is an undischarged bankrupt or a party to a debt agreement (as the case requires);

 (ab) either alone or jointly with another person, enter into a hirepurchase agreement with a person, or enter into a contract or agreement for the leasing or hiring of any goods from a person, being a hirepurchase agreement, contract or agreement under which the amounts payable to that person amount in the aggregate to $3,000 or more, without informing that person that he or she is an undischarged bankrupt or a party to a debt agreement (as the case requires);

 (ac) either alone or jointly with another person, obtain goods or services from a person by promising to pay that person or another person an amount of, or amounts aggregating, $3,000 or more without informing that person that he or she is an undischarged bankrupt or a party to a debt agreement (as the case requires);

 (ad) either alone or jointly with another person, obtain an amount of, or amounts aggregating, $3,000 or more from a person by promising to supply goods to, or render services for, that person or another person without informing that person that he or she is an undischarged bankrupt or a party to a debt agreement (as the case requires); or

 (b) carry on business under an assumed name, in the name of another person or, either alone or in partnership, under a firm name without disclosing to every person with whom he or she or, if he or she is carrying on business in partnership under a firm name, the partnership deals, his or her true name and the fact that he or she is an undischarged bankrupt or a party to a debt agreement (as the case requires).

 (2) This section has effect subject to section 304A.

Penalty: Imprisonment for 3 years.

270  Failure to keep proper books of account

 (1) A person who has become a bankrupt after the commencement of this Act and:

 (a) has not kept such books, accounts and records as are usual and proper in any business carried on by him or her and as sufficiently disclose his or her business transactions and financial position during any period while the business was being carried on within the period of 5 years immediately preceding the date on which he or she became a bankrupt; or

 (b) having kept such books, accounts or records, has not preserved them;

is guilty of an offence and is punishable, upon conviction:

 (c) in the case of a person who has previously been either a bankrupt whose bankruptcy has not been annulled or a person whose affairs have been administered under a personal insolvency agreement, a deed of assignment or a deed of arrangement under this Act or the repealed Act or who has made a composition or arrangement with creditors under this Act or the repealed Act—by imprisonment for a period not exceeding 3 years; and

 (d) in the case of any other person—by imprisonment for a period not exceeding 1 year.

 (2) It is a defence to a prosecution under subsection (1) if the accused proves that in the circumstances his or her failure to keep or preserve the books, accounts or records was honest and excusable.

271  Gambling or hazardous speculations

  A person who has become a bankrupt after the commencement of this Act and:

 (a) within 2 years before the presentation of the petition on which, or by virtue of the presentation of which, he or she became a bankrupt, whether the petition was presented before or after the commencement of this Act, materially contributed to, or increased the extent of, his or her insolvency; or

 (b) during any period between the presentation of that petition and the date on which he or she became a bankrupt, lost any of his or her property;

by gambling or by speculations that, having regard to his or her financial position at the time and any other material circumstance, were rash and hazardous, being gambling or speculations not connected with a trade or business carried on by him or her, is guilty of an offence and is punishable, on conviction, by imprisonment for a period not exceeding 1 year.

272  Leaving Australia with intent to defeat creditors etc.

 (1) A person who:

 (a) within 6 months before the presentation of the petition on or by virtue of which he or she became a bankrupt, left Australia, or did an act preparatory to leaving Australia, with intent to defeat or delay his or her creditors; or

 (b) after the presentation of the petition on or by virtue of which he or she became a bankrupt and before he or she became bankrupt, left Australia, or did an act preparatory to leaving Australia, with intent to defeat or delay his or her creditors; or

 (c) after he or she has become a bankrupt and before he or she is discharged from the bankruptcy, without the consent in writing of the trustee of his or her estate, leaves Australia, or does an act preparatory to leaving Australia;

is guilty of an offence and is punishable, on conviction, if the offence relates to the doing of a thing specified in paragraph (a) or (b), by imprisonment for a period not exceeding 5 years or, in any other case, by imprisonment for a period not exceeding 3 years.

 (2) The trustee may impose written conditions on a consent given for the purposes of paragraph (1)(c). If the bankrupt is liable to make a contribution to the trustee under section 139P or 139Q, the conditions may include conditions regarding the payment of that contribution.

 (3) If the bankrupt contravenes any condition imposed by the trustee, the bankrupt is guilty of an offence and is punishable, on conviction, by imprisonment for a period not exceeding 1 year.

273  Trial of offences

 (1) Subject to this section, an offence against this Act, other than an offence that is punishable by a fine only, is punishable either on indictment or on summary conviction.

 (2) Where proceedings for an offence that is punishable as provided by subsection (1) are brought in a court of summary jurisdiction, the court may either determine the proceedings or commit the defendant for trial, but shall not, if it determines the proceedings, impose a period of imprisonment exceeding 1 year in respect of the offence.

 (3) Subject to subsection (4), an offence against this Act that is punishable by a fine only is punishable by a court of summary jurisdiction.

 (4) The Federal Court has jurisdiction to try summarily any offence against this Act.

Note: State and Territory courts are conferred jurisdiction by the Judiciary Act 1903 in relation to offences against this Act. The exercise by those courts of that jurisdiction does not involve the exercise of jurisdiction in bankruptcy conferred by this Act.

 (5) Where proceedings for an offence other than an offence that is punishable by a fine only are brought in the Federal Court, the Federal Court may either determine the proceedings or commit the defendant for trial before a court of competent jurisdiction, but shall not, if it determines the proceedings, impose a period of imprisonment exceeding 1 year in respect of the offence.

275  Criminal liability not affected by discharge etc.

  A person may be prosecuted for an offence against this Act although:

 (a) he or she has been discharged from bankruptcy or his or her bankruptcy has been annulled;

 (b) a composition or a scheme of arrangement has been accepted or approved under Division 6 of Part IV; or

 (c) a personal insolvency agreement has become binding on his or her creditors.

276  Trustee acting under a personal insolvency agreement that has been set aside

 (1) A person who acts as trustee under a personal insolvency agreement that has, to his or her knowledge, been set aside or been terminated is liable, on conviction by the Court or a court of summary jurisdiction, to a fine not exceeding $20 for each day on which he or she has so acted, not being a day on which his or her acting as a trustee was confined to taking such steps as were necessary for the protection of the property of the debtor.

 (2) It is a defence to proceedings brought under subsection (1) if the person alleged to have acted as trustee proves that his or her acting as a trustee was confined to taking such steps as were necessary for the protection of the property of the debtor.

277  Punishment of contempt of court

  Where by this Act it is provided that a person is guilty of contempt of court, that person may be dealt with by any court having jurisdiction in bankruptcy as if he or she were guilty of a contempt of that court, but a person is not liable to be punished by more than one court in respect of the one contempt.

277A  Keeping of books in respect of period of bankruptcy

 (1) Subject to this section, a bankrupt must:

 (a) keep books that record and explain any income derived by the bankrupt, record the particulars of any employment of the bankrupt, and record and explain any other dealings, transactions or other financial or business affairs of the bankrupt, during the period of the bankruptcy; and

 (b) retain the books until discharged from the bankruptcy.

 (2) The bankrupt must:

 (a) keep the books in writing in the English language or so as to enable the books to be readily accessible and convertible into writing in the English language; and

 (b) keep the books so as to enable any liability of the bankrupt arising under this Act by virtue of any acts, transactions or other matters occurring during the period of the bankruptcy to be readily ascertainable.

 (3) A person who has possession of any books referred to in subsection (1) must:

 (a) produce the books to the trustee or to the Official Receiver when requested to do so; and

 (b) retain the books until the bankrupt is discharged.

 (4) A person is not required to retain books if the trustee or the Official Receiver, by written notice given to the person, has told the person that the retention of those books is not necessary.

Penalty: Imprisonment for 6 months.

277B  Infringement notices for offences

 (1) The regulations may make provision in relation to enabling a person who is alleged to have committed an offence of a kind referred to in the table in subsection (2) to pay to the Commonwealth, as an alternative to prosecution, a penalty of an amount worked out in accordance with subsection (2).

 (2) The amount of penalty payable to the Commonwealth under regulations made for the purposes of subsection (1) in respect of an offence is determined using the following table:

 

Penalties payable

 

 

Item

Alleged offence

Penalty payable

1

subsection 52(1A)

1 penalty unit

2

subsection 73(1A)

1 penalty unit

3

subsection 74(5A)

1 penalty unit

4

subsection 153A(2)

1 penalty unit

5

subsection 153B(3)

1 penalty unit

6

subsection 155J(1)

1 penalty unit

7

subsection 168(1)

2 penalty units

8

subsection 170A(1)

1 penalty unit

9

subsection 173(1)

1 penalty unit

10

subsection 175(5)

1 penalty unit

11

subsection 182(4)

1 penalty unit

12

subsection 185LEA(1)

1 penalty unit

13

subsection 185ZA(1)

1 penalty unit

14

subsection 186N(1)

1 penalty unit

15

subsection 186N(3)

1 penalty unit

16

subsection 186N(5)

1 penalty unit

17

subsection 186N(6A)

1 penalty unit

18

subsection 218(2)

1 penalty unit

19

subsection 224A(1)

1 penalty unit

20

subsection 224A(2)

1 penalty unit

21

subsection 224A(3)

1 penalty unit

22

subsection 224A(4)

1 penalty unit

23

subsection 224A(5)

1 penalty unit

24

subsection 244(14)

1 penalty unit

25

subsection 245(3)

1 penalty unit

26

subsection 246(1)

5 penalty units

27

subsection 247(3)

1 penalty unit

28

subsection 252A(2)

1 penalty unit

Part XVProvisions relating to the Bankruptcy (Estate Charges) Act 1997

 

278  Interpretation

  In this Part:

Estate Charges Act means the Bankruptcy (Estate Charges) Act 1997.

interest charge means charge imposed by Part 2 of the Estate Charges Act.

late payment penalty means penalty payable under subsection 281(1).

realisations charge means charge imposed by Part 3 of the Estate Charges Act.

279  Administration of, and powers and functions in relation to, the Charges Acts

 (1) The InspectorGeneral has the general administration of the Estate Charges Act.

 (2) A reference to “this Act” in section 12 or 77AA of this Act is taken to include a reference to the Estate Charges Act.

280  Deferred payment of interest charge or realisations charge

 (1) A person may defer the payment of an amount of interest charge relating to a particular trustee account if:

 (a) the total amount of interest charge that the person is liable to pay in respect of the account is less than $50; and

 (b) the account has not been closed; and

 (c) the person has notified the InspectorGeneral as provided for in subsection (3).

 (2) A person may defer the payment of an amount of realisations charge relating to a particular bankrupt’s estate, deceased person’s estate or debtor’s property, as the case may be, if:

 (a) the total amount of realisations charge that the person is liable to pay in respect of the estate or property is less than $50; and

 (b) the trustee account in relation to the estate or property has not been closed; and

 (c) the person has notified the InspectorGeneral as provided for in subsection (3).

 (3) If a person intends to defer paying an amount of interest charge or realisations charge, he or she must notify the InspectorGeneral in writing of that fact before the time by which the amount is otherwise required to be paid.

 (4) If a person defers payment of an amount of interest charge or realisations charge in accordance with this section, the amount is still payable to the Commonwealth, but the person does not have to pay it until 21 days after whichever of the following happens first:

 (a) at the end of a charge period:

 (i) if the deferral is of interest charge—the total amount of interest charge that the person is liable to pay in respect of the relevant trustee account is $50 or more; or

 (ii) if the deferral is of realisations charge—the total amount of realisations charge that the person is liable to pay in respect of the relevant estate or property is $50 or more;

 (b) the relevant trustee account is closed.

Note: As a deferred amount is still payable to the Commonwealth, it must be taken into account in working out the total amounts referred to in paragraphs (1)(a), (2)(a) and (4)(a).

 (5) In this section:

trustee account means an account under section 169, or under that section as applied by any of the following provisions:

 (a) section 210 (which applies section 169 to a controlling trustee under Division 2 of Part X);

 (b) subsection 231(5) (which applies section 169 to a personal insolvency agreement);

 (e) subsection 248(1) (which applies section 169 to administration of estates under Part XI).

281  Late payment penalty—interest charge and realisations charge

 (1) If any interest charge or realisations charge remains unpaid after the time for payment of the charge, the person liable to pay the charge is liable to pay to the Commonwealth a late payment penalty calculated from that time at the rate of 20% per year on the amount unpaid.

 (2) The person liable to pay late payment penalty is personally liable to pay the penalty and is not entitled to be reimbursed in respect of the penalty out of the bankrupt’s estate, the deceased person’s estate or the debtor’s property, as the case may be.

282  Extension of time for payment—interest charge and realisations charge

 (1)  The InspectorGeneral may, in a particular case, extend the time for payment of interest charge or realisations charge.

 (2) The following provisions apply in relation to extensions of time under subsection (1):

 (a) the person liable to pay the charge may apply for an extension;

 (b) an application is to be in writing, setting out the reasons for the application, and is to be made to the InspectorGeneral before the original time for payment;

 (c) the InspectorGeneral’s decision on an application is to be in writing;

 (d) application may be made to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal for review of a decision to refuse an application, or to grant a lesser extension than was applied for.

Note: Section 27A of the Administrative Appeals Tribunal Act 1975 requires notification of a decision that is reviewable.

283  Remission of interest charge, realisations charge and late payment penalty

 (1) The InspectorGeneral may remit an amount of interest charge, realisations charge or late payment penalty that is payable but has not been paid if the InspectorGeneral thinks that:

 (a) failure to remit the amount would cause a person undue hardship; and

 (b) it is appropriate to remit the amount.

 (2) The following provisions apply in relation to remissions under subsection (1):

 (a) the person liable to pay the charge or penalty may apply for a remission;

 (b) an application is to be in writing, setting out the reasons for the application, and is to be made to the InspectorGeneral;

 (c) the InspectorGeneral’s decision on an application is to be in writing;

 (d) application may be made to the Administrative Appeals Tribunal for review of a decision to refuse an application, or to remit a lesser amount than was applied for.

Note: Section 27A of the Administrative Appeals Tribunal Act 1975 requires notification of a decision that is reviewable.

284  Recovery of interest charge, realisations charge and late payment penalty

  Interest charge, realisations charge or late payment penalty that is due and payable may be recovered by the Commonwealth as a debt due to the Commonwealth.

285  Payments by cheque or payment order

 (1) If a person gives the Commonwealth a cheque or payment order in payment of an amount of interest charge, realisations charge or late payment penalty, the amount is taken not to be paid until the cheque or payment order is paid by the institution on which it is drawn.

 (2) If:

 (a) a person gives the Commonwealth a cheque or payment order in payment of an amount of interest charge or realisations charge; and

 (b) the cheque or payment order is paid by the institution on which it is drawn;

then, for the purposes of working out if there is a liability to late payment penalty, the amount of charge is taken to have been paid when the person gave the cheque to the Commonwealth.

286  Regulations may deal with other matters

 (1) The regulations may include other provisions dealing with the collection and recovery of interest charge, realisations charge or late payment penalty, including (but not limited to) provisions dealing with the following:

 (a) the methods by which charge and late payment penalty may be paid;

 (b) refunds of, or overpayments of, charge or late payment penalty;

 (c) as an alternative to the refund of the whole or a part of an amount to a person, crediting the amount or part of the amount against a liability of the person to pay charge or late payment penalty;

 (d) forms to be used, and information to be provided, in relation to the payment of charge and late payment penalty.

 (2) The matters that may be covered in regulations made for the purposes of paragraph (1)(a) include, but are not limited to, the making of payments using:

 (a) electronic funds transfer systems; or

 (b) credit cards; or

 (c) debit cards.

 (3) A refund of an amount in accordance with the regulations is to be paid out of the Consolidated Revenue Fund, which is appropriated accordingly.

Part XVIMiscellaneous

 

301  Certain provisions in contracts etc. to be void

 (1) A provision in a contract or agreement for the sale of property, in a lease of property, in a hirepurchase agreement, in a licence or in a PPSA security agreement to the effect that:

 (a) the contract, agreement, lease, hirepurchase agreement, licence or PPSA security agreement is to terminate, or may be terminated by the vendor, lessor, owner, licensor or PPSA secured party; or

 (b) the operation of the contract, agreement, lease, hirepurchase agreement, licence or PPSA security agreement is to be modified; or

 (c) property to which the contract, agreement, lease, hirepurchase agreement, licence or PPSA security agreement relates may be repossessed by or on behalf of the vendor, lessor, owner, licensor or PPSA secured party;

if the purchaser, lessee, hirer, licensee or PPSA grantor or debtor becomes a bankrupt or commits an act of bankruptcy or executes a personal insolvency agreement under this Act is void.

 (2) This section extends to contracts, agreements, leases, hirepurchase agreements and licences entered into or granted before the commencement of this Act.

 (2A) This section extends to a PPSA security agreement entered into at or after the time this subsection commences.

Note: This subsection commenced at the registration commencement time within the meaning of section 306 of the Personal Property Securities Act 2009.

 (3) In this section:

lease includes an agreement for a lease.

lessee includes a person who has agreed to take a lease.

lessor includes a person who has agreed to grant a lease.

302  Certain provisions in bills of sale etc. to be void

 (1) A provision in a bill of sale, mortgage, lien, charge or PPSA security agreement:

 (a) enabling the grantee, mortgagee, person entitled to the benefit of the lien or charge or PPSA secured party to exercise any power or remedy; or

 (b) to the effect that the operation of the bill of sale, mortgage, lien, charge or PPSA security agreement is to be modified;

if the grantor, mortgagor, the person whose property is subject to the lien or charge or the PPSA grantor or debtor becomes a bankrupt or commits an act of bankruptcy or executes a personal insolvency agreement under this Act is void.

 (2) This section extends to bills of sale, mortgages, liens and charges entered into or granted before the commencement of this Act.

 (3) This section extends to a PPSA security agreement entered into at or after the time this subsection commences.

Note: This subsection commenced at the registration commencement time within the meaning of section 306 of the Personal Property Securities Act 2009.

302A  Certain provisions in governing rules of superannuation funds and approved deposit funds to be void

 (1) This section applies to a provision in the governing rules of a provident, benefit, superannuation, retirement or approved deposit fund to the extent to which the provision has the effect that:

 (a) any part of the beneficial interest of a member or depositor is cancelled, forfeited, reduced or qualified; or

 (b) the trustee or another person is empowered to exercise a discretion relating to such a beneficial interest to the detriment of a member or depositor;

if the member or depositor:

 (c) becomes a bankrupt; or

 (d) commits an act of bankruptcy; or

 (e) executes a personal insolvency agreement under this Act.

 (2) The provision is void.

 (2A) This section does not apply to a provision that facilitates compliance with:

 (a) section 128B; or

 (b) section 128C; or

 (c) a notice under section 128E; or

 (d) an order under paragraph 128K(1)(b); or

 (e) a notice under section 139ZQ; or

 (f) an order under subsection 139ZT(2); or

 (g) an order under section 139ZU.

 (3) This section extends to governing rules made before the commencement of this section.

 (4) In this section:

governing rules, in relation to a fund, means any trust instrument, other document or legislation, or combination of them, governing the establishment or operation of the fund.

302AB  Certain provisions in RSA’s terms and conditions to be void

 (1) This section applies to a provision in the terms and conditions of an RSA to the extent to which the provision has the effect that:

 (a) any part of the amount of money a bankrupt holds in an RSA is cancelled, forfeited, reduced or qualified; or

 (b) the provider of the RSA is empowered to exercise a discretion relating to such an amount to the detriment of an RSA holder;

if the RSA holder:

 (c) becomes a bankrupt; or

 (d) commits an act of bankruptcy; or

 (e) executes a personal insolvency agreement under this Act.

 (2) The provision is void.

 (3) This section does not apply to a provision that facilitates compliance with:

 (a) section 128B; or

 (b) section 128C; or

 (c) a notice under section 128E; or

 (d) an order under paragraph 128K(1)(b); or

 (e) a notice under section 139ZQ; or

 (f) an order under subsection 139ZT(2); or

 (g) an order under section 139ZU.

302B  Certain provisions in trust deeds void

 (1) A provision of a trust deed is void to the extent that it has the effect of:

 (a) cancelling, reducing or qualifying a beneficiary’s interest under the trust; or

 (b) allowing the trustee to exercise a discretion to the detriment of a beneficiary’s interest;

if the beneficiary becomes a bankrupt, commits an act of bankruptcy or executes a personal insolvency agreement under this Act.

 (2) This section does not apply to a provision that facilitates compliance with:

 (a) section 128B; or

 (b) section 128C; or

 (c) a notice under section 128E; or

 (d) an order under paragraph 128K(1)(b); or

 (e) a notice under section 139ZQ; or

 (f) an order under subsection 139ZT(2); or

 (g) an order under section 139ZU.

303  Applications to Court

  Where in respect of any matter this Act provides that:

 (a) an application may be made to the Court; or

 (b) the Court or the Registrar may exercise a power;

and does not specify the person by whom the application may be made or the person on whose application the power may be exercised, as the case may be, the application may be made by, or the power may be exercised on the application of, any person aggrieved by or interested in that matter.

304  Parts of dollar to be disregarded in determining majority in value of creditors etc.

  In determining for the purposes of this Act whether a majority in value of creditors, or a particular proportion in value of creditors, has passed a resolution or done any other act or thing, if a creditor’s debt consists of a number of whole dollars and a part of a dollar, the part of the dollar shall be disregarded.

304A  Indexation

 (1) In this section:

index number, in relation to a quarter, means the All Groups Consumer Price Index number, being the weighted average of the 8 capital cities, published by the Australian Statistician in respect of that quarter.

indexable amount means:

 (a) the amount of $20 referred to in paragraph 77D(1)(a); or

 (b) the amount of $20 referred to in subsection 77E(2); or

 (c) the amount of $20 referred to in subsection 77E(3); or

 (d) the amount of $10 referred to in paragraph 77E(4)(a); or

 (e) the amount of $10 referred to in paragraph 77E(4)(b); or

 (f) an amount prescribed by the regulations for the purposes of paragraph 77E(3)(a) or (4)(a); or

 (g) the amount of $3,000 referred to in paragraph 149D(1)(c); or

 (j) each amount of $3,000 referred to in section 269;

or, if any such amount has previously been altered under this section, the amount as so altered or last altered.

 (2) Section 77D or 77E applies in relation to the attendance of a person on a day during a quarter that begins after the commencement of the section concerned as if the indexable amount or each indexable amount in that section were replaced by the amount worked out using the formula in subsection (6).

 (3) Section 149D applies in relation to an act, omission or transaction by a bankrupt that constituted misleading conduct that took place or was entered into on a day during a quarter that begins after the date of commencement of the section concerned as if the indexable amount in that section were replaced by the amount worked out using the formula in subsection (6).

 (5) Section 269 applies in relation to an act, omission or transaction referred to in that section that took place or was entered into on a day during a quarter that begins after the date of commencement of section 41 of the Bankruptcy Amendment Act 1991 as if each indexable amount in section 269 were replaced by the amount worked out using the formula in subsection (6).

 (6) The formula for the purposes of subsections (2), (3) and (5) is:

  

where:

Previous indexable amount means the indexable amount for the previous quarter.

Indexation factor means the indexation factor for the quarter worked out under subsection (8).

 (7) If, apart from this subsection, an amount worked out under subsection (6) would be an amount of dollars and cents, the amount is to be rounded to the nearest dollar (rounding 50 cents upwards).

 (8) The indexation factor for a quarter is the number (worked out to 3 decimal places) worked out by dividing the index number for the previous quarter by the index number for the quarter that immediately preceded the previous quarter.

 (9) If the factor worked out under subsection (8) in relation to a quarter would, if it were worked out to 4 decimal places, end with a number greater than 4, the factor worked out under that subsection in relation to that quarter is taken to be the factor worked out to 3 decimal places and increased by 0.001.

 (10) Subject to subsection (11), if at any time, whether before or after the commencement of this section, the Australian Statistician has published or publishes an index number in respect of a quarter in substitution for an index number previously published by the Australian Statistician in respect of that quarter, the publication of the later index number is to be disregarded for the purposes of this section.

 (11) If at any time, whether before or after the commencement of this section, the Australian Statistician has changed or changes the reference base for the Consumer Price Index, then, for the purposes of the application of this section after the change took place or takes place, regard is to be had only to the index numbers published in terms of the new reference base.

305  Payment of expenses by Commonwealth

 (1) Where the Minister, upon the application of the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt, the trustee under Part X in relation to a debtor or the trustee of the estate of a deceased person that is being administered under Part XI of this Act, is satisfied:

 (a) that proceedings relating to:

 (i) the estate of the bankrupt, the debtor or the deceased person; or

 (ii) any of the examinable affairs of the bankrupt, the debtor or the deceased person;

   should be instituted, continued or defended; or

 (aa) that the trustee should appear and participate in proceedings before the Administrative Appeals Tribunal reviewing a decision or determination by the trustee, or reviewing a decision of the InspectorGeneral on a review of such a decision or determination; or

 (b) that inquiries should be made concerning:

 (i) the estate of the bankrupt, the debtor or the deceased person; or

 (ii) any of the examinable affairs of the bankrupt, the debtor or the deceased person;

and is also satisfied that the moneys in the estate of the bankrupt, the debtor or the deceased person, as the case may be, are, or may be, insufficient to meet the cost of the proceedings or inquiries, the Minister may, by instrument in writing, direct that the cost of the proceedings or inquiries (including any costs that may be awarded against the trustee), or such part of the cost of the proceedings or inquiries (including any costs that may be awarded against the trustee) as is specified in the direction, be paid by the Commonwealth and, in that case, the cost or that part of the cost, as the case may be, shall be paid accordingly out of moneys available under an appropriation made by the Parliament.

 (2) A direction made by the Minister under subsection (1) may be subject to such conditions (including conditions as to the taxation of all or any costs and the reimbursement of the Commonwealth, in whole or in part, by the estate of the bankrupt, the debtor or the deceased person, as the case may be) as the Minister thinks fit.

 (3) The Minister may, by instrument in writing, revoke or vary a direction made by him or her under subsection (1).

 (4) In this section:

estate, in relation to a personal insolvency agreement under Part X, means the property and income subject to the agreement.

306  Formal defect not to invalidate proceedings

 (1) Proceedings under this Act are not invalidated by a formal defect or an irregularity, unless the court before which the objection on that ground is made is of opinion that substantial injustice has been caused by the defect or irregularity and that the injustice cannot be remedied by an order of that court.

 (2) A defect or irregularity in the appointment of any person exercising, or purporting to exercise, a power or function under this Act or under a personal insolvency agreement entered into under this Act does not invalidate an act done by him or her in good faith.

306A  Protection of Registrars, magistrates etc. in relation to examinations

 (1) A Registrar or magistrate has, in the exercise of the powers and the performance of the functions conferred on him or her by this Act in relation to the examination of a person, the same protection and immunity as a Justice of the High Court.

 (2) A barrister, solicitor or other person representing a person being examined under this Act, or a person entitled to take part in the examination of a person under this Act, has in respect of the examination the same protection and immunity as a barrister has in appearing for a party in proceedings in the High Court.

 (3) Subject to this Act, a person summoned to attend for examination, or appearing for examination, under this Act has the same protection, and is, in addition to the penalties provided by this Act, subject to the same liabilities, as a witness in proceedings in the High Court.

306B  Protection in respect of reports

 (1) An action, suit or proceeding does not lie against the InspectorGeneral, an Official Receiver, the trustee of the estate of a bankrupt or any other person in respect of a statement made in good faith in a report prepared or given to a person under subsection 12(1A) or (1B), 155A(6), 155F(2) or 155I(4) or section 189A.

 (2) Subsection (1) shall not be taken to limit or affect any other right, privilege, immunity or defence existing apart from that subsection.

307  Proceedings in firm name

  Any person or persons carrying on business under a firm name may take proceedings or be proceeded against under this Act in the firm name, but in that case the Court may, on the application of an interested person, order the name of the person or the names of the persons so carrying on business to be disclosed and verified in such manner as the Court directs.

308  Representation of corporation etc.

  Subject to this Act, for the purposes of this Act:

 (a) a corporation may act by any person duly authorized in that behalf by the corporation;

 (b) a partnership may act by any of its members or a duly authorized agent;

 (c) a person of unsound mind may act by a person authorized or empowered by law to act for him or her; and

 (d) any person may act by his or her agent duly authorized in that behalf.

309  Service of notices etc.

 (1A) Where a trustee carries on business at 2 or more addresses, a notice or other document in relation to which no special manner of service is prescribed may be sent to the trustee at any of those addresses.

 (2) Where a notice or other document is required by this Act to be served on or given to a person, the Court may, in a particular case, order that it be given or served in a manner specified by the Court, whether or not any other manner of giving or serving the notice or other document is prescribed.

311  Stamp duty not payable on trustee’s cheques or receipts

 (1) In this section, trustee means:

 (a) a trustee of the estate of a bankrupt; or

 (b) a trustee of a personal insolvency agreement; or

 (c) a trustee of a composition or a scheme of arrangement; or

 (d) a trustee of the estate of a deceased person in respect of which an order has been made under Part XI of this Act.

 (2) Notwithstanding anything contained in a law of a State or Territory, stamp duty is not payable under such a law:

 (a) on a cheque drawn by a trustee on an account kept under this Act;

 (b) on a cheque received by a trustee in his or her capacity as trustee, being a cheque drawn in a State or Territory other than that in which it is received by the trustee; or

 (c) on a receipt given by a trustee in his or her capacity as trustee.

312  Return or destruction of old accounts and records

 (1) During the administration of the estate of a bankrupt or debtor, the trustee may destroy or give back to the bankrupt or debtor any books that:

 (a) the bankrupt or debtor gave to any trustee of the estate; and

 (b) the trustee considers will not help the administration.

 (2) After the end of the administration of the estate of a bankrupt or debtor, the last trustee to administer the estate:

 (a) may give back to the bankrupt or debtor any books that the bankrupt or debtor gave to any trustee of the estate; and

 (b) may destroy any other books relating to the estate in accordance with subsection (3) or (4).

 (3) The trustee may destroy books relating to the estate at any time at least 6 years after the end of the administration if, by the end of the administration:

 (a) no property had been realised; and

 (b) no dividends had been distributed to creditors; and

 (c) the trustee considered that there was no chance of realising any property or distributing dividends.

 (4) The trustee may destroy books relating to the estate at any time at least 15 years after the end of the administration if, by the end of the administration:

 (a) property had been realised; and

 (b) the trustee had received some remuneration.

 (5) A trustee may destroy books only in accordance with this section.

 (6) This section does not limit a trustee’s power to give back to a bankrupt or debtor books that the bankrupt or debtor gave to any trustee of the estate of the bankrupt or debtor.

 (7) This section does not limit a trustee’s power to require a bankrupt or debtor to give books to the trustee (even if the books have previously been given to a trustee of the estate).

 (8) In this section:

end of the administration means:

 (a) in the case of a bankruptcy—the day on which the bankrupt is discharged or the bankruptcy is annulled, whichever happens first; or

 (b) in the case of an administration under Part X—the day 3 years after the day on which a personal insolvency agreement made by the debtor for the administration of the debtor’s estate took effect; or

 (c) in the case of an administration under Part XI—the day 3 years after the day on which the administration is taken to have commenced under section 247A.

313  Audit of accounts and records of the Official Trustee and the Official Receivers

 (1) The AuditorGeneral shall inspect and audit the accounts and records of the Official Trustee and the Official Receivers, and shall forthwith draw the attention of the Minister to any irregularity disclosed by the inspection and audit that, in the opinion of the AuditorGeneral, is of sufficient importance to justify his or her so doing.

 (2) The AuditorGeneral may, at his or her discretion, dispense with all or any part of the detailed inspection and audit of any accounts or records of the Official Trustee and the Official Receivers.

 (3) The AuditorGeneral shall, at least once in each financial year, report to the Minister the results of the inspection and audit carried out under subsection (1).

 (4) The AuditorGeneral or a person authorized by him or her is entitled at all reasonable times to full and free access to all books of the Official Trustee and the Official Receivers.

 (5) The AuditorGeneral or a person authorized by him or her may make copies of, or take extracts from, any books of the Official Trustee or an Official Receiver.

 (6) The AuditorGeneral or a person authorized by him or her may require any person to furnish him or her with such information in the possession of the person or to which the person has access as the AuditorGeneral or authorized person considers necessary for the purposes of the functions of the AuditorGeneral under this Act, and the person shall comply with the requirement.

 (7) A person who contravenes subsection (6) is guilty of an offence punishable, upon conviction, by a fine not exceeding $200.

315  Regulations

 (1) The GovernorGeneral may make regulations prescribing matters:

 (a) required or permitted by this Act to be prescribed; or

 (b) necessary or convenient to be prescribed for carrying out or giving effect to this Act.

 (2) In particular, the regulations may:

 (a) provide for the establishment, maintenance, correction and inspection of the National Personal Insolvency Index; and

 (b) specify matters that must be, or may be, entered in the Index; and

 (c) provide for the obtaining of extracts of material entered in the Index; and

 (d) provide for the use of extracts of material entered in the Index in evidence in proceedings under this Act and other laws of the Commonwealth or of a State or Territory; and

 (e) provide for immunity from actions for defamation arising out of publication of material in the Index or publication of extracts of material from the Index; and

 (f) provide for information and documents to be given to persons for entry in the Index; and

 (g) provide for the means of service of documents; and

 (h) provide for the publication of notice of specified events; and

 (i) provide for the manner in which committees referred to in Division 1 of Part VIII are to perform their functions, including:

 (i) the convening of meetings of committees; and

 (ii) the number of members of a committee who form a quorum; and

 (iii) disclosure of interest in a matter before a committee; and

 (iv) the manner in which questions are to be decided by the committee; and

 (j) provide for the charging and payment of fees, but not the setting of amounts of fees other than fees mentioned in paragraph 81(17)(b), in relation to:

 (i) proceedings under this Act; and

 (ii) inspection of material entered in the Index; and

 (iii) obtaining extracts of material entered in the Index; and

 (iv) inspection and copying of documents given to Official Receivers; and

 (v) the making of other requests or applications under this Act or the presentation or lodgment of other documents under this Act; and

 (k) prescribe penalties not exceeding 10 penalty units for offences against the regulations; and

 (l) provide for a person who is alleged to have committed an offence against the regulations to pay a penalty to the Commonwealth as an alternative to prosecution (being a penalty not exceeding onefifth of the maximum fine that a court could impose on the person for that offence).

316  Legislative instruments determining fees

 (1) The Minister may make legislative instruments determining the amounts of one or more of the following:

 (a) fees for the purposes of one or more of subsections 54(4), 55(9), 56G(2) and 57(11), subparagraph 77C(3)(b)(iii), paragraphs 154A(3)(b), 155C(1)(b) and 155D(1)(b) and subsection 163A(2), paragraphs 186B(2)(c) and 186D(1)(b) and subsections 188B(3), 226(3) and (4) and 246(5) (as they apply of their own force or as they apply because of another provision);

 (b) other fees relating to one or more of the following:

 (i) proceedings under this Act;

 (ii) inspection of material entered in the National Personal Insolvency Index;

 (iii) obtaining extracts of material entered in the National Personal Insolvency Index;

 (iv) inspection and copying of documents given to Official Receivers;

 (v) the making of other requests or applications under this Act or the presentation or lodgment of other documents under this Act;

 (c) remuneration of the Official Trustee.

 (2) Fees determined must not be such as to amount to taxation.

Schedule 1Acts repealed

Section 4(1)

Bankruptcy Act 1924

Bankruptcy Act 1927

Bankruptcy Act 1928

Bankruptcy Act 1929

Bankruptcy Act 1930

Bankruptcy Act 1932

Bankruptcy Act 1933

Bankruptcy Act 1945

Bankruptcy Act 1946

Bankruptcy Act 1954

Bankruptcy Act 1958

Bankruptcy Act 1959

Bankruptcy (Decimal Currency) Act 1965

Endnotes

Endnote 1—About the endnotes

The endnotes provide details of the history of this legislation and its provisions. The following endnotes are included in each compilation:

 

Endnote 1—About the endnotes

Endnote 2—Abbreviation key

Endnote 3—Legislation history

Endnote 4—Amendment history

Endnote 5—Uncommenced amendments

Endnote 6—Modifications

Endnote 7—Misdescribed amendments

Endnote 8—Miscellaneous

 

If there is no information under a particular endnote, the word “none” will appear in square brackets after the endnote heading.

 

Abbreviation key—Endnote 2

The abbreviation key in this endnote sets out abbreviations that may be used in the endnotes.

 

Legislation history and amendment history—Endnotes 3 and 4

Amending laws are annotated in the legislation history and amendment history.

 

The legislation history in endnote 3 provides information about each law that has amended the compiled law. The information includes commencement information for amending laws and details of application, saving or transitional provisions that are not included in this compilation.

 

The amendment history in endnote 4 provides information about amendments at the provision level. It also includes information about any provisions that have expired or otherwise ceased to have effect in accordance with a provision of the compiled law.

 

Uncommenced amendments—Endnote 5

The effect of uncommenced amendments is not reflected in the text of the compiled law but the text of the amendments is included in endnote 5.

 

Modifications—Endnote 6

If the compiled law is affected by a modification that is in force, details of the modification are included in endnote 6.

 

Misdescribed amendments—Endnote 7

An amendment is a misdescribed amendment if the effect of the amendment cannot be incorporated into the text of the compilation. Any misdescribed amendment is included in endnote 7.

 

Miscellaneous—Endnote 8

Endnote 8 includes any additional information that may be helpful for a reader of the compilation.

 

Endnote 2—Abbreviation key

 

ad = added or inserted

pres = present

am = amended

prev = previous

c = clause(s)

(prev) = previously

Ch = Chapter(s)

Pt = Part(s)

def = definition(s)

r = regulation(s)/rule(s)

Dict = Dictionary

Reg = Regulation/Regulations

disallowed = disallowed by Parliament

reloc = relocated

Div = Division(s)

renum = renumbered

exp = expired or ceased to have effect

rep = repealed

hdg = heading(s)

rs = repealed and substituted

LI = Legislative Instrument

s = section(s)

LIA = Legislative Instruments Act 2003

Sch = Schedule(s)

mod = modified/modification

Sdiv = Subdivision(s)

No = Number(s)

SLI = Select Legislative Instrument

o = order(s)

SR = Statutory Rules

Ord = Ordinance

Sub-Ch = Sub-Chapter(s)

orig = original

SubPt = Subpart(s)

par = paragraph(s)/subparagraph(s)

/sub-subparagraph(s)

 

 

Endnote 3—Legislation history

 

Act

Number and year

Assent

Commencement

Application, saving and transitional provisions

Bankruptcy Act 1966

33, 1966

1 June 1966

4 Mar 1968 (see Gazette 1968, p. 119)

 

Bankruptcy Act 1968

121, 1968

3 Dec 1968

31 Dec 1968

Judges’ Remuneration Act 1969 (a)

40, 1969

14 June 1969

14 June 1969

Bankruptcy Act 1970

122, 1970

11 Nov 1970

11 Nov 1970

s. 21

Statute Law Revision Act 1973

216, 1973

19 Dec 1973

31 Dec 1973

ss. 9(1) and 10

Postal and Telecommunications Commissions (Transitional Provisions) Act 1975

56, 1975

12 June 1975

ss. 4 and 38: 1 July 1975 (see s. 2(1) and Gazette 1975, No. S122)
Remainder: Royal Assent

s. 38(3)

Administrative Changes (Consequential Provisions) Act 1976

91, 1976

20 Sept 1976

s. 3: (b)

s. 4

Bankruptcy Amendment Act 1976

161, 1976

9 Dec 1976

1 Feb 1977 (see Gazette 1977, No. S3, p. 2)

ss. 5, 6(2), (3) and 7–9

Remuneration and Allowances Amendment Act 1977

111, 1977

28 Oct 1977

ss. 1, 2, 5, 9(2), 13, 16, 18 and 19(2): Royal Assent
Remainder: 1 June 1977

Australian Federal Police (Consequential Amendments) Act 1979

155, 1979

28 Nov 1979

19 Oct 1979 (see s. 2 and Gazette 1979, No. S206)

Bankruptcy Amendment Act 1980

12, 1980

8 Apr 1980

ss. 1, 2, 3(1), 4–6, 8, 13, 14, 18–20, 23–25, 29, 30, 36–41, 45, 46, 47(1), (3), 48, 52–54, 56, 63, 66–68, 71, 73(1), 79, 89, 91, 93–95, 97, 99, 105, 115, 117, 120–123, 126, 128, 129, 131, 133, 135, 143, 149, 150, 153, 155–162, 165–170, 174 and 176: Royal Assent
Remainder: 1 Feb 1981 (see Gazette 1980, No. S282)

ss. 12(2), 17(2), 23(2), 24(2), 26(2), 27(2), 28(2), 29(2), 31(2), 32(2), 33(2), 34(2), 35(2), (3), 36(2), (3), 38(2)–(4), 40(2), 41(2)–(4), 42(2), 43(2), 44(2), 45(2), (3), 47(3), 51(2), (3), 53(2), 54(2), 55(2)–(6), 56(2), 57(2), 58(2), 59(2), 60(2), 61(2), 63(2), 69(2), 70(2), 71(2), 72(2), 75(2), 82(2), (3), 85(2), (3), 91(2), 96(2), 99(2), 104(2), 105(2), 109(2)–(5), 112(2), 115(2), 122(2), 124(2), 125(2), 127(2), 129(2), 130(2), 132(2), 133(2), 134(2), 136(2), 137(2), 139(2), 141(2), 142(2), (3), 147(2), 148(2), 152(2), (3), 158(2), 175 and 176

Australian Federal Police (Consequential Amendments) Act 1980

70, 1980

28 May 1980

28 May 1980

Commonwealth Functions (Statutes Review) Act 1981

74, 1981

18 June 1981

Part V (ss. 122–147): 2 Nov 1981 (see Gazette 1981, No. S229) (c)

ss. 123(2), 125(2), 126(2), 127(2), 128(2), 129(2), 132(2), 134(2), 135(2), 137(2), 146(2), 147(2) and 264

as amended by

 

 

 

 

Statute Law (Miscellaneous Amendments) Act 1981

176, 1981

2 Dec 1981

Part X (ss. 36, 37): 2 Nov 1981 (see Gazette 1981, No. S229) (d)

Statute Law (Miscellaneous Amendments) Act 1981

176, 1981

2 Dec 1981

Part VIII (ss. 28–30): 1 Feb 1982 (see Gazette 1982, No. S10) (e)

s. 30

Income Tax (Payments for Work) (Consequential Amendments) Act 1983

18, 1983

14 June 1983

14 June 1983 (see s. 2)

Australian Government Solicitor (Consequential Amendments) Act 1984

10, 1984

10 Apr 1984

s. 3: 1 July 1984 (see Gazette 1984, No. S231) (f)

s. 4(1) and (2)

Public Service Reform Act 1984

63, 1984

25 June 1984

s. 151(1): 1 July 1984 (see Gazette 1984, No. S245) (g)
s. 151(6): (g)

s. 151(9)

as amended by

 

 

 

 

Prime Minister and Cabinet Legislation Amendment Act 1991

199, 1991

18 Dec 1991

18 Dec 1991

Bankruptcy Amendment Act 1985

21, 1985

7 May 1985

19 May 1986 (see Gazette 1986, No. S224)

ss. 6(2), 7(2), 8(2), 14(2), 29(2), (3) and 35(2)

Statute Law (Miscellaneous Provisions) Act (No. 2) 1985

193, 1985

16 Dec 1985

s. 3: (h)

ss. 7 and 16

Taxation Laws Amendment Act (No. 4) 1986

154, 1986

18 Dec 1986

Part II (ss. 3–6), ss. 8(a) and 9–11: 1 Jan 1987 (see s. 2(3))
s. 8(c): 10 June 1986
ss. 26(b), (c), 28, 40, 49(3) and (7): 1 Jan 1987 (see s. 2(4) and Gazette 1986, No. S650)
s. 55: 1 Mar 1987 (see Gazette 1987, No. S32)
Remainder: Royal Assent

Statute Law (Miscellaneous Provisions) Act (No. 2) 1986

168, 1986

18 Dec 1986

s. 3: 2 Mar 1987 (see Gazette 1987, No. S32) (i)

ss. 5(1), 6(1) and (2)

Proceeds of Crime (Miscellaneous Amendments) Act 1987

73, 1987

5 June 1987

5 June 1987 (see s. 2)

Bankruptcy Amendment Act 1987

119, 1987

16 Dec 1987

ss. 1 and 2: Royal Assent
ss. 4(1)(f), 9–11, 19, 24–29, 31, 32, 34–37, 46, 47, 53–58, 97, 98, 101, 103 and 105: 3 Jan 1989 (see Gazette 1988, No. S392)
ss. 6, 16–18, 20–22, 30, 38, 41, 59, 60, 62–65, 68–79, 82, 86, 87, 90, 99 and 100: 31 July 1989 (see Gazette 1989, No. S245)
ss. 14, 42–44 and 51: 1 Mar 1988 (see Gazette 1988, No. S49)
Remainder: 13 Jan 1988

ss. 4(2), 8(2), 9(2), 10(2), 11(2), 13(2), 15(2), 16(2), 17(2), 18(2), 20(2), 21(2), 22(2), 23(2), 25(2), (3), 26(2), 27(2), 28(2), 29(2), 30(2), 31(2), 32(2), 34(2), 35(2), 36(2), 37(2), (4), 38(2), 39(2), 40(2), 41(2), 42(2), 43(2), (4), 44(2), (4), 45(2), 46(2), 47(2), (3), 48(2), 49(2), 50(2), 51(2), 52(2), 53(3), 55(2), 57(2), 58(2), 59(2), 60(2), 62(2), 63(2), 64(2), 65(2), 68(2), 69(2), 70(2), 71(2), 72(2), 73(2), 74(2), 75(2), 76(2), 77(2), 78(2), 79(2), (5), 82(2), 83(2), 84(2), 85(2), 86(2), 89(2), 91(2), 97(2), 98(2), 99(2), 103(2), 106 and 107

Family Court of Australia (Additional Jurisdiction and Exercise of Powers) Act 1988

8, 1988

5 Apr 1988

s. 12(a) and (d): 1 Jan 1990
ss. 22–26, 28 and 31–45: 1 July 1988 (see Gazette 1988, No. S191)
Remainder: Royal Assent

as amended by

 

 

 

 

Law and Justice Legislation Amendment Act 1988

120, 1988

14 Dec 1988

Part XI (ss. 34, 35): 5 Apr 1988 (j)

Statute Law (Miscellaneous Provisions) Act 1988

38, 1988

3 June 1988

s. 3: Royal Assent (k)

s. 5(1)

Statutory Instruments (Tabling and Disallowance) Legislation Amendment Act 1988

99, 1988

2 Dec 1988

2 Dec 1988

Banking Legislation Amendment Act 1989

129, 1989

7 Nov 1989

Part I (ss. 1, 2), ss. 3, 26, 29–33, 35, 38 and 40: Royal Assent
s. 23(1): 4 May 1989
s. 39: 23 Jan 1988
Remainder: 28 Dec 1989 (see Gazette 1989, No. S383)

s. 28

Law and Justice Legislation Amendment Act 1990

115, 1990

21 Dec 1990

ss. 3, 5, 6, 8, 9, 16, 17, 20–23, 28, 30, 32, 33, 38 and 39: 4 Feb 1991 (see Gazette 1991, No. GN3, p. 278)
ss. 4, 7, 10–15, 18, 19, 24–27, 29, 31 and 34–37: 21 June 1991
Remainder: Royal Assent

ss. 14(2), 15(2), 25(2)–(4), 35(2) and 36(2)

Bankruptcy Amendment Act 1991

9, 1992

17 Jan 1992

Part 2 (ss. 3–50): 1 July 1992 (see Gazette 1992, No. S176)
Remainder: Royal Assent

ss. 51–58

Social Security Legislation Amendment Act 1992

81, 1992

30 June 1992

Schedule 2 (Part 6): 1 July 1992 (l)

Law and Justice Legislation Amendment Act (No. 4) 1992

143, 1992

7 Dec 1992

s. 3: (m)

Corporate Law Reform Act 1992

210, 1992

24 Dec 1992

Part 1 (ss. 1–3): Royal Assent
ss. 26(2) and 28(1): 1 Feb 1994
ss. 29–173 and 177: 23 June 1993 (see Gazette 1993, No. S186)
Remainder: 1 Feb 1993 (see Gazette 1993, No. S25)

Bankruptcy Amendment Act 1993

11, 1993

31 May 1993

31 May 1993

Insolvency (Tax Priorities) Legislation Amendment Act 1993

32, 1993

16 June 1993

ss. 6, 7, 9, 11, 13, 15 and Part 5 (ss. 29, 30): 1 June 1993
Part 4 (ss. 20–28): 1 July 1993
Remainder: Royal Assent

s. 30

Superannuation Industry (Supervision) Consequential Amendments Act 1993

82, 1993

30 Nov 1993

ss. 1, 2, 14, 16(2), 41, 42, 45, 46, 48(1) and 52–64: 1 Dec 1993
Remainder: 1 July 1994

s. 11

Law and Justice Legislation Amendment Act 1994

84, 1994

23 June 1994

ss. 89–91: Royal Assent (n)

s. 91 (am. by 94, 1994, s. 11)

as amended by

 

 

 

 

Primary Industries and Energy Legislation Amendment Act 1994

94, 1994

29 June 1994

s. 11: (o)

s. 12

Student Assistance (Youth Training AllowanceTransitional Provisions and Consequential Amendments) Act 1994

184, 1994

23 Dec 1994

1 Jan 1995 (p)

Taxation Laws Amendment Act (No. 3) 1995

170, 1995

16 Dec 1995

Schedule 2 (items 54–57, 64): Royal Assent (q)

Sch. 2 (items 56, 64)

Bankruptcy Legislation Amendment Act 1996

44, 1996

25 Oct 1996

Schedule 1: 16 Dec 1996 (see Gazette 1996, No. GN49)
Schedule 2: (r)
Remainder: Royal Assent

Sch. 1 (items 441–500)

as amended by

 

 

 

 

Bankruptcy Amendment Act 1997

11, 1997

13 Mar 1997

Schedule 2: (s)

Law and Justice Legislation Amendment Act 1999

125, 1999

13 Oct 1999

Schedule 4: 16 Dec 1996 (sa)

Bankruptcy Amendment Act 1997

11, 1997

13 Mar 1997

Schedules 1 and 3: 14 Apr 1997 (see Gazette 1997, No. S136) (t)

Sch. 3

Retirement Savings Accounts (Consequential Amendments) Act 1997

62, 1997

28 May 1997

2 June 1997 (see s. 2 and Gazette 1997, No. S202)

Audit (Transitional and Miscellaneous) Amendment Act 1997

152, 1997

24 Oct 1997

Schedule 2 (items 584–596): 1 Jan 1998 (see Gazette 1997, GN49) (u)

Farm Household Support Amendment (Restart and Exceptional Circumstances) Act 1997

179, 1997

25 Nov 1997

25 Nov 1997

Social Security Legislation Amendment (Youth Allowance Consequential and Related Measures) Act 1998

45, 1998

17 June 1998

Schedule 13 (item 4): 1 July 1998 (v)

Financial Sector Reform (Consequential Amendments) Act 1998

48, 1998

29 June 1998

Schedule 1 (Items 10–23): 1 July 1998 (see Gazette 1998, No. S316) (w)

s. 4(2)

Social Security and Veterans’ Affairs Legislation Amendment (Budget and Other Measures) Act 1998

93, 1998

15 July 1998

Schedule 7 (item 1): 1 Apr 1998 (x)

Superannuation Legislation Amendment Act 1999

38, 1999

31 May 1999

Schedule 1: Royal Assent (y)

Financial Sector Reform (Amendments and Transitional Provisions) Act (No. 1) 1999

44, 1999

17 June 1999

Schedule 7 (items 1–4): 1 July 1999 (see Gazette 1999, No. S283) (z)
Schedule 8 (items 1–9, 22): Royal Assent (z)

Sch. 8 (items 1–9, 22)
s. 3(2)(e) (am. by 160, 2000, Sch. 4 [item 4])

as amended by

 

 

 

 

Financial Sector Legislation Amendment Act (No. 1) 2000

160, 2000

21 Dec 2000

Schedule 1 (item 21): Royal Assent
Remainder: 18 Jan 2001

A New Tax System (Family Assistance) (Consequential and Related Measures) Act (No. 2) 1999

83, 1999

8 July 1999

Schedule 11 (item 3): (za)

Public Employment (Consequential and Transitional) Amendment Act 1999

146, 1999

11 Nov 1999

Schedule 1 (item 280): 5 Dec 1999 (see Gazette 1999, No. S584) (zb)

A New Tax System (Tax Administration) Act 1999

179, 1999

22 Dec 1999

Schedule 11 (item 3): 1 July 2000 (zc)

Federal Magistrates (Consequential Amendments) Act 1999

194, 1999

23 Dec 1999

Schedule 7: 23 Dec 1999 (zd)

Dairy Industry Adjustment Act 2000

22, 2000

3 Apr 2000

3 Apr 2000

Criminal Code Amendment (Theft, Fraud, Bribery and Related Offences) Act 2000

137, 2000

24 Nov 2000

ss. 1–3 and Schedule 1 (items  1, 4, 6, 7, 9–11, 32): Royal Assent
Remainder: 24 May 2001

Sch. 2 (items 418, 419)

Family Law Amendment Act 2000

143, 2000

29 Nov 2000

Schedule 3 (item 1E): 27 Dec 2000 (ze)

Farm Household Support Amendment Act 2000

144, 2000

7 Dec 2000

ss. 1 and 2: Royal Assent
Remainder: 18 Dec 2000 (see Gazette 2000, No. S634)

Sch. 3 (items 7(1), 8)

Law and Justice Legislation Amendment (Application of Criminal Code) Act 2001

24, 2001

6 Apr 2001

s. 4(1), (2) and Schedule 5: (zf)

s. 4(1) and (2)

Corporations (Repeals, Consequentials and Transitionals) Act 2001

55, 2001

28 June 2001

ss. 4–14 and Schedule 3 (items 80–87): 15 July 2001 (see Gazette 2001, No. S285) (zg)

ss. 4–14

Family Law Legislation Amendment (Superannuation) Act 2001

61, 2001

28 June 2001

28 Dec 2002

s. 5 (as am. by 86, 2002, Sch. 5 [item 10])

as amended by

 

 

 

 

Proceeds of Crime (Consequential Amendments and Transitional Provisions) Act 2002

86, 2002

11 Oct 2002

(see 86, 2002 below)

Higher Education Funding Amendment Act 2001

86, 2001

18 July 2001

Schedule 2 (items 1, 2): Royal Assent (zh)

Financial Services Reform (Consequential Provisions) Act 2001

123, 2001

27 Sept 2001

Schedule 1 (item 216): 11 Mar 2002 (see Gazette 2001, No. GN42) (zi)

Taxation Laws Amendment (Superannuation) Act (No. 2) 2002

51, 2002

29 June 2002

Schedule 6 (items 1, 2): (zj)

Sch. 6 (item 2)

Proceeds of Crime (Consequential Amendments and Transitional Provisions) Act 2002

86, 2002

11 Oct 2002

ss. 1–3: Royal Assent
Remainder: 1 Jan 2003 (see s. 2(1) and Gazette 2002, No. GN44)

Sch. 4 (items 12, 16)

Bankruptcy Legislation Amendment Act 2002

131, 2002

18 Dec 2002

Schedule 1: 5 May 2003 (see Gazette 2003, No. S138)
Remainder: Royal Assent

Sch. 1 (item 198 (as am. by 80, 2004, Sch. 7 [items 1, 2]) Sch. 1 (items 199–237)

as amended by

 

 

 

 

Bankruptcy Legislation Amendment Act 2004

80, 2004

23 June 2004

Schedule 7 (items 1, 2): (zk)
Schedule 7 (item 3): Royal Assent

Sch. 7 (item 3)

Higher Education Support (Transitional Provisions and Consequential Amendments) Act 2003

150, 2003

19 Dec 2003

Schedule 2 (items 96, 97): (zl)

Law and Justice Legislation Amendment Act 2004

62, 2004

26 May 2004

Schedule 1 (items 11, 12): 27 May 2004

Bankruptcy Legislation Amendment Act 2004

80, 2004

23 June 2004

Schedule 1 (items 1–187, 212–215) and Schedules 2–5: 1 Dec 2004 (see Gazette 2004, No. GN34)
Schedule 6: Royal Assent

Sch. 1 (items 212–215), Sch. 2 (items 11–13), Sch. 5 (item 3) and Sch. 6 (item 4)

as amended by

 

 

 

 

Statute Law Revision Act 2005

100, 2005

6 July 2005

Schedule 2 (item 9): (zm)

Financial Framework Legislation Amendment Act 2005

8, 2005

22 Feb 2005

s. 4 and Schedule 1 (items 97–108, 496): Royal Assent

s. 4 and Sch. 1 (item 496)

Bankruptcy and Family Law Legislation Amendment Act 2005

20, 2005

18 Mar 2005

Schedule 1: 18 Sept 2005
Schedules 3–5: 15 Apr 2005
Remainder: Royal Assent

Sch. 2 (item 5), Sch. 3 (item 2) and Sch. 4 (item 3)

Family Law Amendment Act 2005

98, 2005

6 July 2005

Schedule 1 (item 138): 18 Sept 2005

Bankruptcy Legislation Amendment (Antiavoidance) Act 2006

33, 2006

3 May 2006

Schedule 1: 31 May 2006
Remainder: Royal Assent

Sch. 1 (item 30)

Bankruptcy Legislation Amendment (Fees and Charges) Act 2006

34, 2006

3 May 2006

Schedule 1 (items 1–19), Schedules 2 and 3: 1 July 2006
Schedule 1 (items 20, 21): (zn)
Remainder: Royal Assent

Sch. 1 (items 3, 5, 9, 13, 15, 18), Sch. 3 (item 4) and Sch. 4 (item 8)

Tax Laws Amendment (Repeal of Inoperative Provisions) Act 2006

101, 2006

14 Sept 2006

Schedule 2 (items 25, 26) and Schedule 6 (items 1, 6–11): Royal Assent

Sch. 6 (items 1, 6–11)

Statute Law Revision Act 2007

8, 2007

15 Mar 2007

Schedule 4 (items 2–4): Royal Assent

Superannuation Legislation Amendment (Simplification) Act 2007

15, 2007

15 Mar 2007

Schedule 3 (items 1–3): 1 July 2007

Sch. 3 (item 3)

Bankruptcy Legislation Amendment (Debt Agreements) Act 2007

44, 2007

10 Apr 2007

Schedule 1: 11 Apr 2007
Schedule 2: 1 July 2007
Remainder: Royal Assent

Sch. 1 (items 21–23) and Sch. 2 (item 80)

Bankruptcy Legislation Amendment (Superannuation Contributions) Act 2007

57, 2007

15 Apr 2007

Schedule 1 (items 1–14): 28 July 2006
Schedule 1 (items 15–37): 15 Oct 2007
Schedule 2 (items 1, 5–7): 27 Apr 2007 (see F2007L01131)
Schedule 2 (items 2–4, 11–19): 16 Apr 2007
Schedule 2 (items 8–10): (zo)
Remainder: Royal Assent

Sch. 2 (item 4)

Statute Law Revision Act 2008

73, 2008

3 July 2008

Schedule 3 (item 26): Royal Assent

Family Law Amendment (De Facto Financial Matters and Other Measures) Act 2008

115, 2008

21 Nov 2008

Schedule 2 (items 4–18): 1 Mar 2009

SameSex Relationships (Equal Treatment in Commonwealth LawsGeneral Law Reform) Act 2008

144, 2008

9 Dec 2008

Schedule 2 (items 11–23, 25, 27, 29–33): 10 Dec 2008
Schedule 2 (items 24, 26, 28): (zp)

Fair Work (State Referral and Consequential and Other Amendments) Act 2009

54, 2009

25 June 2009

Schedule 5 (items 17–19): (zq)

Federal Court of Australia Amendment (Criminal Jurisdiction) Act 2009

106, 2009

6 Nov 2009

Schedule 1 (items 7–9): 4 Dec 2009

Personal Property Securities (Consequential Amendments) Act 2009

131, 2009

14 Dec 2009

Schedule 5 (items 5–18): 30 Jan 2012 (see F2011L02397)

Sch. 5 (item 18)

Crimes Legislation Amendment (Serious and Organised Crime) Act 2010

3, 2010

19 Feb 2010

Schedule 1 (item 43): Royal Assent

Bankruptcy Legislation Amendment Act 2010

106, 2010

14 July 2010

Schedule 1, Schedule 2 and Schedule 4 (items 5–10, 12, 13): 1 Dec 2010 (see F2010L03074)
Schedule 3: 15 July 2010
Schedule 4 (items 1–4): 11 Aug 2010
Remainder: Royal Assent

Sch. 1 (item 17), Sch. 2 (item 84), Sch. 3 (item 17) and Sch. 4 (items 4, 13)

Statute Law Revision Act 2011

5, 2011

22 Mar 2011

Schedule 5 (items 44, 45) and Schedule 7 (items 30, 31): 19 Apr 2011

Acts Interpretation Amendment Act 2011

46, 2011

27 June 2011

Schedule 2 (items 289–291) and Schedule 3 (items 10, 11): 27 Dec 2011

Sch. 3 (items 10, 11)

Crimes Legislation Amendment Act (No. 2) 2011

174, 2011

5 Dec 2011

Schedule 2 (items 142–150): 1 Jan 2012

Sch. 2 (item 150)

Family Law Legislation Amendment (Family Violence and Other Measures) Act 2011

189, 2011

7 Dec 2011

Schedule 2 (items 1, 2): 4 Jan 2012
Schedule 2 (item 31): Royal Assent

Sch. 2 (item 31)

Federal Circuit Court of Australia (Consequential Amendments) Act 2013

13, 2013

14 Mar 2013

Schedule 1 (items 54–57): 12 Apr 2013 (see s. 2(1))
Schedule 2 (item 1): (zr)

Sch. 1 (item 57)

Statute Law Revision Act (No. 1) 2014

31, 2014

27 May 2014

Sch 4 (items 9, 10, 60): 24 June 2014

 

Number and year

FRLI registration or gazettal

Commencement

Application, saving and transitional provisions

2006 No. 50

17 Mar 2006 (see F2006L00820)

Schedule 32: 27 Mar 2006 (see r. 2(b))

 

(a) The Judges’ Remuneration Act 1969 was repealed by section 7 of the Statute Law Revision Act 1973, subsection 7(2) of that Act provides as follows:

 (2) The repeal of an Act by this section does not affect the operation of:

 (a) any amendment of another Act made by the repealed Act; or

 (b) any provision for the citation of that other Act as amended by the repealed Act.

(b) The Bankruptcy Act 1966 was amended by section 3 only of the Administrative Changes (Consequential Provisions) Act 1976, subsection 2(7) of which provides as follows:

 (7) The amendments of each other Act specified in the Schedule made by this Act shall be deemed to have come into operation on 22 December 1975.

(c) The Bankruptcy Act 1966 was amended by Part V (sections 122–147) only of the Commonwealth Functions (Statutes Review) Act 1981, subsection 2(10) of which provides as follows:

 (10) The remaining provisions of this Act shall come into operation on such respective dates as are fixed by Proclamation.

(d) The Commonwealth Functions (Statutes Review) Act 1981 was amended by Part X (sections 36 and 37) only of the Statute Law (Miscellaneous Amendments) Act 1981, subsection 2(6) of which provides as follows:

 (6) Part X shall come into operation, or shall be deemed to have come into operation, as the case requires, on the date of commencement of subsection 125(1) of the Commonwealth Functions (Statutes Review) Act 1981.

(e) The Bankruptcy Act 1966 was amended by Part VIII (sections 28–30) only of the Statute Law (Miscellaneous Amendments) Act 1981, subsection 2(4) of which provides as follows:

 (4) Part VIII, Part XV, Division 2 of Part XVIII and Division 3 of Part XVIII shall come into operation on such respective dates as are fixed by Proclamation.

(f) The Bankruptcy Act 1966 was amended by section 3 only of the Australian Government Solicitor (Consequential Amendments) Act 1984, subsection 2(1) of which provides as follows:

 (1) Subject to subsection (2), this Act shall come into operation, or shall be deemed to have come into operation, as the case requires, on the day on which section 7 of the Judiciary Amendment Act (No. 2) 1984 comes into operation.

(g) The Bankruptcy Act 1966 was amended by section 151(1) only of the Public Service Reform Act 1984, subsection 2(4) of which provides as follows

 (4) The remaining provisions of this Act shall come into operation on such day as is, or on such respective days as are, fixed by proclamation.

 Section 151(6) of the Public Service Reform Act 1984 provided for the amendment of section 16 of the Bankruptcy Act 1966. The lastmentioned section was repealed by the Prime Minister and Cabinet Legislation Amendment Act 1991 before a date was fixed for the commencement of section 16.

(h) The Bankruptcy Act 1966 was amended by section 3 only of the Statute Law (Miscellaneous Provisions) Act (No. 2) 1985, subsections 2(1) and (2) of which provide as follows:

 (1) Subject to this section, this Act shall come into operation on the day on which it receives the Royal Assent.

 (2) Section 7 of this Act and the amendment of section 41 of the Bankruptcy Act 1966 made by this Act shall come into operation on a day to be fixed by Proclamation.

 The date fixed in pursuance of subsection 2(2) was 9 June 1986 (see Gazette 1986, No. S264).

(i) The Bankruptcy Act 1966 was amended by section 3 only of the Statute Law (Miscellaneous Provisions) Act (No. 2) 1986, subsections 2(1) and (2) of which provide as follows:

 (1) Subject to this section, this Act shall come into operation on the day on which it receives the Royal Assent.

 (2) The amendment of the Bankruptcy Act 1966 made by this Act inserting proposed section 31A shall come into operation on a day to be fixed by Proclamation.

(j) The Family Court of Australia (Additional Jurisdiction and Exercise of Powers) Act 1988 was amended by Part XI (sections 34 and 35) only of the Law and Justice Legislation Act 1988, subsection 2(6) of which provides as follows:

 (6) Part XI shall be taken to have commenced on 5 April 1988.

(k) The Bankruptcy Act 1966 was amended by section 3 only of the Statute Law (Miscellaneous Provisions) Act 1988, subsection 2(1) of which provides as follows:

 (1) Subject to this section, this Act commences on the day on which it receives the Royal Assent.

(l) The Bankruptcy Act 1966 was amended by Schedule 2 (Part 6) only of the Social Security Legislation Amendment Act 1992, paragraph 2(14)(c) of which provides as follows:

 (14) The following provisions commence on 1 July 1992:

 (c) Part 8 of Schedule 1 and Part 6 of Schedule 2.

(m) The Bankruptcy Act 1966 was amended by section 3 only of the Law and Justice Legislation Amendment Act (No. 4) 1992, subsections 2(1) and (2) of which provide as follows:

 (1) Subject to this section, this Act commences on the day on which it receives the Royal Assent.

 (2) The amendment of section 19 of the Bankruptcy Act 1966 made by this Act commences on the 28th day after the day on which this Act receives the Royal Assent.

(n) The Bankruptcy Act 1966 was amended by sections 89 and 90 only of the Law and Justice Legislation Amendment Act 1994, subsection 2(5) of which provides as follows:

 (1) Subject to this section, this Act commences on the day on which it receives the Royal Assent.

(o) The Law and Justice Legislation Amendment Act 1994 was amended by section 11 only of the Primary Industries and Energy Legislation Amendment Act 1994 provides as follows:

 (5) The amendments of the Law and Justice Legislation Amendment Act 1994 made by the Schedule commence, or are taken to have commenced, immediately after the commencement of section 91 of that Act.

 Section 91 commenced on 23 June 1994.

(p) Section 2 of the Student Assistance (Youth Training Allowance—Transitional Provisions and Consequential Amendments) Act 1994 provides as follows:

 2. This Act commences on 1 January 1995 immediately after the commencement of the Student Assistance (Youth Training Allowance) Amendment Act 1994.

(q) The Bankruptcy Act 1966 was amended by Schedule 2 (items 54, 55 and 57) only of the Taxation Laws Amendment Act (No. 3) 1995, subsection 2(1) of which provides as follows:

 (1) Subject to subsection (2), this Act commences on the day on which it receives the Royal Assent.

(r) Subsection 2(4) of the Bankruptcy Legislation Amendment Act 1996 provides as follows:

 (4) Schedule 2 commences immediately after the commencement of Schedule 1.

 Schedule 1 commenced on 16 December 1996 (see Gazette 1996, No. GN49).

(s) The Bankruptcy Act 1966 was amended by Schedule 2 only of the Bankruptcy Amendment Act 1997, subsection 2(4) of which provides as follows:

 (4) Schedule 2 commences, or is taken to have commenced, immediately after the Bankruptcy Legislation Amendment Act 1996 receives or received the Royal Assent.

 The Bankruptcy Legislation Amendment Act 1996 received the Royal Assent on 25 October 1996.

(sa) The Bankruptcy Legislation Amendment Act 1996 was amended by Schedule 4 only of the Law and Justice Legislation Amendment Act 1999, subsection 2(4) of which provides as follows:

 (4) Schedule 4 is taken to have commenced on 16 December 1996, immediately after the commencement of Schedule 1 to the Bankruptcy Legislation Amendment Act 1996.

(t) The Bankruptcy Act 1966 was amended by Schedules 1 and 3 only of the Bankruptcy Amendment Act 1997, subsection 2(2) of which provides as follows:

 (2) Subject to subsection (3), Schedules 1 and 3 commence on the commencement of the Bankruptcy (Estate Charges) Act 1997.

(u) The Bankruptcy Act 1966 was amended by Schedule 2 (items 584–596) only of the Audit (Transitional and Miscellaneous) Amendment Act 1997, subsection 2(2) of which provides as follows:

 (2) Schedules 1, 2 and 4 commence on the same day as the Financial Management and Accountability Act 1997.

(v) The Bankruptcy Act 1966 was amended by Schedule 13 (item 4) only of the Social Security Legislation Amendment (Youth Allowance Consequential and Related Measures) Act 1998, subsection 2(1) of which provides as follows:

 (1) Subject to subsections (2) to (10), this Act commences on 1 July 1998.

(w) The Bankruptcy Act 1966 was amended by Schedule 1 (Items 10–23) only of the Financial Sector Reform (Consequential Amendments) Act 1998, subsection 2(2) of which provides as follows:

 (2) Subject to subsections (3) to (14), Schedules 1, 2 and 3 commence on the commencement of the Australian Prudential Regulation Authority Act 1998.

(x) The Bankruptcy Act 1966 was amended by Schedule 7 (item 1) only of the Social Security and Veterans’ Affairs Legislation Amendment (Budget and Other Measures) Act 1998, subsection 2(9) of which provides as follows:

 (9) Schedule 7 commences, or is taken to have commenced, on 1 April 1998.

(y) The Bankruptcy Act 1966 was amended by Schedule 1 only of the Superannuation Legislation Amendment Act 1999, subsection 2(1) of which provides as follows:

 (1) Subject to this section, this Act commences on the day on which it receives the Royal Assent.

(z) The Bankruptcy Act 1966 was amended by Schedule 7 (items 1–4) only of the Financial Sector Reform (Amendments and Transitional Provisions) Act (No. 1) 1999, subsections 3(1), (2)(e) and (16) of which provide as follows:

 (1) Subject to this section, this Act commences on the day on which it receives the Royal Assent.

 (2) The following provisions commence on the transfer date:

 (e) subject to subsection (12), Schedule 7, other than items 43, 44, 118, 205 and 207 (the commencement of those items is covered by subsections (10), (11) and (13)).

 (16) The GovernorGeneral may, by Proclamation published in the Gazette, specify the date that is to be the transfer date for the purposes of this Act.

(za) The Bankruptcy Act 1966 was amended by Schedule 11 (item 3) only of the A New Tax System (Family Assistance) (Consequential and Related Measures) Act (No. 2) 1999, subsection 2(2) of which provides as follows:

 (2) Schedule 1 (Parts 1 to 5), Schedules 3 to 6, Schedule 7 (other than item 14), Schedules 8 and 9, Schedule 10 (other than item 63) and Schedule 11 (items 3 and 4 only) commence, or are taken to have commenced, on the commencement of Schedule 1 to the A New Tax System (Family Assistance) (Consequential and Related Measures) Act (No. 1) 1999.

 Schedule 1 to the A New Tax System (Family Assistance) (Consequential and Related Measures) Act (No. 1) 1999 commenced immediately after 1 July 2000.

(zb) The Bankruptcy Act 1966 was amended by Schedule 1 (item 280) only of the Public Employment (Consequential and Transitional) Amendment Act 1999, subsections 2(1) and (2) of which provide as follows:

 (1) In this Act, commencing time means the time when the Public Service Act 1999 commences.

 (2) Subject to this section, this Act commences at the commencing time.

 The proposed amendment to section 31A of the Bankruptcy Act 1966 made by Schedule 1 (item 280) of the Public Employment (Consequential and Transitional) Amendment Act 1999 had no effect as section 31A of the Bankruptcy Act 1966 was repealed by Schedule 1 (item 96) of the Bankruptcy Legislation Amendment Act 1996 before the amendment commenced.

(zc) The Bankruptcy Act 1966 was amended by Schedule 11 (item 3) only of the A New Tax System (Tax Administration) Act 1999, subsection 2(9)(b) of which provides as follows:

 (9) The following provisions commence on 1 July 2000:

 (b) Schedule 11 (other than item 44).

(zd) The Bankruptcy Act 1966 was amended by Schedule 7 only of the Federal Magistrates (Consequential Amendments) Act 1999, subsection 2(1) of which provides as follows:

 (1) Subject to this section, this Act commences on the commencement of the Federal Magistrates Act 1999.

(ze) The Bankruptcy Act 1966 was amended by Schedule 3 (item 1E) only of the Family Law Amendment Act 2000, subsection 2(1) of which provides as follows:

 (1) Subject to subsections (1A) and (2), this Act commences 28 days after the day on which it receives the Royal Assent.

(zf) The Bankruptcy Act 1966 was amended by Schedule 5 only of the Law and Justice Legislation Amendment (Application of Criminal Code) Act 2001, subsection 2(1)(a) of which provides as follows:

 (1) Subject to this section, this Act commences at the later of the following times:

 (a) immediately after the commencement of item 15 of Schedule 1 to the Criminal Code Amendment (Theft, Fraud, Bribery and Related Offences) Act 2000;

 Item 15 commenced on 24 May 2001.

(zg) The Bankruptcy Act 1966 was amended by Schedule 3 (items 80–87) only of the Corporations (Repeals, Consequentials and Transitionals) Act 2001, subsection 2(3) of which provides as follows:

 (3) Subject to subsections (4) to (10), Schedule 3 commences, or is taken to have commenced, at the same time as the Corporations Act 2001.

(zh) The Bankruptcy Act 1966 was amended by Schedule 2 (items 1 and 2) only of the Higher Education Funding Amendment Act 2001, subsection 2(1) of which provides as follows:

 (1) Subject to this section, this Act commences on the day on which it receives the Royal Assent.

(zi) The Bankruptcy Act 1966 was amended by Schedule 1 (item 216) only of the Financial Services Reform (Consequential Provisions) Act 2001, subsections 2(1) and (6) of which provide as follows:

 (1) In this section:

  FSR commencement means the commencement of item 1 of Schedule 1 to the Financial Services Reform Act 2001.

 (6) Subject to subsections (7) to (17), the other items of Schedule 1 commence on the FSR commencement.

(zj) Subsection 2(1) (item 10) of the Taxation Laws Amendment (Superannuation) Act (No. 2) 2002 provides as follows:

 (1) Each provision of this Act specified in column 1 of the table commences, or is taken to have commenced, on the day or at the time specified in column 2 of the table.

 

Commencement information

Column 1

Column 2

Column 3

Provision(s)

Commencement

Date/Details

10. Schedule 6, items 1 and 2

The later of:

(a) the day on which this Act receives the Royal Assent; and

(b) immediately after the commencement of item 77 of Schedule 1 to the Bankruptcy Legislation Amendment Act 2002

5 May 2003
(paragraph (b) applies)

(zk) Subsection 2(1) (item 5) of the Bankruptcy Legislation Amendment Act 2004 provides as follows:

 (1) Each provision of this Act specified in column 1 of the table commences, or is taken to have commenced, in accordance with column 2 of the table. Any other statement in column 2 has effect according to its terms.

 

Provision(s)

Commencement

Date/Details

5.  Schedule 7, items 1 and 2

Immediately after the commencement of Schedule 1 to the Bankruptcy Legislation Amendment Act 2002.

5 May 2003

(zl) Subsection 2(1) (item 8) of the Higher Education Support (Transitional Provisions and Consequential Amendments) Act 2003 provides as follows:

 (1) Each provision of this Act specified in column 1 of the table commences, or is taken to have commenced, in accordance with column 2 of the table. Any other statement in column 2 has effect according to its terms.

 

Provision(s)

Commencement

Date/Details

8.  Schedule 2, items 95 to 103

The later of:

(a) 1 January 2004; and

(b) immediately after the commencement of sections 110 to 23815 of the Higher Education Support Act 2003.

1 January 2004
(paragraph (b) applies)

(zm) Subsection 2(1) (item 30) of the Statute Law Revision Act 2005 provides as follows:

 (1) Each provision of this Act specified in column 1 of the table commences, or is taken to have commenced, in accordance with column 2 of the table. Any other statement in column 2 has effect according to its terms.

 

Provision(s)

Commencement

Date/Details

30.  Schedule 2, item 9

Immediately after the time specified in the Bankruptcy Legislation Amendment Act 2004 for the commencement of item 167 of Schedule 1 to that Act.

1 December 2004

(zn) Subsection 2(1) (item 3) of the Bankruptcy Legislation Amendment (Fees and Charges) Act 2006 provides as follows:

 (1) Each provision of this Act specified in column 1 of the table commences, or is taken to have commenced, in accordance with column 2 of the table. Any other statement in column 2 has effect according to its terms.

 

Provision(s)

Commencement

Date/Details

3.  Schedule 1, Part 2

The later of:

(a) immediately after the commencement of the provision(s) covered by table item 2; and

(b) immediately after the commencement of Schedule 1 to the Bankruptcy Legislation Amendment (Antiavoidance) Act 2006.

However, the provision(s) do not commence at all if the event mentioned in paragraph (b) does not occur.

1 July 2006
(paragraph (a) applies)

(zo) Subsection 2(1) (items 7–9) of the Bankruptcy Legislation Amendment (Superannuation Contributions) Act 2007 provides as follows:

 (1) Each provision of this Act specified in column 1 of the table commences, or is taken to have commenced, in accordance with column 2 of the table. Any other statement in column 2 has effect according to its terms.

 

Provision(s)

Commencement

Date/Details

7.  Schedule 2, item 8

Immediately after the commencement of item 12 of Schedule 1 to the Bankruptcy Legislation Amendment (Antiavoidance) Act 2006.

31 May 2006

8.  Schedule 2, item 9

Immediately after the commencement of item 208 of Schedule 1 to the Bankruptcy Legislation Amendment Act 1996.

16 December 1996

9.  Schedule 2, item 10

Immediately after the commencement of section 10 of the Superannuation Industry (Supervision) Consequential Amendments Act 1993.

1 July 1994

(zp) Subsection 2(1) (items 6, 8 and 10) of the SameSex Relationships (Equal Treatment in Commonwealth Laws—General Law Reform) Act 2008 provides as follows:

 (1) Each provision of this Act specified in column 1 of the table commences, or is taken to have commenced, in accordance with column 2 of the table. Any other statement in column 2 has effect according to its terms.

 

Provision(s)

Commencement

Date/Details

6.  Schedule 2, item 24

The later of:

(a) the start of the day after this Act receives the Royal Assent; and

(b) immediately after the commencement of item 13 of Schedule 2 to the Family Law Amendment (De Facto Financial Matters and Other Measures) Act 2008.

However, the provision(s) do not commence at all if the event mentioned in paragraph (b) does not occur.

1 March 2009

(paragraph (b) applies)

8.  Schedule 2, item 26

The later of:

(a) the start of the day after this Act receives the Royal Assent; and

(b) immediately after the commencement of item 15 of Schedule 2 to the Family Law Amendment (De Facto Financial Matters and Other Measures) Act 2008.

However, the provision(s) do not commence at all if the event mentioned in paragraph (b) does not occur.

1 March 2009

(paragraph (b) applies)

10.  Schedule 2, item 28

The later of:

(a) the start of the day after this Act receives the Royal Assent; and

(b) immediately after the commencement of item 17 of Schedule 2 to the Family Law Amendment (De Facto Financial Matters and Other Measures) Act 2008.

However, the provision(s) do not commence at all if the event mentioned in paragraph (b) does not occur.

1 March 2009

(paragraph (b) applies)

(zq) Subsection 2(1) (item 11) of the Fair Work (State Referral and Consequential and Other Amendments) Act 2009 provides as follows:

 (1) Each provision of this Act specified in column 1 of the table commences, or is taken to have commenced, in accordance with column 2 of the table. Any other statement in column 2 has effect according to its terms.

 

Provision(s)

Commencement

Date/Details

11.  Schedule 5, items 1 to 30

Immediately after the commencement of Part 24 of the Fair Work Act 2009.

1 July 2009

(zr) Subsection 2(1) (items 2 and 3) of the Federal Circuit Court of Australia (Consequential Amendments) Act 2013 provides as follows:

 (1) Each provision of this Act specified in column 1 of the table commences, or is taken to have commenced, in accordance with column 2 of the table. Any other statement in column 2 has effect according to its terms.

 

Provision(s)

Commencement

Date/Details

2.  Schedule 1

At the same time as item 1 of Schedule 1 to the Federal Circuit Court of Australia Legislation Amendment Act 2012 commences.

12 April 2013

3.  Schedule 2

Immediately after the commencement of the provision(s) covered by table item 2.

12 April 2013

Endnote 4—Amendment history

 

Provision affected

How affected

Part I

 

s. 3 ....................

am. No. 122, 1970

 

rep. No. 216, 1973

s. 4 ....................

am. No. 12, 1980

Part IA

 

Heading to Part IA ..........

ad. No. 119, 1987

s. 5 ....................

am. No. 121, 1968; No. 122, 1970; No. 155, 1979; Nos. 12 and 70, 1980; No. 21, 1985; Nos. 73 and 119, 1987; No. 8, 1988; No. 129, 1989; No. 115, 1990; Nos. 9 and 210, 1992; No. 82, 1993; No. 44, 1996; No. 62, 1997; No. 48, 1998; No. 194, 1999; No. 143, 2000; Nos. 55 and 123, 2001; Nos. 86 and 131, 2002; No. 80, 2004; No. 20, 2005; Nos. 33 and 34, 2006; Nos. 8, 44 and 57, 2007; Nos. 115 and 144, 2008; Nos. 54 and 131, 2009; Nos. 3 and 106, 2010; Nos. 5 and 174, 2011; No. 13, 2013

s. 5AA ..................

ad. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 80, 2004

 

rep. No. 106, 2010

s. 5A ...................

ad. No. 119, 1987

ss. 5B, 5C ................

ad. No. 119, 1987

 

am. No. 44, 1996

ss. 5D–5F ................

ad. No. 119, 1987

s. 5G ...................

ad. No. 119, 1987

 

am. No. 210, 1992; No. 55, 2001; No. 8, 2007

s. 5H....................

ad. No. 119, 1987

 

am. No. 80, 2004

ss. 5J, 5K.................

ad. No. 119, 1987

Heading to s. 6A ...........

rs. No. 44, 1996

s. 6A ...................

ad. No. 119, 1987

 

rs. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 44, 1996; No. 80, 2004; No. 34, 2006; No. 106, 2010

Heading to s. 6B ...........

am. No. 44, 1996

s. 6B ...................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 44, 1996; No. 34, 2006

s. 6C....................

ad. No. 86, 2002

Part IB

 

Heading to Part IB ..........

ad. No. 119, 1987

s. 7 ....................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 119, 1987; No. 44, 1996

s. 7A ...................

ad. No. 24, 2001

s. 8 ....................

rs. No. 12, 1980

s. 9 ....................

am. No. 12, 1980

Part II

 

Division 1

 

Heading to Div. 1 of Part II.....

ad. No. 12, 1980

s. 10 ...................

am. No. 91, 1976

 

rs. No. 119, 1987

 

am. No. 115, 1990; No. 5, 2011

s. 11 ....................

am. No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002

s. 12 ...................

am. No. 91, 1976; No. 12, 1980; No. 21, 1985; No. 168, 1986; Nos. 73 and 119, 1987; No. 9, 1992; No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002; No. 80, 2004; No. 44, 2007; No. 106, 2010; No. 174, 2011

s. 13 ...................

rs. No. 44, 1996

 

rep. No. 106, 2010

s. 14 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 21, 1985; No. 115, 1990

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

s. 14A ..................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

s. 15 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002; No. 106, 2010

Heading to s. 16 ............

rs. No. 44, 1996

s. 16 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 21, 1985; No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002

s. 17 ...................

am. No. 91, 1976; No. 12, 1980

 

rs. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 21, 1985; No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002; No. 46, 2011

Notes to s. 17(1), (2) .........

ad. No. 46, 2011

s. 17A ..................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 21, 1985

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

s. 17AA .................

ad. No. 193, 1985

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

s. 17B ..................

ad. No. 12, 1980

s. 18 ...................

am. No. 91, 1976; No. 12, 1980

 

rs. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 21, 1985; No. 168, 1986; No. 44, 1996; No. 80, 2004; No. 106, 2010

s. 18AA.................

ad. No. 152, 1997

s. 18A ..................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 44, 1996; No. 80, 2004

s. 19 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 74, 1981; No. 21, 1985; No. 119, 1987; No. 115, 1990; Nos. 9 and 143, 1992; No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002

s. 19AA .................

ad. No. 119, 1987

 

rs. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 131, 2002

Heading to s. 19A ...........

am. No. 44, 1996

s. 19A ..................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 44, 1996

s. 19B ..................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

s. 20 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rs. No. 168, 1986

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

Division 2

 

Div. 2 of Part II ............

ad. No. 12, 1980

s. 20A ..................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 168, 1986; No. 152, 1997; No. 8, 2005

s. 20B ..................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 21, 1985; No. 168, 1986; No. 115, 1990; No. 44, 1996; No. 48, 1998; No. 44, 2007; No. 106, 2010

s. 20C ..................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 63, 1984

 

rep. No. 168, 1986

s. 20D ..................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 168, 1986; No. 119, 1987; No. 44, 1996; No. 11, 1997; No. 48, 1998

s. 20E ..................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 168, 1986; No. 44, 1996; No. 48, 1998; No. 5, 2011

s. 20F ...................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 168, 1986

s. 20G ..................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

rs. No. 152, 1997; No. 8, 2005

Heading to s. 20H...........

am. No. 152, 1997

 

rs. No. 8, 2005

s. 20H ..................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 21, 1985; No. 168, 1986; No. 152, 1997

 

rs. No. 8, 2005

 

am. No. 57, 2007

s. 20J ...................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 168, 1986; No. 44, 1996 (as am. by No. 125, 1999); No. 80, 2004

Part III

 

Div. 1 of Part III ............

rep. No. 44, 1996

s. 21 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

s. 22 ...................

rep. No. 44, 1996

ss. 23, 24 ................

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

s. 25 ...................

am. No. 40, 1969

 

rs. No. 111, 1977

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

s. 26 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

Division 2

 

s. 27 ...................

am. No. 161, 1976; No. 12, 1980; No. 176, 1981; No. 44, 1996; No. 194, 1999; No. 20, 2005; No. 13, 2013

s. 28 ...................

am. No. 161, 1976; No. 12, 1980

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

Heading to s. 29 ............

rs. No. 44, 1996

s. 29 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996

s. 30 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 119, 1987; No. 44, 1996; No. 194, 1999

s. 31 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 119, 1987; No. 143, 1992; No. 44, 1996; No. 80, 2004

s. 31A ..................

ad. No. 168, 1986

 

am. No. 115, 1990; No. 9, 1992

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

s. 33 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996

s. 33A ..................

ad. No. 131, 2002

s. 34 ...................

am. No. 44, 1996

s. 34A ..................

ad. No. 119, 1987

s. 35 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rs. No. 12, 1980

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

 

ad. No. 20, 2005

 

am. No. 115, 2008

s. 35A ..................

ad. No. 8, 1988

 

am. No. 44, 1996; No. 194, 1999; No. 189, 2011; No. 13, 2013

Note to s. 35A(3) ...........

ad. No. 189, 2011

s. 35B ..................

ad. No. 98, 2005

 

am. No. 115, 2008

s. 36 ...................

am. No. 44, 1996

s. 37 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rs. No. 9, 1992

s. 38 ...................

rs. No. 161, 1976

 

am. No. 38, 1988

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

s. 39 ...................

rep. No. 161, 1976

Part IV

 

Division 1

 

s. 40 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 21, 1985; No. 119, 1987; No. 44, 1996; Nos. 86 and 131, 2002; No. 80, 2004; No. 20, 2005; No. 115, 2008; No 31, 2014

s. 41 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 193, 1985; No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002; No. 80, 2004; No. 106, 2010

s. 42 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 10, 1984; No. 5, 2011

Division 2

 

s. 43 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 143, 1992; No. 131, 2002

s. 44 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 21, 1985; No. 44, 1996; No. 106, 2010

s. 45 ...................

am. No. 44, 1996

s. 46 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

s. 47 ...................

am. No. 44, 1996

s. 48 ...................

am. No. 121, 1968; No. 12, 1980

 

rep. No. 12, 1980

s. 50 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 74, 1981; No. 119, 1987; No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002

s. 51 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

s. 52 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 74, 1981 (as am. by No. 176, 1981); No. 21, 1985; No. 44, 1996; No. 106, 2010

s. 53 ...................

am. No. 121, 1968; No. 12, 1980

s. 54 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 74, 1981; No. 21, 1985; No. 119, 1987; No. 44, 1996; No. 24, 2001; No. 131, 2002; No. 34, 2006; No. 106, 2010

Division 2A

 

Div. 2A of Part IV ..........

ad. No. 119, 1987

s. 54A ..................

ad. No. 119, 1987

 

am. No. 44, 1996; No. 106, 2010

s. 54B ..................

ad. No. 119, 1987

s. 54C ..................

ad. No. 119, 1987

 

am. No. 44, 1996; No. 106, 2010

Heading to s. 54D ...........

rs. No. 44, 1996

ss. 54D–54H ..............

ad. No. 119, 1987

 

am. No. 44, 1996

ss. 54J–54L ...............

ad. No. 119, 1987

Division 3

 

s. 55 ...................

am. No. 122, 1970; No. 12, 1980; No. 74, 1981; No. 21, 1985; No. 119, 1987; No. 115, 1990; No. 143, 1992; No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002; No. 80, 2004; No. 34, 2006

s. 56 ...................

am. No. 122, 1970; No. 12, 1980

 

rs. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 74, 1981; No. 21, 1985; No. 119, 1987; No. 115, 1990; No. 143, 1992

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

s. 56A...................

ad. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 80, 2004

ss. 56B–56D..............

ad. No. 44, 1996

s. 56E ..................

ad. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 131, 2002

s. 56F ...................

ad. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 24, 2001; No. 131, 2002; No. 106, 2010

s. 56G ..................

ad. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 131, 2002; No. 34, 2006

s. 57 ...................

rs. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 74, 1981; No. 21, 1985; No. 119, 1987; No. 115, 1990; No. 143, 1992; No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002; No. 80, 2004; No. 34, 2006

s. 57A ..................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 44, 1996

Division 4

 

Heading to s. 58............

am. No. 86, 2002

s. 58 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 74, 1981; No. 73, 1987; No. 44, 1996; No. 86, 2002

Note to s. 58(1) ............

ad. No. 86, 2002

Renumbered Note 1..........

No. 34, 2006

Note 2 to s. 58(1) ...........

ad. No. 34, 2006

s. 58A...................

ad. No. 86, 2002

 

am. No. 174, 2011

s. 59 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rs. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 119, 1987; No. 143, 1992; No. 44, 1996; No. 57, 2007

Heading to s. 59A...........

am. No. 115, 2008

s. 59A ..................

ad. No. 20, 2005

 

am. No. 115, 2008

s. 60 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 73, 1987; No. 44, 1996; No. 86, 2002; No. 144, 2008

Note to s. 60(4) ............

ad. No. 144, 2008

s. 61 ...................

am. No. 44, 1996

s. 63 ...................

am. No. 44, 1996

Division 5

 

Heading to Div. 5
of Part IV

am. No. 119, 1987; No. 115, 1990

 

rs. No. 9, 1992

Subdivision A

 

Subdiv. A of Div. 5
of Part IV 

ad. No. 9, 1992

s. 63A ..................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 44, 1996

s. 63B ..................

ad. No. 9, 1992

Subdivision B

 

Heading to Subdiv. B
of Div. 5 of Part IV

ad. No. 9, 1992

s. 64 ...................

rs. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 74, 1981; No. 21, 1985

 

rs. No. 119, 1987

 

am. No. 9, 1992; No. 131, 2002

s. 64A...................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 80, 2004; No 31, 2014

s. 64B...................

ad. No. 9, 1992

s 64C...................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am No 31, 2014

s. 64D ..................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 44, 1996

ss. 64E, 64F ..............

ad. No. 9, 1992

s. 64G ..................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 44, 1996

Subdivision C

 

ss. 64H, 64J ..............

ad. No. 9, 1992

Subdivision D

 

ss. 64K, 64L ..............

ad. No. 9, 1992

s. 64M ..................

ad. No. 9, 1992

Note to s. 64M(1) ...........

ad. No. 131, 2002

s. 64N ..................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 131, 2002

ss. 64P–64T ..............

ad. No. 9, 1992

s. 64U ..................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002; No. 106, 2010

ss. 64V–64X ..............

ad. No. 9, 1992

Subdivision E

 

s. 64Y...................

ad. No. 9, 1992

s. 64Z ..................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002

s. 64ZA .................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 131, 2002

s. 64ZB .................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002

s. 64ZBA ................

ad. No. 131, 2002

 

am. No. 106, 2010

s. 64ZC .................

ad. No. 9, 1992

s. 64ZD..................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 106, 2010

ss. 64ZE, 64ZF.............

ad. No. 9, 1992

s. 65 ...................

am. No. 119, 1987

 

rep. No. 9, 1992

s. 66 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 119, 1987

 

rep. No. 9, 1992

s. 67 ...................

am. No. 119, 1987

 

rep. No. 9, 1992

s. 68 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 119, 1987

 

rep. No. 9, 1992

s. 69 ...................

am. No. 121, 1968

 

rs. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 74, 1981; No. 21, 1985; No. 119, 1987

 

rep. No. 115, 1990

Division 5A

 

Heading to Div. 5A
of Part IV

ad. No. 9, 1992

s. 70 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 119, 1987; No. 9, 1992; No. 44, 1996

s. 71 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996; No. 80, 2004

Division 6

 

s. 73 ...................

am. No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002; No. 80, 2004; No. 106, 2010

s. 73A ..................

ad. No. 131, 2002

ss. 73B, 73C...............

ad. No. 80, 2004

s. 74 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 119, 1987; No. 9, 1992; No. 44, 1996; No. 106, 2010

s. 74A ..................

ad. No. 131, 2002

s. 75 ...................

am. No. 122, 1970; No. 12, 1980; No. 9, 1992; No. 44, 1996; No. 80, 2004

s. 76 ...................

am. No. 119, 1987; No. 44, 1996

s. 76A ..................

ad. No. 9, 1992; No. 44, 1996

s. 76B...................

ad. No. 80, 2004

Part V

 

Division 1

 

Heading to Div. 1 of Part V ....

ad. No. 9, 1992

s. 77 ...................

am. No. 119, 1987; No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002

Heading to s. 77AA .........

am. No. 44, 1996

s. 77AA .................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 44, 1996

Heading to s. 77A ...........

am. No. 131, 2002

s. 77A ..................

ad. No. 119, 1987

 

am. No. 131, 2002

s. 77B ..................

ad. No. 119, 1987

 

rep. No. 131, 2002

s. 77C...................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. Nos. 33 and 34, 2006

s. 77CA..................

ad. No. 106, 2010

s. 77D...................

ad. No. 9, 1992

s. 77E ..................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 44, 1996

s. 77F ...................

ad. No. 9, 1992

s. 78 ...................

am. No. 121, 1968; No. 12, 1980; No. 119, 1987; No. 44, 1996

s. 79 ...................

am. No. 56, 1975; No. 12, 1980

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

s. 80 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 9, 1992; No. 44, 1996; No. 24, 2001; No. 131, 2002

s. 81 ...................

am. No. 121, 1968

 

rs. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 21, 1985; No. 119, 1987; No. 115, 1990; No. 9, 1992; No. 44, 1996; No. 33, 2006

Division 2

 

Div. 2 of Part V ............

ad. No. 9, 1992

ss. 81A–81F ..............

ad. No. 9, 1992

Division 3

 

Div. 3 of Part V............

ad. No. 9, 1992

s. 81G ..................

ad. No. 9, 1992

Part VI

 

Division 1

 

s. 82 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; Nos. 73 and 119, 1987; No. 210, 1992; No. 44, 1996; No. 55, 2001; Nos. 86 and 131, 2002; No. 150, 2003

Note to s. 82(1) ............

ad. No. 86, 2001

 

rep. No. 150, 2003

s. 83 ...................

am. No. 44, 1996

ss. 84, 85 ................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996; No. 137, 2000

s. 86 ...................

am. No. 44, 1996

ss. 90, 91 ................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996

s. 92 ...................

am. No. 44, 1996

ss. 93–95 ................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996

s. 98 ...................

am. No. 44, 1996

s. 99 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996

 

rep. No. 131, 2002

s. 100 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996

s. 101 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 119, 1987

s. 102 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996

s. 103 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rs. No. 131, 2002

s. 104 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 131, 2002

s. 105 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

s. 106 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996

Heading to s. 107 ...........

am. No. 44, 1996

s. 107 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996

Division 2

 

Subdivision A

 

Heading to Subdiv. A
of Div. 2 of Part VI

ad. No. 86, 2002

Note to s. 108..............

ad. No. 86, 2002

s. 109 ...................

am. No. 122, 1970; No. 12, 1980

 

rs. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 18, 1983; No. 21, 1985; No. 154, 1986; No. 119, 1987; No. 115, 1990; No. 32, 1993; No. 170, 1995; No. 44, 1996; Nos. 51 and 131, 2002; No. 80, 2004; SLI 2006 No. 50; No. 101, 2006; No. 54, 2009

s. 109A .................

ad. No. 21, 1985

s. 110 ...................

am. No. 44, 1996

ss. 111, 112 ...............

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rep. No. 119, 1987

s. 113...................

am. No. 44, 1996

s. 114...................

am. No. 44, 1996; No. 80, 2004

Subdivision B

 

Subdiv. B of Div. 2..........
of Part VI

ad. No. 86, 2002

ss. 114A, 114B.............

ad. No. 86, 2002

Heading to s. 114C..........

am. No. 174, 2011

s. 114C..................

ad. No. 86, 2002

 

am. No. 174, 2011

Division 3

 

Subdivision A

 

Heading to Subdiv. A
of Div. 3 of Part VI

ad. No. 57, 2007

s. 115 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002

s. 116 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 168, 1986; No. 119, 1987; No. 115, 1990; No. 143, 1992; No. 82, 1993; No. 84, 1994; No. 44, 1996; Nos. 62 and 179, 1997; No. 38, 1999; Nos. 22 and 144, 2000; No. 61, 2001; No. 131, 2002; No. 20, 2005; No. 33, 2006; Nos. 15 and 57, 2007; Nos. 115 and 144, 2008

s. 117 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996

ss. 118, 119 ...............

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rs. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 44, 1996

s. 119A .................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 168, 1986; No. 44, 1996

s. 120 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 119, 1987

 

rs. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 33, 2006; Nos. 115 and 144, 2008

Note to s. 120(1) ...........

ad. No. 33, 2006

s. 121 ...................

rs. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 33, 2006; No. 57, 2007; Nos. 115 and 144, 2008

Note to s. 121(1) ...........

ad. No. 33, 2006

s. 121A..................

ad. No. 33, 2006

s. 122 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 32, 1993; No. 44, 1996

Heading to s. 123 ...........

am. No. 44, 1996

s. 123 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 119, 1987; No. 32, 1993; No. 44, 1996; No. 57, 2007

s. 124 ...................

am. No. 12, 198; No. 44, 1996

s. 125 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 21, 1985; No. 44, 1996; No. 48, 1998; No. 44, 1999; No. 20, 2005

s. 126 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996; No. 48, 1998

ss. 127, 128...............

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996

Subdivision B

 

Subdiv. B of Div. 3
of Part VI

ad. No. 57, 2007

s. 128A–128C.............

ad. No. 57, 2007

 

am. No. 57, 2007

s. 128D..................

ad. No. 57, 2007

ss. 128E–128H.............

ad. No. 57, 2007

ss. 128EJ–128M............

ad. No. 57, 2007

s. 128N..................

ad. No. 57, 2007

 

am. No. 57, 2007

Division 4

 

s. 129 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 119, 1987; No. 44, 1996

s. 129AA ................

ad. No. 131, 2002

s. 129A .................

ad. No. 115, 1990

s. 130 ...................

rs. No. 119, 1987

 

am. No. 115, 1990

s. 131 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rep. No. 9, 1992

s. 132 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 74, 1981; No. 21, 1985; No. 44, 1996

s. 133 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 119, 1987; No. 44, 1996

s. 134 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 119, 1987; No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002; No. 144, 2008

Heading to s. 135 ...........

rs. No. 44, 1996

s. 135 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 119, 1987; No. 44, 1996

 

rep. No. 131, 2002

ss. 136, 137 ...............

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996

s. 138 ...................

am. No. 44, 1996

s. 139 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 21, 1985; No. 44, 1996

Division 4A

 

Heading to Div. 4A
of Part VI

rs. No. 33, 2006

Div. 4A of Part VI ..........

ad. No. 119, 1987

ss. 139A–139C ............

ad. No. 119, 1987

s. 139CA.................

ad. No. 33, 2006

Heading to s. 139D..........

am. No. 33, 2006

s. 139D..................

ad. No. 119, 1987

 

am. No. 115, 1990; No. 33, 2006

s. 139DA.................

ad. No. 33, 2006

Heading to s. 139E..........

am. No. 33, 2006

s. 139E ..................

ad. No. 119, 1987

 

am. No. 115, 1990; No. 33, 2006

s. 139EA.................

ad. No. 33, 2006

s. 139F..................

ad. No. 119, 1987

 

am. No. 33, 2006

Heading to s. 139G..........

am. No. 33, 2006

ss. 139G, 139H.............

ad. No. 119, 1987

 

am. No. 33, 2006

Division 4B

 

Div. 4B of Part VI ..........

ad. No. 9, 1992

Subdivision A

 

s. 139J ..................

ad. No. 9, 1992

Subdivision B

 

s. 139K .................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 81, 1992; No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002; No. 144, 2008

Subdivision C

 

s. 139L ..................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 82, 1993; No. 184, 1994; No. 44, 1996; No. 62, 1997; No. 152, 1997; Nos. 45 and 93, 1998, No. 83, 1999; No. 131, 2002; Nos. 8 and 20, 2005

s. 139M .................

ad. No. 9, 1992

s. 139N .................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002

Subdivision D

 

ss. 139P–139S .............

ad. No. 9, 1992

s. 139T ..................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 44, 1996

 

rs. No. 131, 2002

Subdivision E

 

s. 139U .................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 170, 1995; No. 48, 1998; No. 179, 1999; No. 131, 2002

s. 139V .................

ad. No. 9, 1992

Subdivision F

 

s. 139W .................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002; No. 80, 2004

s. 139WA ................

ad. No. 131, 2002

s. 139X .................

ad. No. 9, 1992

s. 139Y .................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. SLI 2006 No. 50; No. 54, 2009

s. 139Z ..................

ad. No. 9, 1992

Subdivision G

 

s. 139ZA ................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 131, 2002

s. 139ZB .................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

ss. 139ZC, 139ZD ..........

ad. No. 9, 1992

s. 139ZE .................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 131, 2002

s. 139ZF .................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

rs. No. 131, 2002

Subdivision H

 

s. 139ZG ................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 11, 1993; No. 131, 2002; No. 34, 2006

ss. 139ZH, 139ZI...........

ad. No. 9, 1992

Subdivision HA

 

Subdiv. HA of Div. 4B
of Part VI

ad. No. 20, 2005

ss. 139ZIA–139ZID..........

ad. No. 20, 2005

s. 139ZIDA...............

ad. No. 20, 2005

s. 139ZIE................

ad. No. 20, 2005

s. 139ZIEA...............

ad. No. 20, 2005

ss. 139ZIF–139ZIH..........

ad. No. 20, 2005

s. 139ZIHA...............

ad. No. 20, 2005

s. 139ZII.................

ad. No. 20, 2005

s. 139ZIIA................

ad. No. 20, 2005

ss. 139ZIJ–139ZIP..........

ad. No. 20, 2005

ss. 139ZIR–139ZIT..........

ad. No. 20, 2005

Subdivision I

 

ss. 139ZJ–139ZP...........

ad. No. 9, 1992

Subdivision J

 

s. 139ZQ.................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 57, 2007

ss. 139ZR–139ZT...........

ad. No. 9, 1992

Subdivision K

 

Subdiv. K of Div. 4B
of Part VI

ad. No. 57, 2007

ss. 139ZU–139ZW..........

ad. No. 57, 2007

Div. 4C of Part VI ..........

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

rep. No. 131, 2002

ss. 139ZU, 139ZV ..........

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 44, 1996

 

rep. No. 131, 2002

ss. 139ZW, 139ZX ..........

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

rep. No. 131, 2002

s. 139ZY.................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 44, 1996

 

rep. No. 131, 2002

Heading to s. 139ZZ .........

rs. No. 44, 1996

 

rep. No. 131, 2002

s. 139ZZ .................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 44, 1996

 

rep. No. 131, 2002

Division 5

 

s. 140 ...................

am. No. 121, 1968; No. 12, 1980; No. 119, 1987; No. 44, 1996; No. 20, 2005; No. 34, 2006; No. 115, 2008

s. 144 ...................

am. No. 44, 1996

s. 145 ...................

rs. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002

s. 146 ...................

am. No. 44, 1996

s. 147 ...................

rs. No. 12, 1980

Part VII

 

Heading to Part VII .........

rs. No. 9, 1992

Division 1

 

Div. 1 of Part VII...........

ad. No. 9, 1992

s. 148 ...................

am. No. 73, 1987

 

rs. No. 9, 1992

Division 2

 

Div. 2 of Part VII ...........

ad. No. 9, 1992

Subdivision A

 

s. 149...................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rs. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 74, 1981; No. 115, 1990

 

rs. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002

s. 149A .................

ad. No. 115, 1990

 

rs. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 131, 2002; No. 57, 2007; No. 106, 2010

Subdivision B

 

s. 149B ..................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002

s. 149C ..................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 131, 2002; No. 106, 2010

s. 149D .................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 55, 2001; No. 131, 2002; No. 57, 2007; No. 106, 2010

s. 149E ..................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

Heading to s. 149F ..........

am. No. 44, 1996

s. 149F ..................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002

s. 149G .................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 44, 1996

Heading to s. 149H ..........

am. No. 131, 2002

ss. 149H, 149J .............

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

rs. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 131, 2002

Subdivision C

 

s. 149K .................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 131, 2002

s. 149L ..................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

s. 149M .................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 131, 2002

s. 149N..................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 131, 2002; No. 106, 2010

s. 149P ..................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 131, 2002

s. 149Q .................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

rs. No. 131, 2002

Div. 3 of Part VII ...........

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

rep. No. 131, 2002

s. 149R ..................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 44, 1996

 

rep. No. 131, 2002

ss. 149S–149Z.............

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

rep. No. 131, 2002

ss. 149ZA–149ZC...........

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

rep. No. 131, 2002

s. 149ZD ................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 55, 2001

 

rep. No. 131, 2002

s. 149ZE .................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

rep. No. 131, 2002

s. 149ZF .................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 44, 1996

 

rep. No. 131, 2002

ss. 149ZG, 149ZH ..........

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

rep. No. 131, 2002

s. 149ZI .................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

ss. 149ZJ–149ZM ...........

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

rep. No. 131, 2002

s. 150 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 74, 1981; No. 21, 1985; No. 119, 1987

 

rep. No. 9, 1992

s. 151 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rep. No. 9, 1992

Division 4

 

Heading to Div. 4
of Part VII

ad. No. 9, 1992

s. 152 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rs. No. 9, 1992

s. 153 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 73, 1987; No. 9, 1992; No. 44, 1996; No. 86, 2002

Note to s. 153(1) ...........

ad. No. 86, 2001

Note to s. 153(2) ...........

ad. No. 86, 2002

Division 5

 

Div. 5 of Part VII ...........

ad. No. 9, 1992

s. 153A..................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002; No. 8, 2005; No. 106, 2010

s. 153B..................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002; No. 106, 2010

s. 154 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rs. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 86, 2002; No. 174, 2011

Part VIII

 

Division 1

 

s. 154A .................

ad. No. 115, 1990

 

rs. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 11, 1997; No. 34, 2006

s. 155 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 21, 1985; No. 119, 1987; No. 115, 1990

 

rs. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 11, 1997; No. 131, 2002

s. 155A .................

ad. No. 115, 1990

 

rs. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 131, 2002; No. 44, 2007

s. 155B ..................

ad. No. 115, 1990

 

rs. No. 44, 1996

s. 155C..................

ad. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 11, 1997; No. 34, 2006

ss. 155D, 155E ............

ad. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 11, 1997; No. 131, 2002; No. 34, 2006

ss. 155F, 155G .............

ad. No. 44, 1996

s. 155H .................

ad. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 131, 2002; No. 80, 2004; No. 44, 2007

s. 155I ..................

ad. No. 44, 1996

s. 155J ..................

ad. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 24, 2001; No. 106, 2010

s. 155K..................

ad. No. 34, 2006

s. 156 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 21, 1985; No. 115, 1990

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

s. 156A .................

ad. No. 74, 1981

 

am. No. 44, 1996

s. 157 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 74, 1981; No. 119, 1987; No. 44, 1996

s. 158 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 74, 1981

s. 159 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 119, 1987

s. 160 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rs. No. 74, 1981

s. 161 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996; No. 20, 2005

s. 161A .................

ad. No. 21, 1985

 

rs. No. 44, 1996

Division 2

 

Heading to s. 161B ..........

rs. No. 44, 1996

s. 161B ..................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002; No. 106, 2010

Heading to s. 162 ...........

rs. No. 44, 1996

s. 162 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 9, 1992; No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002; No. 106, 2010

s. 163 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rs. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 44, 1996; No. 11, 1997; No. 8, 2005; No. 34, 2006

Note to s. 163..............

am. No. 80, 2004; No. 34, 2006

s. 163A .................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 44, 1996; No. 8, 2005; No. 34, 2006

s. 164 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rs. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 131, 2002

s. 165 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 9, 1992; No. 44, 1996

s. 166 ...................

rep. No. 74, 1981

 

ad. No. 106, 2010

s. 167 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996

 

rs. No. 106, 2010

Division 3

 

s. 168...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996; No. 48, 1998; No. 24, 2001; No. 106, 2010

s. 169...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996; No. 11, 1997; No. 48, 1998

s. 170...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996

s. 170A..................

ad. No. 106, 2010

s. 171 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rs. No. 11, 1997

s. 172 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 74, 1981; No. 129, 1989

 

rep. No. 11, 1997

s. 173...................

am. No. 11, 1997; No. 24, 2001

Note to s. 173(1) ...........

ad. No. 106, 2010

s. 174 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996

Heading to s. 175...........

am. No. 11, 1997

s. 175 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 74, 1981; No. 115, 1990;
No. 44, 1996 (as am. by No. 11, 1997); No. 11, 1997; No. 24, 2001

Note to s. 175(5) ...........

ad. No. 106, 2010

s. 176 ...................

rs. No. 12, 1980; No. 119, 1987

 

am. No. 115, 1990; No. 44, 1996

Division 4

 

s. 177 ...................

am. No. 119, 1987

s. 178 ...................

am. No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002

s. 179 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 21, 1985; No. 119, 1987; No. 44, 1996

Div. 4A of Part VIII .........

ad. No. 119, 1987

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

ss. 179A–179K ............

ad. No. 119, 1987

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

Division 5

 

s. 180 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

s. 181 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 74, 1981; No. 9, 1992; No. 44, 1996

s. 181A .................

ad. No. 131, 2002

s. 182 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996; No. 24, 2001; No. 106, 2010

ss. 183, 184 ...............

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996

s. 184A .................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 44, 1996

Part IX

 

Part IX ..................

rep. No. 12, 1980

 

ad. No. 44, 1996

Division 1

 

Heading to Div. 1
of Part IX

rs. No. 44, 2007

Subhead. to s. 185(1) ........

rep. No. 44, 2007

s. 185 ...................

rep. No. 12, 1980

 

ad. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 131, 2002; No. 44, 2007; No. 46, 2011

Subhead. to s. 185A(1) .......

am. No. 131, 2002

 

rep. No. 44, 2007

ss. 185A, 185B ............

ad. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 131, 2002

 

rep. No. 44, 2007

Division 2

 

Heading to s. 185C ..........

am. No. 131, 2002

ss. 185C–185E .............

ad. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 131, 2002; No. 44, 2007

ss. 185EA–185ED ..........

ad. No. 44, 2007

s. 185F ..................

ad. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 44, 2007

s. 185G .................

ad. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 131, 2002; No. 44, 2007

Division 3

 

s. 185H .................

ad. No. 44, 1996

 

rs. No. 44, 2007

s. 185I ..................

ad. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 44, 2007

s. 185J ..................

ad. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 86, 2002

 

rep. No. 44, 2007

s. 185K .................

ad. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 86, 2002; No. 44, 2007

s. 185L ..................

ad. No. 44, 1996

 

rep. No. 44, 2007

Division 3A

 

Div. 3A of Part IX ..........

ad. No. 44, 2007

ss. 185LA–185LE ..........

ad. No. 44, 2007

s. 185LEA................

ad. No. 106, 2010

ss. 185LF, 185LG...........

ad. No. 44, 2007

Division 4

 

Div. 4 of Part IX ...........

ad. No. 44, 1996

s. 185M .................

ad. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 131, 2002; No. 44, 2007

Note to s. 185M(2) ..........

rep. No. 44, 2007

Note to s. 185M(3) ..........

am. No. 44, 2007

ss. 185MA–185MD .........

ad. No. 44, 2007

Division 5

 

s. 185N..................

ad. No. 44, 1996

 

am. Nos. 86 and 131, 2002; No. 44, 2007

s. 185NA ................

ad. No. 44, 2007

s. 185P..................

ad. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 131, 2002; No. 44, 2007

Note to s. 185P(2) ..........

rep. No. 44, 2007

Note to s. 185P(3) ..........

am. No. 44, 2007

ss. 185PA–185PD ..........

ad. No. 44, 2007

s. 185Q..................

ad. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 131, 2002

s. 185QA.................

ad. No. 86, 2002

 

rs. No. 44, 2007

s. 185R ..................

ad. No. 44, 1996

s. 185S..................

ad. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 86, 2002; No. 80, 2004

Note to s. 185S ............

rep. No. 44, 2007

Division 6

 

s. 185T ..................

ad. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 131, 2002

s. 185U .................

ad. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 44, 2007

s. 185V .................

ad. No. 44, 1996

Note to s. 185V ............

rep. No. 44, 2007

Division 7

 

Heading to Div. 7 of Part IX....

rs. No. 44, 2007

Heading to s. 185W .........

am. No. 131, 2002

s. 185W .................

ad. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 131, 2002

Note to s. 185W(2) ..........

rs. No. 131, 2002

 

rep. No. 44, 2007

s. 185X .................

ad. No. 44, 1996

s. 185XA ................

ad. No. 44, 2007

s. 185Y .................

ad. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 131, 2002

 

rs. No. 44, 2007

Note to s. 185Y.............

rep. No. 131, 2002

s. 185Z ..................

ad. No. 44, 1996

 

rs. No. 44, 2007

s. 185ZA.................

ad. No. 131, 2002

 

am. No. 106, 2010

s. 185ZB.................

ad. No. 131, 2002

 

rs. No. 44, 2007

s. 185ZC.................

ad. No. 131, 2002

 

am. No. 44, 2007

ss. 185ZCA, 185ZCB ........

ad. No. 44, 2007

s. 185ZD.................

ad. No. 131, 2002

 

am. No. 44, 2007

s. 186 ...................

rep. No. 12, 1980

Division 8

 

Div. 8 of Part IX............

ad. No. 44, 2007

Subdivision A

 

s. 186A..................

ad. No. 44, 2007

Subdivision B

 

ss. 186B–186D.............

ad. No. 44, 2007

s. 186E..................

ad. No. 44, 2007

 

am. No. 44, 2007

ss. 186F–186H.............

ad. No. 44, 2007

Subdivision C

 

ss. 186J–186L.............

ad. No. 44, 2007

ss. 186LA–186LE...........

ad. No. 44, 2007

Subdivision D

 

s. 186M..................

ad. No. 44, 2007

Subdivision E

 

s. 186N..................

ad. No. 44, 2007

 

am. No. 44, 2007; No. 106, 2010

ss. 186P, 186Q.............

ad. No. 44, 2007

Part X

 

Heading to Part X...........

rs. No. 80, 2004

Division 1

 

s. 187 ...................

am. No. 122, 1970; No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996; No. 80, 2004

s. 187A .................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

rs. No. 119, 1987

Division 2

 

Heading to s. 188 ...........

am. No. 44, 1996; No. 80, 2004

s. 188 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 119, 1987; No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002; No. 80, 2004; No. 34, 2006; No. 106, 2010

s. 188A .................

ad. No. 44, 1996

 

rs. No. 80, 2004

s. 188B..................

ad. No. 80, 2004

 

am. No. 34, 2006

Heading to s. 189 ...........

rs. No. 44, 1996

s. 189 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 21, 1985; No. 119, 1987; No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002; No. 80, 2004

s. 189AAA...............

ad. No. 80, 2004

s. 189AA.................

ad. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 86, 2002

s. 189AB.................

ad. No. 44, 1996

s. 189AC.................

ad. No. 80, 2004

Heading to s. 189A..........

am. No. 80, 2004

s. 189A..................

ad. No. 119, 1987

 

rs. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 80, 2004

s. 189B..................

ad. No. 119, 1987

 

rs. No. 44, 1996

Heading to s. 190 ...........

am. No. 44, 1996

s. 190 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 74, 1981; No. 119, 1987; No. 44, 1996; No. 86, 2002; No. 80, 2004

s. 190A..................

ad. No. 80, 2004

s. 191 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996

s. 192 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rs. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 119, 1987

 

rs. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 80, 2004

s. 193 ...................

rs. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 119, 1987

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

s. 194 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 119, 1987

 

rs. No. 44, 1996; No. 80, 2004

s. 194A..................

ad. No. 80, 2004

s. 195 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 119, 1987; No. 44, 1996

s. 196 ...................

rs. No. 44, 1996

s. 197 ...................

rep. No. 44, 1996

s. 198 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 119, 1987

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

s. 199 ...................

rep. No. 44, 1996

s. 200 ...................

am. No. 119, 1987

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

ss. 201–203 ...............

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

Heading to s. 204...........

am. No. 80, 2004

s. 204 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 119, 1987; No. 44, 1996; No. 80, 2004

s. 205 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rs. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 44, 1996; No. 80, 2004

Heading to s. 205A..........

am. No. 80, 2004

s. 205A .................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 44, 1996; No. 80, 2004

Heading to s. 206...........

am. No. 80, 2004

s. 206 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996; No. 80, 2004

s. 207 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002; No. 80, 2004

s. 208 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rs. No. 44, 1996

Heading to s. 209...........

am. No. 80, 2004

s. 209 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996; No. 80, 2004

s. 210 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rs. No. 44, 1996

s. 211 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 21, 1985; No. 115, 1990

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

 

ad. No. 80, 2004

s. 212 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rs. No. 12, 1980; No. 119, 1987

 

am. No. 115, 1990

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

s. 212A .................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

s. 212B ..................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 119, 1987; No. 115, 1990

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

ss. 212C–212F .............

ad. No. 119, 1987

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

Division 3

 

s. 213 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rep. No. 80, 2004

s. 214 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996

 

rep. No. 80, 2004

s. 215 ...................

rs. No. 44, 1996; No. 80, 2004

Heading to s. 215A..........

am. No. 80, 2004

s. 215A .................

ad. No. 119, 1987

 

am. No. 44, 1996; No. 80, 2004

s. 215B ..................

ad. No. 119, 1987

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

Heading to s. 216...........

am. No. 80, 2004

s. 216 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 80, 2004

Heading to s. 217...........

am. No. 80, 2004

s. 217 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rs. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 44, 1996; No. 80, 2004

Heading to s. 218...........

am. No. 80, 2004

s. 218...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 119, 1987; No. 44, 1996; No. 80, 2004; No. 106, 2010

s. 219...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996; No. 80, 2004

Heading to s. 220...........

am. No. 80, 2004

s. 220...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996; No. 80, 2004

Heading to s. 221...........

am. No. 80, 2004

s. 221 ...................

am. No. 122, 1970; No. 12, 1980; No. 119, 1987; No. 44, 1996; No. 80, 2004

s. 221A..................

ad. No. 80, 2004

s. 222 ...................

am. No. 122, 1970; No. 12, 1980; No. 119, 1987; No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002

 

rs. No. 80, 2004

ss. 222A–222D.............

ad. No. 80, 2004

s. 223 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 119, 1987; No. 44, 1996; No. 80, 2004

s. 223A .................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 119, 1987

 

rs. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 80, 2004

s. 224 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002

 

rs. No. 80, 2004

s. 224A .................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 44, 1996

 

rs. No. 80, 2004

 

am. No. 106, 2010

Heading to s. 225...........

am. No. 80, 2004

s. 225 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 80, 2004

Heading to s. 226...........

am. No. 80, 2004

s. 226 ...................

rs. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 119, 1987; No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002; No. 80, 2004; No. 34, 2006

Heading to s. 227...........

am. No. 80, 2004

s. 227 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 80, 2004

Div. 4 of Part X............

rep. No. 80, 2004

s. 228 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996

 

rep. No. 80, 2004

s. 229 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rs. No. 80, 2004

s. 230 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996

 

rs. No. 80, 2004

s. 231 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 193, 1985; No. 119, 1987; No. 9, 1992; No. 44, 1996

 

rs. No. 80, 2004

s. 231A .................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 86, 2002

 

rs. No. 80, 2004

 

am. No. 174, 2011

s. 232 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996

 

rs. No. 80, 2004

Div. 5 of Part X............

rep. No. 80, 2004

s. 233...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996

 

rep. No. 80, 2004

s. 234 ...................

am. No. 44, 1996

 

rep. No. 80, 2004

ss. 234A, 234B ............

ad. No. 131, 2002

 

rep. No. 80, 2004

s. 235 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rep. No. 80, 2004

s. 236 ...................

am. No. 122, 1970; No. 12, 1980

 

rep. No. 80, 2004

s. 237 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 193, 1985; No. 119, 1987; No. 9, 1992; No. 44, 1996; No. 86, 2002

 

rep. No. 80, 2004

s. 237AA ................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 86, 2002

 

rep. No. 80, 2004

s. 237A .................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 44, 1996

 

rep. No. 80, 2004

Heading to Div. 6
of Part X

rs. No. 122, 1970

 

rep. No. 80, 2004

Div. 6 of Part X............

rep. No. 80, 2004

s. 238 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996

 

rep. No. 80, 2004

s. 239 ...................

am. No. 122, 1970; No. 12, 1980

 

rep. No. 80, 2004

s. 240 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996

 

rep. No. 80, 2004

ss. 240A, 240B ............

ad. No. 131, 2002

 

rep. No. 80, 2004

s. 241...................

am. No. 86, 2002

 

rep. No. 80, 2004

s. 242 ...................

am. No. 122, 1970; No. 12, 1980

 

rep. No. 80, 2004

s. 243 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 193, 1985; No. 119, 1987; No. 9, 1992; No. 44, 1996; No. 86, 2002

 

rep. No. 80, 2004

s. 243AA ................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 86, 2002

 

rep. No. 80, 2004

s. 243A .................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 44, 1996

 

rep. No. 80, 2004

Part XI

 

s. 244 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 21, 1985; No. 44, 1996; No. 106, 2010

s. 245 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996; No. 106, 2010

Heading to s. 246 ...........

am. No. 44, 1996

s. 246 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 119, 1987; No. 44, 1996; No. 24, 2001; No. 34, 2006; No. 106, 2010

s. 247 ...................

am. No. 122, 1970; No. 119, 1987; No. 44, 1996; No. 106, 2010

s. 247A .................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 44, 1996

s. 248 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 119, 1987; No. 9, 1992; No. 44, 1996

s. 248A .................

ad. No. 12, 1980

s. 249 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 9, 1992; No. 82, 1993; No. 44, 1996; No. 62, 1997; No. 38, 1999

s. 249A .................

ad. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996

s. 250 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rs. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 119, 1987; No. 44, 1996; No. 57, 2007

ss. 251, 252 ...............

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996

s. 252A .................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

rs. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 44, 1996; No. 8, 2005; No. 106, 2010

ss. 252B, 252C ............

ad. No. 9, 1992

s. 253 ...................

rep. No. 9, 1992

Part XIA

 

Part XIA ................

ad. No. 122, 1970

s. 253A .................

ad. No. 122, 1970

s. 253B ..................

ad. No. 122, 1970

 

rs. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 168, 1986; No. 115, 1990; No. 73, 2008

s. 253C ..................

ad. No. 122, 1970

 

rs. No. 44, 1996

s. 253D .................

ad. No. 122, 1970

 

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

s. 253E ..................

ad. No. 122, 1970

 

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996

s. 253F ..................

ad. No. 122, 1970

 

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rs. No. 44, 1996

Part XII

 

Heading to s. 254...........

am. No. 8, 2005

s. 254 ...................

am. No. 91, 1976; No. 12, 1980; No. 74, 1981; No. 44, 1996; No. 80, 2004; No. 8, 2005; No. 44, 2007

Part XIII

 

s. 255 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rs. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 115, 1990

 

rs. No. 44, 1996

s. 256 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

s. 257 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996; No. 152, 1997

s. 258 ...................

am. No. 119, 1987; No. 44, 1996; No. 152, 1997

s. 259 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

s. 260 ...................

rs. No. 12, 1980

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

s. 261 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rep. No. 12, 1980

s. 262 ...................

am. No. 122, 1970; No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996; No. 62, 2004

Part XIV

 

s. 263 ...................

am. No. 122, 1970; No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996; No. 137, 2000; No. 80, 2004; No. 106, 2010

s. 263A .................

ad. No. 122, 1970

 

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 24, 2001

s. 263B ..................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

rep. No. 137, 2000

s. 263C ..................

ad. No. 119, 1987

 

rs. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 80, 2004; No. 44, 2007

s. 264 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996

 

rep. No. 137, 2000

s. 264A .................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 119, 1987; No. 115, 1990; No. 24, 2001

s. 264B ..................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 119, 1987; No. 115, 1990; No. 44, 1996

s. 264C ..................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 119, 1987; No. 44, 1996; No. 24, 2001

s. 264D .................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 119, 1987

s. 264E ..................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 119, 1987; No. 24, 2001

s. 265 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 119, 1987; No. 44, 1996; No. 24, 2001; No. 131, 2002; No. 106, 2010

Note to s. 265(2) ...........

ad. No. 144, 2008

Heading to s. 265A ..........

am. No. 131, 2002

s. 265A .................

ad. No. 119, 1987

 

am. No. 9, 1992; No. 24, 2001; No. 131, 2002

s. 266 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996; No. 106, 2010

s. 267 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rs. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 44, 1996; No. 80, 2004; No. 44, 2007; No. 106, 2010

s. 267A .................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

rep. No. 137, 2000

s. 267B ..................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 24, 2001; No. 34, 2006; No. 106, 2010

s. 267C ..................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

rep. No. 137, 2000

s. 267D .................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 24, 2001

s. 267E ..................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 80, 2004

s. 267F ..................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 24, 2001

s. 267G .................

ad. No. 9, 1992

Heading to s. 268...........

am. No. 80, 2004

s. 268 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 119, 1987; No. 44, 1996; No. 24, 2001; No. 80, 2004; No. 106, 2010

Note to s. 268(4) ...........

ad. No. 24, 2001

Note to s. 268(6) ...........

ad. No. 144, 2008

s. 268A .................

ad. No. 119, 1987

 

rep. No. 137, 2000

Heading to s. 269...........

rs. No. 106, 2010

s. 269 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 119, 1987; No. 9, 1992; No. 44, 1996; No. 106, 2010

s. 270...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996; No. 80, 2004

s. 271...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996

s. 272 ...................

rs. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 9, 1992; No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002; No. 106, 2010

s. 273 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996; No. 106, 2009

Note to s. 273(4) ...........

ad. No. 106, 2009

s. 274 ...................

rep. No. 12, 1980

s. 275 ...................

am. No. 44, 1996; No. 80, 2004

Heading to s. 276...........

am. No. 80, 2004

s. 276 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996; No. 80, 2004

s. 277 ...................

am. No. 44, 1996

s. 277A .................

ad. No. 9, 1992

s. 277B..................

ad. No. 106, 2010

Part XV

 

Heading to Part XV..........

rs. No. 34, 2006

Part XV .................

rep. No. 44, 1996

 

ad. No. 11, 1997

s. 278 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 119, 1987

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

 

ad. No. 11, 1997

 

am. No. 34, 2006

s. 279 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

 

ad. No. 11, 1997

 

am. No. 34, 2006

s. 280 ...................

rep. No. 44, 1996

 

ad. No. 11, 1997

 

am. No. 80, 2004

s. 281 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

 

ad. No. 11, 1997

s. 282 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

 

ad. No. 11, 1997

 

am. No. 131, 2002

s. 283 ...................

rep. No. 12, 1980

 

ad. No. 11, 1997

 

am. No. 131, 2002

s. 284 ...................

rep. No. 44, 1996

 

ad. No. 11, 1997

s. 285 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

 

ad. No. 11, 1997

 

am. No. 48, 1998; No. 34, 2006

s. 286 ...................

rep. No. 12, 1980

 

ad. No. 11, 1997

ss. 287, 288 ...............

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

s. 289 ...................

rep. No. 44, 1996

ss. 290–293 ...............

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

s. 294 ...................

rep. No. 12, 1980

s. 295 ...................

am. No. 91, 1976; No. 12, 1980

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

ss. 296–298 ...............

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

ss. 299, 300 ...............

rep. No. 44, 1996

Part XVI

 

ss. 301, 302...............

am. No. 80, 2004; No. 131, 2009

s. 302A .................

ad. No. 82, 1993

 

am. No. 80, 2004; No. 57, 2007

s. 302AB.................

ad. No. 62, 1997

 

am. No. 80, 2004; No. 57, 2007

s. 302B ..................

ad. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 80, 2004; No. 57, 2007

Heading to s. 303 ...........

am. No. 44, 1996

s. 303 ...................

am. No. 44, 1996

s. 304A .................

ad. No. 9, 1992

 

am. No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002; No. 106, 2010

s. 305 ...................

am. No. 91, 1976; No. 9, 1992

 

rs. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 119, 1987; No. 44, 1996; No. 131, 2002; No. 80, 2004

s. 306 ...................

am. No. 44, 1996; No. 80, 2004

s. 306A .................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 119, 1987; No. 44, 1996

s. 306B ..................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 74, 1981; No. 21, 1985; No. 119, 1987; No. 115, 1990; No. 44, 1996

s. 306C ..................

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

rep. No. 74, 1981

s. 308 ...................

am. No. 44, 1996

s. 309 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 44, 1996

s. 310 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 143, 1992

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

s. 311 ...................

am. No. 121, 1968; No. 44, 1996; No. 80, 2004

s. 312 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980

 

rs. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 80, 2004

Heading to s. 313 ...........

am. No. 44, 1996

s. 313 ...................

am. No. 91, 1976; No. 12, 1980

 

rs. No. 12, 1980

 

am. No. 44, 1996

s. 314 ...................

am. No. 91, 1976

 

rs. No. 115, 1990

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

s. 315 ...................

am. No. 12, 1980; No. 99, 1988; No. 115, 1990

 

rs. No. 44, 1996

 

am. No. 11, 1997; No. 34, 2006; No. 106, 2010

s. 316...................

ad. No. 34, 2006

 

am. No. 34, 2006; No. 44, 2007

Heading to The Schedules .....

rep. No. 12, 1980

Heading to First Schedule......  

rep. No. 12, 1980

Schedule 1

 

Heading to Schedule 1 ........

ad. No. 12, 1980

Heading to Second
Schedule 

rep. No. 12, 1980

Heading to Schedule 2 ........

ad. No. 12, 1980

 

rep. No. 44, 1996

Schedule 2 ...............

rep. No. 44, 1996

Third, Fourth Schedules .......

rep. No. 12, 1980

 

Endnote 5—Uncommenced amendments [none]

Endnote 6—Modifications

Bankruptcy Regulations 1996 (No. 263, 1996)

Endnote 7—Misdescribed amendments [none]

Endnote 8—Miscellaneous [none]